Remove cleanups from check_fast_tracepoint_sals
[deliverable/binutils-gdb.git] / gdb / breakpoint.c
1 /* Everything about breakpoints, for GDB.
2
3 Copyright (C) 1986-2018 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
4
5 This file is part of GDB.
6
7 This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
8 it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
9 the Free Software Foundation; either version 3 of the License, or
10 (at your option) any later version.
11
12 This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
13 but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
14 MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
15 GNU General Public License for more details.
16
17 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
18 along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. */
19
20 #include "defs.h"
21 #include "arch-utils.h"
22 #include <ctype.h>
23 #include "hashtab.h"
24 #include "symtab.h"
25 #include "frame.h"
26 #include "breakpoint.h"
27 #include "tracepoint.h"
28 #include "gdbtypes.h"
29 #include "expression.h"
30 #include "gdbcore.h"
31 #include "gdbcmd.h"
32 #include "value.h"
33 #include "command.h"
34 #include "inferior.h"
35 #include "infrun.h"
36 #include "gdbthread.h"
37 #include "target.h"
38 #include "language.h"
39 #include "gdb-demangle.h"
40 #include "filenames.h"
41 #include "annotate.h"
42 #include "symfile.h"
43 #include "objfiles.h"
44 #include "source.h"
45 #include "linespec.h"
46 #include "completer.h"
47 #include "ui-out.h"
48 #include "cli/cli-script.h"
49 #include "block.h"
50 #include "solib.h"
51 #include "solist.h"
52 #include "observer.h"
53 #include "memattr.h"
54 #include "ada-lang.h"
55 #include "top.h"
56 #include "valprint.h"
57 #include "jit.h"
58 #include "parser-defs.h"
59 #include "gdb_regex.h"
60 #include "probe.h"
61 #include "cli/cli-utils.h"
62 #include "continuations.h"
63 #include "stack.h"
64 #include "skip.h"
65 #include "ax-gdb.h"
66 #include "dummy-frame.h"
67 #include "interps.h"
68 #include "format.h"
69 #include "thread-fsm.h"
70 #include "tid-parse.h"
71
72 /* readline include files */
73 #include "readline/readline.h"
74 #include "readline/history.h"
75
76 /* readline defines this. */
77 #undef savestring
78
79 #include "mi/mi-common.h"
80 #include "extension.h"
81 #include <algorithm>
82 #include "progspace-and-thread.h"
83 #include "common/array-view.h"
84 #include "common/gdb_optional.h"
85
86 /* Enums for exception-handling support. */
87 enum exception_event_kind
88 {
89 EX_EVENT_THROW,
90 EX_EVENT_RETHROW,
91 EX_EVENT_CATCH
92 };
93
94 /* Prototypes for local functions. */
95
96 static void map_breakpoint_numbers (const char *,
97 gdb::function_view<void (breakpoint *)>);
98
99 static void breakpoint_re_set_default (struct breakpoint *);
100
101 static void
102 create_sals_from_location_default (const struct event_location *location,
103 struct linespec_result *canonical,
104 enum bptype type_wanted);
105
106 static void create_breakpoints_sal_default (struct gdbarch *,
107 struct linespec_result *,
108 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char>,
109 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char>,
110 enum bptype,
111 enum bpdisp, int, int,
112 int,
113 const struct breakpoint_ops *,
114 int, int, int, unsigned);
115
116 static std::vector<symtab_and_line> decode_location_default
117 (struct breakpoint *b, const struct event_location *location,
118 struct program_space *search_pspace);
119
120 static int can_use_hardware_watchpoint (struct value *);
121
122 static void mention (struct breakpoint *);
123
124 static struct breakpoint *set_raw_breakpoint_without_location (struct gdbarch *,
125 enum bptype,
126 const struct breakpoint_ops *);
127 static struct bp_location *add_location_to_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *,
128 const struct symtab_and_line *);
129
130 /* This function is used in gdbtk sources and thus can not be made
131 static. */
132 struct breakpoint *set_raw_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
133 struct symtab_and_line,
134 enum bptype,
135 const struct breakpoint_ops *);
136
137 static struct breakpoint *
138 momentary_breakpoint_from_master (struct breakpoint *orig,
139 enum bptype type,
140 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops,
141 int loc_enabled);
142
143 static void breakpoint_adjustment_warning (CORE_ADDR, CORE_ADDR, int, int);
144
145 static CORE_ADDR adjust_breakpoint_address (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
146 CORE_ADDR bpaddr,
147 enum bptype bptype);
148
149 static void describe_other_breakpoints (struct gdbarch *,
150 struct program_space *, CORE_ADDR,
151 struct obj_section *, int);
152
153 static int watchpoint_locations_match (struct bp_location *loc1,
154 struct bp_location *loc2);
155
156 static int breakpoint_location_address_match (struct bp_location *bl,
157 const struct address_space *aspace,
158 CORE_ADDR addr);
159
160 static int breakpoint_location_address_range_overlap (struct bp_location *,
161 const address_space *,
162 CORE_ADDR, int);
163
164 static int remove_breakpoint (struct bp_location *);
165 static int remove_breakpoint_1 (struct bp_location *, enum remove_bp_reason);
166
167 static enum print_stop_action print_bp_stop_message (bpstat bs);
168
169 static int hw_breakpoint_used_count (void);
170
171 static int hw_watchpoint_use_count (struct breakpoint *);
172
173 static int hw_watchpoint_used_count_others (struct breakpoint *except,
174 enum bptype type,
175 int *other_type_used);
176
177 static void enable_breakpoint_disp (struct breakpoint *, enum bpdisp,
178 int count);
179
180 static void free_bp_location (struct bp_location *loc);
181 static void incref_bp_location (struct bp_location *loc);
182 static void decref_bp_location (struct bp_location **loc);
183
184 static struct bp_location *allocate_bp_location (struct breakpoint *bpt);
185
186 /* update_global_location_list's modes of operation wrt to whether to
187 insert locations now. */
188 enum ugll_insert_mode
189 {
190 /* Don't insert any breakpoint locations into the inferior, only
191 remove already-inserted locations that no longer should be
192 inserted. Functions that delete a breakpoint or breakpoints
193 should specify this mode, so that deleting a breakpoint doesn't
194 have the side effect of inserting the locations of other
195 breakpoints that are marked not-inserted, but should_be_inserted
196 returns true on them.
197
198 This behavior is useful is situations close to tear-down -- e.g.,
199 after an exec, while the target still has execution, but
200 breakpoint shadows of the previous executable image should *NOT*
201 be restored to the new image; or before detaching, where the
202 target still has execution and wants to delete breakpoints from
203 GDB's lists, and all breakpoints had already been removed from
204 the inferior. */
205 UGLL_DONT_INSERT,
206
207 /* May insert breakpoints iff breakpoints_should_be_inserted_now
208 claims breakpoints should be inserted now. */
209 UGLL_MAY_INSERT,
210
211 /* Insert locations now, irrespective of
212 breakpoints_should_be_inserted_now. E.g., say all threads are
213 stopped right now, and the user did "continue". We need to
214 insert breakpoints _before_ resuming the target, but
215 UGLL_MAY_INSERT wouldn't insert them, because
216 breakpoints_should_be_inserted_now returns false at that point,
217 as no thread is running yet. */
218 UGLL_INSERT
219 };
220
221 static void update_global_location_list (enum ugll_insert_mode);
222
223 static void update_global_location_list_nothrow (enum ugll_insert_mode);
224
225 static int is_hardware_watchpoint (const struct breakpoint *bpt);
226
227 static void insert_breakpoint_locations (void);
228
229 static void trace_pass_command (const char *, int);
230
231 static void set_tracepoint_count (int num);
232
233 static int is_masked_watchpoint (const struct breakpoint *b);
234
235 static struct bp_location **get_first_locp_gte_addr (CORE_ADDR address);
236
237 /* Return 1 if B refers to a static tracepoint set by marker ("-m"), zero
238 otherwise. */
239
240 static int strace_marker_p (struct breakpoint *b);
241
242 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be inherited by all breakpoint_ops
243 that are implemented on top of software or hardware breakpoints
244 (user breakpoints, internal and momentary breakpoints, etc.). */
245 static struct breakpoint_ops bkpt_base_breakpoint_ops;
246
247 /* Internal breakpoints class type. */
248 static struct breakpoint_ops internal_breakpoint_ops;
249
250 /* Momentary breakpoints class type. */
251 static struct breakpoint_ops momentary_breakpoint_ops;
252
253 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used in regular user created
254 breakpoints. */
255 struct breakpoint_ops bkpt_breakpoint_ops;
256
257 /* Breakpoints set on probes. */
258 static struct breakpoint_ops bkpt_probe_breakpoint_ops;
259
260 /* Dynamic printf class type. */
261 struct breakpoint_ops dprintf_breakpoint_ops;
262
263 /* The style in which to perform a dynamic printf. This is a user
264 option because different output options have different tradeoffs;
265 if GDB does the printing, there is better error handling if there
266 is a problem with any of the arguments, but using an inferior
267 function lets you have special-purpose printers and sending of
268 output to the same place as compiled-in print functions. */
269
270 static const char dprintf_style_gdb[] = "gdb";
271 static const char dprintf_style_call[] = "call";
272 static const char dprintf_style_agent[] = "agent";
273 static const char *const dprintf_style_enums[] = {
274 dprintf_style_gdb,
275 dprintf_style_call,
276 dprintf_style_agent,
277 NULL
278 };
279 static const char *dprintf_style = dprintf_style_gdb;
280
281 /* The function to use for dynamic printf if the preferred style is to
282 call into the inferior. The value is simply a string that is
283 copied into the command, so it can be anything that GDB can
284 evaluate to a callable address, not necessarily a function name. */
285
286 static char *dprintf_function;
287
288 /* The channel to use for dynamic printf if the preferred style is to
289 call into the inferior; if a nonempty string, it will be passed to
290 the call as the first argument, with the format string as the
291 second. As with the dprintf function, this can be anything that
292 GDB knows how to evaluate, so in addition to common choices like
293 "stderr", this could be an app-specific expression like
294 "mystreams[curlogger]". */
295
296 static char *dprintf_channel;
297
298 /* True if dprintf commands should continue to operate even if GDB
299 has disconnected. */
300 static int disconnected_dprintf = 1;
301
302 struct command_line *
303 breakpoint_commands (struct breakpoint *b)
304 {
305 return b->commands ? b->commands.get () : NULL;
306 }
307
308 /* Flag indicating that a command has proceeded the inferior past the
309 current breakpoint. */
310
311 static int breakpoint_proceeded;
312
313 const char *
314 bpdisp_text (enum bpdisp disp)
315 {
316 /* NOTE: the following values are a part of MI protocol and
317 represent values of 'disp' field returned when inferior stops at
318 a breakpoint. */
319 static const char * const bpdisps[] = {"del", "dstp", "dis", "keep"};
320
321 return bpdisps[(int) disp];
322 }
323
324 /* Prototypes for exported functions. */
325 /* If FALSE, gdb will not use hardware support for watchpoints, even
326 if such is available. */
327 static int can_use_hw_watchpoints;
328
329 static void
330 show_can_use_hw_watchpoints (struct ui_file *file, int from_tty,
331 struct cmd_list_element *c,
332 const char *value)
333 {
334 fprintf_filtered (file,
335 _("Debugger's willingness to use "
336 "watchpoint hardware is %s.\n"),
337 value);
338 }
339
340 /* If AUTO_BOOLEAN_FALSE, gdb will not attempt to create pending breakpoints.
341 If AUTO_BOOLEAN_TRUE, gdb will automatically create pending breakpoints
342 for unrecognized breakpoint locations.
343 If AUTO_BOOLEAN_AUTO, gdb will query when breakpoints are unrecognized. */
344 static enum auto_boolean pending_break_support;
345 static void
346 show_pending_break_support (struct ui_file *file, int from_tty,
347 struct cmd_list_element *c,
348 const char *value)
349 {
350 fprintf_filtered (file,
351 _("Debugger's behavior regarding "
352 "pending breakpoints is %s.\n"),
353 value);
354 }
355
356 /* If 1, gdb will automatically use hardware breakpoints for breakpoints
357 set with "break" but falling in read-only memory.
358 If 0, gdb will warn about such breakpoints, but won't automatically
359 use hardware breakpoints. */
360 static int automatic_hardware_breakpoints;
361 static void
362 show_automatic_hardware_breakpoints (struct ui_file *file, int from_tty,
363 struct cmd_list_element *c,
364 const char *value)
365 {
366 fprintf_filtered (file,
367 _("Automatic usage of hardware breakpoints is %s.\n"),
368 value);
369 }
370
371 /* If on, GDB keeps breakpoints inserted even if the inferior is
372 stopped, and immediately inserts any new breakpoints as soon as
373 they're created. If off (default), GDB keeps breakpoints off of
374 the target as long as possible. That is, it delays inserting
375 breakpoints until the next resume, and removes them again when the
376 target fully stops. This is a bit safer in case GDB crashes while
377 processing user input. */
378 static int always_inserted_mode = 0;
379
380 static void
381 show_always_inserted_mode (struct ui_file *file, int from_tty,
382 struct cmd_list_element *c, const char *value)
383 {
384 fprintf_filtered (file, _("Always inserted breakpoint mode is %s.\n"),
385 value);
386 }
387
388 /* See breakpoint.h. */
389
390 int
391 breakpoints_should_be_inserted_now (void)
392 {
393 if (gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch ()))
394 {
395 /* If breakpoints are global, they should be inserted even if no
396 thread under gdb's control is running, or even if there are
397 no threads under GDB's control yet. */
398 return 1;
399 }
400 else if (target_has_execution)
401 {
402 struct thread_info *tp;
403
404 if (always_inserted_mode)
405 {
406 /* The user wants breakpoints inserted even if all threads
407 are stopped. */
408 return 1;
409 }
410
411 if (threads_are_executing ())
412 return 1;
413
414 /* Don't remove breakpoints yet if, even though all threads are
415 stopped, we still have events to process. */
416 ALL_NON_EXITED_THREADS (tp)
417 if (tp->resumed
418 && tp->suspend.waitstatus_pending_p)
419 return 1;
420 }
421 return 0;
422 }
423
424 static const char condition_evaluation_both[] = "host or target";
425
426 /* Modes for breakpoint condition evaluation. */
427 static const char condition_evaluation_auto[] = "auto";
428 static const char condition_evaluation_host[] = "host";
429 static const char condition_evaluation_target[] = "target";
430 static const char *const condition_evaluation_enums[] = {
431 condition_evaluation_auto,
432 condition_evaluation_host,
433 condition_evaluation_target,
434 NULL
435 };
436
437 /* Global that holds the current mode for breakpoint condition evaluation. */
438 static const char *condition_evaluation_mode_1 = condition_evaluation_auto;
439
440 /* Global that we use to display information to the user (gets its value from
441 condition_evaluation_mode_1. */
442 static const char *condition_evaluation_mode = condition_evaluation_auto;
443
444 /* Translate a condition evaluation mode MODE into either "host"
445 or "target". This is used mostly to translate from "auto" to the
446 real setting that is being used. It returns the translated
447 evaluation mode. */
448
449 static const char *
450 translate_condition_evaluation_mode (const char *mode)
451 {
452 if (mode == condition_evaluation_auto)
453 {
454 if (target_supports_evaluation_of_breakpoint_conditions ())
455 return condition_evaluation_target;
456 else
457 return condition_evaluation_host;
458 }
459 else
460 return mode;
461 }
462
463 /* Discovers what condition_evaluation_auto translates to. */
464
465 static const char *
466 breakpoint_condition_evaluation_mode (void)
467 {
468 return translate_condition_evaluation_mode (condition_evaluation_mode);
469 }
470
471 /* Return true if GDB should evaluate breakpoint conditions or false
472 otherwise. */
473
474 static int
475 gdb_evaluates_breakpoint_condition_p (void)
476 {
477 const char *mode = breakpoint_condition_evaluation_mode ();
478
479 return (mode == condition_evaluation_host);
480 }
481
482 /* Are we executing breakpoint commands? */
483 static int executing_breakpoint_commands;
484
485 /* Are overlay event breakpoints enabled? */
486 static int overlay_events_enabled;
487
488 /* See description in breakpoint.h. */
489 int target_exact_watchpoints = 0;
490
491 /* Walk the following statement or block through all breakpoints.
492 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE does so even if the statement deletes the
493 current breakpoint. */
494
495 #define ALL_BREAKPOINTS(B) for (B = breakpoint_chain; B; B = B->next)
496
497 #define ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE(B,TMP) \
498 for (B = breakpoint_chain; \
499 B ? (TMP=B->next, 1): 0; \
500 B = TMP)
501
502 /* Similar iterator for the low-level breakpoints. SAFE variant is
503 not provided so update_global_location_list must not be called
504 while executing the block of ALL_BP_LOCATIONS. */
505
506 #define ALL_BP_LOCATIONS(B,BP_TMP) \
507 for (BP_TMP = bp_locations; \
508 BP_TMP < bp_locations + bp_locations_count && (B = *BP_TMP);\
509 BP_TMP++)
510
511 /* Iterates through locations with address ADDRESS for the currently selected
512 program space. BP_LOCP_TMP points to each object. BP_LOCP_START points
513 to where the loop should start from.
514 If BP_LOCP_START is a NULL pointer, the macro automatically seeks the
515 appropriate location to start with. */
516
517 #define ALL_BP_LOCATIONS_AT_ADDR(BP_LOCP_TMP, BP_LOCP_START, ADDRESS) \
518 for (BP_LOCP_START = BP_LOCP_START == NULL ? get_first_locp_gte_addr (ADDRESS) : BP_LOCP_START, \
519 BP_LOCP_TMP = BP_LOCP_START; \
520 BP_LOCP_START \
521 && (BP_LOCP_TMP < bp_locations + bp_locations_count \
522 && (*BP_LOCP_TMP)->address == ADDRESS); \
523 BP_LOCP_TMP++)
524
525 /* Iterator for tracepoints only. */
526
527 #define ALL_TRACEPOINTS(B) \
528 for (B = breakpoint_chain; B; B = B->next) \
529 if (is_tracepoint (B))
530
531 /* Chains of all breakpoints defined. */
532
533 struct breakpoint *breakpoint_chain;
534
535 /* Array is sorted by bp_locations_compare - primarily by the ADDRESS. */
536
537 static struct bp_location **bp_locations;
538
539 /* Number of elements of BP_LOCATIONS. */
540
541 static unsigned bp_locations_count;
542
543 /* Maximum alignment offset between bp_target_info.PLACED_ADDRESS and
544 ADDRESS for the current elements of BP_LOCATIONS which get a valid
545 result from bp_location_has_shadow. You can use it for roughly
546 limiting the subrange of BP_LOCATIONS to scan for shadow bytes for
547 an address you need to read. */
548
549 static CORE_ADDR bp_locations_placed_address_before_address_max;
550
551 /* Maximum offset plus alignment between bp_target_info.PLACED_ADDRESS
552 + bp_target_info.SHADOW_LEN and ADDRESS for the current elements of
553 BP_LOCATIONS which get a valid result from bp_location_has_shadow.
554 You can use it for roughly limiting the subrange of BP_LOCATIONS to
555 scan for shadow bytes for an address you need to read. */
556
557 static CORE_ADDR bp_locations_shadow_len_after_address_max;
558
559 /* The locations that no longer correspond to any breakpoint, unlinked
560 from the bp_locations array, but for which a hit may still be
561 reported by a target. */
562 VEC(bp_location_p) *moribund_locations = NULL;
563
564 /* Number of last breakpoint made. */
565
566 static int breakpoint_count;
567
568 /* The value of `breakpoint_count' before the last command that
569 created breakpoints. If the last (break-like) command created more
570 than one breakpoint, then the difference between BREAKPOINT_COUNT
571 and PREV_BREAKPOINT_COUNT is more than one. */
572 static int prev_breakpoint_count;
573
574 /* Number of last tracepoint made. */
575
576 static int tracepoint_count;
577
578 static struct cmd_list_element *breakpoint_set_cmdlist;
579 static struct cmd_list_element *breakpoint_show_cmdlist;
580 struct cmd_list_element *save_cmdlist;
581
582 /* See declaration at breakpoint.h. */
583
584 struct breakpoint *
585 breakpoint_find_if (int (*func) (struct breakpoint *b, void *d),
586 void *user_data)
587 {
588 struct breakpoint *b = NULL;
589
590 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
591 {
592 if (func (b, user_data) != 0)
593 break;
594 }
595
596 return b;
597 }
598
599 /* Return whether a breakpoint is an active enabled breakpoint. */
600 static int
601 breakpoint_enabled (struct breakpoint *b)
602 {
603 return (b->enable_state == bp_enabled);
604 }
605
606 /* Set breakpoint count to NUM. */
607
608 static void
609 set_breakpoint_count (int num)
610 {
611 prev_breakpoint_count = breakpoint_count;
612 breakpoint_count = num;
613 set_internalvar_integer (lookup_internalvar ("bpnum"), num);
614 }
615
616 /* Used by `start_rbreak_breakpoints' below, to record the current
617 breakpoint count before "rbreak" creates any breakpoint. */
618 static int rbreak_start_breakpoint_count;
619
620 /* Called at the start an "rbreak" command to record the first
621 breakpoint made. */
622
623 scoped_rbreak_breakpoints::scoped_rbreak_breakpoints ()
624 {
625 rbreak_start_breakpoint_count = breakpoint_count;
626 }
627
628 /* Called at the end of an "rbreak" command to record the last
629 breakpoint made. */
630
631 scoped_rbreak_breakpoints::~scoped_rbreak_breakpoints ()
632 {
633 prev_breakpoint_count = rbreak_start_breakpoint_count;
634 }
635
636 /* Used in run_command to zero the hit count when a new run starts. */
637
638 void
639 clear_breakpoint_hit_counts (void)
640 {
641 struct breakpoint *b;
642
643 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
644 b->hit_count = 0;
645 }
646
647 \f
648 /* Return the breakpoint with the specified number, or NULL
649 if the number does not refer to an existing breakpoint. */
650
651 struct breakpoint *
652 get_breakpoint (int num)
653 {
654 struct breakpoint *b;
655
656 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
657 if (b->number == num)
658 return b;
659
660 return NULL;
661 }
662
663 \f
664
665 /* Mark locations as "conditions have changed" in case the target supports
666 evaluating conditions on its side. */
667
668 static void
669 mark_breakpoint_modified (struct breakpoint *b)
670 {
671 struct bp_location *loc;
672
673 /* This is only meaningful if the target is
674 evaluating conditions and if the user has
675 opted for condition evaluation on the target's
676 side. */
677 if (gdb_evaluates_breakpoint_condition_p ()
678 || !target_supports_evaluation_of_breakpoint_conditions ())
679 return;
680
681 if (!is_breakpoint (b))
682 return;
683
684 for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
685 loc->condition_changed = condition_modified;
686 }
687
688 /* Mark location as "conditions have changed" in case the target supports
689 evaluating conditions on its side. */
690
691 static void
692 mark_breakpoint_location_modified (struct bp_location *loc)
693 {
694 /* This is only meaningful if the target is
695 evaluating conditions and if the user has
696 opted for condition evaluation on the target's
697 side. */
698 if (gdb_evaluates_breakpoint_condition_p ()
699 || !target_supports_evaluation_of_breakpoint_conditions ())
700
701 return;
702
703 if (!is_breakpoint (loc->owner))
704 return;
705
706 loc->condition_changed = condition_modified;
707 }
708
709 /* Sets the condition-evaluation mode using the static global
710 condition_evaluation_mode. */
711
712 static void
713 set_condition_evaluation_mode (const char *args, int from_tty,
714 struct cmd_list_element *c)
715 {
716 const char *old_mode, *new_mode;
717
718 if ((condition_evaluation_mode_1 == condition_evaluation_target)
719 && !target_supports_evaluation_of_breakpoint_conditions ())
720 {
721 condition_evaluation_mode_1 = condition_evaluation_mode;
722 warning (_("Target does not support breakpoint condition evaluation.\n"
723 "Using host evaluation mode instead."));
724 return;
725 }
726
727 new_mode = translate_condition_evaluation_mode (condition_evaluation_mode_1);
728 old_mode = translate_condition_evaluation_mode (condition_evaluation_mode);
729
730 /* Flip the switch. Flip it even if OLD_MODE == NEW_MODE as one of the
731 settings was "auto". */
732 condition_evaluation_mode = condition_evaluation_mode_1;
733
734 /* Only update the mode if the user picked a different one. */
735 if (new_mode != old_mode)
736 {
737 struct bp_location *loc, **loc_tmp;
738 /* If the user switched to a different evaluation mode, we
739 need to synch the changes with the target as follows:
740
741 "host" -> "target": Send all (valid) conditions to the target.
742 "target" -> "host": Remove all the conditions from the target.
743 */
744
745 if (new_mode == condition_evaluation_target)
746 {
747 /* Mark everything modified and synch conditions with the
748 target. */
749 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (loc, loc_tmp)
750 mark_breakpoint_location_modified (loc);
751 }
752 else
753 {
754 /* Manually mark non-duplicate locations to synch conditions
755 with the target. We do this to remove all the conditions the
756 target knows about. */
757 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (loc, loc_tmp)
758 if (is_breakpoint (loc->owner) && loc->inserted)
759 loc->needs_update = 1;
760 }
761
762 /* Do the update. */
763 update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
764 }
765
766 return;
767 }
768
769 /* Shows the current mode of breakpoint condition evaluation. Explicitly shows
770 what "auto" is translating to. */
771
772 static void
773 show_condition_evaluation_mode (struct ui_file *file, int from_tty,
774 struct cmd_list_element *c, const char *value)
775 {
776 if (condition_evaluation_mode == condition_evaluation_auto)
777 fprintf_filtered (file,
778 _("Breakpoint condition evaluation "
779 "mode is %s (currently %s).\n"),
780 value,
781 breakpoint_condition_evaluation_mode ());
782 else
783 fprintf_filtered (file, _("Breakpoint condition evaluation mode is %s.\n"),
784 value);
785 }
786
787 /* A comparison function for bp_location AP and BP that is used by
788 bsearch. This comparison function only cares about addresses, unlike
789 the more general bp_locations_compare function. */
790
791 static int
792 bp_locations_compare_addrs (const void *ap, const void *bp)
793 {
794 const struct bp_location *a = *(const struct bp_location **) ap;
795 const struct bp_location *b = *(const struct bp_location **) bp;
796
797 if (a->address == b->address)
798 return 0;
799 else
800 return ((a->address > b->address) - (a->address < b->address));
801 }
802
803 /* Helper function to skip all bp_locations with addresses
804 less than ADDRESS. It returns the first bp_location that
805 is greater than or equal to ADDRESS. If none is found, just
806 return NULL. */
807
808 static struct bp_location **
809 get_first_locp_gte_addr (CORE_ADDR address)
810 {
811 struct bp_location dummy_loc;
812 struct bp_location *dummy_locp = &dummy_loc;
813 struct bp_location **locp_found = NULL;
814
815 /* Initialize the dummy location's address field. */
816 dummy_loc.address = address;
817
818 /* Find a close match to the first location at ADDRESS. */
819 locp_found = ((struct bp_location **)
820 bsearch (&dummy_locp, bp_locations, bp_locations_count,
821 sizeof (struct bp_location **),
822 bp_locations_compare_addrs));
823
824 /* Nothing was found, nothing left to do. */
825 if (locp_found == NULL)
826 return NULL;
827
828 /* We may have found a location that is at ADDRESS but is not the first in the
829 location's list. Go backwards (if possible) and locate the first one. */
830 while ((locp_found - 1) >= bp_locations
831 && (*(locp_found - 1))->address == address)
832 locp_found--;
833
834 return locp_found;
835 }
836
837 void
838 set_breakpoint_condition (struct breakpoint *b, const char *exp,
839 int from_tty)
840 {
841 xfree (b->cond_string);
842 b->cond_string = NULL;
843
844 if (is_watchpoint (b))
845 {
846 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
847
848 w->cond_exp.reset ();
849 }
850 else
851 {
852 struct bp_location *loc;
853
854 for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
855 {
856 loc->cond.reset ();
857
858 /* No need to free the condition agent expression
859 bytecode (if we have one). We will handle this
860 when we go through update_global_location_list. */
861 }
862 }
863
864 if (*exp == 0)
865 {
866 if (from_tty)
867 printf_filtered (_("Breakpoint %d now unconditional.\n"), b->number);
868 }
869 else
870 {
871 const char *arg = exp;
872
873 /* I don't know if it matters whether this is the string the user
874 typed in or the decompiled expression. */
875 b->cond_string = xstrdup (arg);
876 b->condition_not_parsed = 0;
877
878 if (is_watchpoint (b))
879 {
880 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
881
882 innermost_block.reset ();
883 arg = exp;
884 w->cond_exp = parse_exp_1 (&arg, 0, 0, 0);
885 if (*arg)
886 error (_("Junk at end of expression"));
887 w->cond_exp_valid_block = innermost_block.block ();
888 }
889 else
890 {
891 struct bp_location *loc;
892
893 for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
894 {
895 arg = exp;
896 loc->cond =
897 parse_exp_1 (&arg, loc->address,
898 block_for_pc (loc->address), 0);
899 if (*arg)
900 error (_("Junk at end of expression"));
901 }
902 }
903 }
904 mark_breakpoint_modified (b);
905
906 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (b);
907 }
908
909 /* Completion for the "condition" command. */
910
911 static void
912 condition_completer (struct cmd_list_element *cmd,
913 completion_tracker &tracker,
914 const char *text, const char *word)
915 {
916 const char *space;
917
918 text = skip_spaces (text);
919 space = skip_to_space (text);
920 if (*space == '\0')
921 {
922 int len;
923 struct breakpoint *b;
924
925 if (text[0] == '$')
926 {
927 /* We don't support completion of history indices. */
928 if (!isdigit (text[1]))
929 complete_internalvar (tracker, &text[1]);
930 return;
931 }
932
933 /* We're completing the breakpoint number. */
934 len = strlen (text);
935
936 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
937 {
938 char number[50];
939
940 xsnprintf (number, sizeof (number), "%d", b->number);
941
942 if (strncmp (number, text, len) == 0)
943 {
944 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> copy (xstrdup (number));
945 tracker.add_completion (std::move (copy));
946 }
947 }
948
949 return;
950 }
951
952 /* We're completing the expression part. */
953 text = skip_spaces (space);
954 expression_completer (cmd, tracker, text, word);
955 }
956
957 /* condition N EXP -- set break condition of breakpoint N to EXP. */
958
959 static void
960 condition_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
961 {
962 struct breakpoint *b;
963 const char *p;
964 int bnum;
965
966 if (arg == 0)
967 error_no_arg (_("breakpoint number"));
968
969 p = arg;
970 bnum = get_number (&p);
971 if (bnum == 0)
972 error (_("Bad breakpoint argument: '%s'"), arg);
973
974 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
975 if (b->number == bnum)
976 {
977 /* Check if this breakpoint has a "stop" method implemented in an
978 extension language. This method and conditions entered into GDB
979 from the CLI are mutually exclusive. */
980 const struct extension_language_defn *extlang
981 = get_breakpoint_cond_ext_lang (b, EXT_LANG_NONE);
982
983 if (extlang != NULL)
984 {
985 error (_("Only one stop condition allowed. There is currently"
986 " a %s stop condition defined for this breakpoint."),
987 ext_lang_capitalized_name (extlang));
988 }
989 set_breakpoint_condition (b, p, from_tty);
990
991 if (is_breakpoint (b))
992 update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
993
994 return;
995 }
996
997 error (_("No breakpoint number %d."), bnum);
998 }
999
1000 /* Check that COMMAND do not contain commands that are suitable
1001 only for tracepoints and not suitable for ordinary breakpoints.
1002 Throw if any such commands is found. */
1003
1004 static void
1005 check_no_tracepoint_commands (struct command_line *commands)
1006 {
1007 struct command_line *c;
1008
1009 for (c = commands; c; c = c->next)
1010 {
1011 int i;
1012
1013 if (c->control_type == while_stepping_control)
1014 error (_("The 'while-stepping' command can "
1015 "only be used for tracepoints"));
1016
1017 for (i = 0; i < c->body_count; ++i)
1018 check_no_tracepoint_commands ((c->body_list)[i]);
1019
1020 /* Not that command parsing removes leading whitespace and comment
1021 lines and also empty lines. So, we only need to check for
1022 command directly. */
1023 if (strstr (c->line, "collect ") == c->line)
1024 error (_("The 'collect' command can only be used for tracepoints"));
1025
1026 if (strstr (c->line, "teval ") == c->line)
1027 error (_("The 'teval' command can only be used for tracepoints"));
1028 }
1029 }
1030
1031 struct longjmp_breakpoint : public breakpoint
1032 {
1033 ~longjmp_breakpoint () override;
1034 };
1035
1036 /* Encapsulate tests for different types of tracepoints. */
1037
1038 static bool
1039 is_tracepoint_type (bptype type)
1040 {
1041 return (type == bp_tracepoint
1042 || type == bp_fast_tracepoint
1043 || type == bp_static_tracepoint);
1044 }
1045
1046 static bool
1047 is_longjmp_type (bptype type)
1048 {
1049 return type == bp_longjmp || type == bp_exception;
1050 }
1051
1052 int
1053 is_tracepoint (const struct breakpoint *b)
1054 {
1055 return is_tracepoint_type (b->type);
1056 }
1057
1058 /* Factory function to create an appropriate instance of breakpoint given
1059 TYPE. */
1060
1061 static std::unique_ptr<breakpoint>
1062 new_breakpoint_from_type (bptype type)
1063 {
1064 breakpoint *b;
1065
1066 if (is_tracepoint_type (type))
1067 b = new tracepoint ();
1068 else if (is_longjmp_type (type))
1069 b = new longjmp_breakpoint ();
1070 else
1071 b = new breakpoint ();
1072
1073 return std::unique_ptr<breakpoint> (b);
1074 }
1075
1076 /* A helper function that validates that COMMANDS are valid for a
1077 breakpoint. This function will throw an exception if a problem is
1078 found. */
1079
1080 static void
1081 validate_commands_for_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b,
1082 struct command_line *commands)
1083 {
1084 if (is_tracepoint (b))
1085 {
1086 struct tracepoint *t = (struct tracepoint *) b;
1087 struct command_line *c;
1088 struct command_line *while_stepping = 0;
1089
1090 /* Reset the while-stepping step count. The previous commands
1091 might have included a while-stepping action, while the new
1092 ones might not. */
1093 t->step_count = 0;
1094
1095 /* We need to verify that each top-level element of commands is
1096 valid for tracepoints, that there's at most one
1097 while-stepping element, and that the while-stepping's body
1098 has valid tracing commands excluding nested while-stepping.
1099 We also need to validate the tracepoint action line in the
1100 context of the tracepoint --- validate_actionline actually
1101 has side effects, like setting the tracepoint's
1102 while-stepping STEP_COUNT, in addition to checking if the
1103 collect/teval actions parse and make sense in the
1104 tracepoint's context. */
1105 for (c = commands; c; c = c->next)
1106 {
1107 if (c->control_type == while_stepping_control)
1108 {
1109 if (b->type == bp_fast_tracepoint)
1110 error (_("The 'while-stepping' command "
1111 "cannot be used for fast tracepoint"));
1112 else if (b->type == bp_static_tracepoint)
1113 error (_("The 'while-stepping' command "
1114 "cannot be used for static tracepoint"));
1115
1116 if (while_stepping)
1117 error (_("The 'while-stepping' command "
1118 "can be used only once"));
1119 else
1120 while_stepping = c;
1121 }
1122
1123 validate_actionline (c->line, b);
1124 }
1125 if (while_stepping)
1126 {
1127 struct command_line *c2;
1128
1129 gdb_assert (while_stepping->body_count == 1);
1130 c2 = while_stepping->body_list[0];
1131 for (; c2; c2 = c2->next)
1132 {
1133 if (c2->control_type == while_stepping_control)
1134 error (_("The 'while-stepping' command cannot be nested"));
1135 }
1136 }
1137 }
1138 else
1139 {
1140 check_no_tracepoint_commands (commands);
1141 }
1142 }
1143
1144 /* Return a vector of all the static tracepoints set at ADDR. The
1145 caller is responsible for releasing the vector. */
1146
1147 VEC(breakpoint_p) *
1148 static_tracepoints_here (CORE_ADDR addr)
1149 {
1150 struct breakpoint *b;
1151 VEC(breakpoint_p) *found = 0;
1152 struct bp_location *loc;
1153
1154 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
1155 if (b->type == bp_static_tracepoint)
1156 {
1157 for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
1158 if (loc->address == addr)
1159 VEC_safe_push(breakpoint_p, found, b);
1160 }
1161
1162 return found;
1163 }
1164
1165 /* Set the command list of B to COMMANDS. If breakpoint is tracepoint,
1166 validate that only allowed commands are included. */
1167
1168 void
1169 breakpoint_set_commands (struct breakpoint *b,
1170 command_line_up &&commands)
1171 {
1172 validate_commands_for_breakpoint (b, commands.get ());
1173
1174 b->commands = std::move (commands);
1175 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (b);
1176 }
1177
1178 /* Set the internal `silent' flag on the breakpoint. Note that this
1179 is not the same as the "silent" that may appear in the breakpoint's
1180 commands. */
1181
1182 void
1183 breakpoint_set_silent (struct breakpoint *b, int silent)
1184 {
1185 int old_silent = b->silent;
1186
1187 b->silent = silent;
1188 if (old_silent != silent)
1189 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (b);
1190 }
1191
1192 /* Set the thread for this breakpoint. If THREAD is -1, make the
1193 breakpoint work for any thread. */
1194
1195 void
1196 breakpoint_set_thread (struct breakpoint *b, int thread)
1197 {
1198 int old_thread = b->thread;
1199
1200 b->thread = thread;
1201 if (old_thread != thread)
1202 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (b);
1203 }
1204
1205 /* Set the task for this breakpoint. If TASK is 0, make the
1206 breakpoint work for any task. */
1207
1208 void
1209 breakpoint_set_task (struct breakpoint *b, int task)
1210 {
1211 int old_task = b->task;
1212
1213 b->task = task;
1214 if (old_task != task)
1215 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (b);
1216 }
1217
1218 void
1219 check_tracepoint_command (char *line, void *closure)
1220 {
1221 struct breakpoint *b = (struct breakpoint *) closure;
1222
1223 validate_actionline (line, b);
1224 }
1225
1226 static void
1227 commands_command_1 (const char *arg, int from_tty,
1228 struct command_line *control)
1229 {
1230 counted_command_line cmd;
1231
1232 std::string new_arg;
1233
1234 if (arg == NULL || !*arg)
1235 {
1236 if (breakpoint_count - prev_breakpoint_count > 1)
1237 new_arg = string_printf ("%d-%d", prev_breakpoint_count + 1,
1238 breakpoint_count);
1239 else if (breakpoint_count > 0)
1240 new_arg = string_printf ("%d", breakpoint_count);
1241 arg = new_arg.c_str ();
1242 }
1243
1244 map_breakpoint_numbers
1245 (arg, [&] (breakpoint *b)
1246 {
1247 if (cmd == NULL)
1248 {
1249 if (control != NULL)
1250 cmd = copy_command_lines (control->body_list[0]);
1251 else
1252 {
1253 std::string str
1254 = string_printf (_("Type commands for breakpoint(s) "
1255 "%s, one per line."),
1256 arg);
1257
1258 cmd = read_command_lines (&str[0],
1259 from_tty, 1,
1260 (is_tracepoint (b)
1261 ? check_tracepoint_command : 0),
1262 b);
1263 }
1264 }
1265
1266 /* If a breakpoint was on the list more than once, we don't need to
1267 do anything. */
1268 if (b->commands != cmd)
1269 {
1270 validate_commands_for_breakpoint (b, cmd.get ());
1271 b->commands = cmd;
1272 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (b);
1273 }
1274 });
1275 }
1276
1277 static void
1278 commands_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
1279 {
1280 commands_command_1 (arg, from_tty, NULL);
1281 }
1282
1283 /* Like commands_command, but instead of reading the commands from
1284 input stream, takes them from an already parsed command structure.
1285
1286 This is used by cli-script.c to DTRT with breakpoint commands
1287 that are part of if and while bodies. */
1288 enum command_control_type
1289 commands_from_control_command (const char *arg, struct command_line *cmd)
1290 {
1291 commands_command_1 (arg, 0, cmd);
1292 return simple_control;
1293 }
1294
1295 /* Return non-zero if BL->TARGET_INFO contains valid information. */
1296
1297 static int
1298 bp_location_has_shadow (struct bp_location *bl)
1299 {
1300 if (bl->loc_type != bp_loc_software_breakpoint)
1301 return 0;
1302 if (!bl->inserted)
1303 return 0;
1304 if (bl->target_info.shadow_len == 0)
1305 /* BL isn't valid, or doesn't shadow memory. */
1306 return 0;
1307 return 1;
1308 }
1309
1310 /* Update BUF, which is LEN bytes read from the target address
1311 MEMADDR, by replacing a memory breakpoint with its shadowed
1312 contents.
1313
1314 If READBUF is not NULL, this buffer must not overlap with the of
1315 the breakpoint location's shadow_contents buffer. Otherwise, a
1316 failed assertion internal error will be raised. */
1317
1318 static void
1319 one_breakpoint_xfer_memory (gdb_byte *readbuf, gdb_byte *writebuf,
1320 const gdb_byte *writebuf_org,
1321 ULONGEST memaddr, LONGEST len,
1322 struct bp_target_info *target_info,
1323 struct gdbarch *gdbarch)
1324 {
1325 /* Now do full processing of the found relevant range of elements. */
1326 CORE_ADDR bp_addr = 0;
1327 int bp_size = 0;
1328 int bptoffset = 0;
1329
1330 if (!breakpoint_address_match (target_info->placed_address_space, 0,
1331 current_program_space->aspace, 0))
1332 {
1333 /* The breakpoint is inserted in a different address space. */
1334 return;
1335 }
1336
1337 /* Addresses and length of the part of the breakpoint that
1338 we need to copy. */
1339 bp_addr = target_info->placed_address;
1340 bp_size = target_info->shadow_len;
1341
1342 if (bp_addr + bp_size <= memaddr)
1343 {
1344 /* The breakpoint is entirely before the chunk of memory we are
1345 reading. */
1346 return;
1347 }
1348
1349 if (bp_addr >= memaddr + len)
1350 {
1351 /* The breakpoint is entirely after the chunk of memory we are
1352 reading. */
1353 return;
1354 }
1355
1356 /* Offset within shadow_contents. */
1357 if (bp_addr < memaddr)
1358 {
1359 /* Only copy the second part of the breakpoint. */
1360 bp_size -= memaddr - bp_addr;
1361 bptoffset = memaddr - bp_addr;
1362 bp_addr = memaddr;
1363 }
1364
1365 if (bp_addr + bp_size > memaddr + len)
1366 {
1367 /* Only copy the first part of the breakpoint. */
1368 bp_size -= (bp_addr + bp_size) - (memaddr + len);
1369 }
1370
1371 if (readbuf != NULL)
1372 {
1373 /* Verify that the readbuf buffer does not overlap with the
1374 shadow_contents buffer. */
1375 gdb_assert (target_info->shadow_contents >= readbuf + len
1376 || readbuf >= (target_info->shadow_contents
1377 + target_info->shadow_len));
1378
1379 /* Update the read buffer with this inserted breakpoint's
1380 shadow. */
1381 memcpy (readbuf + bp_addr - memaddr,
1382 target_info->shadow_contents + bptoffset, bp_size);
1383 }
1384 else
1385 {
1386 const unsigned char *bp;
1387 CORE_ADDR addr = target_info->reqstd_address;
1388 int placed_size;
1389
1390 /* Update the shadow with what we want to write to memory. */
1391 memcpy (target_info->shadow_contents + bptoffset,
1392 writebuf_org + bp_addr - memaddr, bp_size);
1393
1394 /* Determine appropriate breakpoint contents and size for this
1395 address. */
1396 bp = gdbarch_breakpoint_from_pc (gdbarch, &addr, &placed_size);
1397
1398 /* Update the final write buffer with this inserted
1399 breakpoint's INSN. */
1400 memcpy (writebuf + bp_addr - memaddr, bp + bptoffset, bp_size);
1401 }
1402 }
1403
1404 /* Update BUF, which is LEN bytes read from the target address MEMADDR,
1405 by replacing any memory breakpoints with their shadowed contents.
1406
1407 If READBUF is not NULL, this buffer must not overlap with any of
1408 the breakpoint location's shadow_contents buffers. Otherwise,
1409 a failed assertion internal error will be raised.
1410
1411 The range of shadowed area by each bp_location is:
1412 bl->address - bp_locations_placed_address_before_address_max
1413 up to bl->address + bp_locations_shadow_len_after_address_max
1414 The range we were requested to resolve shadows for is:
1415 memaddr ... memaddr + len
1416 Thus the safe cutoff boundaries for performance optimization are
1417 memaddr + len <= (bl->address
1418 - bp_locations_placed_address_before_address_max)
1419 and:
1420 bl->address + bp_locations_shadow_len_after_address_max <= memaddr */
1421
1422 void
1423 breakpoint_xfer_memory (gdb_byte *readbuf, gdb_byte *writebuf,
1424 const gdb_byte *writebuf_org,
1425 ULONGEST memaddr, LONGEST len)
1426 {
1427 /* Left boundary, right boundary and median element of our binary
1428 search. */
1429 unsigned bc_l, bc_r, bc;
1430
1431 /* Find BC_L which is a leftmost element which may affect BUF
1432 content. It is safe to report lower value but a failure to
1433 report higher one. */
1434
1435 bc_l = 0;
1436 bc_r = bp_locations_count;
1437 while (bc_l + 1 < bc_r)
1438 {
1439 struct bp_location *bl;
1440
1441 bc = (bc_l + bc_r) / 2;
1442 bl = bp_locations[bc];
1443
1444 /* Check first BL->ADDRESS will not overflow due to the added
1445 constant. Then advance the left boundary only if we are sure
1446 the BC element can in no way affect the BUF content (MEMADDR
1447 to MEMADDR + LEN range).
1448
1449 Use the BP_LOCATIONS_SHADOW_LEN_AFTER_ADDRESS_MAX safety
1450 offset so that we cannot miss a breakpoint with its shadow
1451 range tail still reaching MEMADDR. */
1452
1453 if ((bl->address + bp_locations_shadow_len_after_address_max
1454 >= bl->address)
1455 && (bl->address + bp_locations_shadow_len_after_address_max
1456 <= memaddr))
1457 bc_l = bc;
1458 else
1459 bc_r = bc;
1460 }
1461
1462 /* Due to the binary search above, we need to make sure we pick the
1463 first location that's at BC_L's address. E.g., if there are
1464 multiple locations at the same address, BC_L may end up pointing
1465 at a duplicate location, and miss the "master"/"inserted"
1466 location. Say, given locations L1, L2 and L3 at addresses A and
1467 B:
1468
1469 L1@A, L2@A, L3@B, ...
1470
1471 BC_L could end up pointing at location L2, while the "master"
1472 location could be L1. Since the `loc->inserted' flag is only set
1473 on "master" locations, we'd forget to restore the shadow of L1
1474 and L2. */
1475 while (bc_l > 0
1476 && bp_locations[bc_l]->address == bp_locations[bc_l - 1]->address)
1477 bc_l--;
1478
1479 /* Now do full processing of the found relevant range of elements. */
1480
1481 for (bc = bc_l; bc < bp_locations_count; bc++)
1482 {
1483 struct bp_location *bl = bp_locations[bc];
1484
1485 /* bp_location array has BL->OWNER always non-NULL. */
1486 if (bl->owner->type == bp_none)
1487 warning (_("reading through apparently deleted breakpoint #%d?"),
1488 bl->owner->number);
1489
1490 /* Performance optimization: any further element can no longer affect BUF
1491 content. */
1492
1493 if (bl->address >= bp_locations_placed_address_before_address_max
1494 && memaddr + len <= (bl->address
1495 - bp_locations_placed_address_before_address_max))
1496 break;
1497
1498 if (!bp_location_has_shadow (bl))
1499 continue;
1500
1501 one_breakpoint_xfer_memory (readbuf, writebuf, writebuf_org,
1502 memaddr, len, &bl->target_info, bl->gdbarch);
1503 }
1504 }
1505
1506 \f
1507
1508 /* Return true if BPT is either a software breakpoint or a hardware
1509 breakpoint. */
1510
1511 int
1512 is_breakpoint (const struct breakpoint *bpt)
1513 {
1514 return (bpt->type == bp_breakpoint
1515 || bpt->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint
1516 || bpt->type == bp_dprintf);
1517 }
1518
1519 /* Return true if BPT is of any hardware watchpoint kind. */
1520
1521 static int
1522 is_hardware_watchpoint (const struct breakpoint *bpt)
1523 {
1524 return (bpt->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint
1525 || bpt->type == bp_read_watchpoint
1526 || bpt->type == bp_access_watchpoint);
1527 }
1528
1529 /* Return true if BPT is of any watchpoint kind, hardware or
1530 software. */
1531
1532 int
1533 is_watchpoint (const struct breakpoint *bpt)
1534 {
1535 return (is_hardware_watchpoint (bpt)
1536 || bpt->type == bp_watchpoint);
1537 }
1538
1539 /* Returns true if the current thread and its running state are safe
1540 to evaluate or update watchpoint B. Watchpoints on local
1541 expressions need to be evaluated in the context of the thread that
1542 was current when the watchpoint was created, and, that thread needs
1543 to be stopped to be able to select the correct frame context.
1544 Watchpoints on global expressions can be evaluated on any thread,
1545 and in any state. It is presently left to the target allowing
1546 memory accesses when threads are running. */
1547
1548 static int
1549 watchpoint_in_thread_scope (struct watchpoint *b)
1550 {
1551 return (b->pspace == current_program_space
1552 && (ptid_equal (b->watchpoint_thread, null_ptid)
1553 || (ptid_equal (inferior_ptid, b->watchpoint_thread)
1554 && !is_executing (inferior_ptid))));
1555 }
1556
1557 /* Set watchpoint B to disp_del_at_next_stop, even including its possible
1558 associated bp_watchpoint_scope breakpoint. */
1559
1560 static void
1561 watchpoint_del_at_next_stop (struct watchpoint *w)
1562 {
1563 if (w->related_breakpoint != w)
1564 {
1565 gdb_assert (w->related_breakpoint->type == bp_watchpoint_scope);
1566 gdb_assert (w->related_breakpoint->related_breakpoint == w);
1567 w->related_breakpoint->disposition = disp_del_at_next_stop;
1568 w->related_breakpoint->related_breakpoint = w->related_breakpoint;
1569 w->related_breakpoint = w;
1570 }
1571 w->disposition = disp_del_at_next_stop;
1572 }
1573
1574 /* Extract a bitfield value from value VAL using the bit parameters contained in
1575 watchpoint W. */
1576
1577 static struct value *
1578 extract_bitfield_from_watchpoint_value (struct watchpoint *w, struct value *val)
1579 {
1580 struct value *bit_val;
1581
1582 if (val == NULL)
1583 return NULL;
1584
1585 bit_val = allocate_value (value_type (val));
1586
1587 unpack_value_bitfield (bit_val,
1588 w->val_bitpos,
1589 w->val_bitsize,
1590 value_contents_for_printing (val),
1591 value_offset (val),
1592 val);
1593
1594 return bit_val;
1595 }
1596
1597 /* Allocate a dummy location and add it to B, which must be a software
1598 watchpoint. This is required because even if a software watchpoint
1599 is not watching any memory, bpstat_stop_status requires a location
1600 to be able to report stops. */
1601
1602 static void
1603 software_watchpoint_add_no_memory_location (struct breakpoint *b,
1604 struct program_space *pspace)
1605 {
1606 gdb_assert (b->type == bp_watchpoint && b->loc == NULL);
1607
1608 b->loc = allocate_bp_location (b);
1609 b->loc->pspace = pspace;
1610 b->loc->address = -1;
1611 b->loc->length = -1;
1612 }
1613
1614 /* Returns true if B is a software watchpoint that is not watching any
1615 memory (e.g., "watch $pc"). */
1616
1617 static int
1618 is_no_memory_software_watchpoint (struct breakpoint *b)
1619 {
1620 return (b->type == bp_watchpoint
1621 && b->loc != NULL
1622 && b->loc->next == NULL
1623 && b->loc->address == -1
1624 && b->loc->length == -1);
1625 }
1626
1627 /* Assuming that B is a watchpoint:
1628 - Reparse watchpoint expression, if REPARSE is non-zero
1629 - Evaluate expression and store the result in B->val
1630 - Evaluate the condition if there is one, and store the result
1631 in b->loc->cond.
1632 - Update the list of values that must be watched in B->loc.
1633
1634 If the watchpoint disposition is disp_del_at_next_stop, then do
1635 nothing. If this is local watchpoint that is out of scope, delete
1636 it.
1637
1638 Even with `set breakpoint always-inserted on' the watchpoints are
1639 removed + inserted on each stop here. Normal breakpoints must
1640 never be removed because they might be missed by a running thread
1641 when debugging in non-stop mode. On the other hand, hardware
1642 watchpoints (is_hardware_watchpoint; processed here) are specific
1643 to each LWP since they are stored in each LWP's hardware debug
1644 registers. Therefore, such LWP must be stopped first in order to
1645 be able to modify its hardware watchpoints.
1646
1647 Hardware watchpoints must be reset exactly once after being
1648 presented to the user. It cannot be done sooner, because it would
1649 reset the data used to present the watchpoint hit to the user. And
1650 it must not be done later because it could display the same single
1651 watchpoint hit during multiple GDB stops. Note that the latter is
1652 relevant only to the hardware watchpoint types bp_read_watchpoint
1653 and bp_access_watchpoint. False hit by bp_hardware_watchpoint is
1654 not user-visible - its hit is suppressed if the memory content has
1655 not changed.
1656
1657 The following constraints influence the location where we can reset
1658 hardware watchpoints:
1659
1660 * target_stopped_by_watchpoint and target_stopped_data_address are
1661 called several times when GDB stops.
1662
1663 [linux]
1664 * Multiple hardware watchpoints can be hit at the same time,
1665 causing GDB to stop. GDB only presents one hardware watchpoint
1666 hit at a time as the reason for stopping, and all the other hits
1667 are presented later, one after the other, each time the user
1668 requests the execution to be resumed. Execution is not resumed
1669 for the threads still having pending hit event stored in
1670 LWP_INFO->STATUS. While the watchpoint is already removed from
1671 the inferior on the first stop the thread hit event is kept being
1672 reported from its cached value by linux_nat_stopped_data_address
1673 until the real thread resume happens after the watchpoint gets
1674 presented and thus its LWP_INFO->STATUS gets reset.
1675
1676 Therefore the hardware watchpoint hit can get safely reset on the
1677 watchpoint removal from inferior. */
1678
1679 static void
1680 update_watchpoint (struct watchpoint *b, int reparse)
1681 {
1682 int within_current_scope;
1683 struct frame_id saved_frame_id;
1684 int frame_saved;
1685
1686 /* If this is a local watchpoint, we only want to check if the
1687 watchpoint frame is in scope if the current thread is the thread
1688 that was used to create the watchpoint. */
1689 if (!watchpoint_in_thread_scope (b))
1690 return;
1691
1692 if (b->disposition == disp_del_at_next_stop)
1693 return;
1694
1695 frame_saved = 0;
1696
1697 /* Determine if the watchpoint is within scope. */
1698 if (b->exp_valid_block == NULL)
1699 within_current_scope = 1;
1700 else
1701 {
1702 struct frame_info *fi = get_current_frame ();
1703 struct gdbarch *frame_arch = get_frame_arch (fi);
1704 CORE_ADDR frame_pc = get_frame_pc (fi);
1705
1706 /* If we're at a point where the stack has been destroyed
1707 (e.g. in a function epilogue), unwinding may not work
1708 properly. Do not attempt to recreate locations at this
1709 point. See similar comments in watchpoint_check. */
1710 if (gdbarch_stack_frame_destroyed_p (frame_arch, frame_pc))
1711 return;
1712
1713 /* Save the current frame's ID so we can restore it after
1714 evaluating the watchpoint expression on its own frame. */
1715 /* FIXME drow/2003-09-09: It would be nice if evaluate_expression
1716 took a frame parameter, so that we didn't have to change the
1717 selected frame. */
1718 frame_saved = 1;
1719 saved_frame_id = get_frame_id (get_selected_frame (NULL));
1720
1721 fi = frame_find_by_id (b->watchpoint_frame);
1722 within_current_scope = (fi != NULL);
1723 if (within_current_scope)
1724 select_frame (fi);
1725 }
1726
1727 /* We don't free locations. They are stored in the bp_location array
1728 and update_global_location_list will eventually delete them and
1729 remove breakpoints if needed. */
1730 b->loc = NULL;
1731
1732 if (within_current_scope && reparse)
1733 {
1734 const char *s;
1735
1736 b->exp.reset ();
1737 s = b->exp_string_reparse ? b->exp_string_reparse : b->exp_string;
1738 b->exp = parse_exp_1 (&s, 0, b->exp_valid_block, 0);
1739 /* If the meaning of expression itself changed, the old value is
1740 no longer relevant. We don't want to report a watchpoint hit
1741 to the user when the old value and the new value may actually
1742 be completely different objects. */
1743 value_free (b->val);
1744 b->val = NULL;
1745 b->val_valid = 0;
1746
1747 /* Note that unlike with breakpoints, the watchpoint's condition
1748 expression is stored in the breakpoint object, not in the
1749 locations (re)created below. */
1750 if (b->cond_string != NULL)
1751 {
1752 b->cond_exp.reset ();
1753
1754 s = b->cond_string;
1755 b->cond_exp = parse_exp_1 (&s, 0, b->cond_exp_valid_block, 0);
1756 }
1757 }
1758
1759 /* If we failed to parse the expression, for example because
1760 it refers to a global variable in a not-yet-loaded shared library,
1761 don't try to insert watchpoint. We don't automatically delete
1762 such watchpoint, though, since failure to parse expression
1763 is different from out-of-scope watchpoint. */
1764 if (!target_has_execution)
1765 {
1766 /* Without execution, memory can't change. No use to try and
1767 set watchpoint locations. The watchpoint will be reset when
1768 the target gains execution, through breakpoint_re_set. */
1769 if (!can_use_hw_watchpoints)
1770 {
1771 if (b->ops->works_in_software_mode (b))
1772 b->type = bp_watchpoint;
1773 else
1774 error (_("Can't set read/access watchpoint when "
1775 "hardware watchpoints are disabled."));
1776 }
1777 }
1778 else if (within_current_scope && b->exp)
1779 {
1780 int pc = 0;
1781 struct value *val_chain, *v, *result, *next;
1782 struct program_space *frame_pspace;
1783
1784 fetch_subexp_value (b->exp.get (), &pc, &v, &result, &val_chain, 0);
1785
1786 /* Avoid setting b->val if it's already set. The meaning of
1787 b->val is 'the last value' user saw, and we should update
1788 it only if we reported that last value to user. As it
1789 happens, the code that reports it updates b->val directly.
1790 We don't keep track of the memory value for masked
1791 watchpoints. */
1792 if (!b->val_valid && !is_masked_watchpoint (b))
1793 {
1794 if (b->val_bitsize != 0)
1795 {
1796 v = extract_bitfield_from_watchpoint_value (b, v);
1797 if (v != NULL)
1798 release_value (v);
1799 }
1800 b->val = v;
1801 b->val_valid = 1;
1802 }
1803
1804 frame_pspace = get_frame_program_space (get_selected_frame (NULL));
1805
1806 /* Look at each value on the value chain. */
1807 for (v = val_chain; v; v = value_next (v))
1808 {
1809 /* If it's a memory location, and GDB actually needed
1810 its contents to evaluate the expression, then we
1811 must watch it. If the first value returned is
1812 still lazy, that means an error occurred reading it;
1813 watch it anyway in case it becomes readable. */
1814 if (VALUE_LVAL (v) == lval_memory
1815 && (v == val_chain || ! value_lazy (v)))
1816 {
1817 struct type *vtype = check_typedef (value_type (v));
1818
1819 /* We only watch structs and arrays if user asked
1820 for it explicitly, never if they just happen to
1821 appear in the middle of some value chain. */
1822 if (v == result
1823 || (TYPE_CODE (vtype) != TYPE_CODE_STRUCT
1824 && TYPE_CODE (vtype) != TYPE_CODE_ARRAY))
1825 {
1826 CORE_ADDR addr;
1827 enum target_hw_bp_type type;
1828 struct bp_location *loc, **tmp;
1829 int bitpos = 0, bitsize = 0;
1830
1831 if (value_bitsize (v) != 0)
1832 {
1833 /* Extract the bit parameters out from the bitfield
1834 sub-expression. */
1835 bitpos = value_bitpos (v);
1836 bitsize = value_bitsize (v);
1837 }
1838 else if (v == result && b->val_bitsize != 0)
1839 {
1840 /* If VAL_BITSIZE != 0 then RESULT is actually a bitfield
1841 lvalue whose bit parameters are saved in the fields
1842 VAL_BITPOS and VAL_BITSIZE. */
1843 bitpos = b->val_bitpos;
1844 bitsize = b->val_bitsize;
1845 }
1846
1847 addr = value_address (v);
1848 if (bitsize != 0)
1849 {
1850 /* Skip the bytes that don't contain the bitfield. */
1851 addr += bitpos / 8;
1852 }
1853
1854 type = hw_write;
1855 if (b->type == bp_read_watchpoint)
1856 type = hw_read;
1857 else if (b->type == bp_access_watchpoint)
1858 type = hw_access;
1859
1860 loc = allocate_bp_location (b);
1861 for (tmp = &(b->loc); *tmp != NULL; tmp = &((*tmp)->next))
1862 ;
1863 *tmp = loc;
1864 loc->gdbarch = get_type_arch (value_type (v));
1865
1866 loc->pspace = frame_pspace;
1867 loc->address = address_significant (loc->gdbarch, addr);
1868
1869 if (bitsize != 0)
1870 {
1871 /* Just cover the bytes that make up the bitfield. */
1872 loc->length = ((bitpos % 8) + bitsize + 7) / 8;
1873 }
1874 else
1875 loc->length = TYPE_LENGTH (value_type (v));
1876
1877 loc->watchpoint_type = type;
1878 }
1879 }
1880 }
1881
1882 /* Change the type of breakpoint between hardware assisted or
1883 an ordinary watchpoint depending on the hardware support
1884 and free hardware slots. REPARSE is set when the inferior
1885 is started. */
1886 if (reparse)
1887 {
1888 int reg_cnt;
1889 enum bp_loc_type loc_type;
1890 struct bp_location *bl;
1891
1892 reg_cnt = can_use_hardware_watchpoint (val_chain);
1893
1894 if (reg_cnt)
1895 {
1896 int i, target_resources_ok, other_type_used;
1897 enum bptype type;
1898
1899 /* Use an exact watchpoint when there's only one memory region to be
1900 watched, and only one debug register is needed to watch it. */
1901 b->exact = target_exact_watchpoints && reg_cnt == 1;
1902
1903 /* We need to determine how many resources are already
1904 used for all other hardware watchpoints plus this one
1905 to see if we still have enough resources to also fit
1906 this watchpoint in as well. */
1907
1908 /* If this is a software watchpoint, we try to turn it
1909 to a hardware one -- count resources as if B was of
1910 hardware watchpoint type. */
1911 type = b->type;
1912 if (type == bp_watchpoint)
1913 type = bp_hardware_watchpoint;
1914
1915 /* This watchpoint may or may not have been placed on
1916 the list yet at this point (it won't be in the list
1917 if we're trying to create it for the first time,
1918 through watch_command), so always account for it
1919 manually. */
1920
1921 /* Count resources used by all watchpoints except B. */
1922 i = hw_watchpoint_used_count_others (b, type, &other_type_used);
1923
1924 /* Add in the resources needed for B. */
1925 i += hw_watchpoint_use_count (b);
1926
1927 target_resources_ok
1928 = target_can_use_hardware_watchpoint (type, i, other_type_used);
1929 if (target_resources_ok <= 0)
1930 {
1931 int sw_mode = b->ops->works_in_software_mode (b);
1932
1933 if (target_resources_ok == 0 && !sw_mode)
1934 error (_("Target does not support this type of "
1935 "hardware watchpoint."));
1936 else if (target_resources_ok < 0 && !sw_mode)
1937 error (_("There are not enough available hardware "
1938 "resources for this watchpoint."));
1939
1940 /* Downgrade to software watchpoint. */
1941 b->type = bp_watchpoint;
1942 }
1943 else
1944 {
1945 /* If this was a software watchpoint, we've just
1946 found we have enough resources to turn it to a
1947 hardware watchpoint. Otherwise, this is a
1948 nop. */
1949 b->type = type;
1950 }
1951 }
1952 else if (!b->ops->works_in_software_mode (b))
1953 {
1954 if (!can_use_hw_watchpoints)
1955 error (_("Can't set read/access watchpoint when "
1956 "hardware watchpoints are disabled."));
1957 else
1958 error (_("Expression cannot be implemented with "
1959 "read/access watchpoint."));
1960 }
1961 else
1962 b->type = bp_watchpoint;
1963
1964 loc_type = (b->type == bp_watchpoint? bp_loc_other
1965 : bp_loc_hardware_watchpoint);
1966 for (bl = b->loc; bl; bl = bl->next)
1967 bl->loc_type = loc_type;
1968 }
1969
1970 for (v = val_chain; v; v = next)
1971 {
1972 next = value_next (v);
1973 if (v != b->val)
1974 value_free (v);
1975 }
1976
1977 /* If a software watchpoint is not watching any memory, then the
1978 above left it without any location set up. But,
1979 bpstat_stop_status requires a location to be able to report
1980 stops, so make sure there's at least a dummy one. */
1981 if (b->type == bp_watchpoint && b->loc == NULL)
1982 software_watchpoint_add_no_memory_location (b, frame_pspace);
1983 }
1984 else if (!within_current_scope)
1985 {
1986 printf_filtered (_("\
1987 Watchpoint %d deleted because the program has left the block\n\
1988 in which its expression is valid.\n"),
1989 b->number);
1990 watchpoint_del_at_next_stop (b);
1991 }
1992
1993 /* Restore the selected frame. */
1994 if (frame_saved)
1995 select_frame (frame_find_by_id (saved_frame_id));
1996 }
1997
1998
1999 /* Returns 1 iff breakpoint location should be
2000 inserted in the inferior. We don't differentiate the type of BL's owner
2001 (breakpoint vs. tracepoint), although insert_location in tracepoint's
2002 breakpoint_ops is not defined, because in insert_bp_location,
2003 tracepoint's insert_location will not be called. */
2004 static int
2005 should_be_inserted (struct bp_location *bl)
2006 {
2007 if (bl->owner == NULL || !breakpoint_enabled (bl->owner))
2008 return 0;
2009
2010 if (bl->owner->disposition == disp_del_at_next_stop)
2011 return 0;
2012
2013 if (!bl->enabled || bl->shlib_disabled || bl->duplicate)
2014 return 0;
2015
2016 if (user_breakpoint_p (bl->owner) && bl->pspace->executing_startup)
2017 return 0;
2018
2019 /* This is set for example, when we're attached to the parent of a
2020 vfork, and have detached from the child. The child is running
2021 free, and we expect it to do an exec or exit, at which point the
2022 OS makes the parent schedulable again (and the target reports
2023 that the vfork is done). Until the child is done with the shared
2024 memory region, do not insert breakpoints in the parent, otherwise
2025 the child could still trip on the parent's breakpoints. Since
2026 the parent is blocked anyway, it won't miss any breakpoint. */
2027 if (bl->pspace->breakpoints_not_allowed)
2028 return 0;
2029
2030 /* Don't insert a breakpoint if we're trying to step past its
2031 location, except if the breakpoint is a single-step breakpoint,
2032 and the breakpoint's thread is the thread which is stepping past
2033 a breakpoint. */
2034 if ((bl->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint
2035 || bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
2036 && stepping_past_instruction_at (bl->pspace->aspace,
2037 bl->address)
2038 /* The single-step breakpoint may be inserted at the location
2039 we're trying to step if the instruction branches to itself.
2040 However, the instruction won't be executed at all and it may
2041 break the semantics of the instruction, for example, the
2042 instruction is a conditional branch or updates some flags.
2043 We can't fix it unless GDB is able to emulate the instruction
2044 or switch to displaced stepping. */
2045 && !(bl->owner->type == bp_single_step
2046 && thread_is_stepping_over_breakpoint (bl->owner->thread)))
2047 {
2048 if (debug_infrun)
2049 {
2050 fprintf_unfiltered (gdb_stdlog,
2051 "infrun: skipping breakpoint: "
2052 "stepping past insn at: %s\n",
2053 paddress (bl->gdbarch, bl->address));
2054 }
2055 return 0;
2056 }
2057
2058 /* Don't insert watchpoints if we're trying to step past the
2059 instruction that triggered one. */
2060 if ((bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_watchpoint)
2061 && stepping_past_nonsteppable_watchpoint ())
2062 {
2063 if (debug_infrun)
2064 {
2065 fprintf_unfiltered (gdb_stdlog,
2066 "infrun: stepping past non-steppable watchpoint. "
2067 "skipping watchpoint at %s:%d\n",
2068 paddress (bl->gdbarch, bl->address),
2069 bl->length);
2070 }
2071 return 0;
2072 }
2073
2074 return 1;
2075 }
2076
2077 /* Same as should_be_inserted but does the check assuming
2078 that the location is not duplicated. */
2079
2080 static int
2081 unduplicated_should_be_inserted (struct bp_location *bl)
2082 {
2083 int result;
2084 const int save_duplicate = bl->duplicate;
2085
2086 bl->duplicate = 0;
2087 result = should_be_inserted (bl);
2088 bl->duplicate = save_duplicate;
2089 return result;
2090 }
2091
2092 /* Parses a conditional described by an expression COND into an
2093 agent expression bytecode suitable for evaluation
2094 by the bytecode interpreter. Return NULL if there was
2095 any error during parsing. */
2096
2097 static agent_expr_up
2098 parse_cond_to_aexpr (CORE_ADDR scope, struct expression *cond)
2099 {
2100 if (cond == NULL)
2101 return NULL;
2102
2103 agent_expr_up aexpr;
2104
2105 /* We don't want to stop processing, so catch any errors
2106 that may show up. */
2107 TRY
2108 {
2109 aexpr = gen_eval_for_expr (scope, cond);
2110 }
2111
2112 CATCH (ex, RETURN_MASK_ERROR)
2113 {
2114 /* If we got here, it means the condition could not be parsed to a valid
2115 bytecode expression and thus can't be evaluated on the target's side.
2116 It's no use iterating through the conditions. */
2117 }
2118 END_CATCH
2119
2120 /* We have a valid agent expression. */
2121 return aexpr;
2122 }
2123
2124 /* Based on location BL, create a list of breakpoint conditions to be
2125 passed on to the target. If we have duplicated locations with different
2126 conditions, we will add such conditions to the list. The idea is that the
2127 target will evaluate the list of conditions and will only notify GDB when
2128 one of them is true. */
2129
2130 static void
2131 build_target_condition_list (struct bp_location *bl)
2132 {
2133 struct bp_location **locp = NULL, **loc2p;
2134 int null_condition_or_parse_error = 0;
2135 int modified = bl->needs_update;
2136 struct bp_location *loc;
2137
2138 /* Release conditions left over from a previous insert. */
2139 bl->target_info.conditions.clear ();
2140
2141 /* This is only meaningful if the target is
2142 evaluating conditions and if the user has
2143 opted for condition evaluation on the target's
2144 side. */
2145 if (gdb_evaluates_breakpoint_condition_p ()
2146 || !target_supports_evaluation_of_breakpoint_conditions ())
2147 return;
2148
2149 /* Do a first pass to check for locations with no assigned
2150 conditions or conditions that fail to parse to a valid agent expression
2151 bytecode. If any of these happen, then it's no use to send conditions
2152 to the target since this location will always trigger and generate a
2153 response back to GDB. */
2154 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS_AT_ADDR (loc2p, locp, bl->address)
2155 {
2156 loc = (*loc2p);
2157 if (is_breakpoint (loc->owner) && loc->pspace->num == bl->pspace->num)
2158 {
2159 if (modified)
2160 {
2161 /* Re-parse the conditions since something changed. In that
2162 case we already freed the condition bytecodes (see
2163 force_breakpoint_reinsertion). We just
2164 need to parse the condition to bytecodes again. */
2165 loc->cond_bytecode = parse_cond_to_aexpr (bl->address,
2166 loc->cond.get ());
2167 }
2168
2169 /* If we have a NULL bytecode expression, it means something
2170 went wrong or we have a null condition expression. */
2171 if (!loc->cond_bytecode)
2172 {
2173 null_condition_or_parse_error = 1;
2174 break;
2175 }
2176 }
2177 }
2178
2179 /* If any of these happened, it means we will have to evaluate the conditions
2180 for the location's address on gdb's side. It is no use keeping bytecodes
2181 for all the other duplicate locations, thus we free all of them here.
2182
2183 This is so we have a finer control over which locations' conditions are
2184 being evaluated by GDB or the remote stub. */
2185 if (null_condition_or_parse_error)
2186 {
2187 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS_AT_ADDR (loc2p, locp, bl->address)
2188 {
2189 loc = (*loc2p);
2190 if (is_breakpoint (loc->owner) && loc->pspace->num == bl->pspace->num)
2191 {
2192 /* Only go as far as the first NULL bytecode is
2193 located. */
2194 if (!loc->cond_bytecode)
2195 return;
2196
2197 loc->cond_bytecode.reset ();
2198 }
2199 }
2200 }
2201
2202 /* No NULL conditions or failed bytecode generation. Build a condition list
2203 for this location's address. */
2204 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS_AT_ADDR (loc2p, locp, bl->address)
2205 {
2206 loc = (*loc2p);
2207 if (loc->cond
2208 && is_breakpoint (loc->owner)
2209 && loc->pspace->num == bl->pspace->num
2210 && loc->owner->enable_state == bp_enabled
2211 && loc->enabled)
2212 {
2213 /* Add the condition to the vector. This will be used later
2214 to send the conditions to the target. */
2215 bl->target_info.conditions.push_back (loc->cond_bytecode.get ());
2216 }
2217 }
2218
2219 return;
2220 }
2221
2222 /* Parses a command described by string CMD into an agent expression
2223 bytecode suitable for evaluation by the bytecode interpreter.
2224 Return NULL if there was any error during parsing. */
2225
2226 static agent_expr_up
2227 parse_cmd_to_aexpr (CORE_ADDR scope, char *cmd)
2228 {
2229 const char *cmdrest;
2230 const char *format_start, *format_end;
2231 struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_current_arch ();
2232
2233 if (cmd == NULL)
2234 return NULL;
2235
2236 cmdrest = cmd;
2237
2238 if (*cmdrest == ',')
2239 ++cmdrest;
2240 cmdrest = skip_spaces (cmdrest);
2241
2242 if (*cmdrest++ != '"')
2243 error (_("No format string following the location"));
2244
2245 format_start = cmdrest;
2246
2247 format_pieces fpieces (&cmdrest);
2248
2249 format_end = cmdrest;
2250
2251 if (*cmdrest++ != '"')
2252 error (_("Bad format string, non-terminated '\"'."));
2253
2254 cmdrest = skip_spaces (cmdrest);
2255
2256 if (!(*cmdrest == ',' || *cmdrest == '\0'))
2257 error (_("Invalid argument syntax"));
2258
2259 if (*cmdrest == ',')
2260 cmdrest++;
2261 cmdrest = skip_spaces (cmdrest);
2262
2263 /* For each argument, make an expression. */
2264
2265 std::vector<struct expression *> argvec;
2266 while (*cmdrest != '\0')
2267 {
2268 const char *cmd1;
2269
2270 cmd1 = cmdrest;
2271 expression_up expr = parse_exp_1 (&cmd1, scope, block_for_pc (scope), 1);
2272 argvec.push_back (expr.release ());
2273 cmdrest = cmd1;
2274 if (*cmdrest == ',')
2275 ++cmdrest;
2276 }
2277
2278 agent_expr_up aexpr;
2279
2280 /* We don't want to stop processing, so catch any errors
2281 that may show up. */
2282 TRY
2283 {
2284 aexpr = gen_printf (scope, gdbarch, 0, 0,
2285 format_start, format_end - format_start,
2286 argvec.size (), argvec.data ());
2287 }
2288 CATCH (ex, RETURN_MASK_ERROR)
2289 {
2290 /* If we got here, it means the command could not be parsed to a valid
2291 bytecode expression and thus can't be evaluated on the target's side.
2292 It's no use iterating through the other commands. */
2293 }
2294 END_CATCH
2295
2296 /* We have a valid agent expression, return it. */
2297 return aexpr;
2298 }
2299
2300 /* Based on location BL, create a list of breakpoint commands to be
2301 passed on to the target. If we have duplicated locations with
2302 different commands, we will add any such to the list. */
2303
2304 static void
2305 build_target_command_list (struct bp_location *bl)
2306 {
2307 struct bp_location **locp = NULL, **loc2p;
2308 int null_command_or_parse_error = 0;
2309 int modified = bl->needs_update;
2310 struct bp_location *loc;
2311
2312 /* Clear commands left over from a previous insert. */
2313 bl->target_info.tcommands.clear ();
2314
2315 if (!target_can_run_breakpoint_commands ())
2316 return;
2317
2318 /* For now, limit to agent-style dprintf breakpoints. */
2319 if (dprintf_style != dprintf_style_agent)
2320 return;
2321
2322 /* For now, if we have any duplicate location that isn't a dprintf,
2323 don't install the target-side commands, as that would make the
2324 breakpoint not be reported to the core, and we'd lose
2325 control. */
2326 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS_AT_ADDR (loc2p, locp, bl->address)
2327 {
2328 loc = (*loc2p);
2329 if (is_breakpoint (loc->owner)
2330 && loc->pspace->num == bl->pspace->num
2331 && loc->owner->type != bp_dprintf)
2332 return;
2333 }
2334
2335 /* Do a first pass to check for locations with no assigned
2336 conditions or conditions that fail to parse to a valid agent expression
2337 bytecode. If any of these happen, then it's no use to send conditions
2338 to the target since this location will always trigger and generate a
2339 response back to GDB. */
2340 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS_AT_ADDR (loc2p, locp, bl->address)
2341 {
2342 loc = (*loc2p);
2343 if (is_breakpoint (loc->owner) && loc->pspace->num == bl->pspace->num)
2344 {
2345 if (modified)
2346 {
2347 /* Re-parse the commands since something changed. In that
2348 case we already freed the command bytecodes (see
2349 force_breakpoint_reinsertion). We just
2350 need to parse the command to bytecodes again. */
2351 loc->cmd_bytecode
2352 = parse_cmd_to_aexpr (bl->address,
2353 loc->owner->extra_string);
2354 }
2355
2356 /* If we have a NULL bytecode expression, it means something
2357 went wrong or we have a null command expression. */
2358 if (!loc->cmd_bytecode)
2359 {
2360 null_command_or_parse_error = 1;
2361 break;
2362 }
2363 }
2364 }
2365
2366 /* If anything failed, then we're not doing target-side commands,
2367 and so clean up. */
2368 if (null_command_or_parse_error)
2369 {
2370 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS_AT_ADDR (loc2p, locp, bl->address)
2371 {
2372 loc = (*loc2p);
2373 if (is_breakpoint (loc->owner)
2374 && loc->pspace->num == bl->pspace->num)
2375 {
2376 /* Only go as far as the first NULL bytecode is
2377 located. */
2378 if (loc->cmd_bytecode == NULL)
2379 return;
2380
2381 loc->cmd_bytecode.reset ();
2382 }
2383 }
2384 }
2385
2386 /* No NULL commands or failed bytecode generation. Build a command list
2387 for this location's address. */
2388 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS_AT_ADDR (loc2p, locp, bl->address)
2389 {
2390 loc = (*loc2p);
2391 if (loc->owner->extra_string
2392 && is_breakpoint (loc->owner)
2393 && loc->pspace->num == bl->pspace->num
2394 && loc->owner->enable_state == bp_enabled
2395 && loc->enabled)
2396 {
2397 /* Add the command to the vector. This will be used later
2398 to send the commands to the target. */
2399 bl->target_info.tcommands.push_back (loc->cmd_bytecode.get ());
2400 }
2401 }
2402
2403 bl->target_info.persist = 0;
2404 /* Maybe flag this location as persistent. */
2405 if (bl->owner->type == bp_dprintf && disconnected_dprintf)
2406 bl->target_info.persist = 1;
2407 }
2408
2409 /* Return the kind of breakpoint on address *ADDR. Get the kind
2410 of breakpoint according to ADDR except single-step breakpoint.
2411 Get the kind of single-step breakpoint according to the current
2412 registers state. */
2413
2414 static int
2415 breakpoint_kind (struct bp_location *bl, CORE_ADDR *addr)
2416 {
2417 if (bl->owner->type == bp_single_step)
2418 {
2419 struct thread_info *thr = find_thread_global_id (bl->owner->thread);
2420 struct regcache *regcache;
2421
2422 regcache = get_thread_regcache (thr->ptid);
2423
2424 return gdbarch_breakpoint_kind_from_current_state (bl->gdbarch,
2425 regcache, addr);
2426 }
2427 else
2428 return gdbarch_breakpoint_kind_from_pc (bl->gdbarch, addr);
2429 }
2430
2431 /* Insert a low-level "breakpoint" of some type. BL is the breakpoint
2432 location. Any error messages are printed to TMP_ERROR_STREAM; and
2433 DISABLED_BREAKS, and HW_BREAKPOINT_ERROR are used to report problems.
2434 Returns 0 for success, 1 if the bp_location type is not supported or
2435 -1 for failure.
2436
2437 NOTE drow/2003-09-09: This routine could be broken down to an
2438 object-style method for each breakpoint or catchpoint type. */
2439 static int
2440 insert_bp_location (struct bp_location *bl,
2441 struct ui_file *tmp_error_stream,
2442 int *disabled_breaks,
2443 int *hw_breakpoint_error,
2444 int *hw_bp_error_explained_already)
2445 {
2446 gdb_exception bp_excpt = exception_none;
2447
2448 if (!should_be_inserted (bl) || (bl->inserted && !bl->needs_update))
2449 return 0;
2450
2451 /* Note we don't initialize bl->target_info, as that wipes out
2452 the breakpoint location's shadow_contents if the breakpoint
2453 is still inserted at that location. This in turn breaks
2454 target_read_memory which depends on these buffers when
2455 a memory read is requested at the breakpoint location:
2456 Once the target_info has been wiped, we fail to see that
2457 we have a breakpoint inserted at that address and thus
2458 read the breakpoint instead of returning the data saved in
2459 the breakpoint location's shadow contents. */
2460 bl->target_info.reqstd_address = bl->address;
2461 bl->target_info.placed_address_space = bl->pspace->aspace;
2462 bl->target_info.length = bl->length;
2463
2464 /* When working with target-side conditions, we must pass all the conditions
2465 for the same breakpoint address down to the target since GDB will not
2466 insert those locations. With a list of breakpoint conditions, the target
2467 can decide when to stop and notify GDB. */
2468
2469 if (is_breakpoint (bl->owner))
2470 {
2471 build_target_condition_list (bl);
2472 build_target_command_list (bl);
2473 /* Reset the modification marker. */
2474 bl->needs_update = 0;
2475 }
2476
2477 if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint
2478 || bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
2479 {
2480 if (bl->owner->type != bp_hardware_breakpoint)
2481 {
2482 /* If the explicitly specified breakpoint type
2483 is not hardware breakpoint, check the memory map to see
2484 if the breakpoint address is in read only memory or not.
2485
2486 Two important cases are:
2487 - location type is not hardware breakpoint, memory
2488 is readonly. We change the type of the location to
2489 hardware breakpoint.
2490 - location type is hardware breakpoint, memory is
2491 read-write. This means we've previously made the
2492 location hardware one, but then the memory map changed,
2493 so we undo.
2494
2495 When breakpoints are removed, remove_breakpoints will use
2496 location types we've just set here, the only possible
2497 problem is that memory map has changed during running
2498 program, but it's not going to work anyway with current
2499 gdb. */
2500 struct mem_region *mr
2501 = lookup_mem_region (bl->target_info.reqstd_address);
2502
2503 if (mr)
2504 {
2505 if (automatic_hardware_breakpoints)
2506 {
2507 enum bp_loc_type new_type;
2508
2509 if (mr->attrib.mode != MEM_RW)
2510 new_type = bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint;
2511 else
2512 new_type = bp_loc_software_breakpoint;
2513
2514 if (new_type != bl->loc_type)
2515 {
2516 static int said = 0;
2517
2518 bl->loc_type = new_type;
2519 if (!said)
2520 {
2521 fprintf_filtered (gdb_stdout,
2522 _("Note: automatically using "
2523 "hardware breakpoints for "
2524 "read-only addresses.\n"));
2525 said = 1;
2526 }
2527 }
2528 }
2529 else if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint
2530 && mr->attrib.mode != MEM_RW)
2531 {
2532 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
2533 _("Cannot insert breakpoint %d.\n"
2534 "Cannot set software breakpoint "
2535 "at read-only address %s\n"),
2536 bl->owner->number,
2537 paddress (bl->gdbarch, bl->address));
2538 return 1;
2539 }
2540 }
2541 }
2542
2543 /* First check to see if we have to handle an overlay. */
2544 if (overlay_debugging == ovly_off
2545 || bl->section == NULL
2546 || !(section_is_overlay (bl->section)))
2547 {
2548 /* No overlay handling: just set the breakpoint. */
2549 TRY
2550 {
2551 int val;
2552
2553 val = bl->owner->ops->insert_location (bl);
2554 if (val)
2555 bp_excpt = gdb_exception {RETURN_ERROR, GENERIC_ERROR};
2556 }
2557 CATCH (e, RETURN_MASK_ALL)
2558 {
2559 bp_excpt = e;
2560 }
2561 END_CATCH
2562 }
2563 else
2564 {
2565 /* This breakpoint is in an overlay section.
2566 Shall we set a breakpoint at the LMA? */
2567 if (!overlay_events_enabled)
2568 {
2569 /* Yes -- overlay event support is not active,
2570 so we must try to set a breakpoint at the LMA.
2571 This will not work for a hardware breakpoint. */
2572 if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
2573 warning (_("hardware breakpoint %d not supported in overlay!"),
2574 bl->owner->number);
2575 else
2576 {
2577 CORE_ADDR addr = overlay_unmapped_address (bl->address,
2578 bl->section);
2579 /* Set a software (trap) breakpoint at the LMA. */
2580 bl->overlay_target_info = bl->target_info;
2581 bl->overlay_target_info.reqstd_address = addr;
2582
2583 /* No overlay handling: just set the breakpoint. */
2584 TRY
2585 {
2586 int val;
2587
2588 bl->overlay_target_info.kind
2589 = breakpoint_kind (bl, &addr);
2590 bl->overlay_target_info.placed_address = addr;
2591 val = target_insert_breakpoint (bl->gdbarch,
2592 &bl->overlay_target_info);
2593 if (val)
2594 bp_excpt
2595 = gdb_exception {RETURN_ERROR, GENERIC_ERROR};
2596 }
2597 CATCH (e, RETURN_MASK_ALL)
2598 {
2599 bp_excpt = e;
2600 }
2601 END_CATCH
2602
2603 if (bp_excpt.reason != 0)
2604 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
2605 "Overlay breakpoint %d "
2606 "failed: in ROM?\n",
2607 bl->owner->number);
2608 }
2609 }
2610 /* Shall we set a breakpoint at the VMA? */
2611 if (section_is_mapped (bl->section))
2612 {
2613 /* Yes. This overlay section is mapped into memory. */
2614 TRY
2615 {
2616 int val;
2617
2618 val = bl->owner->ops->insert_location (bl);
2619 if (val)
2620 bp_excpt = gdb_exception {RETURN_ERROR, GENERIC_ERROR};
2621 }
2622 CATCH (e, RETURN_MASK_ALL)
2623 {
2624 bp_excpt = e;
2625 }
2626 END_CATCH
2627 }
2628 else
2629 {
2630 /* No. This breakpoint will not be inserted.
2631 No error, but do not mark the bp as 'inserted'. */
2632 return 0;
2633 }
2634 }
2635
2636 if (bp_excpt.reason != 0)
2637 {
2638 /* Can't set the breakpoint. */
2639
2640 /* In some cases, we might not be able to insert a
2641 breakpoint in a shared library that has already been
2642 removed, but we have not yet processed the shlib unload
2643 event. Unfortunately, some targets that implement
2644 breakpoint insertion themselves can't tell why the
2645 breakpoint insertion failed (e.g., the remote target
2646 doesn't define error codes), so we must treat generic
2647 errors as memory errors. */
2648 if (bp_excpt.reason == RETURN_ERROR
2649 && (bp_excpt.error == GENERIC_ERROR
2650 || bp_excpt.error == MEMORY_ERROR)
2651 && bl->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint
2652 && (solib_name_from_address (bl->pspace, bl->address)
2653 || shared_objfile_contains_address_p (bl->pspace,
2654 bl->address)))
2655 {
2656 /* See also: disable_breakpoints_in_shlibs. */
2657 bl->shlib_disabled = 1;
2658 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (bl->owner);
2659 if (!*disabled_breaks)
2660 {
2661 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
2662 "Cannot insert breakpoint %d.\n",
2663 bl->owner->number);
2664 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
2665 "Temporarily disabling shared "
2666 "library breakpoints:\n");
2667 }
2668 *disabled_breaks = 1;
2669 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
2670 "breakpoint #%d\n", bl->owner->number);
2671 return 0;
2672 }
2673 else
2674 {
2675 if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
2676 {
2677 *hw_breakpoint_error = 1;
2678 *hw_bp_error_explained_already = bp_excpt.message != NULL;
2679 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
2680 "Cannot insert hardware breakpoint %d%s",
2681 bl->owner->number,
2682 bp_excpt.message ? ":" : ".\n");
2683 if (bp_excpt.message != NULL)
2684 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream, "%s.\n",
2685 bp_excpt.message);
2686 }
2687 else
2688 {
2689 if (bp_excpt.message == NULL)
2690 {
2691 std::string message
2692 = memory_error_message (TARGET_XFER_E_IO,
2693 bl->gdbarch, bl->address);
2694
2695 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
2696 "Cannot insert breakpoint %d.\n"
2697 "%s\n",
2698 bl->owner->number, message.c_str ());
2699 }
2700 else
2701 {
2702 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
2703 "Cannot insert breakpoint %d: %s\n",
2704 bl->owner->number,
2705 bp_excpt.message);
2706 }
2707 }
2708 return 1;
2709
2710 }
2711 }
2712 else
2713 bl->inserted = 1;
2714
2715 return 0;
2716 }
2717
2718 else if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_watchpoint
2719 /* NOTE drow/2003-09-08: This state only exists for removing
2720 watchpoints. It's not clear that it's necessary... */
2721 && bl->owner->disposition != disp_del_at_next_stop)
2722 {
2723 int val;
2724
2725 gdb_assert (bl->owner->ops != NULL
2726 && bl->owner->ops->insert_location != NULL);
2727
2728 val = bl->owner->ops->insert_location (bl);
2729
2730 /* If trying to set a read-watchpoint, and it turns out it's not
2731 supported, try emulating one with an access watchpoint. */
2732 if (val == 1 && bl->watchpoint_type == hw_read)
2733 {
2734 struct bp_location *loc, **loc_temp;
2735
2736 /* But don't try to insert it, if there's already another
2737 hw_access location that would be considered a duplicate
2738 of this one. */
2739 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (loc, loc_temp)
2740 if (loc != bl
2741 && loc->watchpoint_type == hw_access
2742 && watchpoint_locations_match (bl, loc))
2743 {
2744 bl->duplicate = 1;
2745 bl->inserted = 1;
2746 bl->target_info = loc->target_info;
2747 bl->watchpoint_type = hw_access;
2748 val = 0;
2749 break;
2750 }
2751
2752 if (val == 1)
2753 {
2754 bl->watchpoint_type = hw_access;
2755 val = bl->owner->ops->insert_location (bl);
2756
2757 if (val)
2758 /* Back to the original value. */
2759 bl->watchpoint_type = hw_read;
2760 }
2761 }
2762
2763 bl->inserted = (val == 0);
2764 }
2765
2766 else if (bl->owner->type == bp_catchpoint)
2767 {
2768 int val;
2769
2770 gdb_assert (bl->owner->ops != NULL
2771 && bl->owner->ops->insert_location != NULL);
2772
2773 val = bl->owner->ops->insert_location (bl);
2774 if (val)
2775 {
2776 bl->owner->enable_state = bp_disabled;
2777
2778 if (val == 1)
2779 warning (_("\
2780 Error inserting catchpoint %d: Your system does not support this type\n\
2781 of catchpoint."), bl->owner->number);
2782 else
2783 warning (_("Error inserting catchpoint %d."), bl->owner->number);
2784 }
2785
2786 bl->inserted = (val == 0);
2787
2788 /* We've already printed an error message if there was a problem
2789 inserting this catchpoint, and we've disabled the catchpoint,
2790 so just return success. */
2791 return 0;
2792 }
2793
2794 return 0;
2795 }
2796
2797 /* This function is called when program space PSPACE is about to be
2798 deleted. It takes care of updating breakpoints to not reference
2799 PSPACE anymore. */
2800
2801 void
2802 breakpoint_program_space_exit (struct program_space *pspace)
2803 {
2804 struct breakpoint *b, *b_temp;
2805 struct bp_location *loc, **loc_temp;
2806
2807 /* Remove any breakpoint that was set through this program space. */
2808 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_temp)
2809 {
2810 if (b->pspace == pspace)
2811 delete_breakpoint (b);
2812 }
2813
2814 /* Breakpoints set through other program spaces could have locations
2815 bound to PSPACE as well. Remove those. */
2816 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (loc, loc_temp)
2817 {
2818 struct bp_location *tmp;
2819
2820 if (loc->pspace == pspace)
2821 {
2822 /* ALL_BP_LOCATIONS bp_location has LOC->OWNER always non-NULL. */
2823 if (loc->owner->loc == loc)
2824 loc->owner->loc = loc->next;
2825 else
2826 for (tmp = loc->owner->loc; tmp->next != NULL; tmp = tmp->next)
2827 if (tmp->next == loc)
2828 {
2829 tmp->next = loc->next;
2830 break;
2831 }
2832 }
2833 }
2834
2835 /* Now update the global location list to permanently delete the
2836 removed locations above. */
2837 update_global_location_list (UGLL_DONT_INSERT);
2838 }
2839
2840 /* Make sure all breakpoints are inserted in inferior.
2841 Throws exception on any error.
2842 A breakpoint that is already inserted won't be inserted
2843 again, so calling this function twice is safe. */
2844 void
2845 insert_breakpoints (void)
2846 {
2847 struct breakpoint *bpt;
2848
2849 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (bpt)
2850 if (is_hardware_watchpoint (bpt))
2851 {
2852 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) bpt;
2853
2854 update_watchpoint (w, 0 /* don't reparse. */);
2855 }
2856
2857 /* Updating watchpoints creates new locations, so update the global
2858 location list. Explicitly tell ugll to insert locations and
2859 ignore breakpoints_always_inserted_mode. */
2860 update_global_location_list (UGLL_INSERT);
2861 }
2862
2863 /* Invoke CALLBACK for each of bp_location. */
2864
2865 void
2866 iterate_over_bp_locations (walk_bp_location_callback callback)
2867 {
2868 struct bp_location *loc, **loc_tmp;
2869
2870 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (loc, loc_tmp)
2871 {
2872 callback (loc, NULL);
2873 }
2874 }
2875
2876 /* This is used when we need to synch breakpoint conditions between GDB and the
2877 target. It is the case with deleting and disabling of breakpoints when using
2878 always-inserted mode. */
2879
2880 static void
2881 update_inserted_breakpoint_locations (void)
2882 {
2883 struct bp_location *bl, **blp_tmp;
2884 int error_flag = 0;
2885 int val = 0;
2886 int disabled_breaks = 0;
2887 int hw_breakpoint_error = 0;
2888 int hw_bp_details_reported = 0;
2889
2890 string_file tmp_error_stream;
2891
2892 /* Explicitly mark the warning -- this will only be printed if
2893 there was an error. */
2894 tmp_error_stream.puts ("Warning:\n");
2895
2896 scoped_restore_current_pspace_and_thread restore_pspace_thread;
2897
2898 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bl, blp_tmp)
2899 {
2900 /* We only want to update software breakpoints and hardware
2901 breakpoints. */
2902 if (!is_breakpoint (bl->owner))
2903 continue;
2904
2905 /* We only want to update locations that are already inserted
2906 and need updating. This is to avoid unwanted insertion during
2907 deletion of breakpoints. */
2908 if (!bl->inserted || (bl->inserted && !bl->needs_update))
2909 continue;
2910
2911 switch_to_program_space_and_thread (bl->pspace);
2912
2913 /* For targets that support global breakpoints, there's no need
2914 to select an inferior to insert breakpoint to. In fact, even
2915 if we aren't attached to any process yet, we should still
2916 insert breakpoints. */
2917 if (!gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch ())
2918 && ptid_equal (inferior_ptid, null_ptid))
2919 continue;
2920
2921 val = insert_bp_location (bl, &tmp_error_stream, &disabled_breaks,
2922 &hw_breakpoint_error, &hw_bp_details_reported);
2923 if (val)
2924 error_flag = val;
2925 }
2926
2927 if (error_flag)
2928 {
2929 target_terminal::ours_for_output ();
2930 error_stream (tmp_error_stream);
2931 }
2932 }
2933
2934 /* Used when starting or continuing the program. */
2935
2936 static void
2937 insert_breakpoint_locations (void)
2938 {
2939 struct breakpoint *bpt;
2940 struct bp_location *bl, **blp_tmp;
2941 int error_flag = 0;
2942 int val = 0;
2943 int disabled_breaks = 0;
2944 int hw_breakpoint_error = 0;
2945 int hw_bp_error_explained_already = 0;
2946
2947 string_file tmp_error_stream;
2948
2949 /* Explicitly mark the warning -- this will only be printed if
2950 there was an error. */
2951 tmp_error_stream.puts ("Warning:\n");
2952
2953 scoped_restore_current_pspace_and_thread restore_pspace_thread;
2954
2955 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bl, blp_tmp)
2956 {
2957 if (!should_be_inserted (bl) || (bl->inserted && !bl->needs_update))
2958 continue;
2959
2960 /* There is no point inserting thread-specific breakpoints if
2961 the thread no longer exists. ALL_BP_LOCATIONS bp_location
2962 has BL->OWNER always non-NULL. */
2963 if (bl->owner->thread != -1
2964 && !valid_global_thread_id (bl->owner->thread))
2965 continue;
2966
2967 switch_to_program_space_and_thread (bl->pspace);
2968
2969 /* For targets that support global breakpoints, there's no need
2970 to select an inferior to insert breakpoint to. In fact, even
2971 if we aren't attached to any process yet, we should still
2972 insert breakpoints. */
2973 if (!gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch ())
2974 && ptid_equal (inferior_ptid, null_ptid))
2975 continue;
2976
2977 val = insert_bp_location (bl, &tmp_error_stream, &disabled_breaks,
2978 &hw_breakpoint_error, &hw_bp_error_explained_already);
2979 if (val)
2980 error_flag = val;
2981 }
2982
2983 /* If we failed to insert all locations of a watchpoint, remove
2984 them, as half-inserted watchpoint is of limited use. */
2985 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (bpt)
2986 {
2987 int some_failed = 0;
2988 struct bp_location *loc;
2989
2990 if (!is_hardware_watchpoint (bpt))
2991 continue;
2992
2993 if (!breakpoint_enabled (bpt))
2994 continue;
2995
2996 if (bpt->disposition == disp_del_at_next_stop)
2997 continue;
2998
2999 for (loc = bpt->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
3000 if (!loc->inserted && should_be_inserted (loc))
3001 {
3002 some_failed = 1;
3003 break;
3004 }
3005 if (some_failed)
3006 {
3007 for (loc = bpt->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
3008 if (loc->inserted)
3009 remove_breakpoint (loc);
3010
3011 hw_breakpoint_error = 1;
3012 tmp_error_stream.printf ("Could not insert "
3013 "hardware watchpoint %d.\n",
3014 bpt->number);
3015 error_flag = -1;
3016 }
3017 }
3018
3019 if (error_flag)
3020 {
3021 /* If a hardware breakpoint or watchpoint was inserted, add a
3022 message about possibly exhausted resources. */
3023 if (hw_breakpoint_error && !hw_bp_error_explained_already)
3024 {
3025 tmp_error_stream.printf ("Could not insert hardware breakpoints:\n\
3026 You may have requested too many hardware breakpoints/watchpoints.\n");
3027 }
3028 target_terminal::ours_for_output ();
3029 error_stream (tmp_error_stream);
3030 }
3031 }
3032
3033 /* Used when the program stops.
3034 Returns zero if successful, or non-zero if there was a problem
3035 removing a breakpoint location. */
3036
3037 int
3038 remove_breakpoints (void)
3039 {
3040 struct bp_location *bl, **blp_tmp;
3041 int val = 0;
3042
3043 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bl, blp_tmp)
3044 {
3045 if (bl->inserted && !is_tracepoint (bl->owner))
3046 val |= remove_breakpoint (bl);
3047 }
3048 return val;
3049 }
3050
3051 /* When a thread exits, remove breakpoints that are related to
3052 that thread. */
3053
3054 static void
3055 remove_threaded_breakpoints (struct thread_info *tp, int silent)
3056 {
3057 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
3058
3059 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
3060 {
3061 if (b->thread == tp->global_num && user_breakpoint_p (b))
3062 {
3063 b->disposition = disp_del_at_next_stop;
3064
3065 printf_filtered (_("\
3066 Thread-specific breakpoint %d deleted - thread %s no longer in the thread list.\n"),
3067 b->number, print_thread_id (tp));
3068
3069 /* Hide it from the user. */
3070 b->number = 0;
3071 }
3072 }
3073 }
3074
3075 /* Remove breakpoints of process PID. */
3076
3077 int
3078 remove_breakpoints_pid (int pid)
3079 {
3080 struct bp_location *bl, **blp_tmp;
3081 int val;
3082 struct inferior *inf = find_inferior_pid (pid);
3083
3084 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bl, blp_tmp)
3085 {
3086 if (bl->pspace != inf->pspace)
3087 continue;
3088
3089 if (bl->inserted && !bl->target_info.persist)
3090 {
3091 val = remove_breakpoint (bl);
3092 if (val != 0)
3093 return val;
3094 }
3095 }
3096 return 0;
3097 }
3098
3099 static int internal_breakpoint_number = -1;
3100
3101 /* Set the breakpoint number of B, depending on the value of INTERNAL.
3102 If INTERNAL is non-zero, the breakpoint number will be populated
3103 from internal_breakpoint_number and that variable decremented.
3104 Otherwise the breakpoint number will be populated from
3105 breakpoint_count and that value incremented. Internal breakpoints
3106 do not set the internal var bpnum. */
3107 static void
3108 set_breakpoint_number (int internal, struct breakpoint *b)
3109 {
3110 if (internal)
3111 b->number = internal_breakpoint_number--;
3112 else
3113 {
3114 set_breakpoint_count (breakpoint_count + 1);
3115 b->number = breakpoint_count;
3116 }
3117 }
3118
3119 static struct breakpoint *
3120 create_internal_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
3121 CORE_ADDR address, enum bptype type,
3122 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops)
3123 {
3124 symtab_and_line sal;
3125 sal.pc = address;
3126 sal.section = find_pc_overlay (sal.pc);
3127 sal.pspace = current_program_space;
3128
3129 breakpoint *b = set_raw_breakpoint (gdbarch, sal, type, ops);
3130 b->number = internal_breakpoint_number--;
3131 b->disposition = disp_donttouch;
3132
3133 return b;
3134 }
3135
3136 static const char *const longjmp_names[] =
3137 {
3138 "longjmp", "_longjmp", "siglongjmp", "_siglongjmp"
3139 };
3140 #define NUM_LONGJMP_NAMES ARRAY_SIZE(longjmp_names)
3141
3142 /* Per-objfile data private to breakpoint.c. */
3143 struct breakpoint_objfile_data
3144 {
3145 /* Minimal symbol for "_ovly_debug_event" (if any). */
3146 struct bound_minimal_symbol overlay_msym {};
3147
3148 /* Minimal symbol(s) for "longjmp", "siglongjmp", etc. (if any). */
3149 struct bound_minimal_symbol longjmp_msym[NUM_LONGJMP_NAMES] {};
3150
3151 /* True if we have looked for longjmp probes. */
3152 int longjmp_searched = 0;
3153
3154 /* SystemTap probe points for longjmp (if any). These are non-owning
3155 references. */
3156 std::vector<probe *> longjmp_probes;
3157
3158 /* Minimal symbol for "std::terminate()" (if any). */
3159 struct bound_minimal_symbol terminate_msym {};
3160
3161 /* Minimal symbol for "_Unwind_DebugHook" (if any). */
3162 struct bound_minimal_symbol exception_msym {};
3163
3164 /* True if we have looked for exception probes. */
3165 int exception_searched = 0;
3166
3167 /* SystemTap probe points for unwinding (if any). These are non-owning
3168 references. */
3169 std::vector<probe *> exception_probes;
3170 };
3171
3172 static const struct objfile_data *breakpoint_objfile_key;
3173
3174 /* Minimal symbol not found sentinel. */
3175 static struct minimal_symbol msym_not_found;
3176
3177 /* Returns TRUE if MSYM point to the "not found" sentinel. */
3178
3179 static int
3180 msym_not_found_p (const struct minimal_symbol *msym)
3181 {
3182 return msym == &msym_not_found;
3183 }
3184
3185 /* Return per-objfile data needed by breakpoint.c.
3186 Allocate the data if necessary. */
3187
3188 static struct breakpoint_objfile_data *
3189 get_breakpoint_objfile_data (struct objfile *objfile)
3190 {
3191 struct breakpoint_objfile_data *bp_objfile_data;
3192
3193 bp_objfile_data = ((struct breakpoint_objfile_data *)
3194 objfile_data (objfile, breakpoint_objfile_key));
3195 if (bp_objfile_data == NULL)
3196 {
3197 bp_objfile_data = new breakpoint_objfile_data ();
3198 set_objfile_data (objfile, breakpoint_objfile_key, bp_objfile_data);
3199 }
3200 return bp_objfile_data;
3201 }
3202
3203 static void
3204 free_breakpoint_objfile_data (struct objfile *obj, void *data)
3205 {
3206 struct breakpoint_objfile_data *bp_objfile_data
3207 = (struct breakpoint_objfile_data *) data;
3208
3209 delete bp_objfile_data;
3210 }
3211
3212 static void
3213 create_overlay_event_breakpoint (void)
3214 {
3215 struct objfile *objfile;
3216 const char *const func_name = "_ovly_debug_event";
3217
3218 ALL_OBJFILES (objfile)
3219 {
3220 struct breakpoint *b;
3221 struct breakpoint_objfile_data *bp_objfile_data;
3222 CORE_ADDR addr;
3223 struct explicit_location explicit_loc;
3224
3225 bp_objfile_data = get_breakpoint_objfile_data (objfile);
3226
3227 if (msym_not_found_p (bp_objfile_data->overlay_msym.minsym))
3228 continue;
3229
3230 if (bp_objfile_data->overlay_msym.minsym == NULL)
3231 {
3232 struct bound_minimal_symbol m;
3233
3234 m = lookup_minimal_symbol_text (func_name, objfile);
3235 if (m.minsym == NULL)
3236 {
3237 /* Avoid future lookups in this objfile. */
3238 bp_objfile_data->overlay_msym.minsym = &msym_not_found;
3239 continue;
3240 }
3241 bp_objfile_data->overlay_msym = m;
3242 }
3243
3244 addr = BMSYMBOL_VALUE_ADDRESS (bp_objfile_data->overlay_msym);
3245 b = create_internal_breakpoint (get_objfile_arch (objfile), addr,
3246 bp_overlay_event,
3247 &internal_breakpoint_ops);
3248 initialize_explicit_location (&explicit_loc);
3249 explicit_loc.function_name = ASTRDUP (func_name);
3250 b->location = new_explicit_location (&explicit_loc);
3251
3252 if (overlay_debugging == ovly_auto)
3253 {
3254 b->enable_state = bp_enabled;
3255 overlay_events_enabled = 1;
3256 }
3257 else
3258 {
3259 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
3260 overlay_events_enabled = 0;
3261 }
3262 }
3263 }
3264
3265 static void
3266 create_longjmp_master_breakpoint (void)
3267 {
3268 struct program_space *pspace;
3269
3270 scoped_restore_current_program_space restore_pspace;
3271
3272 ALL_PSPACES (pspace)
3273 {
3274 struct objfile *objfile;
3275
3276 set_current_program_space (pspace);
3277
3278 ALL_OBJFILES (objfile)
3279 {
3280 int i;
3281 struct gdbarch *gdbarch;
3282 struct breakpoint_objfile_data *bp_objfile_data;
3283
3284 gdbarch = get_objfile_arch (objfile);
3285
3286 bp_objfile_data = get_breakpoint_objfile_data (objfile);
3287
3288 if (!bp_objfile_data->longjmp_searched)
3289 {
3290 std::vector<probe *> ret
3291 = find_probes_in_objfile (objfile, "libc", "longjmp");
3292
3293 if (!ret.empty ())
3294 {
3295 /* We are only interested in checking one element. */
3296 probe *p = ret[0];
3297
3298 if (!p->can_evaluate_arguments ())
3299 {
3300 /* We cannot use the probe interface here, because it does
3301 not know how to evaluate arguments. */
3302 ret.clear ();
3303 }
3304 }
3305 bp_objfile_data->longjmp_probes = ret;
3306 bp_objfile_data->longjmp_searched = 1;
3307 }
3308
3309 if (!bp_objfile_data->longjmp_probes.empty ())
3310 {
3311 struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_objfile_arch (objfile);
3312
3313 for (probe *p : bp_objfile_data->longjmp_probes)
3314 {
3315 struct breakpoint *b;
3316
3317 b = create_internal_breakpoint (gdbarch,
3318 p->get_relocated_address (objfile),
3319 bp_longjmp_master,
3320 &internal_breakpoint_ops);
3321 b->location = new_probe_location ("-probe-stap libc:longjmp");
3322 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
3323 }
3324
3325 continue;
3326 }
3327
3328 if (!gdbarch_get_longjmp_target_p (gdbarch))
3329 continue;
3330
3331 for (i = 0; i < NUM_LONGJMP_NAMES; i++)
3332 {
3333 struct breakpoint *b;
3334 const char *func_name;
3335 CORE_ADDR addr;
3336 struct explicit_location explicit_loc;
3337
3338 if (msym_not_found_p (bp_objfile_data->longjmp_msym[i].minsym))
3339 continue;
3340
3341 func_name = longjmp_names[i];
3342 if (bp_objfile_data->longjmp_msym[i].minsym == NULL)
3343 {
3344 struct bound_minimal_symbol m;
3345
3346 m = lookup_minimal_symbol_text (func_name, objfile);
3347 if (m.minsym == NULL)
3348 {
3349 /* Prevent future lookups in this objfile. */
3350 bp_objfile_data->longjmp_msym[i].minsym = &msym_not_found;
3351 continue;
3352 }
3353 bp_objfile_data->longjmp_msym[i] = m;
3354 }
3355
3356 addr = BMSYMBOL_VALUE_ADDRESS (bp_objfile_data->longjmp_msym[i]);
3357 b = create_internal_breakpoint (gdbarch, addr, bp_longjmp_master,
3358 &internal_breakpoint_ops);
3359 initialize_explicit_location (&explicit_loc);
3360 explicit_loc.function_name = ASTRDUP (func_name);
3361 b->location = new_explicit_location (&explicit_loc);
3362 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
3363 }
3364 }
3365 }
3366 }
3367
3368 /* Create a master std::terminate breakpoint. */
3369 static void
3370 create_std_terminate_master_breakpoint (void)
3371 {
3372 struct program_space *pspace;
3373 const char *const func_name = "std::terminate()";
3374
3375 scoped_restore_current_program_space restore_pspace;
3376
3377 ALL_PSPACES (pspace)
3378 {
3379 struct objfile *objfile;
3380 CORE_ADDR addr;
3381
3382 set_current_program_space (pspace);
3383
3384 ALL_OBJFILES (objfile)
3385 {
3386 struct breakpoint *b;
3387 struct breakpoint_objfile_data *bp_objfile_data;
3388 struct explicit_location explicit_loc;
3389
3390 bp_objfile_data = get_breakpoint_objfile_data (objfile);
3391
3392 if (msym_not_found_p (bp_objfile_data->terminate_msym.minsym))
3393 continue;
3394
3395 if (bp_objfile_data->terminate_msym.minsym == NULL)
3396 {
3397 struct bound_minimal_symbol m;
3398
3399 m = lookup_minimal_symbol (func_name, NULL, objfile);
3400 if (m.minsym == NULL || (MSYMBOL_TYPE (m.minsym) != mst_text
3401 && MSYMBOL_TYPE (m.minsym) != mst_file_text))
3402 {
3403 /* Prevent future lookups in this objfile. */
3404 bp_objfile_data->terminate_msym.minsym = &msym_not_found;
3405 continue;
3406 }
3407 bp_objfile_data->terminate_msym = m;
3408 }
3409
3410 addr = BMSYMBOL_VALUE_ADDRESS (bp_objfile_data->terminate_msym);
3411 b = create_internal_breakpoint (get_objfile_arch (objfile), addr,
3412 bp_std_terminate_master,
3413 &internal_breakpoint_ops);
3414 initialize_explicit_location (&explicit_loc);
3415 explicit_loc.function_name = ASTRDUP (func_name);
3416 b->location = new_explicit_location (&explicit_loc);
3417 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
3418 }
3419 }
3420 }
3421
3422 /* Install a master breakpoint on the unwinder's debug hook. */
3423
3424 static void
3425 create_exception_master_breakpoint (void)
3426 {
3427 struct objfile *objfile;
3428 const char *const func_name = "_Unwind_DebugHook";
3429
3430 ALL_OBJFILES (objfile)
3431 {
3432 struct breakpoint *b;
3433 struct gdbarch *gdbarch;
3434 struct breakpoint_objfile_data *bp_objfile_data;
3435 CORE_ADDR addr;
3436 struct explicit_location explicit_loc;
3437
3438 bp_objfile_data = get_breakpoint_objfile_data (objfile);
3439
3440 /* We prefer the SystemTap probe point if it exists. */
3441 if (!bp_objfile_data->exception_searched)
3442 {
3443 std::vector<probe *> ret
3444 = find_probes_in_objfile (objfile, "libgcc", "unwind");
3445
3446 if (!ret.empty ())
3447 {
3448 /* We are only interested in checking one element. */
3449 probe *p = ret[0];
3450
3451 if (!p->can_evaluate_arguments ())
3452 {
3453 /* We cannot use the probe interface here, because it does
3454 not know how to evaluate arguments. */
3455 ret.clear ();
3456 }
3457 }
3458 bp_objfile_data->exception_probes = ret;
3459 bp_objfile_data->exception_searched = 1;
3460 }
3461
3462 if (!bp_objfile_data->exception_probes.empty ())
3463 {
3464 struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_objfile_arch (objfile);
3465
3466 for (probe *p : bp_objfile_data->exception_probes)
3467 {
3468 struct breakpoint *b;
3469
3470 b = create_internal_breakpoint (gdbarch,
3471 p->get_relocated_address (objfile),
3472 bp_exception_master,
3473 &internal_breakpoint_ops);
3474 b->location = new_probe_location ("-probe-stap libgcc:unwind");
3475 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
3476 }
3477
3478 continue;
3479 }
3480
3481 /* Otherwise, try the hook function. */
3482
3483 if (msym_not_found_p (bp_objfile_data->exception_msym.minsym))
3484 continue;
3485
3486 gdbarch = get_objfile_arch (objfile);
3487
3488 if (bp_objfile_data->exception_msym.minsym == NULL)
3489 {
3490 struct bound_minimal_symbol debug_hook;
3491
3492 debug_hook = lookup_minimal_symbol (func_name, NULL, objfile);
3493 if (debug_hook.minsym == NULL)
3494 {
3495 bp_objfile_data->exception_msym.minsym = &msym_not_found;
3496 continue;
3497 }
3498
3499 bp_objfile_data->exception_msym = debug_hook;
3500 }
3501
3502 addr = BMSYMBOL_VALUE_ADDRESS (bp_objfile_data->exception_msym);
3503 addr = gdbarch_convert_from_func_ptr_addr (gdbarch, addr,
3504 &current_target);
3505 b = create_internal_breakpoint (gdbarch, addr, bp_exception_master,
3506 &internal_breakpoint_ops);
3507 initialize_explicit_location (&explicit_loc);
3508 explicit_loc.function_name = ASTRDUP (func_name);
3509 b->location = new_explicit_location (&explicit_loc);
3510 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
3511 }
3512 }
3513
3514 /* Does B have a location spec? */
3515
3516 static int
3517 breakpoint_event_location_empty_p (const struct breakpoint *b)
3518 {
3519 return b->location != NULL && event_location_empty_p (b->location.get ());
3520 }
3521
3522 void
3523 update_breakpoints_after_exec (void)
3524 {
3525 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
3526 struct bp_location *bploc, **bplocp_tmp;
3527
3528 /* We're about to delete breakpoints from GDB's lists. If the
3529 INSERTED flag is true, GDB will try to lift the breakpoints by
3530 writing the breakpoints' "shadow contents" back into memory. The
3531 "shadow contents" are NOT valid after an exec, so GDB should not
3532 do that. Instead, the target is responsible from marking
3533 breakpoints out as soon as it detects an exec. We don't do that
3534 here instead, because there may be other attempts to delete
3535 breakpoints after detecting an exec and before reaching here. */
3536 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bploc, bplocp_tmp)
3537 if (bploc->pspace == current_program_space)
3538 gdb_assert (!bploc->inserted);
3539
3540 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
3541 {
3542 if (b->pspace != current_program_space)
3543 continue;
3544
3545 /* Solib breakpoints must be explicitly reset after an exec(). */
3546 if (b->type == bp_shlib_event)
3547 {
3548 delete_breakpoint (b);
3549 continue;
3550 }
3551
3552 /* JIT breakpoints must be explicitly reset after an exec(). */
3553 if (b->type == bp_jit_event)
3554 {
3555 delete_breakpoint (b);
3556 continue;
3557 }
3558
3559 /* Thread event breakpoints must be set anew after an exec(),
3560 as must overlay event and longjmp master breakpoints. */
3561 if (b->type == bp_thread_event || b->type == bp_overlay_event
3562 || b->type == bp_longjmp_master || b->type == bp_std_terminate_master
3563 || b->type == bp_exception_master)
3564 {
3565 delete_breakpoint (b);
3566 continue;
3567 }
3568
3569 /* Step-resume breakpoints are meaningless after an exec(). */
3570 if (b->type == bp_step_resume || b->type == bp_hp_step_resume)
3571 {
3572 delete_breakpoint (b);
3573 continue;
3574 }
3575
3576 /* Just like single-step breakpoints. */
3577 if (b->type == bp_single_step)
3578 {
3579 delete_breakpoint (b);
3580 continue;
3581 }
3582
3583 /* Longjmp and longjmp-resume breakpoints are also meaningless
3584 after an exec. */
3585 if (b->type == bp_longjmp || b->type == bp_longjmp_resume
3586 || b->type == bp_longjmp_call_dummy
3587 || b->type == bp_exception || b->type == bp_exception_resume)
3588 {
3589 delete_breakpoint (b);
3590 continue;
3591 }
3592
3593 if (b->type == bp_catchpoint)
3594 {
3595 /* For now, none of the bp_catchpoint breakpoints need to
3596 do anything at this point. In the future, if some of
3597 the catchpoints need to something, we will need to add
3598 a new method, and call this method from here. */
3599 continue;
3600 }
3601
3602 /* bp_finish is a special case. The only way we ought to be able
3603 to see one of these when an exec() has happened, is if the user
3604 caught a vfork, and then said "finish". Ordinarily a finish just
3605 carries them to the call-site of the current callee, by setting
3606 a temporary bp there and resuming. But in this case, the finish
3607 will carry them entirely through the vfork & exec.
3608
3609 We don't want to allow a bp_finish to remain inserted now. But
3610 we can't safely delete it, 'cause finish_command has a handle to
3611 the bp on a bpstat, and will later want to delete it. There's a
3612 chance (and I've seen it happen) that if we delete the bp_finish
3613 here, that its storage will get reused by the time finish_command
3614 gets 'round to deleting the "use to be a bp_finish" breakpoint.
3615 We really must allow finish_command to delete a bp_finish.
3616
3617 In the absence of a general solution for the "how do we know
3618 it's safe to delete something others may have handles to?"
3619 problem, what we'll do here is just uninsert the bp_finish, and
3620 let finish_command delete it.
3621
3622 (We know the bp_finish is "doomed" in the sense that it's
3623 momentary, and will be deleted as soon as finish_command sees
3624 the inferior stopped. So it doesn't matter that the bp's
3625 address is probably bogus in the new a.out, unlike e.g., the
3626 solib breakpoints.) */
3627
3628 if (b->type == bp_finish)
3629 {
3630 continue;
3631 }
3632
3633 /* Without a symbolic address, we have little hope of the
3634 pre-exec() address meaning the same thing in the post-exec()
3635 a.out. */
3636 if (breakpoint_event_location_empty_p (b))
3637 {
3638 delete_breakpoint (b);
3639 continue;
3640 }
3641 }
3642 }
3643
3644 int
3645 detach_breakpoints (ptid_t ptid)
3646 {
3647 struct bp_location *bl, **blp_tmp;
3648 int val = 0;
3649 scoped_restore save_inferior_ptid = make_scoped_restore (&inferior_ptid);
3650 struct inferior *inf = current_inferior ();
3651
3652 if (ptid_get_pid (ptid) == ptid_get_pid (inferior_ptid))
3653 error (_("Cannot detach breakpoints of inferior_ptid"));
3654
3655 /* Set inferior_ptid; remove_breakpoint_1 uses this global. */
3656 inferior_ptid = ptid;
3657 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bl, blp_tmp)
3658 {
3659 if (bl->pspace != inf->pspace)
3660 continue;
3661
3662 /* This function must physically remove breakpoints locations
3663 from the specified ptid, without modifying the breakpoint
3664 package's state. Locations of type bp_loc_other are only
3665 maintained at GDB side. So, there is no need to remove
3666 these bp_loc_other locations. Moreover, removing these
3667 would modify the breakpoint package's state. */
3668 if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_other)
3669 continue;
3670
3671 if (bl->inserted)
3672 val |= remove_breakpoint_1 (bl, DETACH_BREAKPOINT);
3673 }
3674
3675 return val;
3676 }
3677
3678 /* Remove the breakpoint location BL from the current address space.
3679 Note that this is used to detach breakpoints from a child fork.
3680 When we get here, the child isn't in the inferior list, and neither
3681 do we have objects to represent its address space --- we should
3682 *not* look at bl->pspace->aspace here. */
3683
3684 static int
3685 remove_breakpoint_1 (struct bp_location *bl, enum remove_bp_reason reason)
3686 {
3687 int val;
3688
3689 /* BL is never in moribund_locations by our callers. */
3690 gdb_assert (bl->owner != NULL);
3691
3692 /* The type of none suggests that owner is actually deleted.
3693 This should not ever happen. */
3694 gdb_assert (bl->owner->type != bp_none);
3695
3696 if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint
3697 || bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
3698 {
3699 /* "Normal" instruction breakpoint: either the standard
3700 trap-instruction bp (bp_breakpoint), or a
3701 bp_hardware_breakpoint. */
3702
3703 /* First check to see if we have to handle an overlay. */
3704 if (overlay_debugging == ovly_off
3705 || bl->section == NULL
3706 || !(section_is_overlay (bl->section)))
3707 {
3708 /* No overlay handling: just remove the breakpoint. */
3709
3710 /* If we're trying to uninsert a memory breakpoint that we
3711 know is set in a dynamic object that is marked
3712 shlib_disabled, then either the dynamic object was
3713 removed with "remove-symbol-file" or with
3714 "nosharedlibrary". In the former case, we don't know
3715 whether another dynamic object might have loaded over the
3716 breakpoint's address -- the user might well let us know
3717 about it next with add-symbol-file (the whole point of
3718 add-symbol-file is letting the user manually maintain a
3719 list of dynamically loaded objects). If we have the
3720 breakpoint's shadow memory, that is, this is a software
3721 breakpoint managed by GDB, check whether the breakpoint
3722 is still inserted in memory, to avoid overwriting wrong
3723 code with stale saved shadow contents. Note that HW
3724 breakpoints don't have shadow memory, as they're
3725 implemented using a mechanism that is not dependent on
3726 being able to modify the target's memory, and as such
3727 they should always be removed. */
3728 if (bl->shlib_disabled
3729 && bl->target_info.shadow_len != 0
3730 && !memory_validate_breakpoint (bl->gdbarch, &bl->target_info))
3731 val = 0;
3732 else
3733 val = bl->owner->ops->remove_location (bl, reason);
3734 }
3735 else
3736 {
3737 /* This breakpoint is in an overlay section.
3738 Did we set a breakpoint at the LMA? */
3739 if (!overlay_events_enabled)
3740 {
3741 /* Yes -- overlay event support is not active, so we
3742 should have set a breakpoint at the LMA. Remove it.
3743 */
3744 /* Ignore any failures: if the LMA is in ROM, we will
3745 have already warned when we failed to insert it. */
3746 if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
3747 target_remove_hw_breakpoint (bl->gdbarch,
3748 &bl->overlay_target_info);
3749 else
3750 target_remove_breakpoint (bl->gdbarch,
3751 &bl->overlay_target_info,
3752 reason);
3753 }
3754 /* Did we set a breakpoint at the VMA?
3755 If so, we will have marked the breakpoint 'inserted'. */
3756 if (bl->inserted)
3757 {
3758 /* Yes -- remove it. Previously we did not bother to
3759 remove the breakpoint if the section had been
3760 unmapped, but let's not rely on that being safe. We
3761 don't know what the overlay manager might do. */
3762
3763 /* However, we should remove *software* breakpoints only
3764 if the section is still mapped, or else we overwrite
3765 wrong code with the saved shadow contents. */
3766 if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint
3767 || section_is_mapped (bl->section))
3768 val = bl->owner->ops->remove_location (bl, reason);
3769 else
3770 val = 0;
3771 }
3772 else
3773 {
3774 /* No -- not inserted, so no need to remove. No error. */
3775 val = 0;
3776 }
3777 }
3778
3779 /* In some cases, we might not be able to remove a breakpoint in
3780 a shared library that has already been removed, but we have
3781 not yet processed the shlib unload event. Similarly for an
3782 unloaded add-symbol-file object - the user might not yet have
3783 had the chance to remove-symbol-file it. shlib_disabled will
3784 be set if the library/object has already been removed, but
3785 the breakpoint hasn't been uninserted yet, e.g., after
3786 "nosharedlibrary" or "remove-symbol-file" with breakpoints
3787 always-inserted mode. */
3788 if (val
3789 && (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint
3790 && (bl->shlib_disabled
3791 || solib_name_from_address (bl->pspace, bl->address)
3792 || shared_objfile_contains_address_p (bl->pspace,
3793 bl->address))))
3794 val = 0;
3795
3796 if (val)
3797 return val;
3798 bl->inserted = (reason == DETACH_BREAKPOINT);
3799 }
3800 else if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_watchpoint)
3801 {
3802 gdb_assert (bl->owner->ops != NULL
3803 && bl->owner->ops->remove_location != NULL);
3804
3805 bl->inserted = (reason == DETACH_BREAKPOINT);
3806 bl->owner->ops->remove_location (bl, reason);
3807
3808 /* Failure to remove any of the hardware watchpoints comes here. */
3809 if (reason == REMOVE_BREAKPOINT && bl->inserted)
3810 warning (_("Could not remove hardware watchpoint %d."),
3811 bl->owner->number);
3812 }
3813 else if (bl->owner->type == bp_catchpoint
3814 && breakpoint_enabled (bl->owner)
3815 && !bl->duplicate)
3816 {
3817 gdb_assert (bl->owner->ops != NULL
3818 && bl->owner->ops->remove_location != NULL);
3819
3820 val = bl->owner->ops->remove_location (bl, reason);
3821 if (val)
3822 return val;
3823
3824 bl->inserted = (reason == DETACH_BREAKPOINT);
3825 }
3826
3827 return 0;
3828 }
3829
3830 static int
3831 remove_breakpoint (struct bp_location *bl)
3832 {
3833 /* BL is never in moribund_locations by our callers. */
3834 gdb_assert (bl->owner != NULL);
3835
3836 /* The type of none suggests that owner is actually deleted.
3837 This should not ever happen. */
3838 gdb_assert (bl->owner->type != bp_none);
3839
3840 scoped_restore_current_pspace_and_thread restore_pspace_thread;
3841
3842 switch_to_program_space_and_thread (bl->pspace);
3843
3844 return remove_breakpoint_1 (bl, REMOVE_BREAKPOINT);
3845 }
3846
3847 /* Clear the "inserted" flag in all breakpoints. */
3848
3849 void
3850 mark_breakpoints_out (void)
3851 {
3852 struct bp_location *bl, **blp_tmp;
3853
3854 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bl, blp_tmp)
3855 if (bl->pspace == current_program_space)
3856 bl->inserted = 0;
3857 }
3858
3859 /* Clear the "inserted" flag in all breakpoints and delete any
3860 breakpoints which should go away between runs of the program.
3861
3862 Plus other such housekeeping that has to be done for breakpoints
3863 between runs.
3864
3865 Note: this function gets called at the end of a run (by
3866 generic_mourn_inferior) and when a run begins (by
3867 init_wait_for_inferior). */
3868
3869
3870
3871 void
3872 breakpoint_init_inferior (enum inf_context context)
3873 {
3874 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
3875 struct bp_location *bl;
3876 int ix;
3877 struct program_space *pspace = current_program_space;
3878
3879 /* If breakpoint locations are shared across processes, then there's
3880 nothing to do. */
3881 if (gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch ()))
3882 return;
3883
3884 mark_breakpoints_out ();
3885
3886 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
3887 {
3888 if (b->loc && b->loc->pspace != pspace)
3889 continue;
3890
3891 switch (b->type)
3892 {
3893 case bp_call_dummy:
3894 case bp_longjmp_call_dummy:
3895
3896 /* If the call dummy breakpoint is at the entry point it will
3897 cause problems when the inferior is rerun, so we better get
3898 rid of it. */
3899
3900 case bp_watchpoint_scope:
3901
3902 /* Also get rid of scope breakpoints. */
3903
3904 case bp_shlib_event:
3905
3906 /* Also remove solib event breakpoints. Their addresses may
3907 have changed since the last time we ran the program.
3908 Actually we may now be debugging against different target;
3909 and so the solib backend that installed this breakpoint may
3910 not be used in by the target. E.g.,
3911
3912 (gdb) file prog-linux
3913 (gdb) run # native linux target
3914 ...
3915 (gdb) kill
3916 (gdb) file prog-win.exe
3917 (gdb) tar rem :9999 # remote Windows gdbserver.
3918 */
3919
3920 case bp_step_resume:
3921
3922 /* Also remove step-resume breakpoints. */
3923
3924 case bp_single_step:
3925
3926 /* Also remove single-step breakpoints. */
3927
3928 delete_breakpoint (b);
3929 break;
3930
3931 case bp_watchpoint:
3932 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
3933 case bp_read_watchpoint:
3934 case bp_access_watchpoint:
3935 {
3936 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
3937
3938 /* Likewise for watchpoints on local expressions. */
3939 if (w->exp_valid_block != NULL)
3940 delete_breakpoint (b);
3941 else
3942 {
3943 /* Get rid of existing locations, which are no longer
3944 valid. New ones will be created in
3945 update_watchpoint, when the inferior is restarted.
3946 The next update_global_location_list call will
3947 garbage collect them. */
3948 b->loc = NULL;
3949
3950 if (context == inf_starting)
3951 {
3952 /* Reset val field to force reread of starting value in
3953 insert_breakpoints. */
3954 if (w->val)
3955 value_free (w->val);
3956 w->val = NULL;
3957 w->val_valid = 0;
3958 }
3959 }
3960 }
3961 break;
3962 default:
3963 break;
3964 }
3965 }
3966
3967 /* Get rid of the moribund locations. */
3968 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (bp_location_p, moribund_locations, ix, bl); ++ix)
3969 decref_bp_location (&bl);
3970 VEC_free (bp_location_p, moribund_locations);
3971 }
3972
3973 /* These functions concern about actual breakpoints inserted in the
3974 target --- to e.g. check if we need to do decr_pc adjustment or if
3975 we need to hop over the bkpt --- so we check for address space
3976 match, not program space. */
3977
3978 /* breakpoint_here_p (PC) returns non-zero if an enabled breakpoint
3979 exists at PC. It returns ordinary_breakpoint_here if it's an
3980 ordinary breakpoint, or permanent_breakpoint_here if it's a
3981 permanent breakpoint.
3982 - When continuing from a location with an ordinary breakpoint, we
3983 actually single step once before calling insert_breakpoints.
3984 - When continuing from a location with a permanent breakpoint, we
3985 need to use the `SKIP_PERMANENT_BREAKPOINT' macro, provided by
3986 the target, to advance the PC past the breakpoint. */
3987
3988 enum breakpoint_here
3989 breakpoint_here_p (const address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR pc)
3990 {
3991 struct bp_location *bl, **blp_tmp;
3992 int any_breakpoint_here = 0;
3993
3994 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bl, blp_tmp)
3995 {
3996 if (bl->loc_type != bp_loc_software_breakpoint
3997 && bl->loc_type != bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
3998 continue;
3999
4000 /* ALL_BP_LOCATIONS bp_location has BL->OWNER always non-NULL. */
4001 if ((breakpoint_enabled (bl->owner)
4002 || bl->permanent)
4003 && breakpoint_location_address_match (bl, aspace, pc))
4004 {
4005 if (overlay_debugging
4006 && section_is_overlay (bl->section)
4007 && !section_is_mapped (bl->section))
4008 continue; /* unmapped overlay -- can't be a match */
4009 else if (bl->permanent)
4010 return permanent_breakpoint_here;
4011 else
4012 any_breakpoint_here = 1;
4013 }
4014 }
4015
4016 return any_breakpoint_here ? ordinary_breakpoint_here : no_breakpoint_here;
4017 }
4018
4019 /* See breakpoint.h. */
4020
4021 int
4022 breakpoint_in_range_p (const address_space *aspace,
4023 CORE_ADDR addr, ULONGEST len)
4024 {
4025 struct bp_location *bl, **blp_tmp;
4026
4027 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bl, blp_tmp)
4028 {
4029 if (bl->loc_type != bp_loc_software_breakpoint
4030 && bl->loc_type != bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
4031 continue;
4032
4033 if ((breakpoint_enabled (bl->owner)
4034 || bl->permanent)
4035 && breakpoint_location_address_range_overlap (bl, aspace,
4036 addr, len))
4037 {
4038 if (overlay_debugging
4039 && section_is_overlay (bl->section)
4040 && !section_is_mapped (bl->section))
4041 {
4042 /* Unmapped overlay -- can't be a match. */
4043 continue;
4044 }
4045
4046 return 1;
4047 }
4048 }
4049
4050 return 0;
4051 }
4052
4053 /* Return true if there's a moribund breakpoint at PC. */
4054
4055 int
4056 moribund_breakpoint_here_p (const address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR pc)
4057 {
4058 struct bp_location *loc;
4059 int ix;
4060
4061 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (bp_location_p, moribund_locations, ix, loc); ++ix)
4062 if (breakpoint_location_address_match (loc, aspace, pc))
4063 return 1;
4064
4065 return 0;
4066 }
4067
4068 /* Returns non-zero iff BL is inserted at PC, in address space
4069 ASPACE. */
4070
4071 static int
4072 bp_location_inserted_here_p (struct bp_location *bl,
4073 const address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR pc)
4074 {
4075 if (bl->inserted
4076 && breakpoint_address_match (bl->pspace->aspace, bl->address,
4077 aspace, pc))
4078 {
4079 if (overlay_debugging
4080 && section_is_overlay (bl->section)
4081 && !section_is_mapped (bl->section))
4082 return 0; /* unmapped overlay -- can't be a match */
4083 else
4084 return 1;
4085 }
4086 return 0;
4087 }
4088
4089 /* Returns non-zero iff there's a breakpoint inserted at PC. */
4090
4091 int
4092 breakpoint_inserted_here_p (const address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR pc)
4093 {
4094 struct bp_location **blp, **blp_tmp = NULL;
4095
4096 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS_AT_ADDR (blp, blp_tmp, pc)
4097 {
4098 struct bp_location *bl = *blp;
4099
4100 if (bl->loc_type != bp_loc_software_breakpoint
4101 && bl->loc_type != bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
4102 continue;
4103
4104 if (bp_location_inserted_here_p (bl, aspace, pc))
4105 return 1;
4106 }
4107 return 0;
4108 }
4109
4110 /* This function returns non-zero iff there is a software breakpoint
4111 inserted at PC. */
4112
4113 int
4114 software_breakpoint_inserted_here_p (const address_space *aspace,
4115 CORE_ADDR pc)
4116 {
4117 struct bp_location **blp, **blp_tmp = NULL;
4118
4119 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS_AT_ADDR (blp, blp_tmp, pc)
4120 {
4121 struct bp_location *bl = *blp;
4122
4123 if (bl->loc_type != bp_loc_software_breakpoint)
4124 continue;
4125
4126 if (bp_location_inserted_here_p (bl, aspace, pc))
4127 return 1;
4128 }
4129
4130 return 0;
4131 }
4132
4133 /* See breakpoint.h. */
4134
4135 int
4136 hardware_breakpoint_inserted_here_p (const address_space *aspace,
4137 CORE_ADDR pc)
4138 {
4139 struct bp_location **blp, **blp_tmp = NULL;
4140
4141 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS_AT_ADDR (blp, blp_tmp, pc)
4142 {
4143 struct bp_location *bl = *blp;
4144
4145 if (bl->loc_type != bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
4146 continue;
4147
4148 if (bp_location_inserted_here_p (bl, aspace, pc))
4149 return 1;
4150 }
4151
4152 return 0;
4153 }
4154
4155 int
4156 hardware_watchpoint_inserted_in_range (const address_space *aspace,
4157 CORE_ADDR addr, ULONGEST len)
4158 {
4159 struct breakpoint *bpt;
4160
4161 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (bpt)
4162 {
4163 struct bp_location *loc;
4164
4165 if (bpt->type != bp_hardware_watchpoint
4166 && bpt->type != bp_access_watchpoint)
4167 continue;
4168
4169 if (!breakpoint_enabled (bpt))
4170 continue;
4171
4172 for (loc = bpt->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
4173 if (loc->pspace->aspace == aspace && loc->inserted)
4174 {
4175 CORE_ADDR l, h;
4176
4177 /* Check for intersection. */
4178 l = std::max<CORE_ADDR> (loc->address, addr);
4179 h = std::min<CORE_ADDR> (loc->address + loc->length, addr + len);
4180 if (l < h)
4181 return 1;
4182 }
4183 }
4184 return 0;
4185 }
4186 \f
4187
4188 /* bpstat stuff. External routines' interfaces are documented
4189 in breakpoint.h. */
4190
4191 int
4192 is_catchpoint (struct breakpoint *ep)
4193 {
4194 return (ep->type == bp_catchpoint);
4195 }
4196
4197 /* Frees any storage that is part of a bpstat. Does not walk the
4198 'next' chain. */
4199
4200 bpstats::~bpstats ()
4201 {
4202 if (old_val != NULL)
4203 value_free (old_val);
4204 if (bp_location_at != NULL)
4205 decref_bp_location (&bp_location_at);
4206 }
4207
4208 /* Clear a bpstat so that it says we are not at any breakpoint.
4209 Also free any storage that is part of a bpstat. */
4210
4211 void
4212 bpstat_clear (bpstat *bsp)
4213 {
4214 bpstat p;
4215 bpstat q;
4216
4217 if (bsp == 0)
4218 return;
4219 p = *bsp;
4220 while (p != NULL)
4221 {
4222 q = p->next;
4223 delete p;
4224 p = q;
4225 }
4226 *bsp = NULL;
4227 }
4228
4229 bpstats::bpstats (const bpstats &other)
4230 : next (NULL),
4231 bp_location_at (other.bp_location_at),
4232 breakpoint_at (other.breakpoint_at),
4233 commands (other.commands),
4234 old_val (other.old_val),
4235 print (other.print),
4236 stop (other.stop),
4237 print_it (other.print_it)
4238 {
4239 if (old_val != NULL)
4240 {
4241 old_val = value_copy (old_val);
4242 release_value (old_val);
4243 }
4244 incref_bp_location (bp_location_at);
4245 }
4246
4247 /* Return a copy of a bpstat. Like "bs1 = bs2" but all storage that
4248 is part of the bpstat is copied as well. */
4249
4250 bpstat
4251 bpstat_copy (bpstat bs)
4252 {
4253 bpstat p = NULL;
4254 bpstat tmp;
4255 bpstat retval = NULL;
4256
4257 if (bs == NULL)
4258 return bs;
4259
4260 for (; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
4261 {
4262 tmp = new bpstats (*bs);
4263
4264 if (p == NULL)
4265 /* This is the first thing in the chain. */
4266 retval = tmp;
4267 else
4268 p->next = tmp;
4269 p = tmp;
4270 }
4271 p->next = NULL;
4272 return retval;
4273 }
4274
4275 /* Find the bpstat associated with this breakpoint. */
4276
4277 bpstat
4278 bpstat_find_breakpoint (bpstat bsp, struct breakpoint *breakpoint)
4279 {
4280 if (bsp == NULL)
4281 return NULL;
4282
4283 for (; bsp != NULL; bsp = bsp->next)
4284 {
4285 if (bsp->breakpoint_at == breakpoint)
4286 return bsp;
4287 }
4288 return NULL;
4289 }
4290
4291 /* See breakpoint.h. */
4292
4293 int
4294 bpstat_explains_signal (bpstat bsp, enum gdb_signal sig)
4295 {
4296 for (; bsp != NULL; bsp = bsp->next)
4297 {
4298 if (bsp->breakpoint_at == NULL)
4299 {
4300 /* A moribund location can never explain a signal other than
4301 GDB_SIGNAL_TRAP. */
4302 if (sig == GDB_SIGNAL_TRAP)
4303 return 1;
4304 }
4305 else
4306 {
4307 if (bsp->breakpoint_at->ops->explains_signal (bsp->breakpoint_at,
4308 sig))
4309 return 1;
4310 }
4311 }
4312
4313 return 0;
4314 }
4315
4316 /* Put in *NUM the breakpoint number of the first breakpoint we are
4317 stopped at. *BSP upon return is a bpstat which points to the
4318 remaining breakpoints stopped at (but which is not guaranteed to be
4319 good for anything but further calls to bpstat_num).
4320
4321 Return 0 if passed a bpstat which does not indicate any breakpoints.
4322 Return -1 if stopped at a breakpoint that has been deleted since
4323 we set it.
4324 Return 1 otherwise. */
4325
4326 int
4327 bpstat_num (bpstat *bsp, int *num)
4328 {
4329 struct breakpoint *b;
4330
4331 if ((*bsp) == NULL)
4332 return 0; /* No more breakpoint values */
4333
4334 /* We assume we'll never have several bpstats that correspond to a
4335 single breakpoint -- otherwise, this function might return the
4336 same number more than once and this will look ugly. */
4337 b = (*bsp)->breakpoint_at;
4338 *bsp = (*bsp)->next;
4339 if (b == NULL)
4340 return -1; /* breakpoint that's been deleted since */
4341
4342 *num = b->number; /* We have its number */
4343 return 1;
4344 }
4345
4346 /* See breakpoint.h. */
4347
4348 void
4349 bpstat_clear_actions (void)
4350 {
4351 struct thread_info *tp;
4352 bpstat bs;
4353
4354 if (ptid_equal (inferior_ptid, null_ptid))
4355 return;
4356
4357 tp = find_thread_ptid (inferior_ptid);
4358 if (tp == NULL)
4359 return;
4360
4361 for (bs = tp->control.stop_bpstat; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
4362 {
4363 bs->commands = NULL;
4364
4365 if (bs->old_val != NULL)
4366 {
4367 value_free (bs->old_val);
4368 bs->old_val = NULL;
4369 }
4370 }
4371 }
4372
4373 /* Called when a command is about to proceed the inferior. */
4374
4375 static void
4376 breakpoint_about_to_proceed (void)
4377 {
4378 if (!ptid_equal (inferior_ptid, null_ptid))
4379 {
4380 struct thread_info *tp = inferior_thread ();
4381
4382 /* Allow inferior function calls in breakpoint commands to not
4383 interrupt the command list. When the call finishes
4384 successfully, the inferior will be standing at the same
4385 breakpoint as if nothing happened. */
4386 if (tp->control.in_infcall)
4387 return;
4388 }
4389
4390 breakpoint_proceeded = 1;
4391 }
4392
4393 /* Return non-zero iff CMD as the first line of a command sequence is `silent'
4394 or its equivalent. */
4395
4396 static int
4397 command_line_is_silent (struct command_line *cmd)
4398 {
4399 return cmd && (strcmp ("silent", cmd->line) == 0);
4400 }
4401
4402 /* Execute all the commands associated with all the breakpoints at
4403 this location. Any of these commands could cause the process to
4404 proceed beyond this point, etc. We look out for such changes by
4405 checking the global "breakpoint_proceeded" after each command.
4406
4407 Returns true if a breakpoint command resumed the inferior. In that
4408 case, it is the caller's responsibility to recall it again with the
4409 bpstat of the current thread. */
4410
4411 static int
4412 bpstat_do_actions_1 (bpstat *bsp)
4413 {
4414 bpstat bs;
4415 int again = 0;
4416
4417 /* Avoid endless recursion if a `source' command is contained
4418 in bs->commands. */
4419 if (executing_breakpoint_commands)
4420 return 0;
4421
4422 scoped_restore save_executing
4423 = make_scoped_restore (&executing_breakpoint_commands, 1);
4424
4425 scoped_restore preventer = prevent_dont_repeat ();
4426
4427 /* This pointer will iterate over the list of bpstat's. */
4428 bs = *bsp;
4429
4430 breakpoint_proceeded = 0;
4431 for (; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
4432 {
4433 struct command_line *cmd = NULL;
4434
4435 /* Take ownership of the BSP's command tree, if it has one.
4436
4437 The command tree could legitimately contain commands like
4438 'step' and 'next', which call clear_proceed_status, which
4439 frees stop_bpstat's command tree. To make sure this doesn't
4440 free the tree we're executing out from under us, we need to
4441 take ownership of the tree ourselves. Since a given bpstat's
4442 commands are only executed once, we don't need to copy it; we
4443 can clear the pointer in the bpstat, and make sure we free
4444 the tree when we're done. */
4445 counted_command_line ccmd = bs->commands;
4446 bs->commands = NULL;
4447 if (ccmd != NULL)
4448 cmd = ccmd.get ();
4449 if (command_line_is_silent (cmd))
4450 {
4451 /* The action has been already done by bpstat_stop_status. */
4452 cmd = cmd->next;
4453 }
4454
4455 while (cmd != NULL)
4456 {
4457 execute_control_command (cmd);
4458
4459 if (breakpoint_proceeded)
4460 break;
4461 else
4462 cmd = cmd->next;
4463 }
4464
4465 if (breakpoint_proceeded)
4466 {
4467 if (current_ui->async)
4468 /* If we are in async mode, then the target might be still
4469 running, not stopped at any breakpoint, so nothing for
4470 us to do here -- just return to the event loop. */
4471 ;
4472 else
4473 /* In sync mode, when execute_control_command returns
4474 we're already standing on the next breakpoint.
4475 Breakpoint commands for that stop were not run, since
4476 execute_command does not run breakpoint commands --
4477 only command_line_handler does, but that one is not
4478 involved in execution of breakpoint commands. So, we
4479 can now execute breakpoint commands. It should be
4480 noted that making execute_command do bpstat actions is
4481 not an option -- in this case we'll have recursive
4482 invocation of bpstat for each breakpoint with a
4483 command, and can easily blow up GDB stack. Instead, we
4484 return true, which will trigger the caller to recall us
4485 with the new stop_bpstat. */
4486 again = 1;
4487 break;
4488 }
4489 }
4490 return again;
4491 }
4492
4493 void
4494 bpstat_do_actions (void)
4495 {
4496 struct cleanup *cleanup_if_error = make_bpstat_clear_actions_cleanup ();
4497
4498 /* Do any commands attached to breakpoint we are stopped at. */
4499 while (!ptid_equal (inferior_ptid, null_ptid)
4500 && target_has_execution
4501 && !is_exited (inferior_ptid)
4502 && !is_executing (inferior_ptid))
4503 /* Since in sync mode, bpstat_do_actions may resume the inferior,
4504 and only return when it is stopped at the next breakpoint, we
4505 keep doing breakpoint actions until it returns false to
4506 indicate the inferior was not resumed. */
4507 if (!bpstat_do_actions_1 (&inferior_thread ()->control.stop_bpstat))
4508 break;
4509
4510 discard_cleanups (cleanup_if_error);
4511 }
4512
4513 /* Print out the (old or new) value associated with a watchpoint. */
4514
4515 static void
4516 watchpoint_value_print (struct value *val, struct ui_file *stream)
4517 {
4518 if (val == NULL)
4519 fprintf_unfiltered (stream, _("<unreadable>"));
4520 else
4521 {
4522 struct value_print_options opts;
4523 get_user_print_options (&opts);
4524 value_print (val, stream, &opts);
4525 }
4526 }
4527
4528 /* Print the "Thread ID hit" part of "Thread ID hit Breakpoint N" if
4529 debugging multiple threads. */
4530
4531 void
4532 maybe_print_thread_hit_breakpoint (struct ui_out *uiout)
4533 {
4534 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
4535 return;
4536
4537 uiout->text ("\n");
4538
4539 if (show_thread_that_caused_stop ())
4540 {
4541 const char *name;
4542 struct thread_info *thr = inferior_thread ();
4543
4544 uiout->text ("Thread ");
4545 uiout->field_fmt ("thread-id", "%s", print_thread_id (thr));
4546
4547 name = thr->name != NULL ? thr->name : target_thread_name (thr);
4548 if (name != NULL)
4549 {
4550 uiout->text (" \"");
4551 uiout->field_fmt ("name", "%s", name);
4552 uiout->text ("\"");
4553 }
4554
4555 uiout->text (" hit ");
4556 }
4557 }
4558
4559 /* Generic routine for printing messages indicating why we
4560 stopped. The behavior of this function depends on the value
4561 'print_it' in the bpstat structure. Under some circumstances we
4562 may decide not to print anything here and delegate the task to
4563 normal_stop(). */
4564
4565 static enum print_stop_action
4566 print_bp_stop_message (bpstat bs)
4567 {
4568 switch (bs->print_it)
4569 {
4570 case print_it_noop:
4571 /* Nothing should be printed for this bpstat entry. */
4572 return PRINT_UNKNOWN;
4573 break;
4574
4575 case print_it_done:
4576 /* We still want to print the frame, but we already printed the
4577 relevant messages. */
4578 return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
4579 break;
4580
4581 case print_it_normal:
4582 {
4583 struct breakpoint *b = bs->breakpoint_at;
4584
4585 /* bs->breakpoint_at can be NULL if it was a momentary breakpoint
4586 which has since been deleted. */
4587 if (b == NULL)
4588 return PRINT_UNKNOWN;
4589
4590 /* Normal case. Call the breakpoint's print_it method. */
4591 return b->ops->print_it (bs);
4592 }
4593 break;
4594
4595 default:
4596 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
4597 _("print_bp_stop_message: unrecognized enum value"));
4598 break;
4599 }
4600 }
4601
4602 /* A helper function that prints a shared library stopped event. */
4603
4604 static void
4605 print_solib_event (int is_catchpoint)
4606 {
4607 int any_deleted
4608 = !VEC_empty (char_ptr, current_program_space->deleted_solibs);
4609 int any_added
4610 = !VEC_empty (so_list_ptr, current_program_space->added_solibs);
4611
4612 if (!is_catchpoint)
4613 {
4614 if (any_added || any_deleted)
4615 current_uiout->text (_("Stopped due to shared library event:\n"));
4616 else
4617 current_uiout->text (_("Stopped due to shared library event (no "
4618 "libraries added or removed)\n"));
4619 }
4620
4621 if (current_uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
4622 current_uiout->field_string ("reason",
4623 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_SOLIB_EVENT));
4624
4625 if (any_deleted)
4626 {
4627 char *name;
4628 int ix;
4629
4630 current_uiout->text (_(" Inferior unloaded "));
4631 ui_out_emit_list list_emitter (current_uiout, "removed");
4632 for (ix = 0;
4633 VEC_iterate (char_ptr, current_program_space->deleted_solibs,
4634 ix, name);
4635 ++ix)
4636 {
4637 if (ix > 0)
4638 current_uiout->text (" ");
4639 current_uiout->field_string ("library", name);
4640 current_uiout->text ("\n");
4641 }
4642 }
4643
4644 if (any_added)
4645 {
4646 struct so_list *iter;
4647 int ix;
4648
4649 current_uiout->text (_(" Inferior loaded "));
4650 ui_out_emit_list list_emitter (current_uiout, "added");
4651 for (ix = 0;
4652 VEC_iterate (so_list_ptr, current_program_space->added_solibs,
4653 ix, iter);
4654 ++ix)
4655 {
4656 if (ix > 0)
4657 current_uiout->text (" ");
4658 current_uiout->field_string ("library", iter->so_name);
4659 current_uiout->text ("\n");
4660 }
4661 }
4662 }
4663
4664 /* Print a message indicating what happened. This is called from
4665 normal_stop(). The input to this routine is the head of the bpstat
4666 list - a list of the eventpoints that caused this stop. KIND is
4667 the target_waitkind for the stopping event. This
4668 routine calls the generic print routine for printing a message
4669 about reasons for stopping. This will print (for example) the
4670 "Breakpoint n," part of the output. The return value of this
4671 routine is one of:
4672
4673 PRINT_UNKNOWN: Means we printed nothing.
4674 PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC: Means we printed something, and expect subsequent
4675 code to print the location. An example is
4676 "Breakpoint 1, " which should be followed by
4677 the location.
4678 PRINT_SRC_ONLY: Means we printed something, but there is no need
4679 to also print the location part of the message.
4680 An example is the catch/throw messages, which
4681 don't require a location appended to the end.
4682 PRINT_NOTHING: We have done some printing and we don't need any
4683 further info to be printed. */
4684
4685 enum print_stop_action
4686 bpstat_print (bpstat bs, int kind)
4687 {
4688 enum print_stop_action val;
4689
4690 /* Maybe another breakpoint in the chain caused us to stop.
4691 (Currently all watchpoints go on the bpstat whether hit or not.
4692 That probably could (should) be changed, provided care is taken
4693 with respect to bpstat_explains_signal). */
4694 for (; bs; bs = bs->next)
4695 {
4696 val = print_bp_stop_message (bs);
4697 if (val == PRINT_SRC_ONLY
4698 || val == PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC
4699 || val == PRINT_NOTHING)
4700 return val;
4701 }
4702
4703 /* If we had hit a shared library event breakpoint,
4704 print_bp_stop_message would print out this message. If we hit an
4705 OS-level shared library event, do the same thing. */
4706 if (kind == TARGET_WAITKIND_LOADED)
4707 {
4708 print_solib_event (0);
4709 return PRINT_NOTHING;
4710 }
4711
4712 /* We reached the end of the chain, or we got a null BS to start
4713 with and nothing was printed. */
4714 return PRINT_UNKNOWN;
4715 }
4716
4717 /* Evaluate the boolean expression EXP and return the result. */
4718
4719 static bool
4720 breakpoint_cond_eval (expression *exp)
4721 {
4722 struct value *mark = value_mark ();
4723 bool res = value_true (evaluate_expression (exp));
4724
4725 value_free_to_mark (mark);
4726 return res;
4727 }
4728
4729 /* Allocate a new bpstat. Link it to the FIFO list by BS_LINK_POINTER. */
4730
4731 bpstats::bpstats (struct bp_location *bl, bpstat **bs_link_pointer)
4732 : next (NULL),
4733 bp_location_at (bl),
4734 breakpoint_at (bl->owner),
4735 commands (NULL),
4736 old_val (NULL),
4737 print (0),
4738 stop (0),
4739 print_it (print_it_normal)
4740 {
4741 incref_bp_location (bl);
4742 **bs_link_pointer = this;
4743 *bs_link_pointer = &next;
4744 }
4745
4746 bpstats::bpstats ()
4747 : next (NULL),
4748 bp_location_at (NULL),
4749 breakpoint_at (NULL),
4750 commands (NULL),
4751 old_val (NULL),
4752 print (0),
4753 stop (0),
4754 print_it (print_it_normal)
4755 {
4756 }
4757 \f
4758 /* The target has stopped with waitstatus WS. Check if any hardware
4759 watchpoints have triggered, according to the target. */
4760
4761 int
4762 watchpoints_triggered (struct target_waitstatus *ws)
4763 {
4764 int stopped_by_watchpoint = target_stopped_by_watchpoint ();
4765 CORE_ADDR addr;
4766 struct breakpoint *b;
4767
4768 if (!stopped_by_watchpoint)
4769 {
4770 /* We were not stopped by a watchpoint. Mark all watchpoints
4771 as not triggered. */
4772 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
4773 if (is_hardware_watchpoint (b))
4774 {
4775 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
4776
4777 w->watchpoint_triggered = watch_triggered_no;
4778 }
4779
4780 return 0;
4781 }
4782
4783 if (!target_stopped_data_address (&current_target, &addr))
4784 {
4785 /* We were stopped by a watchpoint, but we don't know where.
4786 Mark all watchpoints as unknown. */
4787 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
4788 if (is_hardware_watchpoint (b))
4789 {
4790 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
4791
4792 w->watchpoint_triggered = watch_triggered_unknown;
4793 }
4794
4795 return 1;
4796 }
4797
4798 /* The target could report the data address. Mark watchpoints
4799 affected by this data address as triggered, and all others as not
4800 triggered. */
4801
4802 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
4803 if (is_hardware_watchpoint (b))
4804 {
4805 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
4806 struct bp_location *loc;
4807
4808 w->watchpoint_triggered = watch_triggered_no;
4809 for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
4810 {
4811 if (is_masked_watchpoint (b))
4812 {
4813 CORE_ADDR newaddr = addr & w->hw_wp_mask;
4814 CORE_ADDR start = loc->address & w->hw_wp_mask;
4815
4816 if (newaddr == start)
4817 {
4818 w->watchpoint_triggered = watch_triggered_yes;
4819 break;
4820 }
4821 }
4822 /* Exact match not required. Within range is sufficient. */
4823 else if (target_watchpoint_addr_within_range (&current_target,
4824 addr, loc->address,
4825 loc->length))
4826 {
4827 w->watchpoint_triggered = watch_triggered_yes;
4828 break;
4829 }
4830 }
4831 }
4832
4833 return 1;
4834 }
4835
4836 /* Possible return values for watchpoint_check. */
4837 enum wp_check_result
4838 {
4839 /* The watchpoint has been deleted. */
4840 WP_DELETED = 1,
4841
4842 /* The value has changed. */
4843 WP_VALUE_CHANGED = 2,
4844
4845 /* The value has not changed. */
4846 WP_VALUE_NOT_CHANGED = 3,
4847
4848 /* Ignore this watchpoint, no matter if the value changed or not. */
4849 WP_IGNORE = 4,
4850 };
4851
4852 #define BP_TEMPFLAG 1
4853 #define BP_HARDWAREFLAG 2
4854
4855 /* Evaluate watchpoint condition expression and check if its value
4856 changed. */
4857
4858 static wp_check_result
4859 watchpoint_check (bpstat bs)
4860 {
4861 struct watchpoint *b;
4862 struct frame_info *fr;
4863 int within_current_scope;
4864
4865 /* BS is built from an existing struct breakpoint. */
4866 gdb_assert (bs->breakpoint_at != NULL);
4867 b = (struct watchpoint *) bs->breakpoint_at;
4868
4869 /* If this is a local watchpoint, we only want to check if the
4870 watchpoint frame is in scope if the current thread is the thread
4871 that was used to create the watchpoint. */
4872 if (!watchpoint_in_thread_scope (b))
4873 return WP_IGNORE;
4874
4875 if (b->exp_valid_block == NULL)
4876 within_current_scope = 1;
4877 else
4878 {
4879 struct frame_info *frame = get_current_frame ();
4880 struct gdbarch *frame_arch = get_frame_arch (frame);
4881 CORE_ADDR frame_pc = get_frame_pc (frame);
4882
4883 /* stack_frame_destroyed_p() returns a non-zero value if we're
4884 still in the function but the stack frame has already been
4885 invalidated. Since we can't rely on the values of local
4886 variables after the stack has been destroyed, we are treating
4887 the watchpoint in that state as `not changed' without further
4888 checking. Don't mark watchpoints as changed if the current
4889 frame is in an epilogue - even if they are in some other
4890 frame, our view of the stack is likely to be wrong and
4891 frame_find_by_id could error out. */
4892 if (gdbarch_stack_frame_destroyed_p (frame_arch, frame_pc))
4893 return WP_IGNORE;
4894
4895 fr = frame_find_by_id (b->watchpoint_frame);
4896 within_current_scope = (fr != NULL);
4897
4898 /* If we've gotten confused in the unwinder, we might have
4899 returned a frame that can't describe this variable. */
4900 if (within_current_scope)
4901 {
4902 struct symbol *function;
4903
4904 function = get_frame_function (fr);
4905 if (function == NULL
4906 || !contained_in (b->exp_valid_block,
4907 SYMBOL_BLOCK_VALUE (function)))
4908 within_current_scope = 0;
4909 }
4910
4911 if (within_current_scope)
4912 /* If we end up stopping, the current frame will get selected
4913 in normal_stop. So this call to select_frame won't affect
4914 the user. */
4915 select_frame (fr);
4916 }
4917
4918 if (within_current_scope)
4919 {
4920 /* We use value_{,free_to_}mark because it could be a *long*
4921 time before we return to the command level and call
4922 free_all_values. We can't call free_all_values because we
4923 might be in the middle of evaluating a function call. */
4924
4925 int pc = 0;
4926 struct value *mark;
4927 struct value *new_val;
4928
4929 if (is_masked_watchpoint (b))
4930 /* Since we don't know the exact trigger address (from
4931 stopped_data_address), just tell the user we've triggered
4932 a mask watchpoint. */
4933 return WP_VALUE_CHANGED;
4934
4935 mark = value_mark ();
4936 fetch_subexp_value (b->exp.get (), &pc, &new_val, NULL, NULL, 0);
4937
4938 if (b->val_bitsize != 0)
4939 new_val = extract_bitfield_from_watchpoint_value (b, new_val);
4940
4941 /* We use value_equal_contents instead of value_equal because
4942 the latter coerces an array to a pointer, thus comparing just
4943 the address of the array instead of its contents. This is
4944 not what we want. */
4945 if ((b->val != NULL) != (new_val != NULL)
4946 || (b->val != NULL && !value_equal_contents (b->val, new_val)))
4947 {
4948 if (new_val != NULL)
4949 {
4950 release_value (new_val);
4951 value_free_to_mark (mark);
4952 }
4953 bs->old_val = b->val;
4954 b->val = new_val;
4955 b->val_valid = 1;
4956 return WP_VALUE_CHANGED;
4957 }
4958 else
4959 {
4960 /* Nothing changed. */
4961 value_free_to_mark (mark);
4962 return WP_VALUE_NOT_CHANGED;
4963 }
4964 }
4965 else
4966 {
4967 /* This seems like the only logical thing to do because
4968 if we temporarily ignored the watchpoint, then when
4969 we reenter the block in which it is valid it contains
4970 garbage (in the case of a function, it may have two
4971 garbage values, one before and one after the prologue).
4972 So we can't even detect the first assignment to it and
4973 watch after that (since the garbage may or may not equal
4974 the first value assigned). */
4975 /* We print all the stop information in
4976 breakpoint_ops->print_it, but in this case, by the time we
4977 call breakpoint_ops->print_it this bp will be deleted
4978 already. So we have no choice but print the information
4979 here. */
4980
4981 SWITCH_THRU_ALL_UIS ()
4982 {
4983 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
4984
4985 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
4986 uiout->field_string
4987 ("reason", async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_WATCHPOINT_SCOPE));
4988 uiout->text ("\nWatchpoint ");
4989 uiout->field_int ("wpnum", b->number);
4990 uiout->text (" deleted because the program has left the block in\n"
4991 "which its expression is valid.\n");
4992 }
4993
4994 /* Make sure the watchpoint's commands aren't executed. */
4995 b->commands = NULL;
4996 watchpoint_del_at_next_stop (b);
4997
4998 return WP_DELETED;
4999 }
5000 }
5001
5002 /* Return true if it looks like target has stopped due to hitting
5003 breakpoint location BL. This function does not check if we should
5004 stop, only if BL explains the stop. */
5005
5006 static int
5007 bpstat_check_location (const struct bp_location *bl,
5008 const address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR bp_addr,
5009 const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
5010 {
5011 struct breakpoint *b = bl->owner;
5012
5013 /* BL is from an existing breakpoint. */
5014 gdb_assert (b != NULL);
5015
5016 return b->ops->breakpoint_hit (bl, aspace, bp_addr, ws);
5017 }
5018
5019 /* Determine if the watched values have actually changed, and we
5020 should stop. If not, set BS->stop to 0. */
5021
5022 static void
5023 bpstat_check_watchpoint (bpstat bs)
5024 {
5025 const struct bp_location *bl;
5026 struct watchpoint *b;
5027
5028 /* BS is built for existing struct breakpoint. */
5029 bl = bs->bp_location_at;
5030 gdb_assert (bl != NULL);
5031 b = (struct watchpoint *) bs->breakpoint_at;
5032 gdb_assert (b != NULL);
5033
5034 {
5035 int must_check_value = 0;
5036
5037 if (b->type == bp_watchpoint)
5038 /* For a software watchpoint, we must always check the
5039 watched value. */
5040 must_check_value = 1;
5041 else if (b->watchpoint_triggered == watch_triggered_yes)
5042 /* We have a hardware watchpoint (read, write, or access)
5043 and the target earlier reported an address watched by
5044 this watchpoint. */
5045 must_check_value = 1;
5046 else if (b->watchpoint_triggered == watch_triggered_unknown
5047 && b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint)
5048 /* We were stopped by a hardware watchpoint, but the target could
5049 not report the data address. We must check the watchpoint's
5050 value. Access and read watchpoints are out of luck; without
5051 a data address, we can't figure it out. */
5052 must_check_value = 1;
5053
5054 if (must_check_value)
5055 {
5056 wp_check_result e;
5057
5058 TRY
5059 {
5060 e = watchpoint_check (bs);
5061 }
5062 CATCH (ex, RETURN_MASK_ALL)
5063 {
5064 exception_fprintf (gdb_stderr, ex,
5065 "Error evaluating expression "
5066 "for watchpoint %d\n",
5067 b->number);
5068
5069 SWITCH_THRU_ALL_UIS ()
5070 {
5071 printf_filtered (_("Watchpoint %d deleted.\n"),
5072 b->number);
5073 }
5074 watchpoint_del_at_next_stop (b);
5075 e = WP_DELETED;
5076 }
5077 END_CATCH
5078
5079 switch (e)
5080 {
5081 case WP_DELETED:
5082 /* We've already printed what needs to be printed. */
5083 bs->print_it = print_it_done;
5084 /* Stop. */
5085 break;
5086 case WP_IGNORE:
5087 bs->print_it = print_it_noop;
5088 bs->stop = 0;
5089 break;
5090 case WP_VALUE_CHANGED:
5091 if (b->type == bp_read_watchpoint)
5092 {
5093 /* There are two cases to consider here:
5094
5095 1. We're watching the triggered memory for reads.
5096 In that case, trust the target, and always report
5097 the watchpoint hit to the user. Even though
5098 reads don't cause value changes, the value may
5099 have changed since the last time it was read, and
5100 since we're not trapping writes, we will not see
5101 those, and as such we should ignore our notion of
5102 old value.
5103
5104 2. We're watching the triggered memory for both
5105 reads and writes. There are two ways this may
5106 happen:
5107
5108 2.1. This is a target that can't break on data
5109 reads only, but can break on accesses (reads or
5110 writes), such as e.g., x86. We detect this case
5111 at the time we try to insert read watchpoints.
5112
5113 2.2. Otherwise, the target supports read
5114 watchpoints, but, the user set an access or write
5115 watchpoint watching the same memory as this read
5116 watchpoint.
5117
5118 If we're watching memory writes as well as reads,
5119 ignore watchpoint hits when we find that the
5120 value hasn't changed, as reads don't cause
5121 changes. This still gives false positives when
5122 the program writes the same value to memory as
5123 what there was already in memory (we will confuse
5124 it for a read), but it's much better than
5125 nothing. */
5126
5127 int other_write_watchpoint = 0;
5128
5129 if (bl->watchpoint_type == hw_read)
5130 {
5131 struct breakpoint *other_b;
5132
5133 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (other_b)
5134 if (other_b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint
5135 || other_b->type == bp_access_watchpoint)
5136 {
5137 struct watchpoint *other_w =
5138 (struct watchpoint *) other_b;
5139
5140 if (other_w->watchpoint_triggered
5141 == watch_triggered_yes)
5142 {
5143 other_write_watchpoint = 1;
5144 break;
5145 }
5146 }
5147 }
5148
5149 if (other_write_watchpoint
5150 || bl->watchpoint_type == hw_access)
5151 {
5152 /* We're watching the same memory for writes,
5153 and the value changed since the last time we
5154 updated it, so this trap must be for a write.
5155 Ignore it. */
5156 bs->print_it = print_it_noop;
5157 bs->stop = 0;
5158 }
5159 }
5160 break;
5161 case WP_VALUE_NOT_CHANGED:
5162 if (b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint
5163 || b->type == bp_watchpoint)
5164 {
5165 /* Don't stop: write watchpoints shouldn't fire if
5166 the value hasn't changed. */
5167 bs->print_it = print_it_noop;
5168 bs->stop = 0;
5169 }
5170 /* Stop. */
5171 break;
5172 default:
5173 /* Can't happen. */
5174 break;
5175 }
5176 }
5177 else /* must_check_value == 0 */
5178 {
5179 /* This is a case where some watchpoint(s) triggered, but
5180 not at the address of this watchpoint, or else no
5181 watchpoint triggered after all. So don't print
5182 anything for this watchpoint. */
5183 bs->print_it = print_it_noop;
5184 bs->stop = 0;
5185 }
5186 }
5187 }
5188
5189 /* For breakpoints that are currently marked as telling gdb to stop,
5190 check conditions (condition proper, frame, thread and ignore count)
5191 of breakpoint referred to by BS. If we should not stop for this
5192 breakpoint, set BS->stop to 0. */
5193
5194 static void
5195 bpstat_check_breakpoint_conditions (bpstat bs, ptid_t ptid)
5196 {
5197 const struct bp_location *bl;
5198 struct breakpoint *b;
5199 /* Assume stop. */
5200 bool condition_result = true;
5201 struct expression *cond;
5202
5203 gdb_assert (bs->stop);
5204
5205 /* BS is built for existing struct breakpoint. */
5206 bl = bs->bp_location_at;
5207 gdb_assert (bl != NULL);
5208 b = bs->breakpoint_at;
5209 gdb_assert (b != NULL);
5210
5211 /* Even if the target evaluated the condition on its end and notified GDB, we
5212 need to do so again since GDB does not know if we stopped due to a
5213 breakpoint or a single step breakpoint. */
5214
5215 if (frame_id_p (b->frame_id)
5216 && !frame_id_eq (b->frame_id, get_stack_frame_id (get_current_frame ())))
5217 {
5218 bs->stop = 0;
5219 return;
5220 }
5221
5222 /* If this is a thread/task-specific breakpoint, don't waste cpu
5223 evaluating the condition if this isn't the specified
5224 thread/task. */
5225 if ((b->thread != -1 && b->thread != ptid_to_global_thread_id (ptid))
5226 || (b->task != 0 && b->task != ada_get_task_number (ptid)))
5227
5228 {
5229 bs->stop = 0;
5230 return;
5231 }
5232
5233 /* Evaluate extension language breakpoints that have a "stop" method
5234 implemented. */
5235 bs->stop = breakpoint_ext_lang_cond_says_stop (b);
5236
5237 if (is_watchpoint (b))
5238 {
5239 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
5240
5241 cond = w->cond_exp.get ();
5242 }
5243 else
5244 cond = bl->cond.get ();
5245
5246 if (cond && b->disposition != disp_del_at_next_stop)
5247 {
5248 int within_current_scope = 1;
5249 struct watchpoint * w;
5250
5251 /* We use value_mark and value_free_to_mark because it could
5252 be a long time before we return to the command level and
5253 call free_all_values. We can't call free_all_values
5254 because we might be in the middle of evaluating a
5255 function call. */
5256 struct value *mark = value_mark ();
5257
5258 if (is_watchpoint (b))
5259 w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
5260 else
5261 w = NULL;
5262
5263 /* Need to select the frame, with all that implies so that
5264 the conditions will have the right context. Because we
5265 use the frame, we will not see an inlined function's
5266 variables when we arrive at a breakpoint at the start
5267 of the inlined function; the current frame will be the
5268 call site. */
5269 if (w == NULL || w->cond_exp_valid_block == NULL)
5270 select_frame (get_current_frame ());
5271 else
5272 {
5273 struct frame_info *frame;
5274
5275 /* For local watchpoint expressions, which particular
5276 instance of a local is being watched matters, so we
5277 keep track of the frame to evaluate the expression
5278 in. To evaluate the condition however, it doesn't
5279 really matter which instantiation of the function
5280 where the condition makes sense triggers the
5281 watchpoint. This allows an expression like "watch
5282 global if q > 10" set in `func', catch writes to
5283 global on all threads that call `func', or catch
5284 writes on all recursive calls of `func' by a single
5285 thread. We simply always evaluate the condition in
5286 the innermost frame that's executing where it makes
5287 sense to evaluate the condition. It seems
5288 intuitive. */
5289 frame = block_innermost_frame (w->cond_exp_valid_block);
5290 if (frame != NULL)
5291 select_frame (frame);
5292 else
5293 within_current_scope = 0;
5294 }
5295 if (within_current_scope)
5296 {
5297 TRY
5298 {
5299 condition_result = breakpoint_cond_eval (cond);
5300 }
5301 CATCH (ex, RETURN_MASK_ALL)
5302 {
5303 exception_fprintf (gdb_stderr, ex,
5304 "Error in testing breakpoint condition:\n");
5305 }
5306 END_CATCH
5307 }
5308 else
5309 {
5310 warning (_("Watchpoint condition cannot be tested "
5311 "in the current scope"));
5312 /* If we failed to set the right context for this
5313 watchpoint, unconditionally report it. */
5314 }
5315 /* FIXME-someday, should give breakpoint #. */
5316 value_free_to_mark (mark);
5317 }
5318
5319 if (cond && !condition_result)
5320 {
5321 bs->stop = 0;
5322 }
5323 else if (b->ignore_count > 0)
5324 {
5325 b->ignore_count--;
5326 bs->stop = 0;
5327 /* Increase the hit count even though we don't stop. */
5328 ++(b->hit_count);
5329 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (b);
5330 }
5331 }
5332
5333 /* Returns true if we need to track moribund locations of LOC's type
5334 on the current target. */
5335
5336 static int
5337 need_moribund_for_location_type (struct bp_location *loc)
5338 {
5339 return ((loc->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint
5340 && !target_supports_stopped_by_sw_breakpoint ())
5341 || (loc->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint
5342 && !target_supports_stopped_by_hw_breakpoint ()));
5343 }
5344
5345
5346 /* Get a bpstat associated with having just stopped at address
5347 BP_ADDR in thread PTID.
5348
5349 Determine whether we stopped at a breakpoint, etc, or whether we
5350 don't understand this stop. Result is a chain of bpstat's such
5351 that:
5352
5353 if we don't understand the stop, the result is a null pointer.
5354
5355 if we understand why we stopped, the result is not null.
5356
5357 Each element of the chain refers to a particular breakpoint or
5358 watchpoint at which we have stopped. (We may have stopped for
5359 several reasons concurrently.)
5360
5361 Each element of the chain has valid next, breakpoint_at,
5362 commands, FIXME??? fields. */
5363
5364 bpstat
5365 bpstat_stop_status (const address_space *aspace,
5366 CORE_ADDR bp_addr, ptid_t ptid,
5367 const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
5368 {
5369 struct breakpoint *b = NULL;
5370 struct bp_location *bl;
5371 struct bp_location *loc;
5372 /* First item of allocated bpstat's. */
5373 bpstat bs_head = NULL, *bs_link = &bs_head;
5374 /* Pointer to the last thing in the chain currently. */
5375 bpstat bs;
5376 int ix;
5377 int need_remove_insert;
5378 int removed_any;
5379
5380 /* First, build the bpstat chain with locations that explain a
5381 target stop, while being careful to not set the target running,
5382 as that may invalidate locations (in particular watchpoint
5383 locations are recreated). Resuming will happen here with
5384 breakpoint conditions or watchpoint expressions that include
5385 inferior function calls. */
5386
5387 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
5388 {
5389 if (!breakpoint_enabled (b))
5390 continue;
5391
5392 for (bl = b->loc; bl != NULL; bl = bl->next)
5393 {
5394 /* For hardware watchpoints, we look only at the first
5395 location. The watchpoint_check function will work on the
5396 entire expression, not the individual locations. For
5397 read watchpoints, the watchpoints_triggered function has
5398 checked all locations already. */
5399 if (b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint && bl != b->loc)
5400 break;
5401
5402 if (!bl->enabled || bl->shlib_disabled)
5403 continue;
5404
5405 if (!bpstat_check_location (bl, aspace, bp_addr, ws))
5406 continue;
5407
5408 /* Come here if it's a watchpoint, or if the break address
5409 matches. */
5410
5411 bs = new bpstats (bl, &bs_link); /* Alloc a bpstat to
5412 explain stop. */
5413
5414 /* Assume we stop. Should we find a watchpoint that is not
5415 actually triggered, or if the condition of the breakpoint
5416 evaluates as false, we'll reset 'stop' to 0. */
5417 bs->stop = 1;
5418 bs->print = 1;
5419
5420 /* If this is a scope breakpoint, mark the associated
5421 watchpoint as triggered so that we will handle the
5422 out-of-scope event. We'll get to the watchpoint next
5423 iteration. */
5424 if (b->type == bp_watchpoint_scope && b->related_breakpoint != b)
5425 {
5426 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b->related_breakpoint;
5427
5428 w->watchpoint_triggered = watch_triggered_yes;
5429 }
5430 }
5431 }
5432
5433 /* Check if a moribund breakpoint explains the stop. */
5434 if (!target_supports_stopped_by_sw_breakpoint ()
5435 || !target_supports_stopped_by_hw_breakpoint ())
5436 {
5437 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (bp_location_p, moribund_locations, ix, loc); ++ix)
5438 {
5439 if (breakpoint_location_address_match (loc, aspace, bp_addr)
5440 && need_moribund_for_location_type (loc))
5441 {
5442 bs = new bpstats (loc, &bs_link);
5443 /* For hits of moribund locations, we should just proceed. */
5444 bs->stop = 0;
5445 bs->print = 0;
5446 bs->print_it = print_it_noop;
5447 }
5448 }
5449 }
5450
5451 /* A bit of special processing for shlib breakpoints. We need to
5452 process solib loading here, so that the lists of loaded and
5453 unloaded libraries are correct before we handle "catch load" and
5454 "catch unload". */
5455 for (bs = bs_head; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
5456 {
5457 if (bs->breakpoint_at && bs->breakpoint_at->type == bp_shlib_event)
5458 {
5459 handle_solib_event ();
5460 break;
5461 }
5462 }
5463
5464 /* Now go through the locations that caused the target to stop, and
5465 check whether we're interested in reporting this stop to higher
5466 layers, or whether we should resume the target transparently. */
5467
5468 removed_any = 0;
5469
5470 for (bs = bs_head; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
5471 {
5472 if (!bs->stop)
5473 continue;
5474
5475 b = bs->breakpoint_at;
5476 b->ops->check_status (bs);
5477 if (bs->stop)
5478 {
5479 bpstat_check_breakpoint_conditions (bs, ptid);
5480
5481 if (bs->stop)
5482 {
5483 ++(b->hit_count);
5484 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (b);
5485
5486 /* We will stop here. */
5487 if (b->disposition == disp_disable)
5488 {
5489 --(b->enable_count);
5490 if (b->enable_count <= 0)
5491 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
5492 removed_any = 1;
5493 }
5494 if (b->silent)
5495 bs->print = 0;
5496 bs->commands = b->commands;
5497 if (command_line_is_silent (bs->commands
5498 ? bs->commands.get () : NULL))
5499 bs->print = 0;
5500
5501 b->ops->after_condition_true (bs);
5502 }
5503
5504 }
5505
5506 /* Print nothing for this entry if we don't stop or don't
5507 print. */
5508 if (!bs->stop || !bs->print)
5509 bs->print_it = print_it_noop;
5510 }
5511
5512 /* If we aren't stopping, the value of some hardware watchpoint may
5513 not have changed, but the intermediate memory locations we are
5514 watching may have. Don't bother if we're stopping; this will get
5515 done later. */
5516 need_remove_insert = 0;
5517 if (! bpstat_causes_stop (bs_head))
5518 for (bs = bs_head; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
5519 if (!bs->stop
5520 && bs->breakpoint_at
5521 && is_hardware_watchpoint (bs->breakpoint_at))
5522 {
5523 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) bs->breakpoint_at;
5524
5525 update_watchpoint (w, 0 /* don't reparse. */);
5526 need_remove_insert = 1;
5527 }
5528
5529 if (need_remove_insert)
5530 update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
5531 else if (removed_any)
5532 update_global_location_list (UGLL_DONT_INSERT);
5533
5534 return bs_head;
5535 }
5536
5537 static void
5538 handle_jit_event (void)
5539 {
5540 struct frame_info *frame;
5541 struct gdbarch *gdbarch;
5542
5543 if (debug_infrun)
5544 fprintf_unfiltered (gdb_stdlog, "handling bp_jit_event\n");
5545
5546 /* Switch terminal for any messages produced by
5547 breakpoint_re_set. */
5548 target_terminal::ours_for_output ();
5549
5550 frame = get_current_frame ();
5551 gdbarch = get_frame_arch (frame);
5552
5553 jit_event_handler (gdbarch);
5554
5555 target_terminal::inferior ();
5556 }
5557
5558 /* Prepare WHAT final decision for infrun. */
5559
5560 /* Decide what infrun needs to do with this bpstat. */
5561
5562 struct bpstat_what
5563 bpstat_what (bpstat bs_head)
5564 {
5565 struct bpstat_what retval;
5566 bpstat bs;
5567
5568 retval.main_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_KEEP_CHECKING;
5569 retval.call_dummy = STOP_NONE;
5570 retval.is_longjmp = 0;
5571
5572 for (bs = bs_head; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
5573 {
5574 /* Extract this BS's action. After processing each BS, we check
5575 if its action overrides all we've seem so far. */
5576 enum bpstat_what_main_action this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_KEEP_CHECKING;
5577 enum bptype bptype;
5578
5579 if (bs->breakpoint_at == NULL)
5580 {
5581 /* I suspect this can happen if it was a momentary
5582 breakpoint which has since been deleted. */
5583 bptype = bp_none;
5584 }
5585 else
5586 bptype = bs->breakpoint_at->type;
5587
5588 switch (bptype)
5589 {
5590 case bp_none:
5591 break;
5592 case bp_breakpoint:
5593 case bp_hardware_breakpoint:
5594 case bp_single_step:
5595 case bp_until:
5596 case bp_finish:
5597 case bp_shlib_event:
5598 if (bs->stop)
5599 {
5600 if (bs->print)
5601 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_NOISY;
5602 else
5603 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_SILENT;
5604 }
5605 else
5606 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE;
5607 break;
5608 case bp_watchpoint:
5609 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
5610 case bp_read_watchpoint:
5611 case bp_access_watchpoint:
5612 if (bs->stop)
5613 {
5614 if (bs->print)
5615 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_NOISY;
5616 else
5617 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_SILENT;
5618 }
5619 else
5620 {
5621 /* There was a watchpoint, but we're not stopping.
5622 This requires no further action. */
5623 }
5624 break;
5625 case bp_longjmp:
5626 case bp_longjmp_call_dummy:
5627 case bp_exception:
5628 if (bs->stop)
5629 {
5630 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SET_LONGJMP_RESUME;
5631 retval.is_longjmp = bptype != bp_exception;
5632 }
5633 else
5634 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE;
5635 break;
5636 case bp_longjmp_resume:
5637 case bp_exception_resume:
5638 if (bs->stop)
5639 {
5640 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_CLEAR_LONGJMP_RESUME;
5641 retval.is_longjmp = bptype == bp_longjmp_resume;
5642 }
5643 else
5644 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE;
5645 break;
5646 case bp_step_resume:
5647 if (bs->stop)
5648 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STEP_RESUME;
5649 else
5650 {
5651 /* It is for the wrong frame. */
5652 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE;
5653 }
5654 break;
5655 case bp_hp_step_resume:
5656 if (bs->stop)
5657 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_HP_STEP_RESUME;
5658 else
5659 {
5660 /* It is for the wrong frame. */
5661 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE;
5662 }
5663 break;
5664 case bp_watchpoint_scope:
5665 case bp_thread_event:
5666 case bp_overlay_event:
5667 case bp_longjmp_master:
5668 case bp_std_terminate_master:
5669 case bp_exception_master:
5670 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE;
5671 break;
5672 case bp_catchpoint:
5673 if (bs->stop)
5674 {
5675 if (bs->print)
5676 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_NOISY;
5677 else
5678 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_SILENT;
5679 }
5680 else
5681 {
5682 /* There was a catchpoint, but we're not stopping.
5683 This requires no further action. */
5684 }
5685 break;
5686 case bp_jit_event:
5687 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE;
5688 break;
5689 case bp_call_dummy:
5690 /* Make sure the action is stop (silent or noisy),
5691 so infrun.c pops the dummy frame. */
5692 retval.call_dummy = STOP_STACK_DUMMY;
5693 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_SILENT;
5694 break;
5695 case bp_std_terminate:
5696 /* Make sure the action is stop (silent or noisy),
5697 so infrun.c pops the dummy frame. */
5698 retval.call_dummy = STOP_STD_TERMINATE;
5699 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_SILENT;
5700 break;
5701 case bp_tracepoint:
5702 case bp_fast_tracepoint:
5703 case bp_static_tracepoint:
5704 /* Tracepoint hits should not be reported back to GDB, and
5705 if one got through somehow, it should have been filtered
5706 out already. */
5707 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
5708 _("bpstat_what: tracepoint encountered"));
5709 break;
5710 case bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver:
5711 /* Step over it (and insert bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver_return). */
5712 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE;
5713 break;
5714 case bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver_return:
5715 /* The breakpoint will be removed, execution will restart from the
5716 PC of the former breakpoint. */
5717 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_KEEP_CHECKING;
5718 break;
5719
5720 case bp_dprintf:
5721 if (bs->stop)
5722 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_SILENT;
5723 else
5724 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE;
5725 break;
5726
5727 default:
5728 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
5729 _("bpstat_what: unhandled bptype %d"), (int) bptype);
5730 }
5731
5732 retval.main_action = std::max (retval.main_action, this_action);
5733 }
5734
5735 return retval;
5736 }
5737
5738 void
5739 bpstat_run_callbacks (bpstat bs_head)
5740 {
5741 bpstat bs;
5742
5743 for (bs = bs_head; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
5744 {
5745 struct breakpoint *b = bs->breakpoint_at;
5746
5747 if (b == NULL)
5748 continue;
5749 switch (b->type)
5750 {
5751 case bp_jit_event:
5752 handle_jit_event ();
5753 break;
5754 case bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver:
5755 gnu_ifunc_resolver_stop (b);
5756 break;
5757 case bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver_return:
5758 gnu_ifunc_resolver_return_stop (b);
5759 break;
5760 }
5761 }
5762 }
5763
5764 /* Nonzero if we should step constantly (e.g. watchpoints on machines
5765 without hardware support). This isn't related to a specific bpstat,
5766 just to things like whether watchpoints are set. */
5767
5768 int
5769 bpstat_should_step (void)
5770 {
5771 struct breakpoint *b;
5772
5773 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
5774 if (breakpoint_enabled (b) && b->type == bp_watchpoint && b->loc != NULL)
5775 return 1;
5776 return 0;
5777 }
5778
5779 int
5780 bpstat_causes_stop (bpstat bs)
5781 {
5782 for (; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
5783 if (bs->stop)
5784 return 1;
5785
5786 return 0;
5787 }
5788
5789 \f
5790
5791 /* Compute a string of spaces suitable to indent the next line
5792 so it starts at the position corresponding to the table column
5793 named COL_NAME in the currently active table of UIOUT. */
5794
5795 static char *
5796 wrap_indent_at_field (struct ui_out *uiout, const char *col_name)
5797 {
5798 static char wrap_indent[80];
5799 int i, total_width, width, align;
5800 const char *text;
5801
5802 total_width = 0;
5803 for (i = 1; uiout->query_table_field (i, &width, &align, &text); i++)
5804 {
5805 if (strcmp (text, col_name) == 0)
5806 {
5807 gdb_assert (total_width < sizeof wrap_indent);
5808 memset (wrap_indent, ' ', total_width);
5809 wrap_indent[total_width] = 0;
5810
5811 return wrap_indent;
5812 }
5813
5814 total_width += width + 1;
5815 }
5816
5817 return NULL;
5818 }
5819
5820 /* Determine if the locations of this breakpoint will have their conditions
5821 evaluated by the target, host or a mix of both. Returns the following:
5822
5823 "host": Host evals condition.
5824 "host or target": Host or Target evals condition.
5825 "target": Target evals condition.
5826 */
5827
5828 static const char *
5829 bp_condition_evaluator (struct breakpoint *b)
5830 {
5831 struct bp_location *bl;
5832 char host_evals = 0;
5833 char target_evals = 0;
5834
5835 if (!b)
5836 return NULL;
5837
5838 if (!is_breakpoint (b))
5839 return NULL;
5840
5841 if (gdb_evaluates_breakpoint_condition_p ()
5842 || !target_supports_evaluation_of_breakpoint_conditions ())
5843 return condition_evaluation_host;
5844
5845 for (bl = b->loc; bl; bl = bl->next)
5846 {
5847 if (bl->cond_bytecode)
5848 target_evals++;
5849 else
5850 host_evals++;
5851 }
5852
5853 if (host_evals && target_evals)
5854 return condition_evaluation_both;
5855 else if (target_evals)
5856 return condition_evaluation_target;
5857 else
5858 return condition_evaluation_host;
5859 }
5860
5861 /* Determine the breakpoint location's condition evaluator. This is
5862 similar to bp_condition_evaluator, but for locations. */
5863
5864 static const char *
5865 bp_location_condition_evaluator (struct bp_location *bl)
5866 {
5867 if (bl && !is_breakpoint (bl->owner))
5868 return NULL;
5869
5870 if (gdb_evaluates_breakpoint_condition_p ()
5871 || !target_supports_evaluation_of_breakpoint_conditions ())
5872 return condition_evaluation_host;
5873
5874 if (bl && bl->cond_bytecode)
5875 return condition_evaluation_target;
5876 else
5877 return condition_evaluation_host;
5878 }
5879
5880 /* Print the LOC location out of the list of B->LOC locations. */
5881
5882 static void
5883 print_breakpoint_location (struct breakpoint *b,
5884 struct bp_location *loc)
5885 {
5886 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
5887
5888 scoped_restore_current_program_space restore_pspace;
5889
5890 if (loc != NULL && loc->shlib_disabled)
5891 loc = NULL;
5892
5893 if (loc != NULL)
5894 set_current_program_space (loc->pspace);
5895
5896 if (b->display_canonical)
5897 uiout->field_string ("what", event_location_to_string (b->location.get ()));
5898 else if (loc && loc->symtab)
5899 {
5900 const struct symbol *sym = loc->symbol;
5901
5902 if (sym == NULL)
5903 sym = find_pc_sect_function (loc->address, loc->section);
5904
5905 if (sym)
5906 {
5907 uiout->text ("in ");
5908 uiout->field_string ("func", SYMBOL_PRINT_NAME (sym));
5909 uiout->text (" ");
5910 uiout->wrap_hint (wrap_indent_at_field (uiout, "what"));
5911 uiout->text ("at ");
5912 }
5913 uiout->field_string ("file",
5914 symtab_to_filename_for_display (loc->symtab));
5915 uiout->text (":");
5916
5917 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
5918 uiout->field_string ("fullname", symtab_to_fullname (loc->symtab));
5919
5920 uiout->field_int ("line", loc->line_number);
5921 }
5922 else if (loc)
5923 {
5924 string_file stb;
5925
5926 print_address_symbolic (loc->gdbarch, loc->address, &stb,
5927 demangle, "");
5928 uiout->field_stream ("at", stb);
5929 }
5930 else
5931 {
5932 uiout->field_string ("pending",
5933 event_location_to_string (b->location.get ()));
5934 /* If extra_string is available, it could be holding a condition
5935 or dprintf arguments. In either case, make sure it is printed,
5936 too, but only for non-MI streams. */
5937 if (!uiout->is_mi_like_p () && b->extra_string != NULL)
5938 {
5939 if (b->type == bp_dprintf)
5940 uiout->text (",");
5941 else
5942 uiout->text (" ");
5943 uiout->text (b->extra_string);
5944 }
5945 }
5946
5947 if (loc && is_breakpoint (b)
5948 && breakpoint_condition_evaluation_mode () == condition_evaluation_target
5949 && bp_condition_evaluator (b) == condition_evaluation_both)
5950 {
5951 uiout->text (" (");
5952 uiout->field_string ("evaluated-by",
5953 bp_location_condition_evaluator (loc));
5954 uiout->text (")");
5955 }
5956 }
5957
5958 static const char *
5959 bptype_string (enum bptype type)
5960 {
5961 struct ep_type_description
5962 {
5963 enum bptype type;
5964 const char *description;
5965 };
5966 static struct ep_type_description bptypes[] =
5967 {
5968 {bp_none, "?deleted?"},
5969 {bp_breakpoint, "breakpoint"},
5970 {bp_hardware_breakpoint, "hw breakpoint"},
5971 {bp_single_step, "sw single-step"},
5972 {bp_until, "until"},
5973 {bp_finish, "finish"},
5974 {bp_watchpoint, "watchpoint"},
5975 {bp_hardware_watchpoint, "hw watchpoint"},
5976 {bp_read_watchpoint, "read watchpoint"},
5977 {bp_access_watchpoint, "acc watchpoint"},
5978 {bp_longjmp, "longjmp"},
5979 {bp_longjmp_resume, "longjmp resume"},
5980 {bp_longjmp_call_dummy, "longjmp for call dummy"},
5981 {bp_exception, "exception"},
5982 {bp_exception_resume, "exception resume"},
5983 {bp_step_resume, "step resume"},
5984 {bp_hp_step_resume, "high-priority step resume"},
5985 {bp_watchpoint_scope, "watchpoint scope"},
5986 {bp_call_dummy, "call dummy"},
5987 {bp_std_terminate, "std::terminate"},
5988 {bp_shlib_event, "shlib events"},
5989 {bp_thread_event, "thread events"},
5990 {bp_overlay_event, "overlay events"},
5991 {bp_longjmp_master, "longjmp master"},
5992 {bp_std_terminate_master, "std::terminate master"},
5993 {bp_exception_master, "exception master"},
5994 {bp_catchpoint, "catchpoint"},
5995 {bp_tracepoint, "tracepoint"},
5996 {bp_fast_tracepoint, "fast tracepoint"},
5997 {bp_static_tracepoint, "static tracepoint"},
5998 {bp_dprintf, "dprintf"},
5999 {bp_jit_event, "jit events"},
6000 {bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver, "STT_GNU_IFUNC resolver"},
6001 {bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver_return, "STT_GNU_IFUNC resolver return"},
6002 };
6003
6004 if (((int) type >= (sizeof (bptypes) / sizeof (bptypes[0])))
6005 || ((int) type != bptypes[(int) type].type))
6006 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
6007 _("bptypes table does not describe type #%d."),
6008 (int) type);
6009
6010 return bptypes[(int) type].description;
6011 }
6012
6013 /* For MI, output a field named 'thread-groups' with a list as the value.
6014 For CLI, prefix the list with the string 'inf'. */
6015
6016 static void
6017 output_thread_groups (struct ui_out *uiout,
6018 const char *field_name,
6019 const std::vector<int> &inf_nums,
6020 int mi_only)
6021 {
6022 int is_mi = uiout->is_mi_like_p ();
6023
6024 /* For backward compatibility, don't display inferiors in CLI unless
6025 there are several. Always display them for MI. */
6026 if (!is_mi && mi_only)
6027 return;
6028
6029 ui_out_emit_list list_emitter (uiout, field_name);
6030
6031 for (size_t i = 0; i < inf_nums.size (); i++)
6032 {
6033 if (is_mi)
6034 {
6035 char mi_group[10];
6036
6037 xsnprintf (mi_group, sizeof (mi_group), "i%d", inf_nums[i]);
6038 uiout->field_string (NULL, mi_group);
6039 }
6040 else
6041 {
6042 if (i == 0)
6043 uiout->text (" inf ");
6044 else
6045 uiout->text (", ");
6046
6047 uiout->text (plongest (inf_nums[i]));
6048 }
6049 }
6050 }
6051
6052 /* Print B to gdb_stdout. */
6053
6054 static void
6055 print_one_breakpoint_location (struct breakpoint *b,
6056 struct bp_location *loc,
6057 int loc_number,
6058 struct bp_location **last_loc,
6059 int allflag)
6060 {
6061 struct command_line *l;
6062 static char bpenables[] = "nynny";
6063
6064 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
6065 int header_of_multiple = 0;
6066 int part_of_multiple = (loc != NULL);
6067 struct value_print_options opts;
6068
6069 get_user_print_options (&opts);
6070
6071 gdb_assert (!loc || loc_number != 0);
6072 /* See comment in print_one_breakpoint concerning treatment of
6073 breakpoints with single disabled location. */
6074 if (loc == NULL
6075 && (b->loc != NULL
6076 && (b->loc->next != NULL || !b->loc->enabled)))
6077 header_of_multiple = 1;
6078 if (loc == NULL)
6079 loc = b->loc;
6080
6081 annotate_record ();
6082
6083 /* 1 */
6084 annotate_field (0);
6085 if (part_of_multiple)
6086 {
6087 char *formatted;
6088 formatted = xstrprintf ("%d.%d", b->number, loc_number);
6089 uiout->field_string ("number", formatted);
6090 xfree (formatted);
6091 }
6092 else
6093 {
6094 uiout->field_int ("number", b->number);
6095 }
6096
6097 /* 2 */
6098 annotate_field (1);
6099 if (part_of_multiple)
6100 uiout->field_skip ("type");
6101 else
6102 uiout->field_string ("type", bptype_string (b->type));
6103
6104 /* 3 */
6105 annotate_field (2);
6106 if (part_of_multiple)
6107 uiout->field_skip ("disp");
6108 else
6109 uiout->field_string ("disp", bpdisp_text (b->disposition));
6110
6111
6112 /* 4 */
6113 annotate_field (3);
6114 if (part_of_multiple)
6115 uiout->field_string ("enabled", loc->enabled ? "y" : "n");
6116 else
6117 uiout->field_fmt ("enabled", "%c", bpenables[(int) b->enable_state]);
6118 uiout->spaces (2);
6119
6120
6121 /* 5 and 6 */
6122 if (b->ops != NULL && b->ops->print_one != NULL)
6123 {
6124 /* Although the print_one can possibly print all locations,
6125 calling it here is not likely to get any nice result. So,
6126 make sure there's just one location. */
6127 gdb_assert (b->loc == NULL || b->loc->next == NULL);
6128 b->ops->print_one (b, last_loc);
6129 }
6130 else
6131 switch (b->type)
6132 {
6133 case bp_none:
6134 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
6135 _("print_one_breakpoint: bp_none encountered\n"));
6136 break;
6137
6138 case bp_watchpoint:
6139 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
6140 case bp_read_watchpoint:
6141 case bp_access_watchpoint:
6142 {
6143 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
6144
6145 /* Field 4, the address, is omitted (which makes the columns
6146 not line up too nicely with the headers, but the effect
6147 is relatively readable). */
6148 if (opts.addressprint)
6149 uiout->field_skip ("addr");
6150 annotate_field (5);
6151 uiout->field_string ("what", w->exp_string);
6152 }
6153 break;
6154
6155 case bp_breakpoint:
6156 case bp_hardware_breakpoint:
6157 case bp_single_step:
6158 case bp_until:
6159 case bp_finish:
6160 case bp_longjmp:
6161 case bp_longjmp_resume:
6162 case bp_longjmp_call_dummy:
6163 case bp_exception:
6164 case bp_exception_resume:
6165 case bp_step_resume:
6166 case bp_hp_step_resume:
6167 case bp_watchpoint_scope:
6168 case bp_call_dummy:
6169 case bp_std_terminate:
6170 case bp_shlib_event:
6171 case bp_thread_event:
6172 case bp_overlay_event:
6173 case bp_longjmp_master:
6174 case bp_std_terminate_master:
6175 case bp_exception_master:
6176 case bp_tracepoint:
6177 case bp_fast_tracepoint:
6178 case bp_static_tracepoint:
6179 case bp_dprintf:
6180 case bp_jit_event:
6181 case bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver:
6182 case bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver_return:
6183 if (opts.addressprint)
6184 {
6185 annotate_field (4);
6186 if (header_of_multiple)
6187 uiout->field_string ("addr", "<MULTIPLE>");
6188 else if (b->loc == NULL || loc->shlib_disabled)
6189 uiout->field_string ("addr", "<PENDING>");
6190 else
6191 uiout->field_core_addr ("addr",
6192 loc->gdbarch, loc->address);
6193 }
6194 annotate_field (5);
6195 if (!header_of_multiple)
6196 print_breakpoint_location (b, loc);
6197 if (b->loc)
6198 *last_loc = b->loc;
6199 break;
6200 }
6201
6202
6203 if (loc != NULL && !header_of_multiple)
6204 {
6205 struct inferior *inf;
6206 std::vector<int> inf_nums;
6207 int mi_only = 1;
6208
6209 ALL_INFERIORS (inf)
6210 {
6211 if (inf->pspace == loc->pspace)
6212 inf_nums.push_back (inf->num);
6213 }
6214
6215 /* For backward compatibility, don't display inferiors in CLI unless
6216 there are several. Always display for MI. */
6217 if (allflag
6218 || (!gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch ())
6219 && (number_of_program_spaces () > 1
6220 || number_of_inferiors () > 1)
6221 /* LOC is for existing B, it cannot be in
6222 moribund_locations and thus having NULL OWNER. */
6223 && loc->owner->type != bp_catchpoint))
6224 mi_only = 0;
6225 output_thread_groups (uiout, "thread-groups", inf_nums, mi_only);
6226 }
6227
6228 if (!part_of_multiple)
6229 {
6230 if (b->thread != -1)
6231 {
6232 /* FIXME: This seems to be redundant and lost here; see the
6233 "stop only in" line a little further down. */
6234 uiout->text (" thread ");
6235 uiout->field_int ("thread", b->thread);
6236 }
6237 else if (b->task != 0)
6238 {
6239 uiout->text (" task ");
6240 uiout->field_int ("task", b->task);
6241 }
6242 }
6243
6244 uiout->text ("\n");
6245
6246 if (!part_of_multiple)
6247 b->ops->print_one_detail (b, uiout);
6248
6249 if (part_of_multiple && frame_id_p (b->frame_id))
6250 {
6251 annotate_field (6);
6252 uiout->text ("\tstop only in stack frame at ");
6253 /* FIXME: cagney/2002-12-01: Shouldn't be poking around inside
6254 the frame ID. */
6255 uiout->field_core_addr ("frame",
6256 b->gdbarch, b->frame_id.stack_addr);
6257 uiout->text ("\n");
6258 }
6259
6260 if (!part_of_multiple && b->cond_string)
6261 {
6262 annotate_field (7);
6263 if (is_tracepoint (b))
6264 uiout->text ("\ttrace only if ");
6265 else
6266 uiout->text ("\tstop only if ");
6267 uiout->field_string ("cond", b->cond_string);
6268
6269 /* Print whether the target is doing the breakpoint's condition
6270 evaluation. If GDB is doing the evaluation, don't print anything. */
6271 if (is_breakpoint (b)
6272 && breakpoint_condition_evaluation_mode ()
6273 == condition_evaluation_target)
6274 {
6275 uiout->text (" (");
6276 uiout->field_string ("evaluated-by",
6277 bp_condition_evaluator (b));
6278 uiout->text (" evals)");
6279 }
6280 uiout->text ("\n");
6281 }
6282
6283 if (!part_of_multiple && b->thread != -1)
6284 {
6285 /* FIXME should make an annotation for this. */
6286 uiout->text ("\tstop only in thread ");
6287 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
6288 uiout->field_int ("thread", b->thread);
6289 else
6290 {
6291 struct thread_info *thr = find_thread_global_id (b->thread);
6292
6293 uiout->field_string ("thread", print_thread_id (thr));
6294 }
6295 uiout->text ("\n");
6296 }
6297
6298 if (!part_of_multiple)
6299 {
6300 if (b->hit_count)
6301 {
6302 /* FIXME should make an annotation for this. */
6303 if (is_catchpoint (b))
6304 uiout->text ("\tcatchpoint");
6305 else if (is_tracepoint (b))
6306 uiout->text ("\ttracepoint");
6307 else
6308 uiout->text ("\tbreakpoint");
6309 uiout->text (" already hit ");
6310 uiout->field_int ("times", b->hit_count);
6311 if (b->hit_count == 1)
6312 uiout->text (" time\n");
6313 else
6314 uiout->text (" times\n");
6315 }
6316 else
6317 {
6318 /* Output the count also if it is zero, but only if this is mi. */
6319 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
6320 uiout->field_int ("times", b->hit_count);
6321 }
6322 }
6323
6324 if (!part_of_multiple && b->ignore_count)
6325 {
6326 annotate_field (8);
6327 uiout->text ("\tignore next ");
6328 uiout->field_int ("ignore", b->ignore_count);
6329 uiout->text (" hits\n");
6330 }
6331
6332 /* Note that an enable count of 1 corresponds to "enable once"
6333 behavior, which is reported by the combination of enablement and
6334 disposition, so we don't need to mention it here. */
6335 if (!part_of_multiple && b->enable_count > 1)
6336 {
6337 annotate_field (8);
6338 uiout->text ("\tdisable after ");
6339 /* Tweak the wording to clarify that ignore and enable counts
6340 are distinct, and have additive effect. */
6341 if (b->ignore_count)
6342 uiout->text ("additional ");
6343 else
6344 uiout->text ("next ");
6345 uiout->field_int ("enable", b->enable_count);
6346 uiout->text (" hits\n");
6347 }
6348
6349 if (!part_of_multiple && is_tracepoint (b))
6350 {
6351 struct tracepoint *tp = (struct tracepoint *) b;
6352
6353 if (tp->traceframe_usage)
6354 {
6355 uiout->text ("\ttrace buffer usage ");
6356 uiout->field_int ("traceframe-usage", tp->traceframe_usage);
6357 uiout->text (" bytes\n");
6358 }
6359 }
6360
6361 l = b->commands ? b->commands.get () : NULL;
6362 if (!part_of_multiple && l)
6363 {
6364 annotate_field (9);
6365 ui_out_emit_tuple tuple_emitter (uiout, "script");
6366 print_command_lines (uiout, l, 4);
6367 }
6368
6369 if (is_tracepoint (b))
6370 {
6371 struct tracepoint *t = (struct tracepoint *) b;
6372
6373 if (!part_of_multiple && t->pass_count)
6374 {
6375 annotate_field (10);
6376 uiout->text ("\tpass count ");
6377 uiout->field_int ("pass", t->pass_count);
6378 uiout->text (" \n");
6379 }
6380
6381 /* Don't display it when tracepoint or tracepoint location is
6382 pending. */
6383 if (!header_of_multiple && loc != NULL && !loc->shlib_disabled)
6384 {
6385 annotate_field (11);
6386
6387 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
6388 uiout->field_string ("installed",
6389 loc->inserted ? "y" : "n");
6390 else
6391 {
6392 if (loc->inserted)
6393 uiout->text ("\t");
6394 else
6395 uiout->text ("\tnot ");
6396 uiout->text ("installed on target\n");
6397 }
6398 }
6399 }
6400
6401 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p () && !part_of_multiple)
6402 {
6403 if (is_watchpoint (b))
6404 {
6405 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
6406
6407 uiout->field_string ("original-location", w->exp_string);
6408 }
6409 else if (b->location != NULL
6410 && event_location_to_string (b->location.get ()) != NULL)
6411 uiout->field_string ("original-location",
6412 event_location_to_string (b->location.get ()));
6413 }
6414 }
6415
6416 static void
6417 print_one_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b,
6418 struct bp_location **last_loc,
6419 int allflag)
6420 {
6421 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
6422
6423 {
6424 ui_out_emit_tuple tuple_emitter (uiout, "bkpt");
6425
6426 print_one_breakpoint_location (b, NULL, 0, last_loc, allflag);
6427 }
6428
6429 /* If this breakpoint has custom print function,
6430 it's already printed. Otherwise, print individual
6431 locations, if any. */
6432 if (b->ops == NULL || b->ops->print_one == NULL)
6433 {
6434 /* If breakpoint has a single location that is disabled, we
6435 print it as if it had several locations, since otherwise it's
6436 hard to represent "breakpoint enabled, location disabled"
6437 situation.
6438
6439 Note that while hardware watchpoints have several locations
6440 internally, that's not a property exposed to user. */
6441 if (b->loc
6442 && !is_hardware_watchpoint (b)
6443 && (b->loc->next || !b->loc->enabled))
6444 {
6445 struct bp_location *loc;
6446 int n = 1;
6447
6448 for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next, ++n)
6449 {
6450 ui_out_emit_tuple tuple_emitter (uiout, NULL);
6451 print_one_breakpoint_location (b, loc, n, last_loc, allflag);
6452 }
6453 }
6454 }
6455 }
6456
6457 static int
6458 breakpoint_address_bits (struct breakpoint *b)
6459 {
6460 int print_address_bits = 0;
6461 struct bp_location *loc;
6462
6463 /* Software watchpoints that aren't watching memory don't have an
6464 address to print. */
6465 if (is_no_memory_software_watchpoint (b))
6466 return 0;
6467
6468 for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
6469 {
6470 int addr_bit;
6471
6472 addr_bit = gdbarch_addr_bit (loc->gdbarch);
6473 if (addr_bit > print_address_bits)
6474 print_address_bits = addr_bit;
6475 }
6476
6477 return print_address_bits;
6478 }
6479
6480 /* See breakpoint.h. */
6481
6482 void
6483 print_breakpoint (breakpoint *b)
6484 {
6485 struct bp_location *dummy_loc = NULL;
6486 print_one_breakpoint (b, &dummy_loc, 0);
6487 }
6488
6489 /* Return true if this breakpoint was set by the user, false if it is
6490 internal or momentary. */
6491
6492 int
6493 user_breakpoint_p (struct breakpoint *b)
6494 {
6495 return b->number > 0;
6496 }
6497
6498 /* See breakpoint.h. */
6499
6500 int
6501 pending_breakpoint_p (struct breakpoint *b)
6502 {
6503 return b->loc == NULL;
6504 }
6505
6506 /* Print information on user settable breakpoint (watchpoint, etc)
6507 number BNUM. If BNUM is -1 print all user-settable breakpoints.
6508 If ALLFLAG is non-zero, include non-user-settable breakpoints. If
6509 FILTER is non-NULL, call it on each breakpoint and only include the
6510 ones for which it returns non-zero. Return the total number of
6511 breakpoints listed. */
6512
6513 static int
6514 breakpoint_1 (const char *args, int allflag,
6515 int (*filter) (const struct breakpoint *))
6516 {
6517 struct breakpoint *b;
6518 struct bp_location *last_loc = NULL;
6519 int nr_printable_breakpoints;
6520 struct value_print_options opts;
6521 int print_address_bits = 0;
6522 int print_type_col_width = 14;
6523 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
6524
6525 get_user_print_options (&opts);
6526
6527 /* Compute the number of rows in the table, as well as the size
6528 required for address fields. */
6529 nr_printable_breakpoints = 0;
6530 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
6531 {
6532 /* If we have a filter, only list the breakpoints it accepts. */
6533 if (filter && !filter (b))
6534 continue;
6535
6536 /* If we have an "args" string, it is a list of breakpoints to
6537 accept. Skip the others. */
6538 if (args != NULL && *args != '\0')
6539 {
6540 if (allflag && parse_and_eval_long (args) != b->number)
6541 continue;
6542 if (!allflag && !number_is_in_list (args, b->number))
6543 continue;
6544 }
6545
6546 if (allflag || user_breakpoint_p (b))
6547 {
6548 int addr_bit, type_len;
6549
6550 addr_bit = breakpoint_address_bits (b);
6551 if (addr_bit > print_address_bits)
6552 print_address_bits = addr_bit;
6553
6554 type_len = strlen (bptype_string (b->type));
6555 if (type_len > print_type_col_width)
6556 print_type_col_width = type_len;
6557
6558 nr_printable_breakpoints++;
6559 }
6560 }
6561
6562 {
6563 ui_out_emit_table table_emitter (uiout,
6564 opts.addressprint ? 6 : 5,
6565 nr_printable_breakpoints,
6566 "BreakpointTable");
6567
6568 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
6569 annotate_breakpoints_headers ();
6570 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
6571 annotate_field (0);
6572 uiout->table_header (7, ui_left, "number", "Num"); /* 1 */
6573 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
6574 annotate_field (1);
6575 uiout->table_header (print_type_col_width, ui_left, "type", "Type"); /* 2 */
6576 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
6577 annotate_field (2);
6578 uiout->table_header (4, ui_left, "disp", "Disp"); /* 3 */
6579 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
6580 annotate_field (3);
6581 uiout->table_header (3, ui_left, "enabled", "Enb"); /* 4 */
6582 if (opts.addressprint)
6583 {
6584 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
6585 annotate_field (4);
6586 if (print_address_bits <= 32)
6587 uiout->table_header (10, ui_left, "addr", "Address"); /* 5 */
6588 else
6589 uiout->table_header (18, ui_left, "addr", "Address"); /* 5 */
6590 }
6591 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
6592 annotate_field (5);
6593 uiout->table_header (40, ui_noalign, "what", "What"); /* 6 */
6594 uiout->table_body ();
6595 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
6596 annotate_breakpoints_table ();
6597
6598 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
6599 {
6600 QUIT;
6601 /* If we have a filter, only list the breakpoints it accepts. */
6602 if (filter && !filter (b))
6603 continue;
6604
6605 /* If we have an "args" string, it is a list of breakpoints to
6606 accept. Skip the others. */
6607
6608 if (args != NULL && *args != '\0')
6609 {
6610 if (allflag) /* maintenance info breakpoint */
6611 {
6612 if (parse_and_eval_long (args) != b->number)
6613 continue;
6614 }
6615 else /* all others */
6616 {
6617 if (!number_is_in_list (args, b->number))
6618 continue;
6619 }
6620 }
6621 /* We only print out user settable breakpoints unless the
6622 allflag is set. */
6623 if (allflag || user_breakpoint_p (b))
6624 print_one_breakpoint (b, &last_loc, allflag);
6625 }
6626 }
6627
6628 if (nr_printable_breakpoints == 0)
6629 {
6630 /* If there's a filter, let the caller decide how to report
6631 empty list. */
6632 if (!filter)
6633 {
6634 if (args == NULL || *args == '\0')
6635 uiout->message ("No breakpoints or watchpoints.\n");
6636 else
6637 uiout->message ("No breakpoint or watchpoint matching '%s'.\n",
6638 args);
6639 }
6640 }
6641 else
6642 {
6643 if (last_loc && !server_command)
6644 set_next_address (last_loc->gdbarch, last_loc->address);
6645 }
6646
6647 /* FIXME? Should this be moved up so that it is only called when
6648 there have been breakpoints? */
6649 annotate_breakpoints_table_end ();
6650
6651 return nr_printable_breakpoints;
6652 }
6653
6654 /* Display the value of default-collect in a way that is generally
6655 compatible with the breakpoint list. */
6656
6657 static void
6658 default_collect_info (void)
6659 {
6660 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
6661
6662 /* If it has no value (which is frequently the case), say nothing; a
6663 message like "No default-collect." gets in user's face when it's
6664 not wanted. */
6665 if (!*default_collect)
6666 return;
6667
6668 /* The following phrase lines up nicely with per-tracepoint collect
6669 actions. */
6670 uiout->text ("default collect ");
6671 uiout->field_string ("default-collect", default_collect);
6672 uiout->text (" \n");
6673 }
6674
6675 static void
6676 info_breakpoints_command (const char *args, int from_tty)
6677 {
6678 breakpoint_1 (args, 0, NULL);
6679
6680 default_collect_info ();
6681 }
6682
6683 static void
6684 info_watchpoints_command (const char *args, int from_tty)
6685 {
6686 int num_printed = breakpoint_1 (args, 0, is_watchpoint);
6687 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
6688
6689 if (num_printed == 0)
6690 {
6691 if (args == NULL || *args == '\0')
6692 uiout->message ("No watchpoints.\n");
6693 else
6694 uiout->message ("No watchpoint matching '%s'.\n", args);
6695 }
6696 }
6697
6698 static void
6699 maintenance_info_breakpoints (const char *args, int from_tty)
6700 {
6701 breakpoint_1 (args, 1, NULL);
6702
6703 default_collect_info ();
6704 }
6705
6706 static int
6707 breakpoint_has_pc (struct breakpoint *b,
6708 struct program_space *pspace,
6709 CORE_ADDR pc, struct obj_section *section)
6710 {
6711 struct bp_location *bl = b->loc;
6712
6713 for (; bl; bl = bl->next)
6714 {
6715 if (bl->pspace == pspace
6716 && bl->address == pc
6717 && (!overlay_debugging || bl->section == section))
6718 return 1;
6719 }
6720 return 0;
6721 }
6722
6723 /* Print a message describing any user-breakpoints set at PC. This
6724 concerns with logical breakpoints, so we match program spaces, not
6725 address spaces. */
6726
6727 static void
6728 describe_other_breakpoints (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
6729 struct program_space *pspace, CORE_ADDR pc,
6730 struct obj_section *section, int thread)
6731 {
6732 int others = 0;
6733 struct breakpoint *b;
6734
6735 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
6736 others += (user_breakpoint_p (b)
6737 && breakpoint_has_pc (b, pspace, pc, section));
6738 if (others > 0)
6739 {
6740 if (others == 1)
6741 printf_filtered (_("Note: breakpoint "));
6742 else /* if (others == ???) */
6743 printf_filtered (_("Note: breakpoints "));
6744 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
6745 if (user_breakpoint_p (b) && breakpoint_has_pc (b, pspace, pc, section))
6746 {
6747 others--;
6748 printf_filtered ("%d", b->number);
6749 if (b->thread == -1 && thread != -1)
6750 printf_filtered (" (all threads)");
6751 else if (b->thread != -1)
6752 printf_filtered (" (thread %d)", b->thread);
6753 printf_filtered ("%s%s ",
6754 ((b->enable_state == bp_disabled
6755 || b->enable_state == bp_call_disabled)
6756 ? " (disabled)"
6757 : ""),
6758 (others > 1) ? ","
6759 : ((others == 1) ? " and" : ""));
6760 }
6761 printf_filtered (_("also set at pc "));
6762 fputs_filtered (paddress (gdbarch, pc), gdb_stdout);
6763 printf_filtered (".\n");
6764 }
6765 }
6766 \f
6767
6768 /* Return true iff it is meaningful to use the address member of
6769 BPT locations. For some breakpoint types, the locations' address members
6770 are irrelevant and it makes no sense to attempt to compare them to other
6771 addresses (or use them for any other purpose either).
6772
6773 More specifically, each of the following breakpoint types will
6774 always have a zero valued location address and we don't want to mark
6775 breakpoints of any of these types to be a duplicate of an actual
6776 breakpoint location at address zero:
6777
6778 bp_watchpoint
6779 bp_catchpoint
6780
6781 */
6782
6783 static int
6784 breakpoint_address_is_meaningful (struct breakpoint *bpt)
6785 {
6786 enum bptype type = bpt->type;
6787
6788 return (type != bp_watchpoint && type != bp_catchpoint);
6789 }
6790
6791 /* Assuming LOC1 and LOC2's owners are hardware watchpoints, returns
6792 true if LOC1 and LOC2 represent the same watchpoint location. */
6793
6794 static int
6795 watchpoint_locations_match (struct bp_location *loc1,
6796 struct bp_location *loc2)
6797 {
6798 struct watchpoint *w1 = (struct watchpoint *) loc1->owner;
6799 struct watchpoint *w2 = (struct watchpoint *) loc2->owner;
6800
6801 /* Both of them must exist. */
6802 gdb_assert (w1 != NULL);
6803 gdb_assert (w2 != NULL);
6804
6805 /* If the target can evaluate the condition expression in hardware,
6806 then we we need to insert both watchpoints even if they are at
6807 the same place. Otherwise the watchpoint will only trigger when
6808 the condition of whichever watchpoint was inserted evaluates to
6809 true, not giving a chance for GDB to check the condition of the
6810 other watchpoint. */
6811 if ((w1->cond_exp
6812 && target_can_accel_watchpoint_condition (loc1->address,
6813 loc1->length,
6814 loc1->watchpoint_type,
6815 w1->cond_exp.get ()))
6816 || (w2->cond_exp
6817 && target_can_accel_watchpoint_condition (loc2->address,
6818 loc2->length,
6819 loc2->watchpoint_type,
6820 w2->cond_exp.get ())))
6821 return 0;
6822
6823 /* Note that this checks the owner's type, not the location's. In
6824 case the target does not support read watchpoints, but does
6825 support access watchpoints, we'll have bp_read_watchpoint
6826 watchpoints with hw_access locations. Those should be considered
6827 duplicates of hw_read locations. The hw_read locations will
6828 become hw_access locations later. */
6829 return (loc1->owner->type == loc2->owner->type
6830 && loc1->pspace->aspace == loc2->pspace->aspace
6831 && loc1->address == loc2->address
6832 && loc1->length == loc2->length);
6833 }
6834
6835 /* See breakpoint.h. */
6836
6837 int
6838 breakpoint_address_match (const address_space *aspace1, CORE_ADDR addr1,
6839 const address_space *aspace2, CORE_ADDR addr2)
6840 {
6841 return ((gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch ())
6842 || aspace1 == aspace2)
6843 && addr1 == addr2);
6844 }
6845
6846 /* Returns true if {ASPACE2,ADDR2} falls within the range determined by
6847 {ASPACE1,ADDR1,LEN1}. In most targets, this can only be true if ASPACE1
6848 matches ASPACE2. On targets that have global breakpoints, the address
6849 space doesn't really matter. */
6850
6851 static int
6852 breakpoint_address_match_range (const address_space *aspace1,
6853 CORE_ADDR addr1,
6854 int len1, const address_space *aspace2,
6855 CORE_ADDR addr2)
6856 {
6857 return ((gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch ())
6858 || aspace1 == aspace2)
6859 && addr2 >= addr1 && addr2 < addr1 + len1);
6860 }
6861
6862 /* Returns true if {ASPACE,ADDR} matches the breakpoint BL. BL may be
6863 a ranged breakpoint. In most targets, a match happens only if ASPACE
6864 matches the breakpoint's address space. On targets that have global
6865 breakpoints, the address space doesn't really matter. */
6866
6867 static int
6868 breakpoint_location_address_match (struct bp_location *bl,
6869 const address_space *aspace,
6870 CORE_ADDR addr)
6871 {
6872 return (breakpoint_address_match (bl->pspace->aspace, bl->address,
6873 aspace, addr)
6874 || (bl->length
6875 && breakpoint_address_match_range (bl->pspace->aspace,
6876 bl->address, bl->length,
6877 aspace, addr)));
6878 }
6879
6880 /* Returns true if the [ADDR,ADDR+LEN) range in ASPACE overlaps
6881 breakpoint BL. BL may be a ranged breakpoint. In most targets, a
6882 match happens only if ASPACE matches the breakpoint's address
6883 space. On targets that have global breakpoints, the address space
6884 doesn't really matter. */
6885
6886 static int
6887 breakpoint_location_address_range_overlap (struct bp_location *bl,
6888 const address_space *aspace,
6889 CORE_ADDR addr, int len)
6890 {
6891 if (gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch ())
6892 || bl->pspace->aspace == aspace)
6893 {
6894 int bl_len = bl->length != 0 ? bl->length : 1;
6895
6896 if (mem_ranges_overlap (addr, len, bl->address, bl_len))
6897 return 1;
6898 }
6899 return 0;
6900 }
6901
6902 /* If LOC1 and LOC2's owners are not tracepoints, returns false directly.
6903 Then, if LOC1 and LOC2 represent the same tracepoint location, returns
6904 true, otherwise returns false. */
6905
6906 static int
6907 tracepoint_locations_match (struct bp_location *loc1,
6908 struct bp_location *loc2)
6909 {
6910 if (is_tracepoint (loc1->owner) && is_tracepoint (loc2->owner))
6911 /* Since tracepoint locations are never duplicated with others', tracepoint
6912 locations at the same address of different tracepoints are regarded as
6913 different locations. */
6914 return (loc1->address == loc2->address && loc1->owner == loc2->owner);
6915 else
6916 return 0;
6917 }
6918
6919 /* Assuming LOC1 and LOC2's types' have meaningful target addresses
6920 (breakpoint_address_is_meaningful), returns true if LOC1 and LOC2
6921 represent the same location. */
6922
6923 static int
6924 breakpoint_locations_match (struct bp_location *loc1,
6925 struct bp_location *loc2)
6926 {
6927 int hw_point1, hw_point2;
6928
6929 /* Both of them must not be in moribund_locations. */
6930 gdb_assert (loc1->owner != NULL);
6931 gdb_assert (loc2->owner != NULL);
6932
6933 hw_point1 = is_hardware_watchpoint (loc1->owner);
6934 hw_point2 = is_hardware_watchpoint (loc2->owner);
6935
6936 if (hw_point1 != hw_point2)
6937 return 0;
6938 else if (hw_point1)
6939 return watchpoint_locations_match (loc1, loc2);
6940 else if (is_tracepoint (loc1->owner) || is_tracepoint (loc2->owner))
6941 return tracepoint_locations_match (loc1, loc2);
6942 else
6943 /* We compare bp_location.length in order to cover ranged breakpoints. */
6944 return (breakpoint_address_match (loc1->pspace->aspace, loc1->address,
6945 loc2->pspace->aspace, loc2->address)
6946 && loc1->length == loc2->length);
6947 }
6948
6949 static void
6950 breakpoint_adjustment_warning (CORE_ADDR from_addr, CORE_ADDR to_addr,
6951 int bnum, int have_bnum)
6952 {
6953 /* The longest string possibly returned by hex_string_custom
6954 is 50 chars. These must be at least that big for safety. */
6955 char astr1[64];
6956 char astr2[64];
6957
6958 strcpy (astr1, hex_string_custom ((unsigned long) from_addr, 8));
6959 strcpy (astr2, hex_string_custom ((unsigned long) to_addr, 8));
6960 if (have_bnum)
6961 warning (_("Breakpoint %d address previously adjusted from %s to %s."),
6962 bnum, astr1, astr2);
6963 else
6964 warning (_("Breakpoint address adjusted from %s to %s."), astr1, astr2);
6965 }
6966
6967 /* Adjust a breakpoint's address to account for architectural
6968 constraints on breakpoint placement. Return the adjusted address.
6969 Note: Very few targets require this kind of adjustment. For most
6970 targets, this function is simply the identity function. */
6971
6972 static CORE_ADDR
6973 adjust_breakpoint_address (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
6974 CORE_ADDR bpaddr, enum bptype bptype)
6975 {
6976 if (bptype == bp_watchpoint
6977 || bptype == bp_hardware_watchpoint
6978 || bptype == bp_read_watchpoint
6979 || bptype == bp_access_watchpoint
6980 || bptype == bp_catchpoint)
6981 {
6982 /* Watchpoints and the various bp_catch_* eventpoints should not
6983 have their addresses modified. */
6984 return bpaddr;
6985 }
6986 else if (bptype == bp_single_step)
6987 {
6988 /* Single-step breakpoints should not have their addresses
6989 modified. If there's any architectural constrain that
6990 applies to this address, then it should have already been
6991 taken into account when the breakpoint was created in the
6992 first place. If we didn't do this, stepping through e.g.,
6993 Thumb-2 IT blocks would break. */
6994 return bpaddr;
6995 }
6996 else
6997 {
6998 CORE_ADDR adjusted_bpaddr = bpaddr;
6999
7000 if (gdbarch_adjust_breakpoint_address_p (gdbarch))
7001 {
7002 /* Some targets have architectural constraints on the placement
7003 of breakpoint instructions. Obtain the adjusted address. */
7004 adjusted_bpaddr = gdbarch_adjust_breakpoint_address (gdbarch, bpaddr);
7005 }
7006
7007 adjusted_bpaddr = address_significant (gdbarch, adjusted_bpaddr);
7008
7009 /* An adjusted breakpoint address can significantly alter
7010 a user's expectations. Print a warning if an adjustment
7011 is required. */
7012 if (adjusted_bpaddr != bpaddr)
7013 breakpoint_adjustment_warning (bpaddr, adjusted_bpaddr, 0, 0);
7014
7015 return adjusted_bpaddr;
7016 }
7017 }
7018
7019 bp_location::bp_location (const bp_location_ops *ops, breakpoint *owner)
7020 {
7021 bp_location *loc = this;
7022
7023 gdb_assert (ops != NULL);
7024
7025 loc->ops = ops;
7026 loc->owner = owner;
7027 loc->cond_bytecode = NULL;
7028 loc->shlib_disabled = 0;
7029 loc->enabled = 1;
7030
7031 switch (owner->type)
7032 {
7033 case bp_breakpoint:
7034 case bp_single_step:
7035 case bp_until:
7036 case bp_finish:
7037 case bp_longjmp:
7038 case bp_longjmp_resume:
7039 case bp_longjmp_call_dummy:
7040 case bp_exception:
7041 case bp_exception_resume:
7042 case bp_step_resume:
7043 case bp_hp_step_resume:
7044 case bp_watchpoint_scope:
7045 case bp_call_dummy:
7046 case bp_std_terminate:
7047 case bp_shlib_event:
7048 case bp_thread_event:
7049 case bp_overlay_event:
7050 case bp_jit_event:
7051 case bp_longjmp_master:
7052 case bp_std_terminate_master:
7053 case bp_exception_master:
7054 case bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver:
7055 case bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver_return:
7056 case bp_dprintf:
7057 loc->loc_type = bp_loc_software_breakpoint;
7058 mark_breakpoint_location_modified (loc);
7059 break;
7060 case bp_hardware_breakpoint:
7061 loc->loc_type = bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint;
7062 mark_breakpoint_location_modified (loc);
7063 break;
7064 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
7065 case bp_read_watchpoint:
7066 case bp_access_watchpoint:
7067 loc->loc_type = bp_loc_hardware_watchpoint;
7068 break;
7069 case bp_watchpoint:
7070 case bp_catchpoint:
7071 case bp_tracepoint:
7072 case bp_fast_tracepoint:
7073 case bp_static_tracepoint:
7074 loc->loc_type = bp_loc_other;
7075 break;
7076 default:
7077 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__, _("unknown breakpoint type"));
7078 }
7079
7080 loc->refc = 1;
7081 }
7082
7083 /* Allocate a struct bp_location. */
7084
7085 static struct bp_location *
7086 allocate_bp_location (struct breakpoint *bpt)
7087 {
7088 return bpt->ops->allocate_location (bpt);
7089 }
7090
7091 static void
7092 free_bp_location (struct bp_location *loc)
7093 {
7094 loc->ops->dtor (loc);
7095 delete loc;
7096 }
7097
7098 /* Increment reference count. */
7099
7100 static void
7101 incref_bp_location (struct bp_location *bl)
7102 {
7103 ++bl->refc;
7104 }
7105
7106 /* Decrement reference count. If the reference count reaches 0,
7107 destroy the bp_location. Sets *BLP to NULL. */
7108
7109 static void
7110 decref_bp_location (struct bp_location **blp)
7111 {
7112 gdb_assert ((*blp)->refc > 0);
7113
7114 if (--(*blp)->refc == 0)
7115 free_bp_location (*blp);
7116 *blp = NULL;
7117 }
7118
7119 /* Add breakpoint B at the end of the global breakpoint chain. */
7120
7121 static breakpoint *
7122 add_to_breakpoint_chain (std::unique_ptr<breakpoint> &&b)
7123 {
7124 struct breakpoint *b1;
7125 struct breakpoint *result = b.get ();
7126
7127 /* Add this breakpoint to the end of the chain so that a list of
7128 breakpoints will come out in order of increasing numbers. */
7129
7130 b1 = breakpoint_chain;
7131 if (b1 == 0)
7132 breakpoint_chain = b.release ();
7133 else
7134 {
7135 while (b1->next)
7136 b1 = b1->next;
7137 b1->next = b.release ();
7138 }
7139
7140 return result;
7141 }
7142
7143 /* Initializes breakpoint B with type BPTYPE and no locations yet. */
7144
7145 static void
7146 init_raw_breakpoint_without_location (struct breakpoint *b,
7147 struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
7148 enum bptype bptype,
7149 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops)
7150 {
7151 gdb_assert (ops != NULL);
7152
7153 b->ops = ops;
7154 b->type = bptype;
7155 b->gdbarch = gdbarch;
7156 b->language = current_language->la_language;
7157 b->input_radix = input_radix;
7158 b->related_breakpoint = b;
7159 }
7160
7161 /* Helper to set_raw_breakpoint below. Creates a breakpoint
7162 that has type BPTYPE and has no locations as yet. */
7163
7164 static struct breakpoint *
7165 set_raw_breakpoint_without_location (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
7166 enum bptype bptype,
7167 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops)
7168 {
7169 std::unique_ptr<breakpoint> b = new_breakpoint_from_type (bptype);
7170
7171 init_raw_breakpoint_without_location (b.get (), gdbarch, bptype, ops);
7172 return add_to_breakpoint_chain (std::move (b));
7173 }
7174
7175 /* Initialize loc->function_name. EXPLICIT_LOC says no indirect function
7176 resolutions should be made as the user specified the location explicitly
7177 enough. */
7178
7179 static void
7180 set_breakpoint_location_function (struct bp_location *loc, int explicit_loc)
7181 {
7182 gdb_assert (loc->owner != NULL);
7183
7184 if (loc->owner->type == bp_breakpoint
7185 || loc->owner->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint
7186 || is_tracepoint (loc->owner))
7187 {
7188 int is_gnu_ifunc;
7189 const char *function_name;
7190 CORE_ADDR func_addr;
7191
7192 find_pc_partial_function_gnu_ifunc (loc->address, &function_name,
7193 &func_addr, NULL, &is_gnu_ifunc);
7194
7195 if (is_gnu_ifunc && !explicit_loc)
7196 {
7197 struct breakpoint *b = loc->owner;
7198
7199 gdb_assert (loc->pspace == current_program_space);
7200 if (gnu_ifunc_resolve_name (function_name,
7201 &loc->requested_address))
7202 {
7203 /* Recalculate ADDRESS based on new REQUESTED_ADDRESS. */
7204 loc->address = adjust_breakpoint_address (loc->gdbarch,
7205 loc->requested_address,
7206 b->type);
7207 }
7208 else if (b->type == bp_breakpoint && b->loc == loc
7209 && loc->next == NULL && b->related_breakpoint == b)
7210 {
7211 /* Create only the whole new breakpoint of this type but do not
7212 mess more complicated breakpoints with multiple locations. */
7213 b->type = bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver;
7214 /* Remember the resolver's address for use by the return
7215 breakpoint. */
7216 loc->related_address = func_addr;
7217 }
7218 }
7219
7220 if (function_name)
7221 loc->function_name = xstrdup (function_name);
7222 }
7223 }
7224
7225 /* Attempt to determine architecture of location identified by SAL. */
7226 struct gdbarch *
7227 get_sal_arch (struct symtab_and_line sal)
7228 {
7229 if (sal.section)
7230 return get_objfile_arch (sal.section->objfile);
7231 if (sal.symtab)
7232 return get_objfile_arch (SYMTAB_OBJFILE (sal.symtab));
7233
7234 return NULL;
7235 }
7236
7237 /* Low level routine for partially initializing a breakpoint of type
7238 BPTYPE. The newly created breakpoint's address, section, source
7239 file name, and line number are provided by SAL.
7240
7241 It is expected that the caller will complete the initialization of
7242 the newly created breakpoint struct as well as output any status
7243 information regarding the creation of a new breakpoint. */
7244
7245 static void
7246 init_raw_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b, struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
7247 struct symtab_and_line sal, enum bptype bptype,
7248 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops)
7249 {
7250 init_raw_breakpoint_without_location (b, gdbarch, bptype, ops);
7251
7252 add_location_to_breakpoint (b, &sal);
7253
7254 if (bptype != bp_catchpoint)
7255 gdb_assert (sal.pspace != NULL);
7256
7257 /* Store the program space that was used to set the breakpoint,
7258 except for ordinary breakpoints, which are independent of the
7259 program space. */
7260 if (bptype != bp_breakpoint && bptype != bp_hardware_breakpoint)
7261 b->pspace = sal.pspace;
7262 }
7263
7264 /* set_raw_breakpoint is a low level routine for allocating and
7265 partially initializing a breakpoint of type BPTYPE. The newly
7266 created breakpoint's address, section, source file name, and line
7267 number are provided by SAL. The newly created and partially
7268 initialized breakpoint is added to the breakpoint chain and
7269 is also returned as the value of this function.
7270
7271 It is expected that the caller will complete the initialization of
7272 the newly created breakpoint struct as well as output any status
7273 information regarding the creation of a new breakpoint. In
7274 particular, set_raw_breakpoint does NOT set the breakpoint
7275 number! Care should be taken to not allow an error to occur
7276 prior to completing the initialization of the breakpoint. If this
7277 should happen, a bogus breakpoint will be left on the chain. */
7278
7279 struct breakpoint *
7280 set_raw_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
7281 struct symtab_and_line sal, enum bptype bptype,
7282 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops)
7283 {
7284 std::unique_ptr<breakpoint> b = new_breakpoint_from_type (bptype);
7285
7286 init_raw_breakpoint (b.get (), gdbarch, sal, bptype, ops);
7287 return add_to_breakpoint_chain (std::move (b));
7288 }
7289
7290 /* Call this routine when stepping and nexting to enable a breakpoint
7291 if we do a longjmp() or 'throw' in TP. FRAME is the frame which
7292 initiated the operation. */
7293
7294 void
7295 set_longjmp_breakpoint (struct thread_info *tp, struct frame_id frame)
7296 {
7297 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
7298 int thread = tp->global_num;
7299
7300 /* To avoid having to rescan all objfile symbols at every step,
7301 we maintain a list of continually-inserted but always disabled
7302 longjmp "master" breakpoints. Here, we simply create momentary
7303 clones of those and enable them for the requested thread. */
7304 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
7305 if (b->pspace == current_program_space
7306 && (b->type == bp_longjmp_master
7307 || b->type == bp_exception_master))
7308 {
7309 enum bptype type = b->type == bp_longjmp_master ? bp_longjmp : bp_exception;
7310 struct breakpoint *clone;
7311
7312 /* longjmp_breakpoint_ops ensures INITIATING_FRAME is cleared again
7313 after their removal. */
7314 clone = momentary_breakpoint_from_master (b, type,
7315 &momentary_breakpoint_ops, 1);
7316 clone->thread = thread;
7317 }
7318
7319 tp->initiating_frame = frame;
7320 }
7321
7322 /* Delete all longjmp breakpoints from THREAD. */
7323 void
7324 delete_longjmp_breakpoint (int thread)
7325 {
7326 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
7327
7328 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
7329 if (b->type == bp_longjmp || b->type == bp_exception)
7330 {
7331 if (b->thread == thread)
7332 delete_breakpoint (b);
7333 }
7334 }
7335
7336 void
7337 delete_longjmp_breakpoint_at_next_stop (int thread)
7338 {
7339 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
7340
7341 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
7342 if (b->type == bp_longjmp || b->type == bp_exception)
7343 {
7344 if (b->thread == thread)
7345 b->disposition = disp_del_at_next_stop;
7346 }
7347 }
7348
7349 /* Place breakpoints of type bp_longjmp_call_dummy to catch longjmp for
7350 INFERIOR_PTID thread. Chain them all by RELATED_BREAKPOINT and return
7351 pointer to any of them. Return NULL if this system cannot place longjmp
7352 breakpoints. */
7353
7354 struct breakpoint *
7355 set_longjmp_breakpoint_for_call_dummy (void)
7356 {
7357 struct breakpoint *b, *retval = NULL;
7358
7359 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
7360 if (b->pspace == current_program_space && b->type == bp_longjmp_master)
7361 {
7362 struct breakpoint *new_b;
7363
7364 new_b = momentary_breakpoint_from_master (b, bp_longjmp_call_dummy,
7365 &momentary_breakpoint_ops,
7366 1);
7367 new_b->thread = ptid_to_global_thread_id (inferior_ptid);
7368
7369 /* Link NEW_B into the chain of RETVAL breakpoints. */
7370
7371 gdb_assert (new_b->related_breakpoint == new_b);
7372 if (retval == NULL)
7373 retval = new_b;
7374 new_b->related_breakpoint = retval;
7375 while (retval->related_breakpoint != new_b->related_breakpoint)
7376 retval = retval->related_breakpoint;
7377 retval->related_breakpoint = new_b;
7378 }
7379
7380 return retval;
7381 }
7382
7383 /* Verify all existing dummy frames and their associated breakpoints for
7384 TP. Remove those which can no longer be found in the current frame
7385 stack.
7386
7387 You should call this function only at places where it is safe to currently
7388 unwind the whole stack. Failed stack unwind would discard live dummy
7389 frames. */
7390
7391 void
7392 check_longjmp_breakpoint_for_call_dummy (struct thread_info *tp)
7393 {
7394 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
7395
7396 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
7397 if (b->type == bp_longjmp_call_dummy && b->thread == tp->global_num)
7398 {
7399 struct breakpoint *dummy_b = b->related_breakpoint;
7400
7401 while (dummy_b != b && dummy_b->type != bp_call_dummy)
7402 dummy_b = dummy_b->related_breakpoint;
7403 if (dummy_b->type != bp_call_dummy
7404 || frame_find_by_id (dummy_b->frame_id) != NULL)
7405 continue;
7406
7407 dummy_frame_discard (dummy_b->frame_id, tp->ptid);
7408
7409 while (b->related_breakpoint != b)
7410 {
7411 if (b_tmp == b->related_breakpoint)
7412 b_tmp = b->related_breakpoint->next;
7413 delete_breakpoint (b->related_breakpoint);
7414 }
7415 delete_breakpoint (b);
7416 }
7417 }
7418
7419 void
7420 enable_overlay_breakpoints (void)
7421 {
7422 struct breakpoint *b;
7423
7424 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
7425 if (b->type == bp_overlay_event)
7426 {
7427 b->enable_state = bp_enabled;
7428 update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
7429 overlay_events_enabled = 1;
7430 }
7431 }
7432
7433 void
7434 disable_overlay_breakpoints (void)
7435 {
7436 struct breakpoint *b;
7437
7438 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
7439 if (b->type == bp_overlay_event)
7440 {
7441 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
7442 update_global_location_list (UGLL_DONT_INSERT);
7443 overlay_events_enabled = 0;
7444 }
7445 }
7446
7447 /* Set an active std::terminate breakpoint for each std::terminate
7448 master breakpoint. */
7449 void
7450 set_std_terminate_breakpoint (void)
7451 {
7452 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
7453
7454 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
7455 if (b->pspace == current_program_space
7456 && b->type == bp_std_terminate_master)
7457 {
7458 momentary_breakpoint_from_master (b, bp_std_terminate,
7459 &momentary_breakpoint_ops, 1);
7460 }
7461 }
7462
7463 /* Delete all the std::terminate breakpoints. */
7464 void
7465 delete_std_terminate_breakpoint (void)
7466 {
7467 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
7468
7469 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
7470 if (b->type == bp_std_terminate)
7471 delete_breakpoint (b);
7472 }
7473
7474 struct breakpoint *
7475 create_thread_event_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, CORE_ADDR address)
7476 {
7477 struct breakpoint *b;
7478
7479 b = create_internal_breakpoint (gdbarch, address, bp_thread_event,
7480 &internal_breakpoint_ops);
7481
7482 b->enable_state = bp_enabled;
7483 /* location has to be used or breakpoint_re_set will delete me. */
7484 b->location = new_address_location (b->loc->address, NULL, 0);
7485
7486 update_global_location_list_nothrow (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
7487
7488 return b;
7489 }
7490
7491 struct lang_and_radix
7492 {
7493 enum language lang;
7494 int radix;
7495 };
7496
7497 /* Create a breakpoint for JIT code registration and unregistration. */
7498
7499 struct breakpoint *
7500 create_jit_event_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, CORE_ADDR address)
7501 {
7502 return create_internal_breakpoint (gdbarch, address, bp_jit_event,
7503 &internal_breakpoint_ops);
7504 }
7505
7506 /* Remove JIT code registration and unregistration breakpoint(s). */
7507
7508 void
7509 remove_jit_event_breakpoints (void)
7510 {
7511 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
7512
7513 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
7514 if (b->type == bp_jit_event
7515 && b->loc->pspace == current_program_space)
7516 delete_breakpoint (b);
7517 }
7518
7519 void
7520 remove_solib_event_breakpoints (void)
7521 {
7522 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
7523
7524 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
7525 if (b->type == bp_shlib_event
7526 && b->loc->pspace == current_program_space)
7527 delete_breakpoint (b);
7528 }
7529
7530 /* See breakpoint.h. */
7531
7532 void
7533 remove_solib_event_breakpoints_at_next_stop (void)
7534 {
7535 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
7536
7537 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
7538 if (b->type == bp_shlib_event
7539 && b->loc->pspace == current_program_space)
7540 b->disposition = disp_del_at_next_stop;
7541 }
7542
7543 /* Helper for create_solib_event_breakpoint /
7544 create_and_insert_solib_event_breakpoint. Allows specifying which
7545 INSERT_MODE to pass through to update_global_location_list. */
7546
7547 static struct breakpoint *
7548 create_solib_event_breakpoint_1 (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, CORE_ADDR address,
7549 enum ugll_insert_mode insert_mode)
7550 {
7551 struct breakpoint *b;
7552
7553 b = create_internal_breakpoint (gdbarch, address, bp_shlib_event,
7554 &internal_breakpoint_ops);
7555 update_global_location_list_nothrow (insert_mode);
7556 return b;
7557 }
7558
7559 struct breakpoint *
7560 create_solib_event_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, CORE_ADDR address)
7561 {
7562 return create_solib_event_breakpoint_1 (gdbarch, address, UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
7563 }
7564
7565 /* See breakpoint.h. */
7566
7567 struct breakpoint *
7568 create_and_insert_solib_event_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, CORE_ADDR address)
7569 {
7570 struct breakpoint *b;
7571
7572 /* Explicitly tell update_global_location_list to insert
7573 locations. */
7574 b = create_solib_event_breakpoint_1 (gdbarch, address, UGLL_INSERT);
7575 if (!b->loc->inserted)
7576 {
7577 delete_breakpoint (b);
7578 return NULL;
7579 }
7580 return b;
7581 }
7582
7583 /* Disable any breakpoints that are on code in shared libraries. Only
7584 apply to enabled breakpoints, disabled ones can just stay disabled. */
7585
7586 void
7587 disable_breakpoints_in_shlibs (void)
7588 {
7589 struct bp_location *loc, **locp_tmp;
7590
7591 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (loc, locp_tmp)
7592 {
7593 /* ALL_BP_LOCATIONS bp_location has LOC->OWNER always non-NULL. */
7594 struct breakpoint *b = loc->owner;
7595
7596 /* We apply the check to all breakpoints, including disabled for
7597 those with loc->duplicate set. This is so that when breakpoint
7598 becomes enabled, or the duplicate is removed, gdb will try to
7599 insert all breakpoints. If we don't set shlib_disabled here,
7600 we'll try to insert those breakpoints and fail. */
7601 if (((b->type == bp_breakpoint)
7602 || (b->type == bp_jit_event)
7603 || (b->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint)
7604 || (is_tracepoint (b)))
7605 && loc->pspace == current_program_space
7606 && !loc->shlib_disabled
7607 && solib_name_from_address (loc->pspace, loc->address)
7608 )
7609 {
7610 loc->shlib_disabled = 1;
7611 }
7612 }
7613 }
7614
7615 /* Disable any breakpoints and tracepoints that are in SOLIB upon
7616 notification of unloaded_shlib. Only apply to enabled breakpoints,
7617 disabled ones can just stay disabled. */
7618
7619 static void
7620 disable_breakpoints_in_unloaded_shlib (struct so_list *solib)
7621 {
7622 struct bp_location *loc, **locp_tmp;
7623 int disabled_shlib_breaks = 0;
7624
7625 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (loc, locp_tmp)
7626 {
7627 /* ALL_BP_LOCATIONS bp_location has LOC->OWNER always non-NULL. */
7628 struct breakpoint *b = loc->owner;
7629
7630 if (solib->pspace == loc->pspace
7631 && !loc->shlib_disabled
7632 && (((b->type == bp_breakpoint
7633 || b->type == bp_jit_event
7634 || b->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint)
7635 && (loc->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint
7636 || loc->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint))
7637 || is_tracepoint (b))
7638 && solib_contains_address_p (solib, loc->address))
7639 {
7640 loc->shlib_disabled = 1;
7641 /* At this point, we cannot rely on remove_breakpoint
7642 succeeding so we must mark the breakpoint as not inserted
7643 to prevent future errors occurring in remove_breakpoints. */
7644 loc->inserted = 0;
7645
7646 /* This may cause duplicate notifications for the same breakpoint. */
7647 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (b);
7648
7649 if (!disabled_shlib_breaks)
7650 {
7651 target_terminal::ours_for_output ();
7652 warning (_("Temporarily disabling breakpoints "
7653 "for unloaded shared library \"%s\""),
7654 solib->so_name);
7655 }
7656 disabled_shlib_breaks = 1;
7657 }
7658 }
7659 }
7660
7661 /* Disable any breakpoints and tracepoints in OBJFILE upon
7662 notification of free_objfile. Only apply to enabled breakpoints,
7663 disabled ones can just stay disabled. */
7664
7665 static void
7666 disable_breakpoints_in_freed_objfile (struct objfile *objfile)
7667 {
7668 struct breakpoint *b;
7669
7670 if (objfile == NULL)
7671 return;
7672
7673 /* OBJF_SHARED|OBJF_USERLOADED objfiles are dynamic modules manually
7674 managed by the user with add-symbol-file/remove-symbol-file.
7675 Similarly to how breakpoints in shared libraries are handled in
7676 response to "nosharedlibrary", mark breakpoints in such modules
7677 shlib_disabled so they end up uninserted on the next global
7678 location list update. Shared libraries not loaded by the user
7679 aren't handled here -- they're already handled in
7680 disable_breakpoints_in_unloaded_shlib, called by solib.c's
7681 solib_unloaded observer. We skip objfiles that are not
7682 OBJF_SHARED as those aren't considered dynamic objects (e.g. the
7683 main objfile). */
7684 if ((objfile->flags & OBJF_SHARED) == 0
7685 || (objfile->flags & OBJF_USERLOADED) == 0)
7686 return;
7687
7688 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
7689 {
7690 struct bp_location *loc;
7691 int bp_modified = 0;
7692
7693 if (!is_breakpoint (b) && !is_tracepoint (b))
7694 continue;
7695
7696 for (loc = b->loc; loc != NULL; loc = loc->next)
7697 {
7698 CORE_ADDR loc_addr = loc->address;
7699
7700 if (loc->loc_type != bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint
7701 && loc->loc_type != bp_loc_software_breakpoint)
7702 continue;
7703
7704 if (loc->shlib_disabled != 0)
7705 continue;
7706
7707 if (objfile->pspace != loc->pspace)
7708 continue;
7709
7710 if (loc->loc_type != bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint
7711 && loc->loc_type != bp_loc_software_breakpoint)
7712 continue;
7713
7714 if (is_addr_in_objfile (loc_addr, objfile))
7715 {
7716 loc->shlib_disabled = 1;
7717 /* At this point, we don't know whether the object was
7718 unmapped from the inferior or not, so leave the
7719 inserted flag alone. We'll handle failure to
7720 uninsert quietly, in case the object was indeed
7721 unmapped. */
7722
7723 mark_breakpoint_location_modified (loc);
7724
7725 bp_modified = 1;
7726 }
7727 }
7728
7729 if (bp_modified)
7730 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (b);
7731 }
7732 }
7733
7734 /* FORK & VFORK catchpoints. */
7735
7736 /* An instance of this type is used to represent a fork or vfork
7737 catchpoint. A breakpoint is really of this type iff its ops pointer points
7738 to CATCH_FORK_BREAKPOINT_OPS. */
7739
7740 struct fork_catchpoint : public breakpoint
7741 {
7742 /* Process id of a child process whose forking triggered this
7743 catchpoint. This field is only valid immediately after this
7744 catchpoint has triggered. */
7745 ptid_t forked_inferior_pid;
7746 };
7747
7748 /* Implement the "insert" breakpoint_ops method for fork
7749 catchpoints. */
7750
7751 static int
7752 insert_catch_fork (struct bp_location *bl)
7753 {
7754 return target_insert_fork_catchpoint (ptid_get_pid (inferior_ptid));
7755 }
7756
7757 /* Implement the "remove" breakpoint_ops method for fork
7758 catchpoints. */
7759
7760 static int
7761 remove_catch_fork (struct bp_location *bl, enum remove_bp_reason reason)
7762 {
7763 return target_remove_fork_catchpoint (ptid_get_pid (inferior_ptid));
7764 }
7765
7766 /* Implement the "breakpoint_hit" breakpoint_ops method for fork
7767 catchpoints. */
7768
7769 static int
7770 breakpoint_hit_catch_fork (const struct bp_location *bl,
7771 const address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR bp_addr,
7772 const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
7773 {
7774 struct fork_catchpoint *c = (struct fork_catchpoint *) bl->owner;
7775
7776 if (ws->kind != TARGET_WAITKIND_FORKED)
7777 return 0;
7778
7779 c->forked_inferior_pid = ws->value.related_pid;
7780 return 1;
7781 }
7782
7783 /* Implement the "print_it" breakpoint_ops method for fork
7784 catchpoints. */
7785
7786 static enum print_stop_action
7787 print_it_catch_fork (bpstat bs)
7788 {
7789 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
7790 struct breakpoint *b = bs->breakpoint_at;
7791 struct fork_catchpoint *c = (struct fork_catchpoint *) bs->breakpoint_at;
7792
7793 annotate_catchpoint (b->number);
7794 maybe_print_thread_hit_breakpoint (uiout);
7795 if (b->disposition == disp_del)
7796 uiout->text ("Temporary catchpoint ");
7797 else
7798 uiout->text ("Catchpoint ");
7799 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
7800 {
7801 uiout->field_string ("reason", async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_FORK));
7802 uiout->field_string ("disp", bpdisp_text (b->disposition));
7803 }
7804 uiout->field_int ("bkptno", b->number);
7805 uiout->text (" (forked process ");
7806 uiout->field_int ("newpid", ptid_get_pid (c->forked_inferior_pid));
7807 uiout->text ("), ");
7808 return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
7809 }
7810
7811 /* Implement the "print_one" breakpoint_ops method for fork
7812 catchpoints. */
7813
7814 static void
7815 print_one_catch_fork (struct breakpoint *b, struct bp_location **last_loc)
7816 {
7817 struct fork_catchpoint *c = (struct fork_catchpoint *) b;
7818 struct value_print_options opts;
7819 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
7820
7821 get_user_print_options (&opts);
7822
7823 /* Field 4, the address, is omitted (which makes the columns not
7824 line up too nicely with the headers, but the effect is relatively
7825 readable). */
7826 if (opts.addressprint)
7827 uiout->field_skip ("addr");
7828 annotate_field (5);
7829 uiout->text ("fork");
7830 if (!ptid_equal (c->forked_inferior_pid, null_ptid))
7831 {
7832 uiout->text (", process ");
7833 uiout->field_int ("what", ptid_get_pid (c->forked_inferior_pid));
7834 uiout->spaces (1);
7835 }
7836
7837 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
7838 uiout->field_string ("catch-type", "fork");
7839 }
7840
7841 /* Implement the "print_mention" breakpoint_ops method for fork
7842 catchpoints. */
7843
7844 static void
7845 print_mention_catch_fork (struct breakpoint *b)
7846 {
7847 printf_filtered (_("Catchpoint %d (fork)"), b->number);
7848 }
7849
7850 /* Implement the "print_recreate" breakpoint_ops method for fork
7851 catchpoints. */
7852
7853 static void
7854 print_recreate_catch_fork (struct breakpoint *b, struct ui_file *fp)
7855 {
7856 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "catch fork");
7857 print_recreate_thread (b, fp);
7858 }
7859
7860 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used in fork catchpoints. */
7861
7862 static struct breakpoint_ops catch_fork_breakpoint_ops;
7863
7864 /* Implement the "insert" breakpoint_ops method for vfork
7865 catchpoints. */
7866
7867 static int
7868 insert_catch_vfork (struct bp_location *bl)
7869 {
7870 return target_insert_vfork_catchpoint (ptid_get_pid (inferior_ptid));
7871 }
7872
7873 /* Implement the "remove" breakpoint_ops method for vfork
7874 catchpoints. */
7875
7876 static int
7877 remove_catch_vfork (struct bp_location *bl, enum remove_bp_reason reason)
7878 {
7879 return target_remove_vfork_catchpoint (ptid_get_pid (inferior_ptid));
7880 }
7881
7882 /* Implement the "breakpoint_hit" breakpoint_ops method for vfork
7883 catchpoints. */
7884
7885 static int
7886 breakpoint_hit_catch_vfork (const struct bp_location *bl,
7887 const address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR bp_addr,
7888 const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
7889 {
7890 struct fork_catchpoint *c = (struct fork_catchpoint *) bl->owner;
7891
7892 if (ws->kind != TARGET_WAITKIND_VFORKED)
7893 return 0;
7894
7895 c->forked_inferior_pid = ws->value.related_pid;
7896 return 1;
7897 }
7898
7899 /* Implement the "print_it" breakpoint_ops method for vfork
7900 catchpoints. */
7901
7902 static enum print_stop_action
7903 print_it_catch_vfork (bpstat bs)
7904 {
7905 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
7906 struct breakpoint *b = bs->breakpoint_at;
7907 struct fork_catchpoint *c = (struct fork_catchpoint *) b;
7908
7909 annotate_catchpoint (b->number);
7910 maybe_print_thread_hit_breakpoint (uiout);
7911 if (b->disposition == disp_del)
7912 uiout->text ("Temporary catchpoint ");
7913 else
7914 uiout->text ("Catchpoint ");
7915 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
7916 {
7917 uiout->field_string ("reason", async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_VFORK));
7918 uiout->field_string ("disp", bpdisp_text (b->disposition));
7919 }
7920 uiout->field_int ("bkptno", b->number);
7921 uiout->text (" (vforked process ");
7922 uiout->field_int ("newpid", ptid_get_pid (c->forked_inferior_pid));
7923 uiout->text ("), ");
7924 return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
7925 }
7926
7927 /* Implement the "print_one" breakpoint_ops method for vfork
7928 catchpoints. */
7929
7930 static void
7931 print_one_catch_vfork (struct breakpoint *b, struct bp_location **last_loc)
7932 {
7933 struct fork_catchpoint *c = (struct fork_catchpoint *) b;
7934 struct value_print_options opts;
7935 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
7936
7937 get_user_print_options (&opts);
7938 /* Field 4, the address, is omitted (which makes the columns not
7939 line up too nicely with the headers, but the effect is relatively
7940 readable). */
7941 if (opts.addressprint)
7942 uiout->field_skip ("addr");
7943 annotate_field (5);
7944 uiout->text ("vfork");
7945 if (!ptid_equal (c->forked_inferior_pid, null_ptid))
7946 {
7947 uiout->text (", process ");
7948 uiout->field_int ("what", ptid_get_pid (c->forked_inferior_pid));
7949 uiout->spaces (1);
7950 }
7951
7952 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
7953 uiout->field_string ("catch-type", "vfork");
7954 }
7955
7956 /* Implement the "print_mention" breakpoint_ops method for vfork
7957 catchpoints. */
7958
7959 static void
7960 print_mention_catch_vfork (struct breakpoint *b)
7961 {
7962 printf_filtered (_("Catchpoint %d (vfork)"), b->number);
7963 }
7964
7965 /* Implement the "print_recreate" breakpoint_ops method for vfork
7966 catchpoints. */
7967
7968 static void
7969 print_recreate_catch_vfork (struct breakpoint *b, struct ui_file *fp)
7970 {
7971 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "catch vfork");
7972 print_recreate_thread (b, fp);
7973 }
7974
7975 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used in vfork catchpoints. */
7976
7977 static struct breakpoint_ops catch_vfork_breakpoint_ops;
7978
7979 /* An instance of this type is used to represent an solib catchpoint.
7980 A breakpoint is really of this type iff its ops pointer points to
7981 CATCH_SOLIB_BREAKPOINT_OPS. */
7982
7983 struct solib_catchpoint : public breakpoint
7984 {
7985 ~solib_catchpoint () override;
7986
7987 /* True for "catch load", false for "catch unload". */
7988 unsigned char is_load;
7989
7990 /* Regular expression to match, if any. COMPILED is only valid when
7991 REGEX is non-NULL. */
7992 char *regex;
7993 std::unique_ptr<compiled_regex> compiled;
7994 };
7995
7996 solib_catchpoint::~solib_catchpoint ()
7997 {
7998 xfree (this->regex);
7999 }
8000
8001 static int
8002 insert_catch_solib (struct bp_location *ignore)
8003 {
8004 return 0;
8005 }
8006
8007 static int
8008 remove_catch_solib (struct bp_location *ignore, enum remove_bp_reason reason)
8009 {
8010 return 0;
8011 }
8012
8013 static int
8014 breakpoint_hit_catch_solib (const struct bp_location *bl,
8015 const address_space *aspace,
8016 CORE_ADDR bp_addr,
8017 const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
8018 {
8019 struct solib_catchpoint *self = (struct solib_catchpoint *) bl->owner;
8020 struct breakpoint *other;
8021
8022 if (ws->kind == TARGET_WAITKIND_LOADED)
8023 return 1;
8024
8025 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (other)
8026 {
8027 struct bp_location *other_bl;
8028
8029 if (other == bl->owner)
8030 continue;
8031
8032 if (other->type != bp_shlib_event)
8033 continue;
8034
8035 if (self->pspace != NULL && other->pspace != self->pspace)
8036 continue;
8037
8038 for (other_bl = other->loc; other_bl != NULL; other_bl = other_bl->next)
8039 {
8040 if (other->ops->breakpoint_hit (other_bl, aspace, bp_addr, ws))
8041 return 1;
8042 }
8043 }
8044
8045 return 0;
8046 }
8047
8048 static void
8049 check_status_catch_solib (struct bpstats *bs)
8050 {
8051 struct solib_catchpoint *self
8052 = (struct solib_catchpoint *) bs->breakpoint_at;
8053 int ix;
8054
8055 if (self->is_load)
8056 {
8057 struct so_list *iter;
8058
8059 for (ix = 0;
8060 VEC_iterate (so_list_ptr, current_program_space->added_solibs,
8061 ix, iter);
8062 ++ix)
8063 {
8064 if (!self->regex
8065 || self->compiled->exec (iter->so_name, 0, NULL, 0) == 0)
8066 return;
8067 }
8068 }
8069 else
8070 {
8071 char *iter;
8072
8073 for (ix = 0;
8074 VEC_iterate (char_ptr, current_program_space->deleted_solibs,
8075 ix, iter);
8076 ++ix)
8077 {
8078 if (!self->regex
8079 || self->compiled->exec (iter, 0, NULL, 0) == 0)
8080 return;
8081 }
8082 }
8083
8084 bs->stop = 0;
8085 bs->print_it = print_it_noop;
8086 }
8087
8088 static enum print_stop_action
8089 print_it_catch_solib (bpstat bs)
8090 {
8091 struct breakpoint *b = bs->breakpoint_at;
8092 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
8093
8094 annotate_catchpoint (b->number);
8095 maybe_print_thread_hit_breakpoint (uiout);
8096 if (b->disposition == disp_del)
8097 uiout->text ("Temporary catchpoint ");
8098 else
8099 uiout->text ("Catchpoint ");
8100 uiout->field_int ("bkptno", b->number);
8101 uiout->text ("\n");
8102 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
8103 uiout->field_string ("disp", bpdisp_text (b->disposition));
8104 print_solib_event (1);
8105 return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
8106 }
8107
8108 static void
8109 print_one_catch_solib (struct breakpoint *b, struct bp_location **locs)
8110 {
8111 struct solib_catchpoint *self = (struct solib_catchpoint *) b;
8112 struct value_print_options opts;
8113 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
8114 char *msg;
8115
8116 get_user_print_options (&opts);
8117 /* Field 4, the address, is omitted (which makes the columns not
8118 line up too nicely with the headers, but the effect is relatively
8119 readable). */
8120 if (opts.addressprint)
8121 {
8122 annotate_field (4);
8123 uiout->field_skip ("addr");
8124 }
8125
8126 annotate_field (5);
8127 if (self->is_load)
8128 {
8129 if (self->regex)
8130 msg = xstrprintf (_("load of library matching %s"), self->regex);
8131 else
8132 msg = xstrdup (_("load of library"));
8133 }
8134 else
8135 {
8136 if (self->regex)
8137 msg = xstrprintf (_("unload of library matching %s"), self->regex);
8138 else
8139 msg = xstrdup (_("unload of library"));
8140 }
8141 uiout->field_string ("what", msg);
8142 xfree (msg);
8143
8144 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
8145 uiout->field_string ("catch-type", self->is_load ? "load" : "unload");
8146 }
8147
8148 static void
8149 print_mention_catch_solib (struct breakpoint *b)
8150 {
8151 struct solib_catchpoint *self = (struct solib_catchpoint *) b;
8152
8153 printf_filtered (_("Catchpoint %d (%s)"), b->number,
8154 self->is_load ? "load" : "unload");
8155 }
8156
8157 static void
8158 print_recreate_catch_solib (struct breakpoint *b, struct ui_file *fp)
8159 {
8160 struct solib_catchpoint *self = (struct solib_catchpoint *) b;
8161
8162 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "%s %s",
8163 b->disposition == disp_del ? "tcatch" : "catch",
8164 self->is_load ? "load" : "unload");
8165 if (self->regex)
8166 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " %s", self->regex);
8167 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "\n");
8168 }
8169
8170 static struct breakpoint_ops catch_solib_breakpoint_ops;
8171
8172 /* Shared helper function (MI and CLI) for creating and installing
8173 a shared object event catchpoint. If IS_LOAD is non-zero then
8174 the events to be caught are load events, otherwise they are
8175 unload events. If IS_TEMP is non-zero the catchpoint is a
8176 temporary one. If ENABLED is non-zero the catchpoint is
8177 created in an enabled state. */
8178
8179 void
8180 add_solib_catchpoint (const char *arg, int is_load, int is_temp, int enabled)
8181 {
8182 struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_current_arch ();
8183
8184 if (!arg)
8185 arg = "";
8186 arg = skip_spaces (arg);
8187
8188 std::unique_ptr<solib_catchpoint> c (new solib_catchpoint ());
8189
8190 if (*arg != '\0')
8191 {
8192 c->compiled.reset (new compiled_regex (arg, REG_NOSUB,
8193 _("Invalid regexp")));
8194 c->regex = xstrdup (arg);
8195 }
8196
8197 c->is_load = is_load;
8198 init_catchpoint (c.get (), gdbarch, is_temp, NULL,
8199 &catch_solib_breakpoint_ops);
8200
8201 c->enable_state = enabled ? bp_enabled : bp_disabled;
8202
8203 install_breakpoint (0, std::move (c), 1);
8204 }
8205
8206 /* A helper function that does all the work for "catch load" and
8207 "catch unload". */
8208
8209 static void
8210 catch_load_or_unload (const char *arg, int from_tty, int is_load,
8211 struct cmd_list_element *command)
8212 {
8213 int tempflag;
8214 const int enabled = 1;
8215
8216 tempflag = get_cmd_context (command) == CATCH_TEMPORARY;
8217
8218 add_solib_catchpoint (arg, is_load, tempflag, enabled);
8219 }
8220
8221 static void
8222 catch_load_command_1 (const char *arg, int from_tty,
8223 struct cmd_list_element *command)
8224 {
8225 catch_load_or_unload (arg, from_tty, 1, command);
8226 }
8227
8228 static void
8229 catch_unload_command_1 (const char *arg, int from_tty,
8230 struct cmd_list_element *command)
8231 {
8232 catch_load_or_unload (arg, from_tty, 0, command);
8233 }
8234
8235 /* Initialize a new breakpoint of the bp_catchpoint kind. If TEMPFLAG
8236 is non-zero, then make the breakpoint temporary. If COND_STRING is
8237 not NULL, then store it in the breakpoint. OPS, if not NULL, is
8238 the breakpoint_ops structure associated to the catchpoint. */
8239
8240 void
8241 init_catchpoint (struct breakpoint *b,
8242 struct gdbarch *gdbarch, int tempflag,
8243 const char *cond_string,
8244 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops)
8245 {
8246 symtab_and_line sal;
8247 sal.pspace = current_program_space;
8248
8249 init_raw_breakpoint (b, gdbarch, sal, bp_catchpoint, ops);
8250
8251 b->cond_string = (cond_string == NULL) ? NULL : xstrdup (cond_string);
8252 b->disposition = tempflag ? disp_del : disp_donttouch;
8253 }
8254
8255 void
8256 install_breakpoint (int internal, std::unique_ptr<breakpoint> &&arg, int update_gll)
8257 {
8258 breakpoint *b = add_to_breakpoint_chain (std::move (arg));
8259 set_breakpoint_number (internal, b);
8260 if (is_tracepoint (b))
8261 set_tracepoint_count (breakpoint_count);
8262 if (!internal)
8263 mention (b);
8264 observer_notify_breakpoint_created (b);
8265
8266 if (update_gll)
8267 update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
8268 }
8269
8270 static void
8271 create_fork_vfork_event_catchpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
8272 int tempflag, const char *cond_string,
8273 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops)
8274 {
8275 std::unique_ptr<fork_catchpoint> c (new fork_catchpoint ());
8276
8277 init_catchpoint (c.get (), gdbarch, tempflag, cond_string, ops);
8278
8279 c->forked_inferior_pid = null_ptid;
8280
8281 install_breakpoint (0, std::move (c), 1);
8282 }
8283
8284 /* Exec catchpoints. */
8285
8286 /* An instance of this type is used to represent an exec catchpoint.
8287 A breakpoint is really of this type iff its ops pointer points to
8288 CATCH_EXEC_BREAKPOINT_OPS. */
8289
8290 struct exec_catchpoint : public breakpoint
8291 {
8292 ~exec_catchpoint () override;
8293
8294 /* Filename of a program whose exec triggered this catchpoint.
8295 This field is only valid immediately after this catchpoint has
8296 triggered. */
8297 char *exec_pathname;
8298 };
8299
8300 /* Exec catchpoint destructor. */
8301
8302 exec_catchpoint::~exec_catchpoint ()
8303 {
8304 xfree (this->exec_pathname);
8305 }
8306
8307 static int
8308 insert_catch_exec (struct bp_location *bl)
8309 {
8310 return target_insert_exec_catchpoint (ptid_get_pid (inferior_ptid));
8311 }
8312
8313 static int
8314 remove_catch_exec (struct bp_location *bl, enum remove_bp_reason reason)
8315 {
8316 return target_remove_exec_catchpoint (ptid_get_pid (inferior_ptid));
8317 }
8318
8319 static int
8320 breakpoint_hit_catch_exec (const struct bp_location *bl,
8321 const address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR bp_addr,
8322 const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
8323 {
8324 struct exec_catchpoint *c = (struct exec_catchpoint *) bl->owner;
8325
8326 if (ws->kind != TARGET_WAITKIND_EXECD)
8327 return 0;
8328
8329 c->exec_pathname = xstrdup (ws->value.execd_pathname);
8330 return 1;
8331 }
8332
8333 static enum print_stop_action
8334 print_it_catch_exec (bpstat bs)
8335 {
8336 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
8337 struct breakpoint *b = bs->breakpoint_at;
8338 struct exec_catchpoint *c = (struct exec_catchpoint *) b;
8339
8340 annotate_catchpoint (b->number);
8341 maybe_print_thread_hit_breakpoint (uiout);
8342 if (b->disposition == disp_del)
8343 uiout->text ("Temporary catchpoint ");
8344 else
8345 uiout->text ("Catchpoint ");
8346 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
8347 {
8348 uiout->field_string ("reason", async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_EXEC));
8349 uiout->field_string ("disp", bpdisp_text (b->disposition));
8350 }
8351 uiout->field_int ("bkptno", b->number);
8352 uiout->text (" (exec'd ");
8353 uiout->field_string ("new-exec", c->exec_pathname);
8354 uiout->text ("), ");
8355
8356 return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
8357 }
8358
8359 static void
8360 print_one_catch_exec (struct breakpoint *b, struct bp_location **last_loc)
8361 {
8362 struct exec_catchpoint *c = (struct exec_catchpoint *) b;
8363 struct value_print_options opts;
8364 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
8365
8366 get_user_print_options (&opts);
8367
8368 /* Field 4, the address, is omitted (which makes the columns
8369 not line up too nicely with the headers, but the effect
8370 is relatively readable). */
8371 if (opts.addressprint)
8372 uiout->field_skip ("addr");
8373 annotate_field (5);
8374 uiout->text ("exec");
8375 if (c->exec_pathname != NULL)
8376 {
8377 uiout->text (", program \"");
8378 uiout->field_string ("what", c->exec_pathname);
8379 uiout->text ("\" ");
8380 }
8381
8382 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
8383 uiout->field_string ("catch-type", "exec");
8384 }
8385
8386 static void
8387 print_mention_catch_exec (struct breakpoint *b)
8388 {
8389 printf_filtered (_("Catchpoint %d (exec)"), b->number);
8390 }
8391
8392 /* Implement the "print_recreate" breakpoint_ops method for exec
8393 catchpoints. */
8394
8395 static void
8396 print_recreate_catch_exec (struct breakpoint *b, struct ui_file *fp)
8397 {
8398 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "catch exec");
8399 print_recreate_thread (b, fp);
8400 }
8401
8402 static struct breakpoint_ops catch_exec_breakpoint_ops;
8403
8404 static int
8405 hw_breakpoint_used_count (void)
8406 {
8407 int i = 0;
8408 struct breakpoint *b;
8409 struct bp_location *bl;
8410
8411 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
8412 {
8413 if (b->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint && breakpoint_enabled (b))
8414 for (bl = b->loc; bl; bl = bl->next)
8415 {
8416 /* Special types of hardware breakpoints may use more than
8417 one register. */
8418 i += b->ops->resources_needed (bl);
8419 }
8420 }
8421
8422 return i;
8423 }
8424
8425 /* Returns the resources B would use if it were a hardware
8426 watchpoint. */
8427
8428 static int
8429 hw_watchpoint_use_count (struct breakpoint *b)
8430 {
8431 int i = 0;
8432 struct bp_location *bl;
8433
8434 if (!breakpoint_enabled (b))
8435 return 0;
8436
8437 for (bl = b->loc; bl; bl = bl->next)
8438 {
8439 /* Special types of hardware watchpoints may use more than
8440 one register. */
8441 i += b->ops->resources_needed (bl);
8442 }
8443
8444 return i;
8445 }
8446
8447 /* Returns the sum the used resources of all hardware watchpoints of
8448 type TYPE in the breakpoints list. Also returns in OTHER_TYPE_USED
8449 the sum of the used resources of all hardware watchpoints of other
8450 types _not_ TYPE. */
8451
8452 static int
8453 hw_watchpoint_used_count_others (struct breakpoint *except,
8454 enum bptype type, int *other_type_used)
8455 {
8456 int i = 0;
8457 struct breakpoint *b;
8458
8459 *other_type_used = 0;
8460 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
8461 {
8462 if (b == except)
8463 continue;
8464 if (!breakpoint_enabled (b))
8465 continue;
8466
8467 if (b->type == type)
8468 i += hw_watchpoint_use_count (b);
8469 else if (is_hardware_watchpoint (b))
8470 *other_type_used = 1;
8471 }
8472
8473 return i;
8474 }
8475
8476 void
8477 disable_watchpoints_before_interactive_call_start (void)
8478 {
8479 struct breakpoint *b;
8480
8481 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
8482 {
8483 if (is_watchpoint (b) && breakpoint_enabled (b))
8484 {
8485 b->enable_state = bp_call_disabled;
8486 update_global_location_list (UGLL_DONT_INSERT);
8487 }
8488 }
8489 }
8490
8491 void
8492 enable_watchpoints_after_interactive_call_stop (void)
8493 {
8494 struct breakpoint *b;
8495
8496 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
8497 {
8498 if (is_watchpoint (b) && b->enable_state == bp_call_disabled)
8499 {
8500 b->enable_state = bp_enabled;
8501 update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
8502 }
8503 }
8504 }
8505
8506 void
8507 disable_breakpoints_before_startup (void)
8508 {
8509 current_program_space->executing_startup = 1;
8510 update_global_location_list (UGLL_DONT_INSERT);
8511 }
8512
8513 void
8514 enable_breakpoints_after_startup (void)
8515 {
8516 current_program_space->executing_startup = 0;
8517 breakpoint_re_set ();
8518 }
8519
8520 /* Create a new single-step breakpoint for thread THREAD, with no
8521 locations. */
8522
8523 static struct breakpoint *
8524 new_single_step_breakpoint (int thread, struct gdbarch *gdbarch)
8525 {
8526 std::unique_ptr<breakpoint> b (new breakpoint ());
8527
8528 init_raw_breakpoint_without_location (b.get (), gdbarch, bp_single_step,
8529 &momentary_breakpoint_ops);
8530
8531 b->disposition = disp_donttouch;
8532 b->frame_id = null_frame_id;
8533
8534 b->thread = thread;
8535 gdb_assert (b->thread != 0);
8536
8537 return add_to_breakpoint_chain (std::move (b));
8538 }
8539
8540 /* Set a momentary breakpoint of type TYPE at address specified by
8541 SAL. If FRAME_ID is valid, the breakpoint is restricted to that
8542 frame. */
8543
8544 breakpoint_up
8545 set_momentary_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, struct symtab_and_line sal,
8546 struct frame_id frame_id, enum bptype type)
8547 {
8548 struct breakpoint *b;
8549
8550 /* If FRAME_ID is valid, it should be a real frame, not an inlined or
8551 tail-called one. */
8552 gdb_assert (!frame_id_artificial_p (frame_id));
8553
8554 b = set_raw_breakpoint (gdbarch, sal, type, &momentary_breakpoint_ops);
8555 b->enable_state = bp_enabled;
8556 b->disposition = disp_donttouch;
8557 b->frame_id = frame_id;
8558
8559 /* If we're debugging a multi-threaded program, then we want
8560 momentary breakpoints to be active in only a single thread of
8561 control. */
8562 if (in_thread_list (inferior_ptid))
8563 b->thread = ptid_to_global_thread_id (inferior_ptid);
8564
8565 update_global_location_list_nothrow (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
8566
8567 return breakpoint_up (b);
8568 }
8569
8570 /* Make a momentary breakpoint based on the master breakpoint ORIG.
8571 The new breakpoint will have type TYPE, use OPS as its
8572 breakpoint_ops, and will set enabled to LOC_ENABLED. */
8573
8574 static struct breakpoint *
8575 momentary_breakpoint_from_master (struct breakpoint *orig,
8576 enum bptype type,
8577 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops,
8578 int loc_enabled)
8579 {
8580 struct breakpoint *copy;
8581
8582 copy = set_raw_breakpoint_without_location (orig->gdbarch, type, ops);
8583 copy->loc = allocate_bp_location (copy);
8584 set_breakpoint_location_function (copy->loc, 1);
8585
8586 copy->loc->gdbarch = orig->loc->gdbarch;
8587 copy->loc->requested_address = orig->loc->requested_address;
8588 copy->loc->address = orig->loc->address;
8589 copy->loc->section = orig->loc->section;
8590 copy->loc->pspace = orig->loc->pspace;
8591 copy->loc->probe = orig->loc->probe;
8592 copy->loc->line_number = orig->loc->line_number;
8593 copy->loc->symtab = orig->loc->symtab;
8594 copy->loc->enabled = loc_enabled;
8595 copy->frame_id = orig->frame_id;
8596 copy->thread = orig->thread;
8597 copy->pspace = orig->pspace;
8598
8599 copy->enable_state = bp_enabled;
8600 copy->disposition = disp_donttouch;
8601 copy->number = internal_breakpoint_number--;
8602
8603 update_global_location_list_nothrow (UGLL_DONT_INSERT);
8604 return copy;
8605 }
8606
8607 /* Make a deep copy of momentary breakpoint ORIG. Returns NULL if
8608 ORIG is NULL. */
8609
8610 struct breakpoint *
8611 clone_momentary_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *orig)
8612 {
8613 /* If there's nothing to clone, then return nothing. */
8614 if (orig == NULL)
8615 return NULL;
8616
8617 return momentary_breakpoint_from_master (orig, orig->type, orig->ops, 0);
8618 }
8619
8620 breakpoint_up
8621 set_momentary_breakpoint_at_pc (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, CORE_ADDR pc,
8622 enum bptype type)
8623 {
8624 struct symtab_and_line sal;
8625
8626 sal = find_pc_line (pc, 0);
8627 sal.pc = pc;
8628 sal.section = find_pc_overlay (pc);
8629 sal.explicit_pc = 1;
8630
8631 return set_momentary_breakpoint (gdbarch, sal, null_frame_id, type);
8632 }
8633 \f
8634
8635 /* Tell the user we have just set a breakpoint B. */
8636
8637 static void
8638 mention (struct breakpoint *b)
8639 {
8640 b->ops->print_mention (b);
8641 if (current_uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
8642 return;
8643 printf_filtered ("\n");
8644 }
8645 \f
8646
8647 static int bp_loc_is_permanent (struct bp_location *loc);
8648
8649 static struct bp_location *
8650 add_location_to_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b,
8651 const struct symtab_and_line *sal)
8652 {
8653 struct bp_location *loc, **tmp;
8654 CORE_ADDR adjusted_address;
8655 struct gdbarch *loc_gdbarch = get_sal_arch (*sal);
8656
8657 if (loc_gdbarch == NULL)
8658 loc_gdbarch = b->gdbarch;
8659
8660 /* Adjust the breakpoint's address prior to allocating a location.
8661 Once we call allocate_bp_location(), that mostly uninitialized
8662 location will be placed on the location chain. Adjustment of the
8663 breakpoint may cause target_read_memory() to be called and we do
8664 not want its scan of the location chain to find a breakpoint and
8665 location that's only been partially initialized. */
8666 adjusted_address = adjust_breakpoint_address (loc_gdbarch,
8667 sal->pc, b->type);
8668
8669 /* Sort the locations by their ADDRESS. */
8670 loc = allocate_bp_location (b);
8671 for (tmp = &(b->loc); *tmp != NULL && (*tmp)->address <= adjusted_address;
8672 tmp = &((*tmp)->next))
8673 ;
8674 loc->next = *tmp;
8675 *tmp = loc;
8676
8677 loc->requested_address = sal->pc;
8678 loc->address = adjusted_address;
8679 loc->pspace = sal->pspace;
8680 loc->probe.prob = sal->prob;
8681 loc->probe.objfile = sal->objfile;
8682 gdb_assert (loc->pspace != NULL);
8683 loc->section = sal->section;
8684 loc->gdbarch = loc_gdbarch;
8685 loc->line_number = sal->line;
8686 loc->symtab = sal->symtab;
8687 loc->symbol = sal->symbol;
8688
8689 set_breakpoint_location_function (loc,
8690 sal->explicit_pc || sal->explicit_line);
8691
8692 /* While by definition, permanent breakpoints are already present in the
8693 code, we don't mark the location as inserted. Normally one would expect
8694 that GDB could rely on that breakpoint instruction to stop the program,
8695 thus removing the need to insert its own breakpoint, except that executing
8696 the breakpoint instruction can kill the target instead of reporting a
8697 SIGTRAP. E.g., on SPARC, when interrupts are disabled, executing the
8698 instruction resets the CPU, so QEMU 2.0.0 for SPARC correspondingly dies
8699 with "Trap 0x02 while interrupts disabled, Error state". Letting the
8700 breakpoint be inserted normally results in QEMU knowing about the GDB
8701 breakpoint, and thus trap before the breakpoint instruction is executed.
8702 (If GDB later needs to continue execution past the permanent breakpoint,
8703 it manually increments the PC, thus avoiding executing the breakpoint
8704 instruction.) */
8705 if (bp_loc_is_permanent (loc))
8706 loc->permanent = 1;
8707
8708 return loc;
8709 }
8710 \f
8711
8712 /* See breakpoint.h. */
8713
8714 int
8715 program_breakpoint_here_p (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, CORE_ADDR address)
8716 {
8717 int len;
8718 CORE_ADDR addr;
8719 const gdb_byte *bpoint;
8720 gdb_byte *target_mem;
8721
8722 addr = address;
8723 bpoint = gdbarch_breakpoint_from_pc (gdbarch, &addr, &len);
8724
8725 /* Software breakpoints unsupported? */
8726 if (bpoint == NULL)
8727 return 0;
8728
8729 target_mem = (gdb_byte *) alloca (len);
8730
8731 /* Enable the automatic memory restoration from breakpoints while
8732 we read the memory. Otherwise we could say about our temporary
8733 breakpoints they are permanent. */
8734 scoped_restore restore_memory
8735 = make_scoped_restore_show_memory_breakpoints (0);
8736
8737 if (target_read_memory (address, target_mem, len) == 0
8738 && memcmp (target_mem, bpoint, len) == 0)
8739 return 1;
8740
8741 return 0;
8742 }
8743
8744 /* Return 1 if LOC is pointing to a permanent breakpoint,
8745 return 0 otherwise. */
8746
8747 static int
8748 bp_loc_is_permanent (struct bp_location *loc)
8749 {
8750 gdb_assert (loc != NULL);
8751
8752 /* If we have a catchpoint or a watchpoint, just return 0. We should not
8753 attempt to read from the addresses the locations of these breakpoint types
8754 point to. program_breakpoint_here_p, below, will attempt to read
8755 memory. */
8756 if (!breakpoint_address_is_meaningful (loc->owner))
8757 return 0;
8758
8759 scoped_restore_current_pspace_and_thread restore_pspace_thread;
8760 switch_to_program_space_and_thread (loc->pspace);
8761 return program_breakpoint_here_p (loc->gdbarch, loc->address);
8762 }
8763
8764 /* Build a command list for the dprintf corresponding to the current
8765 settings of the dprintf style options. */
8766
8767 static void
8768 update_dprintf_command_list (struct breakpoint *b)
8769 {
8770 char *dprintf_args = b->extra_string;
8771 char *printf_line = NULL;
8772
8773 if (!dprintf_args)
8774 return;
8775
8776 dprintf_args = skip_spaces (dprintf_args);
8777
8778 /* Allow a comma, as it may have terminated a location, but don't
8779 insist on it. */
8780 if (*dprintf_args == ',')
8781 ++dprintf_args;
8782 dprintf_args = skip_spaces (dprintf_args);
8783
8784 if (*dprintf_args != '"')
8785 error (_("Bad format string, missing '\"'."));
8786
8787 if (strcmp (dprintf_style, dprintf_style_gdb) == 0)
8788 printf_line = xstrprintf ("printf %s", dprintf_args);
8789 else if (strcmp (dprintf_style, dprintf_style_call) == 0)
8790 {
8791 if (!dprintf_function)
8792 error (_("No function supplied for dprintf call"));
8793
8794 if (dprintf_channel && strlen (dprintf_channel) > 0)
8795 printf_line = xstrprintf ("call (void) %s (%s,%s)",
8796 dprintf_function,
8797 dprintf_channel,
8798 dprintf_args);
8799 else
8800 printf_line = xstrprintf ("call (void) %s (%s)",
8801 dprintf_function,
8802 dprintf_args);
8803 }
8804 else if (strcmp (dprintf_style, dprintf_style_agent) == 0)
8805 {
8806 if (target_can_run_breakpoint_commands ())
8807 printf_line = xstrprintf ("agent-printf %s", dprintf_args);
8808 else
8809 {
8810 warning (_("Target cannot run dprintf commands, falling back to GDB printf"));
8811 printf_line = xstrprintf ("printf %s", dprintf_args);
8812 }
8813 }
8814 else
8815 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
8816 _("Invalid dprintf style."));
8817
8818 gdb_assert (printf_line != NULL);
8819 /* Manufacture a printf sequence. */
8820 {
8821 struct command_line *printf_cmd_line = XNEW (struct command_line);
8822
8823 printf_cmd_line->control_type = simple_control;
8824 printf_cmd_line->body_count = 0;
8825 printf_cmd_line->body_list = NULL;
8826 printf_cmd_line->next = NULL;
8827 printf_cmd_line->line = printf_line;
8828
8829 breakpoint_set_commands (b, command_line_up (printf_cmd_line));
8830 }
8831 }
8832
8833 /* Update all dprintf commands, making their command lists reflect
8834 current style settings. */
8835
8836 static void
8837 update_dprintf_commands (const char *args, int from_tty,
8838 struct cmd_list_element *c)
8839 {
8840 struct breakpoint *b;
8841
8842 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
8843 {
8844 if (b->type == bp_dprintf)
8845 update_dprintf_command_list (b);
8846 }
8847 }
8848
8849 /* Create a breakpoint with SAL as location. Use LOCATION
8850 as a description of the location, and COND_STRING
8851 as condition expression. If LOCATION is NULL then create an
8852 "address location" from the address in the SAL. */
8853
8854 static void
8855 init_breakpoint_sal (struct breakpoint *b, struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
8856 gdb::array_view<const symtab_and_line> sals,
8857 event_location_up &&location,
8858 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> filter,
8859 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> cond_string,
8860 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> extra_string,
8861 enum bptype type, enum bpdisp disposition,
8862 int thread, int task, int ignore_count,
8863 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops, int from_tty,
8864 int enabled, int internal, unsigned flags,
8865 int display_canonical)
8866 {
8867 int i;
8868
8869 if (type == bp_hardware_breakpoint)
8870 {
8871 int target_resources_ok;
8872
8873 i = hw_breakpoint_used_count ();
8874 target_resources_ok =
8875 target_can_use_hardware_watchpoint (bp_hardware_breakpoint,
8876 i + 1, 0);
8877 if (target_resources_ok == 0)
8878 error (_("No hardware breakpoint support in the target."));
8879 else if (target_resources_ok < 0)
8880 error (_("Hardware breakpoints used exceeds limit."));
8881 }
8882
8883 gdb_assert (!sals.empty ());
8884
8885 for (const auto &sal : sals)
8886 {
8887 struct bp_location *loc;
8888
8889 if (from_tty)
8890 {
8891 struct gdbarch *loc_gdbarch = get_sal_arch (sal);
8892 if (!loc_gdbarch)
8893 loc_gdbarch = gdbarch;
8894
8895 describe_other_breakpoints (loc_gdbarch,
8896 sal.pspace, sal.pc, sal.section, thread);
8897 }
8898
8899 if (&sal == &sals[0])
8900 {
8901 init_raw_breakpoint (b, gdbarch, sal, type, ops);
8902 b->thread = thread;
8903 b->task = task;
8904
8905 b->cond_string = cond_string.release ();
8906 b->extra_string = extra_string.release ();
8907 b->ignore_count = ignore_count;
8908 b->enable_state = enabled ? bp_enabled : bp_disabled;
8909 b->disposition = disposition;
8910
8911 if ((flags & CREATE_BREAKPOINT_FLAGS_INSERTED) != 0)
8912 b->loc->inserted = 1;
8913
8914 if (type == bp_static_tracepoint)
8915 {
8916 struct tracepoint *t = (struct tracepoint *) b;
8917 struct static_tracepoint_marker marker;
8918
8919 if (strace_marker_p (b))
8920 {
8921 /* We already know the marker exists, otherwise, we
8922 wouldn't see a sal for it. */
8923 const char *p
8924 = &event_location_to_string (b->location.get ())[3];
8925 const char *endp;
8926 char *marker_str;
8927
8928 p = skip_spaces (p);
8929
8930 endp = skip_to_space (p);
8931
8932 marker_str = savestring (p, endp - p);
8933 t->static_trace_marker_id = marker_str;
8934
8935 printf_filtered (_("Probed static tracepoint "
8936 "marker \"%s\"\n"),
8937 t->static_trace_marker_id);
8938 }
8939 else if (target_static_tracepoint_marker_at (sal.pc, &marker))
8940 {
8941 t->static_trace_marker_id = xstrdup (marker.str_id);
8942 release_static_tracepoint_marker (&marker);
8943
8944 printf_filtered (_("Probed static tracepoint "
8945 "marker \"%s\"\n"),
8946 t->static_trace_marker_id);
8947 }
8948 else
8949 warning (_("Couldn't determine the static "
8950 "tracepoint marker to probe"));
8951 }
8952
8953 loc = b->loc;
8954 }
8955 else
8956 {
8957 loc = add_location_to_breakpoint (b, &sal);
8958 if ((flags & CREATE_BREAKPOINT_FLAGS_INSERTED) != 0)
8959 loc->inserted = 1;
8960 }
8961
8962 if (b->cond_string)
8963 {
8964 const char *arg = b->cond_string;
8965
8966 loc->cond = parse_exp_1 (&arg, loc->address,
8967 block_for_pc (loc->address), 0);
8968 if (*arg)
8969 error (_("Garbage '%s' follows condition"), arg);
8970 }
8971
8972 /* Dynamic printf requires and uses additional arguments on the
8973 command line, otherwise it's an error. */
8974 if (type == bp_dprintf)
8975 {
8976 if (b->extra_string)
8977 update_dprintf_command_list (b);
8978 else
8979 error (_("Format string required"));
8980 }
8981 else if (b->extra_string)
8982 error (_("Garbage '%s' at end of command"), b->extra_string);
8983 }
8984
8985 b->display_canonical = display_canonical;
8986 if (location != NULL)
8987 b->location = std::move (location);
8988 else
8989 b->location = new_address_location (b->loc->address, NULL, 0);
8990 b->filter = filter.release ();
8991 }
8992
8993 static void
8994 create_breakpoint_sal (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
8995 gdb::array_view<const symtab_and_line> sals,
8996 event_location_up &&location,
8997 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> filter,
8998 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> cond_string,
8999 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> extra_string,
9000 enum bptype type, enum bpdisp disposition,
9001 int thread, int task, int ignore_count,
9002 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops, int from_tty,
9003 int enabled, int internal, unsigned flags,
9004 int display_canonical)
9005 {
9006 std::unique_ptr<breakpoint> b = new_breakpoint_from_type (type);
9007
9008 init_breakpoint_sal (b.get (), gdbarch,
9009 sals, std::move (location),
9010 std::move (filter),
9011 std::move (cond_string),
9012 std::move (extra_string),
9013 type, disposition,
9014 thread, task, ignore_count,
9015 ops, from_tty,
9016 enabled, internal, flags,
9017 display_canonical);
9018
9019 install_breakpoint (internal, std::move (b), 0);
9020 }
9021
9022 /* Add SALS.nelts breakpoints to the breakpoint table. For each
9023 SALS.sal[i] breakpoint, include the corresponding ADDR_STRING[i]
9024 value. COND_STRING, if not NULL, specified the condition to be
9025 used for all breakpoints. Essentially the only case where
9026 SALS.nelts is not 1 is when we set a breakpoint on an overloaded
9027 function. In that case, it's still not possible to specify
9028 separate conditions for different overloaded functions, so
9029 we take just a single condition string.
9030
9031 NOTE: If the function succeeds, the caller is expected to cleanup
9032 the arrays ADDR_STRING, COND_STRING, and SALS (but not the
9033 array contents). If the function fails (error() is called), the
9034 caller is expected to cleanups both the ADDR_STRING, COND_STRING,
9035 COND and SALS arrays and each of those arrays contents. */
9036
9037 static void
9038 create_breakpoints_sal (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
9039 struct linespec_result *canonical,
9040 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> cond_string,
9041 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> extra_string,
9042 enum bptype type, enum bpdisp disposition,
9043 int thread, int task, int ignore_count,
9044 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops, int from_tty,
9045 int enabled, int internal, unsigned flags)
9046 {
9047 if (canonical->pre_expanded)
9048 gdb_assert (canonical->lsals.size () == 1);
9049
9050 for (const auto &lsal : canonical->lsals)
9051 {
9052 /* Note that 'location' can be NULL in the case of a plain
9053 'break', without arguments. */
9054 event_location_up location
9055 = (canonical->location != NULL
9056 ? copy_event_location (canonical->location.get ()) : NULL);
9057 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> filter_string
9058 (lsal.canonical != NULL ? xstrdup (lsal.canonical) : NULL);
9059
9060 create_breakpoint_sal (gdbarch, lsal.sals,
9061 std::move (location),
9062 std::move (filter_string),
9063 std::move (cond_string),
9064 std::move (extra_string),
9065 type, disposition,
9066 thread, task, ignore_count, ops,
9067 from_tty, enabled, internal, flags,
9068 canonical->special_display);
9069 }
9070 }
9071
9072 /* Parse LOCATION which is assumed to be a SAL specification possibly
9073 followed by conditionals. On return, SALS contains an array of SAL
9074 addresses found. LOCATION points to the end of the SAL (for
9075 linespec locations).
9076
9077 The array and the line spec strings are allocated on the heap, it is
9078 the caller's responsibility to free them. */
9079
9080 static void
9081 parse_breakpoint_sals (const struct event_location *location,
9082 struct linespec_result *canonical)
9083 {
9084 struct symtab_and_line cursal;
9085
9086 if (event_location_type (location) == LINESPEC_LOCATION)
9087 {
9088 const char *spec = get_linespec_location (location)->spec_string;
9089
9090 if (spec == NULL)
9091 {
9092 /* The last displayed codepoint, if it's valid, is our default
9093 breakpoint address. */
9094 if (last_displayed_sal_is_valid ())
9095 {
9096 /* Set sal's pspace, pc, symtab, and line to the values
9097 corresponding to the last call to print_frame_info.
9098 Be sure to reinitialize LINE with NOTCURRENT == 0
9099 as the breakpoint line number is inappropriate otherwise.
9100 find_pc_line would adjust PC, re-set it back. */
9101 symtab_and_line sal = get_last_displayed_sal ();
9102 CORE_ADDR pc = sal.pc;
9103
9104 sal = find_pc_line (pc, 0);
9105
9106 /* "break" without arguments is equivalent to "break *PC"
9107 where PC is the last displayed codepoint's address. So
9108 make sure to set sal.explicit_pc to prevent GDB from
9109 trying to expand the list of sals to include all other
9110 instances with the same symtab and line. */
9111 sal.pc = pc;
9112 sal.explicit_pc = 1;
9113
9114 struct linespec_sals lsal;
9115 lsal.sals = {sal};
9116 lsal.canonical = NULL;
9117
9118 canonical->lsals.push_back (std::move (lsal));
9119 return;
9120 }
9121 else
9122 error (_("No default breakpoint address now."));
9123 }
9124 }
9125
9126 /* Force almost all breakpoints to be in terms of the
9127 current_source_symtab (which is decode_line_1's default).
9128 This should produce the results we want almost all of the
9129 time while leaving default_breakpoint_* alone.
9130
9131 ObjC: However, don't match an Objective-C method name which
9132 may have a '+' or '-' succeeded by a '['. */
9133 cursal = get_current_source_symtab_and_line ();
9134 if (last_displayed_sal_is_valid ())
9135 {
9136 const char *spec = NULL;
9137
9138 if (event_location_type (location) == LINESPEC_LOCATION)
9139 spec = get_linespec_location (location)->spec_string;
9140
9141 if (!cursal.symtab
9142 || (spec != NULL
9143 && strchr ("+-", spec[0]) != NULL
9144 && spec[1] != '['))
9145 {
9146 decode_line_full (location, DECODE_LINE_FUNFIRSTLINE, NULL,
9147 get_last_displayed_symtab (),
9148 get_last_displayed_line (),
9149 canonical, NULL, NULL);
9150 return;
9151 }
9152 }
9153
9154 decode_line_full (location, DECODE_LINE_FUNFIRSTLINE, NULL,
9155 cursal.symtab, cursal.line, canonical, NULL, NULL);
9156 }
9157
9158
9159 /* Convert each SAL into a real PC. Verify that the PC can be
9160 inserted as a breakpoint. If it can't throw an error. */
9161
9162 static void
9163 breakpoint_sals_to_pc (std::vector<symtab_and_line> &sals)
9164 {
9165 for (auto &sal : sals)
9166 resolve_sal_pc (&sal);
9167 }
9168
9169 /* Fast tracepoints may have restrictions on valid locations. For
9170 instance, a fast tracepoint using a jump instead of a trap will
9171 likely have to overwrite more bytes than a trap would, and so can
9172 only be placed where the instruction is longer than the jump, or a
9173 multi-instruction sequence does not have a jump into the middle of
9174 it, etc. */
9175
9176 static void
9177 check_fast_tracepoint_sals (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
9178 gdb::array_view<const symtab_and_line> sals)
9179 {
9180 for (const auto &sal : sals)
9181 {
9182 struct gdbarch *sarch;
9183
9184 sarch = get_sal_arch (sal);
9185 /* We fall back to GDBARCH if there is no architecture
9186 associated with SAL. */
9187 if (sarch == NULL)
9188 sarch = gdbarch;
9189 std::string msg;
9190 if (!gdbarch_fast_tracepoint_valid_at (sarch, sal.pc, &msg))
9191 error (_("May not have a fast tracepoint at %s%s"),
9192 paddress (sarch, sal.pc), msg.c_str ());
9193 }
9194 }
9195
9196 /* Given TOK, a string specification of condition and thread, as
9197 accepted by the 'break' command, extract the condition
9198 string and thread number and set *COND_STRING and *THREAD.
9199 PC identifies the context at which the condition should be parsed.
9200 If no condition is found, *COND_STRING is set to NULL.
9201 If no thread is found, *THREAD is set to -1. */
9202
9203 static void
9204 find_condition_and_thread (const char *tok, CORE_ADDR pc,
9205 char **cond_string, int *thread, int *task,
9206 char **rest)
9207 {
9208 *cond_string = NULL;
9209 *thread = -1;
9210 *task = 0;
9211 *rest = NULL;
9212
9213 while (tok && *tok)
9214 {
9215 const char *end_tok;
9216 int toklen;
9217 const char *cond_start = NULL;
9218 const char *cond_end = NULL;
9219
9220 tok = skip_spaces (tok);
9221
9222 if ((*tok == '"' || *tok == ',') && rest)
9223 {
9224 *rest = savestring (tok, strlen (tok));
9225 return;
9226 }
9227
9228 end_tok = skip_to_space (tok);
9229
9230 toklen = end_tok - tok;
9231
9232 if (toklen >= 1 && strncmp (tok, "if", toklen) == 0)
9233 {
9234 tok = cond_start = end_tok + 1;
9235 parse_exp_1 (&tok, pc, block_for_pc (pc), 0);
9236 cond_end = tok;
9237 *cond_string = savestring (cond_start, cond_end - cond_start);
9238 }
9239 else if (toklen >= 1 && strncmp (tok, "thread", toklen) == 0)
9240 {
9241 const char *tmptok;
9242 struct thread_info *thr;
9243
9244 tok = end_tok + 1;
9245 thr = parse_thread_id (tok, &tmptok);
9246 if (tok == tmptok)
9247 error (_("Junk after thread keyword."));
9248 *thread = thr->global_num;
9249 tok = tmptok;
9250 }
9251 else if (toklen >= 1 && strncmp (tok, "task", toklen) == 0)
9252 {
9253 char *tmptok;
9254
9255 tok = end_tok + 1;
9256 *task = strtol (tok, &tmptok, 0);
9257 if (tok == tmptok)
9258 error (_("Junk after task keyword."));
9259 if (!valid_task_id (*task))
9260 error (_("Unknown task %d."), *task);
9261 tok = tmptok;
9262 }
9263 else if (rest)
9264 {
9265 *rest = savestring (tok, strlen (tok));
9266 return;
9267 }
9268 else
9269 error (_("Junk at end of arguments."));
9270 }
9271 }
9272
9273 /* Decode a static tracepoint marker spec. */
9274
9275 static std::vector<symtab_and_line>
9276 decode_static_tracepoint_spec (const char **arg_p)
9277 {
9278 VEC(static_tracepoint_marker_p) *markers = NULL;
9279 const char *p = &(*arg_p)[3];
9280 const char *endp;
9281 int i;
9282
9283 p = skip_spaces (p);
9284
9285 endp = skip_to_space (p);
9286
9287 std::string marker_str (p, endp - p);
9288
9289 markers = target_static_tracepoint_markers_by_strid (marker_str.c_str ());
9290 if (VEC_empty(static_tracepoint_marker_p, markers))
9291 error (_("No known static tracepoint marker named %s"),
9292 marker_str.c_str ());
9293
9294 std::vector<symtab_and_line> sals;
9295 sals.reserve (VEC_length(static_tracepoint_marker_p, markers));
9296
9297 for (i = 0; i < VEC_length(static_tracepoint_marker_p, markers); i++)
9298 {
9299 struct static_tracepoint_marker *marker;
9300
9301 marker = VEC_index (static_tracepoint_marker_p, markers, i);
9302
9303 symtab_and_line sal = find_pc_line (marker->address, 0);
9304 sal.pc = marker->address;
9305 sals.push_back (sal);
9306
9307 release_static_tracepoint_marker (marker);
9308 }
9309
9310 *arg_p = endp;
9311 return sals;
9312 }
9313
9314 /* See breakpoint.h. */
9315
9316 int
9317 create_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
9318 const struct event_location *location,
9319 const char *cond_string,
9320 int thread, const char *extra_string,
9321 int parse_extra,
9322 int tempflag, enum bptype type_wanted,
9323 int ignore_count,
9324 enum auto_boolean pending_break_support,
9325 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops,
9326 int from_tty, int enabled, int internal,
9327 unsigned flags)
9328 {
9329 struct linespec_result canonical;
9330 struct cleanup *bkpt_chain = NULL;
9331 int pending = 0;
9332 int task = 0;
9333 int prev_bkpt_count = breakpoint_count;
9334
9335 gdb_assert (ops != NULL);
9336
9337 /* If extra_string isn't useful, set it to NULL. */
9338 if (extra_string != NULL && *extra_string == '\0')
9339 extra_string = NULL;
9340
9341 TRY
9342 {
9343 ops->create_sals_from_location (location, &canonical, type_wanted);
9344 }
9345 CATCH (e, RETURN_MASK_ERROR)
9346 {
9347 /* If caller is interested in rc value from parse, set
9348 value. */
9349 if (e.error == NOT_FOUND_ERROR)
9350 {
9351 /* If pending breakpoint support is turned off, throw
9352 error. */
9353
9354 if (pending_break_support == AUTO_BOOLEAN_FALSE)
9355 throw_exception (e);
9356
9357 exception_print (gdb_stderr, e);
9358
9359 /* If pending breakpoint support is auto query and the user
9360 selects no, then simply return the error code. */
9361 if (pending_break_support == AUTO_BOOLEAN_AUTO
9362 && !nquery (_("Make %s pending on future shared library load? "),
9363 bptype_string (type_wanted)))
9364 return 0;
9365
9366 /* At this point, either the user was queried about setting
9367 a pending breakpoint and selected yes, or pending
9368 breakpoint behavior is on and thus a pending breakpoint
9369 is defaulted on behalf of the user. */
9370 pending = 1;
9371 }
9372 else
9373 throw_exception (e);
9374 }
9375 END_CATCH
9376
9377 if (!pending && canonical.lsals.empty ())
9378 return 0;
9379
9380 /* ----------------------------- SNIP -----------------------------
9381 Anything added to the cleanup chain beyond this point is assumed
9382 to be part of a breakpoint. If the breakpoint create succeeds
9383 then the memory is not reclaimed. */
9384 bkpt_chain = make_cleanup (null_cleanup, 0);
9385
9386 /* Resolve all line numbers to PC's and verify that the addresses
9387 are ok for the target. */
9388 if (!pending)
9389 {
9390 for (auto &lsal : canonical.lsals)
9391 breakpoint_sals_to_pc (lsal.sals);
9392 }
9393
9394 /* Fast tracepoints may have additional restrictions on location. */
9395 if (!pending && type_wanted == bp_fast_tracepoint)
9396 {
9397 for (const auto &lsal : canonical.lsals)
9398 check_fast_tracepoint_sals (gdbarch, lsal.sals);
9399 }
9400
9401 /* Verify that condition can be parsed, before setting any
9402 breakpoints. Allocate a separate condition expression for each
9403 breakpoint. */
9404 if (!pending)
9405 {
9406 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> cond_string_copy;
9407 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> extra_string_copy;
9408
9409 if (parse_extra)
9410 {
9411 char *rest;
9412 char *cond;
9413
9414 const linespec_sals &lsal = canonical.lsals[0];
9415
9416 /* Here we only parse 'arg' to separate condition
9417 from thread number, so parsing in context of first
9418 sal is OK. When setting the breakpoint we'll
9419 re-parse it in context of each sal. */
9420
9421 find_condition_and_thread (extra_string, lsal.sals[0].pc,
9422 &cond, &thread, &task, &rest);
9423 cond_string_copy.reset (cond);
9424 extra_string_copy.reset (rest);
9425 }
9426 else
9427 {
9428 if (type_wanted != bp_dprintf
9429 && extra_string != NULL && *extra_string != '\0')
9430 error (_("Garbage '%s' at end of location"), extra_string);
9431
9432 /* Create a private copy of condition string. */
9433 if (cond_string)
9434 cond_string_copy.reset (xstrdup (cond_string));
9435 /* Create a private copy of any extra string. */
9436 if (extra_string)
9437 extra_string_copy.reset (xstrdup (extra_string));
9438 }
9439
9440 ops->create_breakpoints_sal (gdbarch, &canonical,
9441 std::move (cond_string_copy),
9442 std::move (extra_string_copy),
9443 type_wanted,
9444 tempflag ? disp_del : disp_donttouch,
9445 thread, task, ignore_count, ops,
9446 from_tty, enabled, internal, flags);
9447 }
9448 else
9449 {
9450 std::unique_ptr <breakpoint> b = new_breakpoint_from_type (type_wanted);
9451
9452 init_raw_breakpoint_without_location (b.get (), gdbarch, type_wanted, ops);
9453 b->location = copy_event_location (location);
9454
9455 if (parse_extra)
9456 b->cond_string = NULL;
9457 else
9458 {
9459 /* Create a private copy of condition string. */
9460 b->cond_string = cond_string != NULL ? xstrdup (cond_string) : NULL;
9461 b->thread = thread;
9462 }
9463
9464 /* Create a private copy of any extra string. */
9465 b->extra_string = extra_string != NULL ? xstrdup (extra_string) : NULL;
9466 b->ignore_count = ignore_count;
9467 b->disposition = tempflag ? disp_del : disp_donttouch;
9468 b->condition_not_parsed = 1;
9469 b->enable_state = enabled ? bp_enabled : bp_disabled;
9470 if ((type_wanted != bp_breakpoint
9471 && type_wanted != bp_hardware_breakpoint) || thread != -1)
9472 b->pspace = current_program_space;
9473
9474 install_breakpoint (internal, std::move (b), 0);
9475 }
9476
9477 if (canonical.lsals.size () > 1)
9478 {
9479 warning (_("Multiple breakpoints were set.\nUse the "
9480 "\"delete\" command to delete unwanted breakpoints."));
9481 prev_breakpoint_count = prev_bkpt_count;
9482 }
9483
9484 /* That's it. Discard the cleanups for data inserted into the
9485 breakpoint. */
9486 discard_cleanups (bkpt_chain);
9487
9488 /* error call may happen here - have BKPT_CHAIN already discarded. */
9489 update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
9490
9491 return 1;
9492 }
9493
9494 /* Set a breakpoint.
9495 ARG is a string describing breakpoint address,
9496 condition, and thread.
9497 FLAG specifies if a breakpoint is hardware on,
9498 and if breakpoint is temporary, using BP_HARDWARE_FLAG
9499 and BP_TEMPFLAG. */
9500
9501 static void
9502 break_command_1 (const char *arg, int flag, int from_tty)
9503 {
9504 int tempflag = flag & BP_TEMPFLAG;
9505 enum bptype type_wanted = (flag & BP_HARDWAREFLAG
9506 ? bp_hardware_breakpoint
9507 : bp_breakpoint);
9508 struct breakpoint_ops *ops;
9509
9510 event_location_up location = string_to_event_location (&arg, current_language);
9511
9512 /* Matching breakpoints on probes. */
9513 if (location != NULL
9514 && event_location_type (location.get ()) == PROBE_LOCATION)
9515 ops = &bkpt_probe_breakpoint_ops;
9516 else
9517 ops = &bkpt_breakpoint_ops;
9518
9519 create_breakpoint (get_current_arch (),
9520 location.get (),
9521 NULL, 0, arg, 1 /* parse arg */,
9522 tempflag, type_wanted,
9523 0 /* Ignore count */,
9524 pending_break_support,
9525 ops,
9526 from_tty,
9527 1 /* enabled */,
9528 0 /* internal */,
9529 0);
9530 }
9531
9532 /* Helper function for break_command_1 and disassemble_command. */
9533
9534 void
9535 resolve_sal_pc (struct symtab_and_line *sal)
9536 {
9537 CORE_ADDR pc;
9538
9539 if (sal->pc == 0 && sal->symtab != NULL)
9540 {
9541 if (!find_line_pc (sal->symtab, sal->line, &pc))
9542 error (_("No line %d in file \"%s\"."),
9543 sal->line, symtab_to_filename_for_display (sal->symtab));
9544 sal->pc = pc;
9545
9546 /* If this SAL corresponds to a breakpoint inserted using a line
9547 number, then skip the function prologue if necessary. */
9548 if (sal->explicit_line)
9549 skip_prologue_sal (sal);
9550 }
9551
9552 if (sal->section == 0 && sal->symtab != NULL)
9553 {
9554 const struct blockvector *bv;
9555 const struct block *b;
9556 struct symbol *sym;
9557
9558 bv = blockvector_for_pc_sect (sal->pc, 0, &b,
9559 SYMTAB_COMPUNIT (sal->symtab));
9560 if (bv != NULL)
9561 {
9562 sym = block_linkage_function (b);
9563 if (sym != NULL)
9564 {
9565 fixup_symbol_section (sym, SYMTAB_OBJFILE (sal->symtab));
9566 sal->section = SYMBOL_OBJ_SECTION (SYMTAB_OBJFILE (sal->symtab),
9567 sym);
9568 }
9569 else
9570 {
9571 /* It really is worthwhile to have the section, so we'll
9572 just have to look harder. This case can be executed
9573 if we have line numbers but no functions (as can
9574 happen in assembly source). */
9575
9576 scoped_restore_current_pspace_and_thread restore_pspace_thread;
9577 switch_to_program_space_and_thread (sal->pspace);
9578
9579 bound_minimal_symbol msym = lookup_minimal_symbol_by_pc (sal->pc);
9580 if (msym.minsym)
9581 sal->section = MSYMBOL_OBJ_SECTION (msym.objfile, msym.minsym);
9582 }
9583 }
9584 }
9585 }
9586
9587 void
9588 break_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
9589 {
9590 break_command_1 (arg, 0, from_tty);
9591 }
9592
9593 void
9594 tbreak_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
9595 {
9596 break_command_1 (arg, BP_TEMPFLAG, from_tty);
9597 }
9598
9599 static void
9600 hbreak_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
9601 {
9602 break_command_1 (arg, BP_HARDWAREFLAG, from_tty);
9603 }
9604
9605 static void
9606 thbreak_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
9607 {
9608 break_command_1 (arg, (BP_TEMPFLAG | BP_HARDWAREFLAG), from_tty);
9609 }
9610
9611 static void
9612 stop_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
9613 {
9614 printf_filtered (_("Specify the type of breakpoint to set.\n\
9615 Usage: stop in <function | address>\n\
9616 stop at <line>\n"));
9617 }
9618
9619 static void
9620 stopin_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
9621 {
9622 int badInput = 0;
9623
9624 if (arg == (char *) NULL)
9625 badInput = 1;
9626 else if (*arg != '*')
9627 {
9628 const char *argptr = arg;
9629 int hasColon = 0;
9630
9631 /* Look for a ':'. If this is a line number specification, then
9632 say it is bad, otherwise, it should be an address or
9633 function/method name. */
9634 while (*argptr && !hasColon)
9635 {
9636 hasColon = (*argptr == ':');
9637 argptr++;
9638 }
9639
9640 if (hasColon)
9641 badInput = (*argptr != ':'); /* Not a class::method */
9642 else
9643 badInput = isdigit (*arg); /* a simple line number */
9644 }
9645
9646 if (badInput)
9647 printf_filtered (_("Usage: stop in <function | address>\n"));
9648 else
9649 break_command_1 (arg, 0, from_tty);
9650 }
9651
9652 static void
9653 stopat_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
9654 {
9655 int badInput = 0;
9656
9657 if (arg == (char *) NULL || *arg == '*') /* no line number */
9658 badInput = 1;
9659 else
9660 {
9661 const char *argptr = arg;
9662 int hasColon = 0;
9663
9664 /* Look for a ':'. If there is a '::' then get out, otherwise
9665 it is probably a line number. */
9666 while (*argptr && !hasColon)
9667 {
9668 hasColon = (*argptr == ':');
9669 argptr++;
9670 }
9671
9672 if (hasColon)
9673 badInput = (*argptr == ':'); /* we have class::method */
9674 else
9675 badInput = !isdigit (*arg); /* not a line number */
9676 }
9677
9678 if (badInput)
9679 printf_filtered (_("Usage: stop at <line>\n"));
9680 else
9681 break_command_1 (arg, 0, from_tty);
9682 }
9683
9684 /* The dynamic printf command is mostly like a regular breakpoint, but
9685 with a prewired command list consisting of a single output command,
9686 built from extra arguments supplied on the dprintf command
9687 line. */
9688
9689 static void
9690 dprintf_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
9691 {
9692 event_location_up location = string_to_event_location (&arg, current_language);
9693
9694 /* If non-NULL, ARG should have been advanced past the location;
9695 the next character must be ','. */
9696 if (arg != NULL)
9697 {
9698 if (arg[0] != ',' || arg[1] == '\0')
9699 error (_("Format string required"));
9700 else
9701 {
9702 /* Skip the comma. */
9703 ++arg;
9704 }
9705 }
9706
9707 create_breakpoint (get_current_arch (),
9708 location.get (),
9709 NULL, 0, arg, 1 /* parse arg */,
9710 0, bp_dprintf,
9711 0 /* Ignore count */,
9712 pending_break_support,
9713 &dprintf_breakpoint_ops,
9714 from_tty,
9715 1 /* enabled */,
9716 0 /* internal */,
9717 0);
9718 }
9719
9720 static void
9721 agent_printf_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
9722 {
9723 error (_("May only run agent-printf on the target"));
9724 }
9725
9726 /* Implement the "breakpoint_hit" breakpoint_ops method for
9727 ranged breakpoints. */
9728
9729 static int
9730 breakpoint_hit_ranged_breakpoint (const struct bp_location *bl,
9731 const address_space *aspace,
9732 CORE_ADDR bp_addr,
9733 const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
9734 {
9735 if (ws->kind != TARGET_WAITKIND_STOPPED
9736 || ws->value.sig != GDB_SIGNAL_TRAP)
9737 return 0;
9738
9739 return breakpoint_address_match_range (bl->pspace->aspace, bl->address,
9740 bl->length, aspace, bp_addr);
9741 }
9742
9743 /* Implement the "resources_needed" breakpoint_ops method for
9744 ranged breakpoints. */
9745
9746 static int
9747 resources_needed_ranged_breakpoint (const struct bp_location *bl)
9748 {
9749 return target_ranged_break_num_registers ();
9750 }
9751
9752 /* Implement the "print_it" breakpoint_ops method for
9753 ranged breakpoints. */
9754
9755 static enum print_stop_action
9756 print_it_ranged_breakpoint (bpstat bs)
9757 {
9758 struct breakpoint *b = bs->breakpoint_at;
9759 struct bp_location *bl = b->loc;
9760 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
9761
9762 gdb_assert (b->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint);
9763
9764 /* Ranged breakpoints have only one location. */
9765 gdb_assert (bl && bl->next == NULL);
9766
9767 annotate_breakpoint (b->number);
9768
9769 maybe_print_thread_hit_breakpoint (uiout);
9770
9771 if (b->disposition == disp_del)
9772 uiout->text ("Temporary ranged breakpoint ");
9773 else
9774 uiout->text ("Ranged breakpoint ");
9775 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
9776 {
9777 uiout->field_string ("reason",
9778 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_BREAKPOINT_HIT));
9779 uiout->field_string ("disp", bpdisp_text (b->disposition));
9780 }
9781 uiout->field_int ("bkptno", b->number);
9782 uiout->text (", ");
9783
9784 return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
9785 }
9786
9787 /* Implement the "print_one" breakpoint_ops method for
9788 ranged breakpoints. */
9789
9790 static void
9791 print_one_ranged_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b,
9792 struct bp_location **last_loc)
9793 {
9794 struct bp_location *bl = b->loc;
9795 struct value_print_options opts;
9796 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
9797
9798 /* Ranged breakpoints have only one location. */
9799 gdb_assert (bl && bl->next == NULL);
9800
9801 get_user_print_options (&opts);
9802
9803 if (opts.addressprint)
9804 /* We don't print the address range here, it will be printed later
9805 by print_one_detail_ranged_breakpoint. */
9806 uiout->field_skip ("addr");
9807 annotate_field (5);
9808 print_breakpoint_location (b, bl);
9809 *last_loc = bl;
9810 }
9811
9812 /* Implement the "print_one_detail" breakpoint_ops method for
9813 ranged breakpoints. */
9814
9815 static void
9816 print_one_detail_ranged_breakpoint (const struct breakpoint *b,
9817 struct ui_out *uiout)
9818 {
9819 CORE_ADDR address_start, address_end;
9820 struct bp_location *bl = b->loc;
9821 string_file stb;
9822
9823 gdb_assert (bl);
9824
9825 address_start = bl->address;
9826 address_end = address_start + bl->length - 1;
9827
9828 uiout->text ("\taddress range: ");
9829 stb.printf ("[%s, %s]",
9830 print_core_address (bl->gdbarch, address_start),
9831 print_core_address (bl->gdbarch, address_end));
9832 uiout->field_stream ("addr", stb);
9833 uiout->text ("\n");
9834 }
9835
9836 /* Implement the "print_mention" breakpoint_ops method for
9837 ranged breakpoints. */
9838
9839 static void
9840 print_mention_ranged_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b)
9841 {
9842 struct bp_location *bl = b->loc;
9843 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
9844
9845 gdb_assert (bl);
9846 gdb_assert (b->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint);
9847
9848 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
9849 return;
9850
9851 printf_filtered (_("Hardware assisted ranged breakpoint %d from %s to %s."),
9852 b->number, paddress (bl->gdbarch, bl->address),
9853 paddress (bl->gdbarch, bl->address + bl->length - 1));
9854 }
9855
9856 /* Implement the "print_recreate" breakpoint_ops method for
9857 ranged breakpoints. */
9858
9859 static void
9860 print_recreate_ranged_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b, struct ui_file *fp)
9861 {
9862 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "break-range %s, %s",
9863 event_location_to_string (b->location.get ()),
9864 event_location_to_string (b->location_range_end.get ()));
9865 print_recreate_thread (b, fp);
9866 }
9867
9868 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used in ranged breakpoints. */
9869
9870 static struct breakpoint_ops ranged_breakpoint_ops;
9871
9872 /* Find the address where the end of the breakpoint range should be
9873 placed, given the SAL of the end of the range. This is so that if
9874 the user provides a line number, the end of the range is set to the
9875 last instruction of the given line. */
9876
9877 static CORE_ADDR
9878 find_breakpoint_range_end (struct symtab_and_line sal)
9879 {
9880 CORE_ADDR end;
9881
9882 /* If the user provided a PC value, use it. Otherwise,
9883 find the address of the end of the given location. */
9884 if (sal.explicit_pc)
9885 end = sal.pc;
9886 else
9887 {
9888 int ret;
9889 CORE_ADDR start;
9890
9891 ret = find_line_pc_range (sal, &start, &end);
9892 if (!ret)
9893 error (_("Could not find location of the end of the range."));
9894
9895 /* find_line_pc_range returns the start of the next line. */
9896 end--;
9897 }
9898
9899 return end;
9900 }
9901
9902 /* Implement the "break-range" CLI command. */
9903
9904 static void
9905 break_range_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
9906 {
9907 const char *arg_start;
9908 struct linespec_result canonical_start, canonical_end;
9909 int bp_count, can_use_bp, length;
9910 CORE_ADDR end;
9911 struct breakpoint *b;
9912
9913 /* We don't support software ranged breakpoints. */
9914 if (target_ranged_break_num_registers () < 0)
9915 error (_("This target does not support hardware ranged breakpoints."));
9916
9917 bp_count = hw_breakpoint_used_count ();
9918 bp_count += target_ranged_break_num_registers ();
9919 can_use_bp = target_can_use_hardware_watchpoint (bp_hardware_breakpoint,
9920 bp_count, 0);
9921 if (can_use_bp < 0)
9922 error (_("Hardware breakpoints used exceeds limit."));
9923
9924 arg = skip_spaces (arg);
9925 if (arg == NULL || arg[0] == '\0')
9926 error(_("No address range specified."));
9927
9928 arg_start = arg;
9929 event_location_up start_location = string_to_event_location (&arg,
9930 current_language);
9931 parse_breakpoint_sals (start_location.get (), &canonical_start);
9932
9933 if (arg[0] != ',')
9934 error (_("Too few arguments."));
9935 else if (canonical_start.lsals.empty ())
9936 error (_("Could not find location of the beginning of the range."));
9937
9938 const linespec_sals &lsal_start = canonical_start.lsals[0];
9939
9940 if (canonical_start.lsals.size () > 1
9941 || lsal_start.sals.size () != 1)
9942 error (_("Cannot create a ranged breakpoint with multiple locations."));
9943
9944 const symtab_and_line &sal_start = lsal_start.sals[0];
9945 std::string addr_string_start (arg_start, arg - arg_start);
9946
9947 arg++; /* Skip the comma. */
9948 arg = skip_spaces (arg);
9949
9950 /* Parse the end location. */
9951
9952 arg_start = arg;
9953
9954 /* We call decode_line_full directly here instead of using
9955 parse_breakpoint_sals because we need to specify the start location's
9956 symtab and line as the default symtab and line for the end of the
9957 range. This makes it possible to have ranges like "foo.c:27, +14",
9958 where +14 means 14 lines from the start location. */
9959 event_location_up end_location = string_to_event_location (&arg,
9960 current_language);
9961 decode_line_full (end_location.get (), DECODE_LINE_FUNFIRSTLINE, NULL,
9962 sal_start.symtab, sal_start.line,
9963 &canonical_end, NULL, NULL);
9964
9965 if (canonical_end.lsals.empty ())
9966 error (_("Could not find location of the end of the range."));
9967
9968 const linespec_sals &lsal_end = canonical_end.lsals[0];
9969 if (canonical_end.lsals.size () > 1
9970 || lsal_end.sals.size () != 1)
9971 error (_("Cannot create a ranged breakpoint with multiple locations."));
9972
9973 const symtab_and_line &sal_end = lsal_end.sals[0];
9974
9975 end = find_breakpoint_range_end (sal_end);
9976 if (sal_start.pc > end)
9977 error (_("Invalid address range, end precedes start."));
9978
9979 length = end - sal_start.pc + 1;
9980 if (length < 0)
9981 /* Length overflowed. */
9982 error (_("Address range too large."));
9983 else if (length == 1)
9984 {
9985 /* This range is simple enough to be handled by
9986 the `hbreak' command. */
9987 hbreak_command (&addr_string_start[0], 1);
9988
9989 return;
9990 }
9991
9992 /* Now set up the breakpoint. */
9993 b = set_raw_breakpoint (get_current_arch (), sal_start,
9994 bp_hardware_breakpoint, &ranged_breakpoint_ops);
9995 set_breakpoint_count (breakpoint_count + 1);
9996 b->number = breakpoint_count;
9997 b->disposition = disp_donttouch;
9998 b->location = std::move (start_location);
9999 b->location_range_end = std::move (end_location);
10000 b->loc->length = length;
10001
10002 mention (b);
10003 observer_notify_breakpoint_created (b);
10004 update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
10005 }
10006
10007 /* Return non-zero if EXP is verified as constant. Returned zero
10008 means EXP is variable. Also the constant detection may fail for
10009 some constant expressions and in such case still falsely return
10010 zero. */
10011
10012 static int
10013 watchpoint_exp_is_const (const struct expression *exp)
10014 {
10015 int i = exp->nelts;
10016
10017 while (i > 0)
10018 {
10019 int oplenp, argsp;
10020
10021 /* We are only interested in the descriptor of each element. */
10022 operator_length (exp, i, &oplenp, &argsp);
10023 i -= oplenp;
10024
10025 switch (exp->elts[i].opcode)
10026 {
10027 case BINOP_ADD:
10028 case BINOP_SUB:
10029 case BINOP_MUL:
10030 case BINOP_DIV:
10031 case BINOP_REM:
10032 case BINOP_MOD:
10033 case BINOP_LSH:
10034 case BINOP_RSH:
10035 case BINOP_LOGICAL_AND:
10036 case BINOP_LOGICAL_OR:
10037 case BINOP_BITWISE_AND:
10038 case BINOP_BITWISE_IOR:
10039 case BINOP_BITWISE_XOR:
10040 case BINOP_EQUAL:
10041 case BINOP_NOTEQUAL:
10042 case BINOP_LESS:
10043 case BINOP_GTR:
10044 case BINOP_LEQ:
10045 case BINOP_GEQ:
10046 case BINOP_REPEAT:
10047 case BINOP_COMMA:
10048 case BINOP_EXP:
10049 case BINOP_MIN:
10050 case BINOP_MAX:
10051 case BINOP_INTDIV:
10052 case BINOP_CONCAT:
10053 case TERNOP_COND:
10054 case TERNOP_SLICE:
10055
10056 case OP_LONG:
10057 case OP_FLOAT:
10058 case OP_LAST:
10059 case OP_COMPLEX:
10060 case OP_STRING:
10061 case OP_ARRAY:
10062 case OP_TYPE:
10063 case OP_TYPEOF:
10064 case OP_DECLTYPE:
10065 case OP_TYPEID:
10066 case OP_NAME:
10067 case OP_OBJC_NSSTRING:
10068
10069 case UNOP_NEG:
10070 case UNOP_LOGICAL_NOT:
10071 case UNOP_COMPLEMENT:
10072 case UNOP_ADDR:
10073 case UNOP_HIGH:
10074 case UNOP_CAST:
10075
10076 case UNOP_CAST_TYPE:
10077 case UNOP_REINTERPRET_CAST:
10078 case UNOP_DYNAMIC_CAST:
10079 /* Unary, binary and ternary operators: We have to check
10080 their operands. If they are constant, then so is the
10081 result of that operation. For instance, if A and B are
10082 determined to be constants, then so is "A + B".
10083
10084 UNOP_IND is one exception to the rule above, because the
10085 value of *ADDR is not necessarily a constant, even when
10086 ADDR is. */
10087 break;
10088
10089 case OP_VAR_VALUE:
10090 /* Check whether the associated symbol is a constant.
10091
10092 We use SYMBOL_CLASS rather than TYPE_CONST because it's
10093 possible that a buggy compiler could mark a variable as
10094 constant even when it is not, and TYPE_CONST would return
10095 true in this case, while SYMBOL_CLASS wouldn't.
10096
10097 We also have to check for function symbols because they
10098 are always constant. */
10099 {
10100 struct symbol *s = exp->elts[i + 2].symbol;
10101
10102 if (SYMBOL_CLASS (s) != LOC_BLOCK
10103 && SYMBOL_CLASS (s) != LOC_CONST
10104 && SYMBOL_CLASS (s) != LOC_CONST_BYTES)
10105 return 0;
10106 break;
10107 }
10108
10109 /* The default action is to return 0 because we are using
10110 the optimistic approach here: If we don't know something,
10111 then it is not a constant. */
10112 default:
10113 return 0;
10114 }
10115 }
10116
10117 return 1;
10118 }
10119
10120 /* Watchpoint destructor. */
10121
10122 watchpoint::~watchpoint ()
10123 {
10124 xfree (this->exp_string);
10125 xfree (this->exp_string_reparse);
10126 value_free (this->val);
10127 }
10128
10129 /* Implement the "re_set" breakpoint_ops method for watchpoints. */
10130
10131 static void
10132 re_set_watchpoint (struct breakpoint *b)
10133 {
10134 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
10135
10136 /* Watchpoint can be either on expression using entirely global
10137 variables, or it can be on local variables.
10138
10139 Watchpoints of the first kind are never auto-deleted, and even
10140 persist across program restarts. Since they can use variables
10141 from shared libraries, we need to reparse expression as libraries
10142 are loaded and unloaded.
10143
10144 Watchpoints on local variables can also change meaning as result
10145 of solib event. For example, if a watchpoint uses both a local
10146 and a global variables in expression, it's a local watchpoint,
10147 but unloading of a shared library will make the expression
10148 invalid. This is not a very common use case, but we still
10149 re-evaluate expression, to avoid surprises to the user.
10150
10151 Note that for local watchpoints, we re-evaluate it only if
10152 watchpoints frame id is still valid. If it's not, it means the
10153 watchpoint is out of scope and will be deleted soon. In fact,
10154 I'm not sure we'll ever be called in this case.
10155
10156 If a local watchpoint's frame id is still valid, then
10157 w->exp_valid_block is likewise valid, and we can safely use it.
10158
10159 Don't do anything about disabled watchpoints, since they will be
10160 reevaluated again when enabled. */
10161 update_watchpoint (w, 1 /* reparse */);
10162 }
10163
10164 /* Implement the "insert" breakpoint_ops method for hardware watchpoints. */
10165
10166 static int
10167 insert_watchpoint (struct bp_location *bl)
10168 {
10169 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) bl->owner;
10170 int length = w->exact ? 1 : bl->length;
10171
10172 return target_insert_watchpoint (bl->address, length, bl->watchpoint_type,
10173 w->cond_exp.get ());
10174 }
10175
10176 /* Implement the "remove" breakpoint_ops method for hardware watchpoints. */
10177
10178 static int
10179 remove_watchpoint (struct bp_location *bl, enum remove_bp_reason reason)
10180 {
10181 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) bl->owner;
10182 int length = w->exact ? 1 : bl->length;
10183
10184 return target_remove_watchpoint (bl->address, length, bl->watchpoint_type,
10185 w->cond_exp.get ());
10186 }
10187
10188 static int
10189 breakpoint_hit_watchpoint (const struct bp_location *bl,
10190 const address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR bp_addr,
10191 const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
10192 {
10193 struct breakpoint *b = bl->owner;
10194 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
10195
10196 /* Continuable hardware watchpoints are treated as non-existent if the
10197 reason we stopped wasn't a hardware watchpoint (we didn't stop on
10198 some data address). Otherwise gdb won't stop on a break instruction
10199 in the code (not from a breakpoint) when a hardware watchpoint has
10200 been defined. Also skip watchpoints which we know did not trigger
10201 (did not match the data address). */
10202 if (is_hardware_watchpoint (b)
10203 && w->watchpoint_triggered == watch_triggered_no)
10204 return 0;
10205
10206 return 1;
10207 }
10208
10209 static void
10210 check_status_watchpoint (bpstat bs)
10211 {
10212 gdb_assert (is_watchpoint (bs->breakpoint_at));
10213
10214 bpstat_check_watchpoint (bs);
10215 }
10216
10217 /* Implement the "resources_needed" breakpoint_ops method for
10218 hardware watchpoints. */
10219
10220 static int
10221 resources_needed_watchpoint (const struct bp_location *bl)
10222 {
10223 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) bl->owner;
10224 int length = w->exact? 1 : bl->length;
10225
10226 return target_region_ok_for_hw_watchpoint (bl->address, length);
10227 }
10228
10229 /* Implement the "works_in_software_mode" breakpoint_ops method for
10230 hardware watchpoints. */
10231
10232 static int
10233 works_in_software_mode_watchpoint (const struct breakpoint *b)
10234 {
10235 /* Read and access watchpoints only work with hardware support. */
10236 return b->type == bp_watchpoint || b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint;
10237 }
10238
10239 static enum print_stop_action
10240 print_it_watchpoint (bpstat bs)
10241 {
10242 struct breakpoint *b;
10243 enum print_stop_action result;
10244 struct watchpoint *w;
10245 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
10246
10247 gdb_assert (bs->bp_location_at != NULL);
10248
10249 b = bs->breakpoint_at;
10250 w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
10251
10252 annotate_watchpoint (b->number);
10253 maybe_print_thread_hit_breakpoint (uiout);
10254
10255 string_file stb;
10256
10257 gdb::optional<ui_out_emit_tuple> tuple_emitter;
10258 switch (b->type)
10259 {
10260 case bp_watchpoint:
10261 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
10262 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
10263 uiout->field_string
10264 ("reason", async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_WATCHPOINT_TRIGGER));
10265 mention (b);
10266 tuple_emitter.emplace (uiout, "value");
10267 uiout->text ("\nOld value = ");
10268 watchpoint_value_print (bs->old_val, &stb);
10269 uiout->field_stream ("old", stb);
10270 uiout->text ("\nNew value = ");
10271 watchpoint_value_print (w->val, &stb);
10272 uiout->field_stream ("new", stb);
10273 uiout->text ("\n");
10274 /* More than one watchpoint may have been triggered. */
10275 result = PRINT_UNKNOWN;
10276 break;
10277
10278 case bp_read_watchpoint:
10279 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
10280 uiout->field_string
10281 ("reason", async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_READ_WATCHPOINT_TRIGGER));
10282 mention (b);
10283 tuple_emitter.emplace (uiout, "value");
10284 uiout->text ("\nValue = ");
10285 watchpoint_value_print (w->val, &stb);
10286 uiout->field_stream ("value", stb);
10287 uiout->text ("\n");
10288 result = PRINT_UNKNOWN;
10289 break;
10290
10291 case bp_access_watchpoint:
10292 if (bs->old_val != NULL)
10293 {
10294 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
10295 uiout->field_string
10296 ("reason",
10297 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_ACCESS_WATCHPOINT_TRIGGER));
10298 mention (b);
10299 tuple_emitter.emplace (uiout, "value");
10300 uiout->text ("\nOld value = ");
10301 watchpoint_value_print (bs->old_val, &stb);
10302 uiout->field_stream ("old", stb);
10303 uiout->text ("\nNew value = ");
10304 }
10305 else
10306 {
10307 mention (b);
10308 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
10309 uiout->field_string
10310 ("reason",
10311 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_ACCESS_WATCHPOINT_TRIGGER));
10312 tuple_emitter.emplace (uiout, "value");
10313 uiout->text ("\nValue = ");
10314 }
10315 watchpoint_value_print (w->val, &stb);
10316 uiout->field_stream ("new", stb);
10317 uiout->text ("\n");
10318 result = PRINT_UNKNOWN;
10319 break;
10320 default:
10321 result = PRINT_UNKNOWN;
10322 }
10323
10324 return result;
10325 }
10326
10327 /* Implement the "print_mention" breakpoint_ops method for hardware
10328 watchpoints. */
10329
10330 static void
10331 print_mention_watchpoint (struct breakpoint *b)
10332 {
10333 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
10334 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
10335 const char *tuple_name;
10336
10337 switch (b->type)
10338 {
10339 case bp_watchpoint:
10340 uiout->text ("Watchpoint ");
10341 tuple_name = "wpt";
10342 break;
10343 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
10344 uiout->text ("Hardware watchpoint ");
10345 tuple_name = "wpt";
10346 break;
10347 case bp_read_watchpoint:
10348 uiout->text ("Hardware read watchpoint ");
10349 tuple_name = "hw-rwpt";
10350 break;
10351 case bp_access_watchpoint:
10352 uiout->text ("Hardware access (read/write) watchpoint ");
10353 tuple_name = "hw-awpt";
10354 break;
10355 default:
10356 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
10357 _("Invalid hardware watchpoint type."));
10358 }
10359
10360 ui_out_emit_tuple tuple_emitter (uiout, tuple_name);
10361 uiout->field_int ("number", b->number);
10362 uiout->text (": ");
10363 uiout->field_string ("exp", w->exp_string);
10364 }
10365
10366 /* Implement the "print_recreate" breakpoint_ops method for
10367 watchpoints. */
10368
10369 static void
10370 print_recreate_watchpoint (struct breakpoint *b, struct ui_file *fp)
10371 {
10372 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
10373
10374 switch (b->type)
10375 {
10376 case bp_watchpoint:
10377 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
10378 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "watch");
10379 break;
10380 case bp_read_watchpoint:
10381 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "rwatch");
10382 break;
10383 case bp_access_watchpoint:
10384 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "awatch");
10385 break;
10386 default:
10387 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
10388 _("Invalid watchpoint type."));
10389 }
10390
10391 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " %s", w->exp_string);
10392 print_recreate_thread (b, fp);
10393 }
10394
10395 /* Implement the "explains_signal" breakpoint_ops method for
10396 watchpoints. */
10397
10398 static int
10399 explains_signal_watchpoint (struct breakpoint *b, enum gdb_signal sig)
10400 {
10401 /* A software watchpoint cannot cause a signal other than
10402 GDB_SIGNAL_TRAP. */
10403 if (b->type == bp_watchpoint && sig != GDB_SIGNAL_TRAP)
10404 return 0;
10405
10406 return 1;
10407 }
10408
10409 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used in hardware watchpoints. */
10410
10411 static struct breakpoint_ops watchpoint_breakpoint_ops;
10412
10413 /* Implement the "insert" breakpoint_ops method for
10414 masked hardware watchpoints. */
10415
10416 static int
10417 insert_masked_watchpoint (struct bp_location *bl)
10418 {
10419 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) bl->owner;
10420
10421 return target_insert_mask_watchpoint (bl->address, w->hw_wp_mask,
10422 bl->watchpoint_type);
10423 }
10424
10425 /* Implement the "remove" breakpoint_ops method for
10426 masked hardware watchpoints. */
10427
10428 static int
10429 remove_masked_watchpoint (struct bp_location *bl, enum remove_bp_reason reason)
10430 {
10431 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) bl->owner;
10432
10433 return target_remove_mask_watchpoint (bl->address, w->hw_wp_mask,
10434 bl->watchpoint_type);
10435 }
10436
10437 /* Implement the "resources_needed" breakpoint_ops method for
10438 masked hardware watchpoints. */
10439
10440 static int
10441 resources_needed_masked_watchpoint (const struct bp_location *bl)
10442 {
10443 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) bl->owner;
10444
10445 return target_masked_watch_num_registers (bl->address, w->hw_wp_mask);
10446 }
10447
10448 /* Implement the "works_in_software_mode" breakpoint_ops method for
10449 masked hardware watchpoints. */
10450
10451 static int
10452 works_in_software_mode_masked_watchpoint (const struct breakpoint *b)
10453 {
10454 return 0;
10455 }
10456
10457 /* Implement the "print_it" breakpoint_ops method for
10458 masked hardware watchpoints. */
10459
10460 static enum print_stop_action
10461 print_it_masked_watchpoint (bpstat bs)
10462 {
10463 struct breakpoint *b = bs->breakpoint_at;
10464 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
10465
10466 /* Masked watchpoints have only one location. */
10467 gdb_assert (b->loc && b->loc->next == NULL);
10468
10469 annotate_watchpoint (b->number);
10470 maybe_print_thread_hit_breakpoint (uiout);
10471
10472 switch (b->type)
10473 {
10474 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
10475 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
10476 uiout->field_string
10477 ("reason", async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_WATCHPOINT_TRIGGER));
10478 break;
10479
10480 case bp_read_watchpoint:
10481 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
10482 uiout->field_string
10483 ("reason", async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_READ_WATCHPOINT_TRIGGER));
10484 break;
10485
10486 case bp_access_watchpoint:
10487 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
10488 uiout->field_string
10489 ("reason",
10490 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_ACCESS_WATCHPOINT_TRIGGER));
10491 break;
10492 default:
10493 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
10494 _("Invalid hardware watchpoint type."));
10495 }
10496
10497 mention (b);
10498 uiout->text (_("\n\
10499 Check the underlying instruction at PC for the memory\n\
10500 address and value which triggered this watchpoint.\n"));
10501 uiout->text ("\n");
10502
10503 /* More than one watchpoint may have been triggered. */
10504 return PRINT_UNKNOWN;
10505 }
10506
10507 /* Implement the "print_one_detail" breakpoint_ops method for
10508 masked hardware watchpoints. */
10509
10510 static void
10511 print_one_detail_masked_watchpoint (const struct breakpoint *b,
10512 struct ui_out *uiout)
10513 {
10514 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
10515
10516 /* Masked watchpoints have only one location. */
10517 gdb_assert (b->loc && b->loc->next == NULL);
10518
10519 uiout->text ("\tmask ");
10520 uiout->field_core_addr ("mask", b->loc->gdbarch, w->hw_wp_mask);
10521 uiout->text ("\n");
10522 }
10523
10524 /* Implement the "print_mention" breakpoint_ops method for
10525 masked hardware watchpoints. */
10526
10527 static void
10528 print_mention_masked_watchpoint (struct breakpoint *b)
10529 {
10530 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
10531 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
10532 const char *tuple_name;
10533
10534 switch (b->type)
10535 {
10536 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
10537 uiout->text ("Masked hardware watchpoint ");
10538 tuple_name = "wpt";
10539 break;
10540 case bp_read_watchpoint:
10541 uiout->text ("Masked hardware read watchpoint ");
10542 tuple_name = "hw-rwpt";
10543 break;
10544 case bp_access_watchpoint:
10545 uiout->text ("Masked hardware access (read/write) watchpoint ");
10546 tuple_name = "hw-awpt";
10547 break;
10548 default:
10549 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
10550 _("Invalid hardware watchpoint type."));
10551 }
10552
10553 ui_out_emit_tuple tuple_emitter (uiout, tuple_name);
10554 uiout->field_int ("number", b->number);
10555 uiout->text (": ");
10556 uiout->field_string ("exp", w->exp_string);
10557 }
10558
10559 /* Implement the "print_recreate" breakpoint_ops method for
10560 masked hardware watchpoints. */
10561
10562 static void
10563 print_recreate_masked_watchpoint (struct breakpoint *b, struct ui_file *fp)
10564 {
10565 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
10566 char tmp[40];
10567
10568 switch (b->type)
10569 {
10570 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
10571 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "watch");
10572 break;
10573 case bp_read_watchpoint:
10574 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "rwatch");
10575 break;
10576 case bp_access_watchpoint:
10577 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "awatch");
10578 break;
10579 default:
10580 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
10581 _("Invalid hardware watchpoint type."));
10582 }
10583
10584 sprintf_vma (tmp, w->hw_wp_mask);
10585 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " %s mask 0x%s", w->exp_string, tmp);
10586 print_recreate_thread (b, fp);
10587 }
10588
10589 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used in masked hardware watchpoints. */
10590
10591 static struct breakpoint_ops masked_watchpoint_breakpoint_ops;
10592
10593 /* Tell whether the given watchpoint is a masked hardware watchpoint. */
10594
10595 static int
10596 is_masked_watchpoint (const struct breakpoint *b)
10597 {
10598 return b->ops == &masked_watchpoint_breakpoint_ops;
10599 }
10600
10601 /* accessflag: hw_write: watch write,
10602 hw_read: watch read,
10603 hw_access: watch access (read or write) */
10604 static void
10605 watch_command_1 (const char *arg, int accessflag, int from_tty,
10606 int just_location, int internal)
10607 {
10608 struct breakpoint *scope_breakpoint = NULL;
10609 const struct block *exp_valid_block = NULL, *cond_exp_valid_block = NULL;
10610 struct value *val, *mark, *result;
10611 int saved_bitpos = 0, saved_bitsize = 0;
10612 const char *exp_start = NULL;
10613 const char *exp_end = NULL;
10614 const char *tok, *end_tok;
10615 int toklen = -1;
10616 const char *cond_start = NULL;
10617 const char *cond_end = NULL;
10618 enum bptype bp_type;
10619 int thread = -1;
10620 int pc = 0;
10621 /* Flag to indicate whether we are going to use masks for
10622 the hardware watchpoint. */
10623 int use_mask = 0;
10624 CORE_ADDR mask = 0;
10625
10626 /* Make sure that we actually have parameters to parse. */
10627 if (arg != NULL && arg[0] != '\0')
10628 {
10629 const char *value_start;
10630
10631 exp_end = arg + strlen (arg);
10632
10633 /* Look for "parameter value" pairs at the end
10634 of the arguments string. */
10635 for (tok = exp_end - 1; tok > arg; tok--)
10636 {
10637 /* Skip whitespace at the end of the argument list. */
10638 while (tok > arg && (*tok == ' ' || *tok == '\t'))
10639 tok--;
10640
10641 /* Find the beginning of the last token.
10642 This is the value of the parameter. */
10643 while (tok > arg && (*tok != ' ' && *tok != '\t'))
10644 tok--;
10645 value_start = tok + 1;
10646
10647 /* Skip whitespace. */
10648 while (tok > arg && (*tok == ' ' || *tok == '\t'))
10649 tok--;
10650
10651 end_tok = tok;
10652
10653 /* Find the beginning of the second to last token.
10654 This is the parameter itself. */
10655 while (tok > arg && (*tok != ' ' && *tok != '\t'))
10656 tok--;
10657 tok++;
10658 toklen = end_tok - tok + 1;
10659
10660 if (toklen == 6 && startswith (tok, "thread"))
10661 {
10662 struct thread_info *thr;
10663 /* At this point we've found a "thread" token, which means
10664 the user is trying to set a watchpoint that triggers
10665 only in a specific thread. */
10666 const char *endp;
10667
10668 if (thread != -1)
10669 error(_("You can specify only one thread."));
10670
10671 /* Extract the thread ID from the next token. */
10672 thr = parse_thread_id (value_start, &endp);
10673
10674 /* Check if the user provided a valid thread ID. */
10675 if (*endp != ' ' && *endp != '\t' && *endp != '\0')
10676 invalid_thread_id_error (value_start);
10677
10678 thread = thr->global_num;
10679 }
10680 else if (toklen == 4 && startswith (tok, "mask"))
10681 {
10682 /* We've found a "mask" token, which means the user wants to
10683 create a hardware watchpoint that is going to have the mask
10684 facility. */
10685 struct value *mask_value, *mark;
10686
10687 if (use_mask)
10688 error(_("You can specify only one mask."));
10689
10690 use_mask = just_location = 1;
10691
10692 mark = value_mark ();
10693 mask_value = parse_to_comma_and_eval (&value_start);
10694 mask = value_as_address (mask_value);
10695 value_free_to_mark (mark);
10696 }
10697 else
10698 /* We didn't recognize what we found. We should stop here. */
10699 break;
10700
10701 /* Truncate the string and get rid of the "parameter value" pair before
10702 the arguments string is parsed by the parse_exp_1 function. */
10703 exp_end = tok;
10704 }
10705 }
10706 else
10707 exp_end = arg;
10708
10709 /* Parse the rest of the arguments. From here on out, everything
10710 is in terms of a newly allocated string instead of the original
10711 ARG. */
10712 innermost_block.reset ();
10713 std::string expression (arg, exp_end - arg);
10714 exp_start = arg = expression.c_str ();
10715 expression_up exp = parse_exp_1 (&arg, 0, 0, 0);
10716 exp_end = arg;
10717 /* Remove trailing whitespace from the expression before saving it.
10718 This makes the eventual display of the expression string a bit
10719 prettier. */
10720 while (exp_end > exp_start && (exp_end[-1] == ' ' || exp_end[-1] == '\t'))
10721 --exp_end;
10722
10723 /* Checking if the expression is not constant. */
10724 if (watchpoint_exp_is_const (exp.get ()))
10725 {
10726 int len;
10727
10728 len = exp_end - exp_start;
10729 while (len > 0 && isspace (exp_start[len - 1]))
10730 len--;
10731 error (_("Cannot watch constant value `%.*s'."), len, exp_start);
10732 }
10733
10734 exp_valid_block = innermost_block.block ();
10735 mark = value_mark ();
10736 fetch_subexp_value (exp.get (), &pc, &val, &result, NULL, just_location);
10737
10738 if (val != NULL && just_location)
10739 {
10740 saved_bitpos = value_bitpos (val);
10741 saved_bitsize = value_bitsize (val);
10742 }
10743
10744 if (just_location)
10745 {
10746 int ret;
10747
10748 exp_valid_block = NULL;
10749 val = value_addr (result);
10750 release_value (val);
10751 value_free_to_mark (mark);
10752
10753 if (use_mask)
10754 {
10755 ret = target_masked_watch_num_registers (value_as_address (val),
10756 mask);
10757 if (ret == -1)
10758 error (_("This target does not support masked watchpoints."));
10759 else if (ret == -2)
10760 error (_("Invalid mask or memory region."));
10761 }
10762 }
10763 else if (val != NULL)
10764 release_value (val);
10765
10766 tok = skip_spaces (arg);
10767 end_tok = skip_to_space (tok);
10768
10769 toklen = end_tok - tok;
10770 if (toklen >= 1 && strncmp (tok, "if", toklen) == 0)
10771 {
10772 innermost_block.reset ();
10773 tok = cond_start = end_tok + 1;
10774 parse_exp_1 (&tok, 0, 0, 0);
10775
10776 /* The watchpoint expression may not be local, but the condition
10777 may still be. E.g.: `watch global if local > 0'. */
10778 cond_exp_valid_block = innermost_block.block ();
10779
10780 cond_end = tok;
10781 }
10782 if (*tok)
10783 error (_("Junk at end of command."));
10784
10785 frame_info *wp_frame = block_innermost_frame (exp_valid_block);
10786
10787 /* Save this because create_internal_breakpoint below invalidates
10788 'wp_frame'. */
10789 frame_id watchpoint_frame = get_frame_id (wp_frame);
10790
10791 /* If the expression is "local", then set up a "watchpoint scope"
10792 breakpoint at the point where we've left the scope of the watchpoint
10793 expression. Create the scope breakpoint before the watchpoint, so
10794 that we will encounter it first in bpstat_stop_status. */
10795 if (exp_valid_block != NULL && wp_frame != NULL)
10796 {
10797 frame_id caller_frame_id = frame_unwind_caller_id (wp_frame);
10798
10799 if (frame_id_p (caller_frame_id))
10800 {
10801 gdbarch *caller_arch = frame_unwind_caller_arch (wp_frame);
10802 CORE_ADDR caller_pc = frame_unwind_caller_pc (wp_frame);
10803
10804 scope_breakpoint
10805 = create_internal_breakpoint (caller_arch, caller_pc,
10806 bp_watchpoint_scope,
10807 &momentary_breakpoint_ops);
10808
10809 /* create_internal_breakpoint could invalidate WP_FRAME. */
10810 wp_frame = NULL;
10811
10812 scope_breakpoint->enable_state = bp_enabled;
10813
10814 /* Automatically delete the breakpoint when it hits. */
10815 scope_breakpoint->disposition = disp_del;
10816
10817 /* Only break in the proper frame (help with recursion). */
10818 scope_breakpoint->frame_id = caller_frame_id;
10819
10820 /* Set the address at which we will stop. */
10821 scope_breakpoint->loc->gdbarch = caller_arch;
10822 scope_breakpoint->loc->requested_address = caller_pc;
10823 scope_breakpoint->loc->address
10824 = adjust_breakpoint_address (scope_breakpoint->loc->gdbarch,
10825 scope_breakpoint->loc->requested_address,
10826 scope_breakpoint->type);
10827 }
10828 }
10829
10830 /* Now set up the breakpoint. We create all watchpoints as hardware
10831 watchpoints here even if hardware watchpoints are turned off, a call
10832 to update_watchpoint later in this function will cause the type to
10833 drop back to bp_watchpoint (software watchpoint) if required. */
10834
10835 if (accessflag == hw_read)
10836 bp_type = bp_read_watchpoint;
10837 else if (accessflag == hw_access)
10838 bp_type = bp_access_watchpoint;
10839 else
10840 bp_type = bp_hardware_watchpoint;
10841
10842 std::unique_ptr<watchpoint> w (new watchpoint ());
10843
10844 if (use_mask)
10845 init_raw_breakpoint_without_location (w.get (), NULL, bp_type,
10846 &masked_watchpoint_breakpoint_ops);
10847 else
10848 init_raw_breakpoint_without_location (w.get (), NULL, bp_type,
10849 &watchpoint_breakpoint_ops);
10850 w->thread = thread;
10851 w->disposition = disp_donttouch;
10852 w->pspace = current_program_space;
10853 w->exp = std::move (exp);
10854 w->exp_valid_block = exp_valid_block;
10855 w->cond_exp_valid_block = cond_exp_valid_block;
10856 if (just_location)
10857 {
10858 struct type *t = value_type (val);
10859 CORE_ADDR addr = value_as_address (val);
10860
10861 w->exp_string_reparse
10862 = current_language->la_watch_location_expression (t, addr).release ();
10863
10864 w->exp_string = xstrprintf ("-location %.*s",
10865 (int) (exp_end - exp_start), exp_start);
10866 }
10867 else
10868 w->exp_string = savestring (exp_start, exp_end - exp_start);
10869
10870 if (use_mask)
10871 {
10872 w->hw_wp_mask = mask;
10873 }
10874 else
10875 {
10876 w->val = val;
10877 w->val_bitpos = saved_bitpos;
10878 w->val_bitsize = saved_bitsize;
10879 w->val_valid = 1;
10880 }
10881
10882 if (cond_start)
10883 w->cond_string = savestring (cond_start, cond_end - cond_start);
10884 else
10885 w->cond_string = 0;
10886
10887 if (frame_id_p (watchpoint_frame))
10888 {
10889 w->watchpoint_frame = watchpoint_frame;
10890 w->watchpoint_thread = inferior_ptid;
10891 }
10892 else
10893 {
10894 w->watchpoint_frame = null_frame_id;
10895 w->watchpoint_thread = null_ptid;
10896 }
10897
10898 if (scope_breakpoint != NULL)
10899 {
10900 /* The scope breakpoint is related to the watchpoint. We will
10901 need to act on them together. */
10902 w->related_breakpoint = scope_breakpoint;
10903 scope_breakpoint->related_breakpoint = w.get ();
10904 }
10905
10906 if (!just_location)
10907 value_free_to_mark (mark);
10908
10909 /* Finally update the new watchpoint. This creates the locations
10910 that should be inserted. */
10911 update_watchpoint (w.get (), 1);
10912
10913 install_breakpoint (internal, std::move (w), 1);
10914 }
10915
10916 /* Return count of debug registers needed to watch the given expression.
10917 If the watchpoint cannot be handled in hardware return zero. */
10918
10919 static int
10920 can_use_hardware_watchpoint (struct value *v)
10921 {
10922 int found_memory_cnt = 0;
10923 struct value *head = v;
10924
10925 /* Did the user specifically forbid us to use hardware watchpoints? */
10926 if (!can_use_hw_watchpoints)
10927 return 0;
10928
10929 /* Make sure that the value of the expression depends only upon
10930 memory contents, and values computed from them within GDB. If we
10931 find any register references or function calls, we can't use a
10932 hardware watchpoint.
10933
10934 The idea here is that evaluating an expression generates a series
10935 of values, one holding the value of every subexpression. (The
10936 expression a*b+c has five subexpressions: a, b, a*b, c, and
10937 a*b+c.) GDB's values hold almost enough information to establish
10938 the criteria given above --- they identify memory lvalues,
10939 register lvalues, computed values, etcetera. So we can evaluate
10940 the expression, and then scan the chain of values that leaves
10941 behind to decide whether we can detect any possible change to the
10942 expression's final value using only hardware watchpoints.
10943
10944 However, I don't think that the values returned by inferior
10945 function calls are special in any way. So this function may not
10946 notice that an expression involving an inferior function call
10947 can't be watched with hardware watchpoints. FIXME. */
10948 for (; v; v = value_next (v))
10949 {
10950 if (VALUE_LVAL (v) == lval_memory)
10951 {
10952 if (v != head && value_lazy (v))
10953 /* A lazy memory lvalue in the chain is one that GDB never
10954 needed to fetch; we either just used its address (e.g.,
10955 `a' in `a.b') or we never needed it at all (e.g., `a'
10956 in `a,b'). This doesn't apply to HEAD; if that is
10957 lazy then it was not readable, but watch it anyway. */
10958 ;
10959 else
10960 {
10961 /* Ahh, memory we actually used! Check if we can cover
10962 it with hardware watchpoints. */
10963 struct type *vtype = check_typedef (value_type (v));
10964
10965 /* We only watch structs and arrays if user asked for it
10966 explicitly, never if they just happen to appear in a
10967 middle of some value chain. */
10968 if (v == head
10969 || (TYPE_CODE (vtype) != TYPE_CODE_STRUCT
10970 && TYPE_CODE (vtype) != TYPE_CODE_ARRAY))
10971 {
10972 CORE_ADDR vaddr = value_address (v);
10973 int len;
10974 int num_regs;
10975
10976 len = (target_exact_watchpoints
10977 && is_scalar_type_recursive (vtype))?
10978 1 : TYPE_LENGTH (value_type (v));
10979
10980 num_regs = target_region_ok_for_hw_watchpoint (vaddr, len);
10981 if (!num_regs)
10982 return 0;
10983 else
10984 found_memory_cnt += num_regs;
10985 }
10986 }
10987 }
10988 else if (VALUE_LVAL (v) != not_lval
10989 && deprecated_value_modifiable (v) == 0)
10990 return 0; /* These are values from the history (e.g., $1). */
10991 else if (VALUE_LVAL (v) == lval_register)
10992 return 0; /* Cannot watch a register with a HW watchpoint. */
10993 }
10994
10995 /* The expression itself looks suitable for using a hardware
10996 watchpoint, but give the target machine a chance to reject it. */
10997 return found_memory_cnt;
10998 }
10999
11000 void
11001 watch_command_wrapper (const char *arg, int from_tty, int internal)
11002 {
11003 watch_command_1 (arg, hw_write, from_tty, 0, internal);
11004 }
11005
11006 /* A helper function that looks for the "-location" argument and then
11007 calls watch_command_1. */
11008
11009 static void
11010 watch_maybe_just_location (const char *arg, int accessflag, int from_tty)
11011 {
11012 int just_location = 0;
11013
11014 if (arg
11015 && (check_for_argument (&arg, "-location", sizeof ("-location") - 1)
11016 || check_for_argument (&arg, "-l", sizeof ("-l") - 1)))
11017 {
11018 arg = skip_spaces (arg);
11019 just_location = 1;
11020 }
11021
11022 watch_command_1 (arg, accessflag, from_tty, just_location, 0);
11023 }
11024
11025 static void
11026 watch_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
11027 {
11028 watch_maybe_just_location (arg, hw_write, from_tty);
11029 }
11030
11031 void
11032 rwatch_command_wrapper (const char *arg, int from_tty, int internal)
11033 {
11034 watch_command_1 (arg, hw_read, from_tty, 0, internal);
11035 }
11036
11037 static void
11038 rwatch_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
11039 {
11040 watch_maybe_just_location (arg, hw_read, from_tty);
11041 }
11042
11043 void
11044 awatch_command_wrapper (const char *arg, int from_tty, int internal)
11045 {
11046 watch_command_1 (arg, hw_access, from_tty, 0, internal);
11047 }
11048
11049 static void
11050 awatch_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
11051 {
11052 watch_maybe_just_location (arg, hw_access, from_tty);
11053 }
11054 \f
11055
11056 /* Data for the FSM that manages the until(location)/advance commands
11057 in infcmd.c. Here because it uses the mechanisms of
11058 breakpoints. */
11059
11060 struct until_break_fsm
11061 {
11062 /* The base class. */
11063 struct thread_fsm thread_fsm;
11064
11065 /* The thread that as current when the command was executed. */
11066 int thread;
11067
11068 /* The breakpoint set at the destination location. */
11069 struct breakpoint *location_breakpoint;
11070
11071 /* Breakpoint set at the return address in the caller frame. May be
11072 NULL. */
11073 struct breakpoint *caller_breakpoint;
11074 };
11075
11076 static void until_break_fsm_clean_up (struct thread_fsm *self,
11077 struct thread_info *thread);
11078 static int until_break_fsm_should_stop (struct thread_fsm *self,
11079 struct thread_info *thread);
11080 static enum async_reply_reason
11081 until_break_fsm_async_reply_reason (struct thread_fsm *self);
11082
11083 /* until_break_fsm's vtable. */
11084
11085 static struct thread_fsm_ops until_break_fsm_ops =
11086 {
11087 NULL, /* dtor */
11088 until_break_fsm_clean_up,
11089 until_break_fsm_should_stop,
11090 NULL, /* return_value */
11091 until_break_fsm_async_reply_reason,
11092 };
11093
11094 /* Allocate a new until_break_command_fsm. */
11095
11096 static struct until_break_fsm *
11097 new_until_break_fsm (struct interp *cmd_interp, int thread,
11098 breakpoint_up &&location_breakpoint,
11099 breakpoint_up &&caller_breakpoint)
11100 {
11101 struct until_break_fsm *sm;
11102
11103 sm = XCNEW (struct until_break_fsm);
11104 thread_fsm_ctor (&sm->thread_fsm, &until_break_fsm_ops, cmd_interp);
11105
11106 sm->thread = thread;
11107 sm->location_breakpoint = location_breakpoint.release ();
11108 sm->caller_breakpoint = caller_breakpoint.release ();
11109
11110 return sm;
11111 }
11112
11113 /* Implementation of the 'should_stop' FSM method for the
11114 until(location)/advance commands. */
11115
11116 static int
11117 until_break_fsm_should_stop (struct thread_fsm *self,
11118 struct thread_info *tp)
11119 {
11120 struct until_break_fsm *sm = (struct until_break_fsm *) self;
11121
11122 if (bpstat_find_breakpoint (tp->control.stop_bpstat,
11123 sm->location_breakpoint) != NULL
11124 || (sm->caller_breakpoint != NULL
11125 && bpstat_find_breakpoint (tp->control.stop_bpstat,
11126 sm->caller_breakpoint) != NULL))
11127 thread_fsm_set_finished (self);
11128
11129 return 1;
11130 }
11131
11132 /* Implementation of the 'clean_up' FSM method for the
11133 until(location)/advance commands. */
11134
11135 static void
11136 until_break_fsm_clean_up (struct thread_fsm *self,
11137 struct thread_info *thread)
11138 {
11139 struct until_break_fsm *sm = (struct until_break_fsm *) self;
11140
11141 /* Clean up our temporary breakpoints. */
11142 if (sm->location_breakpoint != NULL)
11143 {
11144 delete_breakpoint (sm->location_breakpoint);
11145 sm->location_breakpoint = NULL;
11146 }
11147 if (sm->caller_breakpoint != NULL)
11148 {
11149 delete_breakpoint (sm->caller_breakpoint);
11150 sm->caller_breakpoint = NULL;
11151 }
11152 delete_longjmp_breakpoint (sm->thread);
11153 }
11154
11155 /* Implementation of the 'async_reply_reason' FSM method for the
11156 until(location)/advance commands. */
11157
11158 static enum async_reply_reason
11159 until_break_fsm_async_reply_reason (struct thread_fsm *self)
11160 {
11161 return EXEC_ASYNC_LOCATION_REACHED;
11162 }
11163
11164 void
11165 until_break_command (const char *arg, int from_tty, int anywhere)
11166 {
11167 struct frame_info *frame;
11168 struct gdbarch *frame_gdbarch;
11169 struct frame_id stack_frame_id;
11170 struct frame_id caller_frame_id;
11171 struct cleanup *old_chain;
11172 int thread;
11173 struct thread_info *tp;
11174 struct until_break_fsm *sm;
11175
11176 clear_proceed_status (0);
11177
11178 /* Set a breakpoint where the user wants it and at return from
11179 this function. */
11180
11181 event_location_up location = string_to_event_location (&arg, current_language);
11182
11183 std::vector<symtab_and_line> sals
11184 = (last_displayed_sal_is_valid ()
11185 ? decode_line_1 (location.get (), DECODE_LINE_FUNFIRSTLINE, NULL,
11186 get_last_displayed_symtab (),
11187 get_last_displayed_line ())
11188 : decode_line_1 (location.get (), DECODE_LINE_FUNFIRSTLINE,
11189 NULL, (struct symtab *) NULL, 0));
11190
11191 if (sals.size () != 1)
11192 error (_("Couldn't get information on specified line."));
11193
11194 symtab_and_line &sal = sals[0];
11195
11196 if (*arg)
11197 error (_("Junk at end of arguments."));
11198
11199 resolve_sal_pc (&sal);
11200
11201 tp = inferior_thread ();
11202 thread = tp->global_num;
11203
11204 old_chain = make_cleanup (null_cleanup, NULL);
11205
11206 /* Note linespec handling above invalidates the frame chain.
11207 Installing a breakpoint also invalidates the frame chain (as it
11208 may need to switch threads), so do any frame handling before
11209 that. */
11210
11211 frame = get_selected_frame (NULL);
11212 frame_gdbarch = get_frame_arch (frame);
11213 stack_frame_id = get_stack_frame_id (frame);
11214 caller_frame_id = frame_unwind_caller_id (frame);
11215
11216 /* Keep within the current frame, or in frames called by the current
11217 one. */
11218
11219 breakpoint_up caller_breakpoint;
11220 if (frame_id_p (caller_frame_id))
11221 {
11222 struct symtab_and_line sal2;
11223 struct gdbarch *caller_gdbarch;
11224
11225 sal2 = find_pc_line (frame_unwind_caller_pc (frame), 0);
11226 sal2.pc = frame_unwind_caller_pc (frame);
11227 caller_gdbarch = frame_unwind_caller_arch (frame);
11228 caller_breakpoint = set_momentary_breakpoint (caller_gdbarch,
11229 sal2,
11230 caller_frame_id,
11231 bp_until);
11232
11233 set_longjmp_breakpoint (tp, caller_frame_id);
11234 make_cleanup (delete_longjmp_breakpoint_cleanup, &thread);
11235 }
11236
11237 /* set_momentary_breakpoint could invalidate FRAME. */
11238 frame = NULL;
11239
11240 breakpoint_up location_breakpoint;
11241 if (anywhere)
11242 /* If the user told us to continue until a specified location,
11243 we don't specify a frame at which we need to stop. */
11244 location_breakpoint = set_momentary_breakpoint (frame_gdbarch, sal,
11245 null_frame_id, bp_until);
11246 else
11247 /* Otherwise, specify the selected frame, because we want to stop
11248 only at the very same frame. */
11249 location_breakpoint = set_momentary_breakpoint (frame_gdbarch, sal,
11250 stack_frame_id, bp_until);
11251
11252 sm = new_until_break_fsm (command_interp (), tp->global_num,
11253 std::move (location_breakpoint),
11254 std::move (caller_breakpoint));
11255 tp->thread_fsm = &sm->thread_fsm;
11256
11257 discard_cleanups (old_chain);
11258
11259 proceed (-1, GDB_SIGNAL_DEFAULT);
11260 }
11261
11262 /* This function attempts to parse an optional "if <cond>" clause
11263 from the arg string. If one is not found, it returns NULL.
11264
11265 Else, it returns a pointer to the condition string. (It does not
11266 attempt to evaluate the string against a particular block.) And,
11267 it updates arg to point to the first character following the parsed
11268 if clause in the arg string. */
11269
11270 const char *
11271 ep_parse_optional_if_clause (const char **arg)
11272 {
11273 const char *cond_string;
11274
11275 if (((*arg)[0] != 'i') || ((*arg)[1] != 'f') || !isspace ((*arg)[2]))
11276 return NULL;
11277
11278 /* Skip the "if" keyword. */
11279 (*arg) += 2;
11280
11281 /* Skip any extra leading whitespace, and record the start of the
11282 condition string. */
11283 *arg = skip_spaces (*arg);
11284 cond_string = *arg;
11285
11286 /* Assume that the condition occupies the remainder of the arg
11287 string. */
11288 (*arg) += strlen (cond_string);
11289
11290 return cond_string;
11291 }
11292
11293 /* Commands to deal with catching events, such as signals, exceptions,
11294 process start/exit, etc. */
11295
11296 typedef enum
11297 {
11298 catch_fork_temporary, catch_vfork_temporary,
11299 catch_fork_permanent, catch_vfork_permanent
11300 }
11301 catch_fork_kind;
11302
11303 static void
11304 catch_fork_command_1 (const char *arg, int from_tty,
11305 struct cmd_list_element *command)
11306 {
11307 struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_current_arch ();
11308 const char *cond_string = NULL;
11309 catch_fork_kind fork_kind;
11310 int tempflag;
11311
11312 fork_kind = (catch_fork_kind) (uintptr_t) get_cmd_context (command);
11313 tempflag = (fork_kind == catch_fork_temporary
11314 || fork_kind == catch_vfork_temporary);
11315
11316 if (!arg)
11317 arg = "";
11318 arg = skip_spaces (arg);
11319
11320 /* The allowed syntax is:
11321 catch [v]fork
11322 catch [v]fork if <cond>
11323
11324 First, check if there's an if clause. */
11325 cond_string = ep_parse_optional_if_clause (&arg);
11326
11327 if ((*arg != '\0') && !isspace (*arg))
11328 error (_("Junk at end of arguments."));
11329
11330 /* If this target supports it, create a fork or vfork catchpoint
11331 and enable reporting of such events. */
11332 switch (fork_kind)
11333 {
11334 case catch_fork_temporary:
11335 case catch_fork_permanent:
11336 create_fork_vfork_event_catchpoint (gdbarch, tempflag, cond_string,
11337 &catch_fork_breakpoint_ops);
11338 break;
11339 case catch_vfork_temporary:
11340 case catch_vfork_permanent:
11341 create_fork_vfork_event_catchpoint (gdbarch, tempflag, cond_string,
11342 &catch_vfork_breakpoint_ops);
11343 break;
11344 default:
11345 error (_("unsupported or unknown fork kind; cannot catch it"));
11346 break;
11347 }
11348 }
11349
11350 static void
11351 catch_exec_command_1 (const char *arg, int from_tty,
11352 struct cmd_list_element *command)
11353 {
11354 struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_current_arch ();
11355 int tempflag;
11356 const char *cond_string = NULL;
11357
11358 tempflag = get_cmd_context (command) == CATCH_TEMPORARY;
11359
11360 if (!arg)
11361 arg = "";
11362 arg = skip_spaces (arg);
11363
11364 /* The allowed syntax is:
11365 catch exec
11366 catch exec if <cond>
11367
11368 First, check if there's an if clause. */
11369 cond_string = ep_parse_optional_if_clause (&arg);
11370
11371 if ((*arg != '\0') && !isspace (*arg))
11372 error (_("Junk at end of arguments."));
11373
11374 std::unique_ptr<exec_catchpoint> c (new exec_catchpoint ());
11375 init_catchpoint (c.get (), gdbarch, tempflag, cond_string,
11376 &catch_exec_breakpoint_ops);
11377 c->exec_pathname = NULL;
11378
11379 install_breakpoint (0, std::move (c), 1);
11380 }
11381
11382 void
11383 init_ada_exception_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b,
11384 struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
11385 struct symtab_and_line sal,
11386 const char *addr_string,
11387 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops,
11388 int tempflag,
11389 int enabled,
11390 int from_tty)
11391 {
11392 if (from_tty)
11393 {
11394 struct gdbarch *loc_gdbarch = get_sal_arch (sal);
11395 if (!loc_gdbarch)
11396 loc_gdbarch = gdbarch;
11397
11398 describe_other_breakpoints (loc_gdbarch,
11399 sal.pspace, sal.pc, sal.section, -1);
11400 /* FIXME: brobecker/2006-12-28: Actually, re-implement a special
11401 version for exception catchpoints, because two catchpoints
11402 used for different exception names will use the same address.
11403 In this case, a "breakpoint ... also set at..." warning is
11404 unproductive. Besides, the warning phrasing is also a bit
11405 inappropriate, we should use the word catchpoint, and tell
11406 the user what type of catchpoint it is. The above is good
11407 enough for now, though. */
11408 }
11409
11410 init_raw_breakpoint (b, gdbarch, sal, bp_breakpoint, ops);
11411
11412 b->enable_state = enabled ? bp_enabled : bp_disabled;
11413 b->disposition = tempflag ? disp_del : disp_donttouch;
11414 b->location = string_to_event_location (&addr_string,
11415 language_def (language_ada));
11416 b->language = language_ada;
11417 }
11418
11419 static void
11420 catch_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
11421 {
11422 error (_("Catch requires an event name."));
11423 }
11424 \f
11425
11426 static void
11427 tcatch_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
11428 {
11429 error (_("Catch requires an event name."));
11430 }
11431
11432 /* Compare two breakpoints and return a strcmp-like result. */
11433
11434 static int
11435 compare_breakpoints (const breakpoint *a, const breakpoint *b)
11436 {
11437 uintptr_t ua = (uintptr_t) a;
11438 uintptr_t ub = (uintptr_t) b;
11439
11440 if (a->number < b->number)
11441 return -1;
11442 else if (a->number > b->number)
11443 return 1;
11444
11445 /* Now sort by address, in case we see, e..g, two breakpoints with
11446 the number 0. */
11447 if (ua < ub)
11448 return -1;
11449 return ua > ub ? 1 : 0;
11450 }
11451
11452 /* Delete breakpoints by address or line. */
11453
11454 static void
11455 clear_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
11456 {
11457 struct breakpoint *b;
11458 int default_match;
11459
11460 std::vector<symtab_and_line> decoded_sals;
11461 symtab_and_line last_sal;
11462 gdb::array_view<symtab_and_line> sals;
11463 if (arg)
11464 {
11465 decoded_sals
11466 = decode_line_with_current_source (arg,
11467 (DECODE_LINE_FUNFIRSTLINE
11468 | DECODE_LINE_LIST_MODE));
11469 default_match = 0;
11470 sals = decoded_sals;
11471 }
11472 else
11473 {
11474 /* Set sal's line, symtab, pc, and pspace to the values
11475 corresponding to the last call to print_frame_info. If the
11476 codepoint is not valid, this will set all the fields to 0. */
11477 last_sal = get_last_displayed_sal ();
11478 if (last_sal.symtab == 0)
11479 error (_("No source file specified."));
11480
11481 default_match = 1;
11482 sals = last_sal;
11483 }
11484
11485 /* We don't call resolve_sal_pc here. That's not as bad as it
11486 seems, because all existing breakpoints typically have both
11487 file/line and pc set. So, if clear is given file/line, we can
11488 match this to existing breakpoint without obtaining pc at all.
11489
11490 We only support clearing given the address explicitly
11491 present in breakpoint table. Say, we've set breakpoint
11492 at file:line. There were several PC values for that file:line,
11493 due to optimization, all in one block.
11494
11495 We've picked one PC value. If "clear" is issued with another
11496 PC corresponding to the same file:line, the breakpoint won't
11497 be cleared. We probably can still clear the breakpoint, but
11498 since the other PC value is never presented to user, user
11499 can only find it by guessing, and it does not seem important
11500 to support that. */
11501
11502 /* For each line spec given, delete bps which correspond to it. Do
11503 it in two passes, solely to preserve the current behavior that
11504 from_tty is forced true if we delete more than one
11505 breakpoint. */
11506
11507 std::vector<struct breakpoint *> found;
11508 for (const auto &sal : sals)
11509 {
11510 const char *sal_fullname;
11511
11512 /* If exact pc given, clear bpts at that pc.
11513 If line given (pc == 0), clear all bpts on specified line.
11514 If defaulting, clear all bpts on default line
11515 or at default pc.
11516
11517 defaulting sal.pc != 0 tests to do
11518
11519 0 1 pc
11520 1 1 pc _and_ line
11521 0 0 line
11522 1 0 <can't happen> */
11523
11524 sal_fullname = (sal.symtab == NULL
11525 ? NULL : symtab_to_fullname (sal.symtab));
11526
11527 /* Find all matching breakpoints and add them to 'found'. */
11528 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
11529 {
11530 int match = 0;
11531 /* Are we going to delete b? */
11532 if (b->type != bp_none && !is_watchpoint (b))
11533 {
11534 struct bp_location *loc = b->loc;
11535 for (; loc; loc = loc->next)
11536 {
11537 /* If the user specified file:line, don't allow a PC
11538 match. This matches historical gdb behavior. */
11539 int pc_match = (!sal.explicit_line
11540 && sal.pc
11541 && (loc->pspace == sal.pspace)
11542 && (loc->address == sal.pc)
11543 && (!section_is_overlay (loc->section)
11544 || loc->section == sal.section));
11545 int line_match = 0;
11546
11547 if ((default_match || sal.explicit_line)
11548 && loc->symtab != NULL
11549 && sal_fullname != NULL
11550 && sal.pspace == loc->pspace
11551 && loc->line_number == sal.line
11552 && filename_cmp (symtab_to_fullname (loc->symtab),
11553 sal_fullname) == 0)
11554 line_match = 1;
11555
11556 if (pc_match || line_match)
11557 {
11558 match = 1;
11559 break;
11560 }
11561 }
11562 }
11563
11564 if (match)
11565 found.push_back (b);
11566 }
11567 }
11568
11569 /* Now go thru the 'found' chain and delete them. */
11570 if (found.empty ())
11571 {
11572 if (arg)
11573 error (_("No breakpoint at %s."), arg);
11574 else
11575 error (_("No breakpoint at this line."));
11576 }
11577
11578 /* Remove duplicates from the vec. */
11579 std::sort (found.begin (), found.end (),
11580 [] (const breakpoint *a, const breakpoint *b)
11581 {
11582 return compare_breakpoints (a, b) < 0;
11583 });
11584 found.erase (std::unique (found.begin (), found.end (),
11585 [] (const breakpoint *a, const breakpoint *b)
11586 {
11587 return compare_breakpoints (a, b) == 0;
11588 }),
11589 found.end ());
11590
11591 if (found.size () > 1)
11592 from_tty = 1; /* Always report if deleted more than one. */
11593 if (from_tty)
11594 {
11595 if (found.size () == 1)
11596 printf_unfiltered (_("Deleted breakpoint "));
11597 else
11598 printf_unfiltered (_("Deleted breakpoints "));
11599 }
11600
11601 for (breakpoint *iter : found)
11602 {
11603 if (from_tty)
11604 printf_unfiltered ("%d ", iter->number);
11605 delete_breakpoint (iter);
11606 }
11607 if (from_tty)
11608 putchar_unfiltered ('\n');
11609 }
11610 \f
11611 /* Delete breakpoint in BS if they are `delete' breakpoints and
11612 all breakpoints that are marked for deletion, whether hit or not.
11613 This is called after any breakpoint is hit, or after errors. */
11614
11615 void
11616 breakpoint_auto_delete (bpstat bs)
11617 {
11618 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
11619
11620 for (; bs; bs = bs->next)
11621 if (bs->breakpoint_at
11622 && bs->breakpoint_at->disposition == disp_del
11623 && bs->stop)
11624 delete_breakpoint (bs->breakpoint_at);
11625
11626 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
11627 {
11628 if (b->disposition == disp_del_at_next_stop)
11629 delete_breakpoint (b);
11630 }
11631 }
11632
11633 /* A comparison function for bp_location AP and BP being interfaced to
11634 qsort. Sort elements primarily by their ADDRESS (no matter what
11635 does breakpoint_address_is_meaningful say for its OWNER),
11636 secondarily by ordering first permanent elements and
11637 terciarily just ensuring the array is sorted stable way despite
11638 qsort being an unstable algorithm. */
11639
11640 static int
11641 bp_locations_compare (const void *ap, const void *bp)
11642 {
11643 const struct bp_location *a = *(const struct bp_location **) ap;
11644 const struct bp_location *b = *(const struct bp_location **) bp;
11645
11646 if (a->address != b->address)
11647 return (a->address > b->address) - (a->address < b->address);
11648
11649 /* Sort locations at the same address by their pspace number, keeping
11650 locations of the same inferior (in a multi-inferior environment)
11651 grouped. */
11652
11653 if (a->pspace->num != b->pspace->num)
11654 return ((a->pspace->num > b->pspace->num)
11655 - (a->pspace->num < b->pspace->num));
11656
11657 /* Sort permanent breakpoints first. */
11658 if (a->permanent != b->permanent)
11659 return (a->permanent < b->permanent) - (a->permanent > b->permanent);
11660
11661 /* Make the internal GDB representation stable across GDB runs
11662 where A and B memory inside GDB can differ. Breakpoint locations of
11663 the same type at the same address can be sorted in arbitrary order. */
11664
11665 if (a->owner->number != b->owner->number)
11666 return ((a->owner->number > b->owner->number)
11667 - (a->owner->number < b->owner->number));
11668
11669 return (a > b) - (a < b);
11670 }
11671
11672 /* Set bp_locations_placed_address_before_address_max and
11673 bp_locations_shadow_len_after_address_max according to the current
11674 content of the bp_locations array. */
11675
11676 static void
11677 bp_locations_target_extensions_update (void)
11678 {
11679 struct bp_location *bl, **blp_tmp;
11680
11681 bp_locations_placed_address_before_address_max = 0;
11682 bp_locations_shadow_len_after_address_max = 0;
11683
11684 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bl, blp_tmp)
11685 {
11686 CORE_ADDR start, end, addr;
11687
11688 if (!bp_location_has_shadow (bl))
11689 continue;
11690
11691 start = bl->target_info.placed_address;
11692 end = start + bl->target_info.shadow_len;
11693
11694 gdb_assert (bl->address >= start);
11695 addr = bl->address - start;
11696 if (addr > bp_locations_placed_address_before_address_max)
11697 bp_locations_placed_address_before_address_max = addr;
11698
11699 /* Zero SHADOW_LEN would not pass bp_location_has_shadow. */
11700
11701 gdb_assert (bl->address < end);
11702 addr = end - bl->address;
11703 if (addr > bp_locations_shadow_len_after_address_max)
11704 bp_locations_shadow_len_after_address_max = addr;
11705 }
11706 }
11707
11708 /* Download tracepoint locations if they haven't been. */
11709
11710 static void
11711 download_tracepoint_locations (void)
11712 {
11713 struct breakpoint *b;
11714 enum tribool can_download_tracepoint = TRIBOOL_UNKNOWN;
11715
11716 scoped_restore_current_pspace_and_thread restore_pspace_thread;
11717
11718 ALL_TRACEPOINTS (b)
11719 {
11720 struct bp_location *bl;
11721 struct tracepoint *t;
11722 int bp_location_downloaded = 0;
11723
11724 if ((b->type == bp_fast_tracepoint
11725 ? !may_insert_fast_tracepoints
11726 : !may_insert_tracepoints))
11727 continue;
11728
11729 if (can_download_tracepoint == TRIBOOL_UNKNOWN)
11730 {
11731 if (target_can_download_tracepoint ())
11732 can_download_tracepoint = TRIBOOL_TRUE;
11733 else
11734 can_download_tracepoint = TRIBOOL_FALSE;
11735 }
11736
11737 if (can_download_tracepoint == TRIBOOL_FALSE)
11738 break;
11739
11740 for (bl = b->loc; bl; bl = bl->next)
11741 {
11742 /* In tracepoint, locations are _never_ duplicated, so
11743 should_be_inserted is equivalent to
11744 unduplicated_should_be_inserted. */
11745 if (!should_be_inserted (bl) || bl->inserted)
11746 continue;
11747
11748 switch_to_program_space_and_thread (bl->pspace);
11749
11750 target_download_tracepoint (bl);
11751
11752 bl->inserted = 1;
11753 bp_location_downloaded = 1;
11754 }
11755 t = (struct tracepoint *) b;
11756 t->number_on_target = b->number;
11757 if (bp_location_downloaded)
11758 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (b);
11759 }
11760 }
11761
11762 /* Swap the insertion/duplication state between two locations. */
11763
11764 static void
11765 swap_insertion (struct bp_location *left, struct bp_location *right)
11766 {
11767 const int left_inserted = left->inserted;
11768 const int left_duplicate = left->duplicate;
11769 const int left_needs_update = left->needs_update;
11770 const struct bp_target_info left_target_info = left->target_info;
11771
11772 /* Locations of tracepoints can never be duplicated. */
11773 if (is_tracepoint (left->owner))
11774 gdb_assert (!left->duplicate);
11775 if (is_tracepoint (right->owner))
11776 gdb_assert (!right->duplicate);
11777
11778 left->inserted = right->inserted;
11779 left->duplicate = right->duplicate;
11780 left->needs_update = right->needs_update;
11781 left->target_info = right->target_info;
11782 right->inserted = left_inserted;
11783 right->duplicate = left_duplicate;
11784 right->needs_update = left_needs_update;
11785 right->target_info = left_target_info;
11786 }
11787
11788 /* Force the re-insertion of the locations at ADDRESS. This is called
11789 once a new/deleted/modified duplicate location is found and we are evaluating
11790 conditions on the target's side. Such conditions need to be updated on
11791 the target. */
11792
11793 static void
11794 force_breakpoint_reinsertion (struct bp_location *bl)
11795 {
11796 struct bp_location **locp = NULL, **loc2p;
11797 struct bp_location *loc;
11798 CORE_ADDR address = 0;
11799 int pspace_num;
11800
11801 address = bl->address;
11802 pspace_num = bl->pspace->num;
11803
11804 /* This is only meaningful if the target is
11805 evaluating conditions and if the user has
11806 opted for condition evaluation on the target's
11807 side. */
11808 if (gdb_evaluates_breakpoint_condition_p ()
11809 || !target_supports_evaluation_of_breakpoint_conditions ())
11810 return;
11811
11812 /* Flag all breakpoint locations with this address and
11813 the same program space as the location
11814 as "its condition has changed". We need to
11815 update the conditions on the target's side. */
11816 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS_AT_ADDR (loc2p, locp, address)
11817 {
11818 loc = *loc2p;
11819
11820 if (!is_breakpoint (loc->owner)
11821 || pspace_num != loc->pspace->num)
11822 continue;
11823
11824 /* Flag the location appropriately. We use a different state to
11825 let everyone know that we already updated the set of locations
11826 with addr bl->address and program space bl->pspace. This is so
11827 we don't have to keep calling these functions just to mark locations
11828 that have already been marked. */
11829 loc->condition_changed = condition_updated;
11830
11831 /* Free the agent expression bytecode as well. We will compute
11832 it later on. */
11833 loc->cond_bytecode.reset ();
11834 }
11835 }
11836 /* Called whether new breakpoints are created, or existing breakpoints
11837 deleted, to update the global location list and recompute which
11838 locations are duplicate of which.
11839
11840 The INSERT_MODE flag determines whether locations may not, may, or
11841 shall be inserted now. See 'enum ugll_insert_mode' for more
11842 info. */
11843
11844 static void
11845 update_global_location_list (enum ugll_insert_mode insert_mode)
11846 {
11847 struct breakpoint *b;
11848 struct bp_location **locp, *loc;
11849 /* Last breakpoint location address that was marked for update. */
11850 CORE_ADDR last_addr = 0;
11851 /* Last breakpoint location program space that was marked for update. */
11852 int last_pspace_num = -1;
11853
11854 /* Used in the duplicates detection below. When iterating over all
11855 bp_locations, points to the first bp_location of a given address.
11856 Breakpoints and watchpoints of different types are never
11857 duplicates of each other. Keep one pointer for each type of
11858 breakpoint/watchpoint, so we only need to loop over all locations
11859 once. */
11860 struct bp_location *bp_loc_first; /* breakpoint */
11861 struct bp_location *wp_loc_first; /* hardware watchpoint */
11862 struct bp_location *awp_loc_first; /* access watchpoint */
11863 struct bp_location *rwp_loc_first; /* read watchpoint */
11864
11865 /* Saved former bp_locations array which we compare against the newly
11866 built bp_locations from the current state of ALL_BREAKPOINTS. */
11867 struct bp_location **old_locp;
11868 unsigned old_locations_count;
11869 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<struct bp_location *> old_locations (bp_locations);
11870
11871 old_locations_count = bp_locations_count;
11872 bp_locations = NULL;
11873 bp_locations_count = 0;
11874
11875 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
11876 for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
11877 bp_locations_count++;
11878
11879 bp_locations = XNEWVEC (struct bp_location *, bp_locations_count);
11880 locp = bp_locations;
11881 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
11882 for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
11883 *locp++ = loc;
11884 qsort (bp_locations, bp_locations_count, sizeof (*bp_locations),
11885 bp_locations_compare);
11886
11887 bp_locations_target_extensions_update ();
11888
11889 /* Identify bp_location instances that are no longer present in the
11890 new list, and therefore should be freed. Note that it's not
11891 necessary that those locations should be removed from inferior --
11892 if there's another location at the same address (previously
11893 marked as duplicate), we don't need to remove/insert the
11894 location.
11895
11896 LOCP is kept in sync with OLD_LOCP, each pointing to the current
11897 and former bp_location array state respectively. */
11898
11899 locp = bp_locations;
11900 for (old_locp = old_locations.get ();
11901 old_locp < old_locations.get () + old_locations_count;
11902 old_locp++)
11903 {
11904 struct bp_location *old_loc = *old_locp;
11905 struct bp_location **loc2p;
11906
11907 /* Tells if 'old_loc' is found among the new locations. If
11908 not, we have to free it. */
11909 int found_object = 0;
11910 /* Tells if the location should remain inserted in the target. */
11911 int keep_in_target = 0;
11912 int removed = 0;
11913
11914 /* Skip LOCP entries which will definitely never be needed.
11915 Stop either at or being the one matching OLD_LOC. */
11916 while (locp < bp_locations + bp_locations_count
11917 && (*locp)->address < old_loc->address)
11918 locp++;
11919
11920 for (loc2p = locp;
11921 (loc2p < bp_locations + bp_locations_count
11922 && (*loc2p)->address == old_loc->address);
11923 loc2p++)
11924 {
11925 /* Check if this is a new/duplicated location or a duplicated
11926 location that had its condition modified. If so, we want to send
11927 its condition to the target if evaluation of conditions is taking
11928 place there. */
11929 if ((*loc2p)->condition_changed == condition_modified
11930 && (last_addr != old_loc->address
11931 || last_pspace_num != old_loc->pspace->num))
11932 {
11933 force_breakpoint_reinsertion (*loc2p);
11934 last_pspace_num = old_loc->pspace->num;
11935 }
11936
11937 if (*loc2p == old_loc)
11938 found_object = 1;
11939 }
11940
11941 /* We have already handled this address, update it so that we don't
11942 have to go through updates again. */
11943 last_addr = old_loc->address;
11944
11945 /* Target-side condition evaluation: Handle deleted locations. */
11946 if (!found_object)
11947 force_breakpoint_reinsertion (old_loc);
11948
11949 /* If this location is no longer present, and inserted, look if
11950 there's maybe a new location at the same address. If so,
11951 mark that one inserted, and don't remove this one. This is
11952 needed so that we don't have a time window where a breakpoint
11953 at certain location is not inserted. */
11954
11955 if (old_loc->inserted)
11956 {
11957 /* If the location is inserted now, we might have to remove
11958 it. */
11959
11960 if (found_object && should_be_inserted (old_loc))
11961 {
11962 /* The location is still present in the location list,
11963 and still should be inserted. Don't do anything. */
11964 keep_in_target = 1;
11965 }
11966 else
11967 {
11968 /* This location still exists, but it won't be kept in the
11969 target since it may have been disabled. We proceed to
11970 remove its target-side condition. */
11971
11972 /* The location is either no longer present, or got
11973 disabled. See if there's another location at the
11974 same address, in which case we don't need to remove
11975 this one from the target. */
11976
11977 /* OLD_LOC comes from existing struct breakpoint. */
11978 if (breakpoint_address_is_meaningful (old_loc->owner))
11979 {
11980 for (loc2p = locp;
11981 (loc2p < bp_locations + bp_locations_count
11982 && (*loc2p)->address == old_loc->address);
11983 loc2p++)
11984 {
11985 struct bp_location *loc2 = *loc2p;
11986
11987 if (breakpoint_locations_match (loc2, old_loc))
11988 {
11989 /* Read watchpoint locations are switched to
11990 access watchpoints, if the former are not
11991 supported, but the latter are. */
11992 if (is_hardware_watchpoint (old_loc->owner))
11993 {
11994 gdb_assert (is_hardware_watchpoint (loc2->owner));
11995 loc2->watchpoint_type = old_loc->watchpoint_type;
11996 }
11997
11998 /* loc2 is a duplicated location. We need to check
11999 if it should be inserted in case it will be
12000 unduplicated. */
12001 if (loc2 != old_loc
12002 && unduplicated_should_be_inserted (loc2))
12003 {
12004 swap_insertion (old_loc, loc2);
12005 keep_in_target = 1;
12006 break;
12007 }
12008 }
12009 }
12010 }
12011 }
12012
12013 if (!keep_in_target)
12014 {
12015 if (remove_breakpoint (old_loc))
12016 {
12017 /* This is just about all we can do. We could keep
12018 this location on the global list, and try to
12019 remove it next time, but there's no particular
12020 reason why we will succeed next time.
12021
12022 Note that at this point, old_loc->owner is still
12023 valid, as delete_breakpoint frees the breakpoint
12024 only after calling us. */
12025 printf_filtered (_("warning: Error removing "
12026 "breakpoint %d\n"),
12027 old_loc->owner->number);
12028 }
12029 removed = 1;
12030 }
12031 }
12032
12033 if (!found_object)
12034 {
12035 if (removed && target_is_non_stop_p ()
12036 && need_moribund_for_location_type (old_loc))
12037 {
12038 /* This location was removed from the target. In
12039 non-stop mode, a race condition is possible where
12040 we've removed a breakpoint, but stop events for that
12041 breakpoint are already queued and will arrive later.
12042 We apply an heuristic to be able to distinguish such
12043 SIGTRAPs from other random SIGTRAPs: we keep this
12044 breakpoint location for a bit, and will retire it
12045 after we see some number of events. The theory here
12046 is that reporting of events should, "on the average",
12047 be fair, so after a while we'll see events from all
12048 threads that have anything of interest, and no longer
12049 need to keep this breakpoint location around. We
12050 don't hold locations forever so to reduce chances of
12051 mistaking a non-breakpoint SIGTRAP for a breakpoint
12052 SIGTRAP.
12053
12054 The heuristic failing can be disastrous on
12055 decr_pc_after_break targets.
12056
12057 On decr_pc_after_break targets, like e.g., x86-linux,
12058 if we fail to recognize a late breakpoint SIGTRAP,
12059 because events_till_retirement has reached 0 too
12060 soon, we'll fail to do the PC adjustment, and report
12061 a random SIGTRAP to the user. When the user resumes
12062 the inferior, it will most likely immediately crash
12063 with SIGILL/SIGBUS/SIGSEGV, or worse, get silently
12064 corrupted, because of being resumed e.g., in the
12065 middle of a multi-byte instruction, or skipped a
12066 one-byte instruction. This was actually seen happen
12067 on native x86-linux, and should be less rare on
12068 targets that do not support new thread events, like
12069 remote, due to the heuristic depending on
12070 thread_count.
12071
12072 Mistaking a random SIGTRAP for a breakpoint trap
12073 causes similar symptoms (PC adjustment applied when
12074 it shouldn't), but then again, playing with SIGTRAPs
12075 behind the debugger's back is asking for trouble.
12076
12077 Since hardware watchpoint traps are always
12078 distinguishable from other traps, so we don't need to
12079 apply keep hardware watchpoint moribund locations
12080 around. We simply always ignore hardware watchpoint
12081 traps we can no longer explain. */
12082
12083 old_loc->events_till_retirement = 3 * (thread_count () + 1);
12084 old_loc->owner = NULL;
12085
12086 VEC_safe_push (bp_location_p, moribund_locations, old_loc);
12087 }
12088 else
12089 {
12090 old_loc->owner = NULL;
12091 decref_bp_location (&old_loc);
12092 }
12093 }
12094 }
12095
12096 /* Rescan breakpoints at the same address and section, marking the
12097 first one as "first" and any others as "duplicates". This is so
12098 that the bpt instruction is only inserted once. If we have a
12099 permanent breakpoint at the same place as BPT, make that one the
12100 official one, and the rest as duplicates. Permanent breakpoints
12101 are sorted first for the same address.
12102
12103 Do the same for hardware watchpoints, but also considering the
12104 watchpoint's type (regular/access/read) and length. */
12105
12106 bp_loc_first = NULL;
12107 wp_loc_first = NULL;
12108 awp_loc_first = NULL;
12109 rwp_loc_first = NULL;
12110 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (loc, locp)
12111 {
12112 /* ALL_BP_LOCATIONS bp_location has LOC->OWNER always
12113 non-NULL. */
12114 struct bp_location **loc_first_p;
12115 b = loc->owner;
12116
12117 if (!unduplicated_should_be_inserted (loc)
12118 || !breakpoint_address_is_meaningful (b)
12119 /* Don't detect duplicate for tracepoint locations because they are
12120 never duplicated. See the comments in field `duplicate' of
12121 `struct bp_location'. */
12122 || is_tracepoint (b))
12123 {
12124 /* Clear the condition modification flag. */
12125 loc->condition_changed = condition_unchanged;
12126 continue;
12127 }
12128
12129 if (b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint)
12130 loc_first_p = &wp_loc_first;
12131 else if (b->type == bp_read_watchpoint)
12132 loc_first_p = &rwp_loc_first;
12133 else if (b->type == bp_access_watchpoint)
12134 loc_first_p = &awp_loc_first;
12135 else
12136 loc_first_p = &bp_loc_first;
12137
12138 if (*loc_first_p == NULL
12139 || (overlay_debugging && loc->section != (*loc_first_p)->section)
12140 || !breakpoint_locations_match (loc, *loc_first_p))
12141 {
12142 *loc_first_p = loc;
12143 loc->duplicate = 0;
12144
12145 if (is_breakpoint (loc->owner) && loc->condition_changed)
12146 {
12147 loc->needs_update = 1;
12148 /* Clear the condition modification flag. */
12149 loc->condition_changed = condition_unchanged;
12150 }
12151 continue;
12152 }
12153
12154
12155 /* This and the above ensure the invariant that the first location
12156 is not duplicated, and is the inserted one.
12157 All following are marked as duplicated, and are not inserted. */
12158 if (loc->inserted)
12159 swap_insertion (loc, *loc_first_p);
12160 loc->duplicate = 1;
12161
12162 /* Clear the condition modification flag. */
12163 loc->condition_changed = condition_unchanged;
12164 }
12165
12166 if (insert_mode == UGLL_INSERT || breakpoints_should_be_inserted_now ())
12167 {
12168 if (insert_mode != UGLL_DONT_INSERT)
12169 insert_breakpoint_locations ();
12170 else
12171 {
12172 /* Even though the caller told us to not insert new
12173 locations, we may still need to update conditions on the
12174 target's side of breakpoints that were already inserted
12175 if the target is evaluating breakpoint conditions. We
12176 only update conditions for locations that are marked
12177 "needs_update". */
12178 update_inserted_breakpoint_locations ();
12179 }
12180 }
12181
12182 if (insert_mode != UGLL_DONT_INSERT)
12183 download_tracepoint_locations ();
12184 }
12185
12186 void
12187 breakpoint_retire_moribund (void)
12188 {
12189 struct bp_location *loc;
12190 int ix;
12191
12192 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (bp_location_p, moribund_locations, ix, loc); ++ix)
12193 if (--(loc->events_till_retirement) == 0)
12194 {
12195 decref_bp_location (&loc);
12196 VEC_unordered_remove (bp_location_p, moribund_locations, ix);
12197 --ix;
12198 }
12199 }
12200
12201 static void
12202 update_global_location_list_nothrow (enum ugll_insert_mode insert_mode)
12203 {
12204
12205 TRY
12206 {
12207 update_global_location_list (insert_mode);
12208 }
12209 CATCH (e, RETURN_MASK_ERROR)
12210 {
12211 }
12212 END_CATCH
12213 }
12214
12215 /* Clear BKP from a BPS. */
12216
12217 static void
12218 bpstat_remove_bp_location (bpstat bps, struct breakpoint *bpt)
12219 {
12220 bpstat bs;
12221
12222 for (bs = bps; bs; bs = bs->next)
12223 if (bs->breakpoint_at == bpt)
12224 {
12225 bs->breakpoint_at = NULL;
12226 bs->old_val = NULL;
12227 /* bs->commands will be freed later. */
12228 }
12229 }
12230
12231 /* Callback for iterate_over_threads. */
12232 static int
12233 bpstat_remove_breakpoint_callback (struct thread_info *th, void *data)
12234 {
12235 struct breakpoint *bpt = (struct breakpoint *) data;
12236
12237 bpstat_remove_bp_location (th->control.stop_bpstat, bpt);
12238 return 0;
12239 }
12240
12241 /* Helper for breakpoint and tracepoint breakpoint_ops->mention
12242 callbacks. */
12243
12244 static void
12245 say_where (struct breakpoint *b)
12246 {
12247 struct value_print_options opts;
12248
12249 get_user_print_options (&opts);
12250
12251 /* i18n: cagney/2005-02-11: Below needs to be merged into a
12252 single string. */
12253 if (b->loc == NULL)
12254 {
12255 /* For pending locations, the output differs slightly based
12256 on b->extra_string. If this is non-NULL, it contains either
12257 a condition or dprintf arguments. */
12258 if (b->extra_string == NULL)
12259 {
12260 printf_filtered (_(" (%s) pending."),
12261 event_location_to_string (b->location.get ()));
12262 }
12263 else if (b->type == bp_dprintf)
12264 {
12265 printf_filtered (_(" (%s,%s) pending."),
12266 event_location_to_string (b->location.get ()),
12267 b->extra_string);
12268 }
12269 else
12270 {
12271 printf_filtered (_(" (%s %s) pending."),
12272 event_location_to_string (b->location.get ()),
12273 b->extra_string);
12274 }
12275 }
12276 else
12277 {
12278 if (opts.addressprint || b->loc->symtab == NULL)
12279 {
12280 printf_filtered (" at ");
12281 fputs_filtered (paddress (b->loc->gdbarch, b->loc->address),
12282 gdb_stdout);
12283 }
12284 if (b->loc->symtab != NULL)
12285 {
12286 /* If there is a single location, we can print the location
12287 more nicely. */
12288 if (b->loc->next == NULL)
12289 printf_filtered (": file %s, line %d.",
12290 symtab_to_filename_for_display (b->loc->symtab),
12291 b->loc->line_number);
12292 else
12293 /* This is not ideal, but each location may have a
12294 different file name, and this at least reflects the
12295 real situation somewhat. */
12296 printf_filtered (": %s.",
12297 event_location_to_string (b->location.get ()));
12298 }
12299
12300 if (b->loc->next)
12301 {
12302 struct bp_location *loc = b->loc;
12303 int n = 0;
12304 for (; loc; loc = loc->next)
12305 ++n;
12306 printf_filtered (" (%d locations)", n);
12307 }
12308 }
12309 }
12310
12311 /* Default bp_location_ops methods. */
12312
12313 static void
12314 bp_location_dtor (struct bp_location *self)
12315 {
12316 xfree (self->function_name);
12317 }
12318
12319 static const struct bp_location_ops bp_location_ops =
12320 {
12321 bp_location_dtor
12322 };
12323
12324 /* Destructor for the breakpoint base class. */
12325
12326 breakpoint::~breakpoint ()
12327 {
12328 xfree (this->cond_string);
12329 xfree (this->extra_string);
12330 xfree (this->filter);
12331 }
12332
12333 static struct bp_location *
12334 base_breakpoint_allocate_location (struct breakpoint *self)
12335 {
12336 return new bp_location (&bp_location_ops, self);
12337 }
12338
12339 static void
12340 base_breakpoint_re_set (struct breakpoint *b)
12341 {
12342 /* Nothing to re-set. */
12343 }
12344
12345 #define internal_error_pure_virtual_called() \
12346 gdb_assert_not_reached ("pure virtual function called")
12347
12348 static int
12349 base_breakpoint_insert_location (struct bp_location *bl)
12350 {
12351 internal_error_pure_virtual_called ();
12352 }
12353
12354 static int
12355 base_breakpoint_remove_location (struct bp_location *bl,
12356 enum remove_bp_reason reason)
12357 {
12358 internal_error_pure_virtual_called ();
12359 }
12360
12361 static int
12362 base_breakpoint_breakpoint_hit (const struct bp_location *bl,
12363 const address_space *aspace,
12364 CORE_ADDR bp_addr,
12365 const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
12366 {
12367 internal_error_pure_virtual_called ();
12368 }
12369
12370 static void
12371 base_breakpoint_check_status (bpstat bs)
12372 {
12373 /* Always stop. */
12374 }
12375
12376 /* A "works_in_software_mode" breakpoint_ops method that just internal
12377 errors. */
12378
12379 static int
12380 base_breakpoint_works_in_software_mode (const struct breakpoint *b)
12381 {
12382 internal_error_pure_virtual_called ();
12383 }
12384
12385 /* A "resources_needed" breakpoint_ops method that just internal
12386 errors. */
12387
12388 static int
12389 base_breakpoint_resources_needed (const struct bp_location *bl)
12390 {
12391 internal_error_pure_virtual_called ();
12392 }
12393
12394 static enum print_stop_action
12395 base_breakpoint_print_it (bpstat bs)
12396 {
12397 internal_error_pure_virtual_called ();
12398 }
12399
12400 static void
12401 base_breakpoint_print_one_detail (const struct breakpoint *self,
12402 struct ui_out *uiout)
12403 {
12404 /* nothing */
12405 }
12406
12407 static void
12408 base_breakpoint_print_mention (struct breakpoint *b)
12409 {
12410 internal_error_pure_virtual_called ();
12411 }
12412
12413 static void
12414 base_breakpoint_print_recreate (struct breakpoint *b, struct ui_file *fp)
12415 {
12416 internal_error_pure_virtual_called ();
12417 }
12418
12419 static void
12420 base_breakpoint_create_sals_from_location
12421 (const struct event_location *location,
12422 struct linespec_result *canonical,
12423 enum bptype type_wanted)
12424 {
12425 internal_error_pure_virtual_called ();
12426 }
12427
12428 static void
12429 base_breakpoint_create_breakpoints_sal (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
12430 struct linespec_result *c,
12431 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> cond_string,
12432 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> extra_string,
12433 enum bptype type_wanted,
12434 enum bpdisp disposition,
12435 int thread,
12436 int task, int ignore_count,
12437 const struct breakpoint_ops *o,
12438 int from_tty, int enabled,
12439 int internal, unsigned flags)
12440 {
12441 internal_error_pure_virtual_called ();
12442 }
12443
12444 static std::vector<symtab_and_line>
12445 base_breakpoint_decode_location (struct breakpoint *b,
12446 const struct event_location *location,
12447 struct program_space *search_pspace)
12448 {
12449 internal_error_pure_virtual_called ();
12450 }
12451
12452 /* The default 'explains_signal' method. */
12453
12454 static int
12455 base_breakpoint_explains_signal (struct breakpoint *b, enum gdb_signal sig)
12456 {
12457 return 1;
12458 }
12459
12460 /* The default "after_condition_true" method. */
12461
12462 static void
12463 base_breakpoint_after_condition_true (struct bpstats *bs)
12464 {
12465 /* Nothing to do. */
12466 }
12467
12468 struct breakpoint_ops base_breakpoint_ops =
12469 {
12470 base_breakpoint_allocate_location,
12471 base_breakpoint_re_set,
12472 base_breakpoint_insert_location,
12473 base_breakpoint_remove_location,
12474 base_breakpoint_breakpoint_hit,
12475 base_breakpoint_check_status,
12476 base_breakpoint_resources_needed,
12477 base_breakpoint_works_in_software_mode,
12478 base_breakpoint_print_it,
12479 NULL,
12480 base_breakpoint_print_one_detail,
12481 base_breakpoint_print_mention,
12482 base_breakpoint_print_recreate,
12483 base_breakpoint_create_sals_from_location,
12484 base_breakpoint_create_breakpoints_sal,
12485 base_breakpoint_decode_location,
12486 base_breakpoint_explains_signal,
12487 base_breakpoint_after_condition_true,
12488 };
12489
12490 /* Default breakpoint_ops methods. */
12491
12492 static void
12493 bkpt_re_set (struct breakpoint *b)
12494 {
12495 /* FIXME: is this still reachable? */
12496 if (breakpoint_event_location_empty_p (b))
12497 {
12498 /* Anything without a location can't be re-set. */
12499 delete_breakpoint (b);
12500 return;
12501 }
12502
12503 breakpoint_re_set_default (b);
12504 }
12505
12506 static int
12507 bkpt_insert_location (struct bp_location *bl)
12508 {
12509 CORE_ADDR addr = bl->target_info.reqstd_address;
12510
12511 bl->target_info.kind = breakpoint_kind (bl, &addr);
12512 bl->target_info.placed_address = addr;
12513
12514 if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
12515 return target_insert_hw_breakpoint (bl->gdbarch, &bl->target_info);
12516 else
12517 return target_insert_breakpoint (bl->gdbarch, &bl->target_info);
12518 }
12519
12520 static int
12521 bkpt_remove_location (struct bp_location *bl, enum remove_bp_reason reason)
12522 {
12523 if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
12524 return target_remove_hw_breakpoint (bl->gdbarch, &bl->target_info);
12525 else
12526 return target_remove_breakpoint (bl->gdbarch, &bl->target_info, reason);
12527 }
12528
12529 static int
12530 bkpt_breakpoint_hit (const struct bp_location *bl,
12531 const address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR bp_addr,
12532 const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
12533 {
12534 if (ws->kind != TARGET_WAITKIND_STOPPED
12535 || ws->value.sig != GDB_SIGNAL_TRAP)
12536 return 0;
12537
12538 if (!breakpoint_address_match (bl->pspace->aspace, bl->address,
12539 aspace, bp_addr))
12540 return 0;
12541
12542 if (overlay_debugging /* unmapped overlay section */
12543 && section_is_overlay (bl->section)
12544 && !section_is_mapped (bl->section))
12545 return 0;
12546
12547 return 1;
12548 }
12549
12550 static int
12551 dprintf_breakpoint_hit (const struct bp_location *bl,
12552 const address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR bp_addr,
12553 const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
12554 {
12555 if (dprintf_style == dprintf_style_agent
12556 && target_can_run_breakpoint_commands ())
12557 {
12558 /* An agent-style dprintf never causes a stop. If we see a trap
12559 for this address it must be for a breakpoint that happens to
12560 be set at the same address. */
12561 return 0;
12562 }
12563
12564 return bkpt_breakpoint_hit (bl, aspace, bp_addr, ws);
12565 }
12566
12567 static int
12568 bkpt_resources_needed (const struct bp_location *bl)
12569 {
12570 gdb_assert (bl->owner->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint);
12571
12572 return 1;
12573 }
12574
12575 static enum print_stop_action
12576 bkpt_print_it (bpstat bs)
12577 {
12578 struct breakpoint *b;
12579 const struct bp_location *bl;
12580 int bp_temp;
12581 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
12582
12583 gdb_assert (bs->bp_location_at != NULL);
12584
12585 bl = bs->bp_location_at;
12586 b = bs->breakpoint_at;
12587
12588 bp_temp = b->disposition == disp_del;
12589 if (bl->address != bl->requested_address)
12590 breakpoint_adjustment_warning (bl->requested_address,
12591 bl->address,
12592 b->number, 1);
12593 annotate_breakpoint (b->number);
12594 maybe_print_thread_hit_breakpoint (uiout);
12595
12596 if (bp_temp)
12597 uiout->text ("Temporary breakpoint ");
12598 else
12599 uiout->text ("Breakpoint ");
12600 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
12601 {
12602 uiout->field_string ("reason",
12603 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_BREAKPOINT_HIT));
12604 uiout->field_string ("disp", bpdisp_text (b->disposition));
12605 }
12606 uiout->field_int ("bkptno", b->number);
12607 uiout->text (", ");
12608
12609 return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
12610 }
12611
12612 static void
12613 bkpt_print_mention (struct breakpoint *b)
12614 {
12615 if (current_uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
12616 return;
12617
12618 switch (b->type)
12619 {
12620 case bp_breakpoint:
12621 case bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver:
12622 if (b->disposition == disp_del)
12623 printf_filtered (_("Temporary breakpoint"));
12624 else
12625 printf_filtered (_("Breakpoint"));
12626 printf_filtered (_(" %d"), b->number);
12627 if (b->type == bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver)
12628 printf_filtered (_(" at gnu-indirect-function resolver"));
12629 break;
12630 case bp_hardware_breakpoint:
12631 printf_filtered (_("Hardware assisted breakpoint %d"), b->number);
12632 break;
12633 case bp_dprintf:
12634 printf_filtered (_("Dprintf %d"), b->number);
12635 break;
12636 }
12637
12638 say_where (b);
12639 }
12640
12641 static void
12642 bkpt_print_recreate (struct breakpoint *tp, struct ui_file *fp)
12643 {
12644 if (tp->type == bp_breakpoint && tp->disposition == disp_del)
12645 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "tbreak");
12646 else if (tp->type == bp_breakpoint)
12647 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "break");
12648 else if (tp->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint
12649 && tp->disposition == disp_del)
12650 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "thbreak");
12651 else if (tp->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint)
12652 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "hbreak");
12653 else
12654 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
12655 _("unhandled breakpoint type %d"), (int) tp->type);
12656
12657 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " %s",
12658 event_location_to_string (tp->location.get ()));
12659
12660 /* Print out extra_string if this breakpoint is pending. It might
12661 contain, for example, conditions that were set by the user. */
12662 if (tp->loc == NULL && tp->extra_string != NULL)
12663 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " %s", tp->extra_string);
12664
12665 print_recreate_thread (tp, fp);
12666 }
12667
12668 static void
12669 bkpt_create_sals_from_location (const struct event_location *location,
12670 struct linespec_result *canonical,
12671 enum bptype type_wanted)
12672 {
12673 create_sals_from_location_default (location, canonical, type_wanted);
12674 }
12675
12676 static void
12677 bkpt_create_breakpoints_sal (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
12678 struct linespec_result *canonical,
12679 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> cond_string,
12680 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> extra_string,
12681 enum bptype type_wanted,
12682 enum bpdisp disposition,
12683 int thread,
12684 int task, int ignore_count,
12685 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops,
12686 int from_tty, int enabled,
12687 int internal, unsigned flags)
12688 {
12689 create_breakpoints_sal_default (gdbarch, canonical,
12690 std::move (cond_string),
12691 std::move (extra_string),
12692 type_wanted,
12693 disposition, thread, task,
12694 ignore_count, ops, from_tty,
12695 enabled, internal, flags);
12696 }
12697
12698 static std::vector<symtab_and_line>
12699 bkpt_decode_location (struct breakpoint *b,
12700 const struct event_location *location,
12701 struct program_space *search_pspace)
12702 {
12703 return decode_location_default (b, location, search_pspace);
12704 }
12705
12706 /* Virtual table for internal breakpoints. */
12707
12708 static void
12709 internal_bkpt_re_set (struct breakpoint *b)
12710 {
12711 switch (b->type)
12712 {
12713 /* Delete overlay event and longjmp master breakpoints; they
12714 will be reset later by breakpoint_re_set. */
12715 case bp_overlay_event:
12716 case bp_longjmp_master:
12717 case bp_std_terminate_master:
12718 case bp_exception_master:
12719 delete_breakpoint (b);
12720 break;
12721
12722 /* This breakpoint is special, it's set up when the inferior
12723 starts and we really don't want to touch it. */
12724 case bp_shlib_event:
12725
12726 /* Like bp_shlib_event, this breakpoint type is special. Once
12727 it is set up, we do not want to touch it. */
12728 case bp_thread_event:
12729 break;
12730 }
12731 }
12732
12733 static void
12734 internal_bkpt_check_status (bpstat bs)
12735 {
12736 if (bs->breakpoint_at->type == bp_shlib_event)
12737 {
12738 /* If requested, stop when the dynamic linker notifies GDB of
12739 events. This allows the user to get control and place
12740 breakpoints in initializer routines for dynamically loaded
12741 objects (among other things). */
12742 bs->stop = stop_on_solib_events;
12743 bs->print = stop_on_solib_events;
12744 }
12745 else
12746 bs->stop = 0;
12747 }
12748
12749 static enum print_stop_action
12750 internal_bkpt_print_it (bpstat bs)
12751 {
12752 struct breakpoint *b;
12753
12754 b = bs->breakpoint_at;
12755
12756 switch (b->type)
12757 {
12758 case bp_shlib_event:
12759 /* Did we stop because the user set the stop_on_solib_events
12760 variable? (If so, we report this as a generic, "Stopped due
12761 to shlib event" message.) */
12762 print_solib_event (0);
12763 break;
12764
12765 case bp_thread_event:
12766 /* Not sure how we will get here.
12767 GDB should not stop for these breakpoints. */
12768 printf_filtered (_("Thread Event Breakpoint: gdb should not stop!\n"));
12769 break;
12770
12771 case bp_overlay_event:
12772 /* By analogy with the thread event, GDB should not stop for these. */
12773 printf_filtered (_("Overlay Event Breakpoint: gdb should not stop!\n"));
12774 break;
12775
12776 case bp_longjmp_master:
12777 /* These should never be enabled. */
12778 printf_filtered (_("Longjmp Master Breakpoint: gdb should not stop!\n"));
12779 break;
12780
12781 case bp_std_terminate_master:
12782 /* These should never be enabled. */
12783 printf_filtered (_("std::terminate Master Breakpoint: "
12784 "gdb should not stop!\n"));
12785 break;
12786
12787 case bp_exception_master:
12788 /* These should never be enabled. */
12789 printf_filtered (_("Exception Master Breakpoint: "
12790 "gdb should not stop!\n"));
12791 break;
12792 }
12793
12794 return PRINT_NOTHING;
12795 }
12796
12797 static void
12798 internal_bkpt_print_mention (struct breakpoint *b)
12799 {
12800 /* Nothing to mention. These breakpoints are internal. */
12801 }
12802
12803 /* Virtual table for momentary breakpoints */
12804
12805 static void
12806 momentary_bkpt_re_set (struct breakpoint *b)
12807 {
12808 /* Keep temporary breakpoints, which can be encountered when we step
12809 over a dlopen call and solib_add is resetting the breakpoints.
12810 Otherwise these should have been blown away via the cleanup chain
12811 or by breakpoint_init_inferior when we rerun the executable. */
12812 }
12813
12814 static void
12815 momentary_bkpt_check_status (bpstat bs)
12816 {
12817 /* Nothing. The point of these breakpoints is causing a stop. */
12818 }
12819
12820 static enum print_stop_action
12821 momentary_bkpt_print_it (bpstat bs)
12822 {
12823 return PRINT_UNKNOWN;
12824 }
12825
12826 static void
12827 momentary_bkpt_print_mention (struct breakpoint *b)
12828 {
12829 /* Nothing to mention. These breakpoints are internal. */
12830 }
12831
12832 /* Ensure INITIATING_FRAME is cleared when no such breakpoint exists.
12833
12834 It gets cleared already on the removal of the first one of such placed
12835 breakpoints. This is OK as they get all removed altogether. */
12836
12837 longjmp_breakpoint::~longjmp_breakpoint ()
12838 {
12839 thread_info *tp = find_thread_global_id (this->thread);
12840
12841 if (tp != NULL)
12842 tp->initiating_frame = null_frame_id;
12843 }
12844
12845 /* Specific methods for probe breakpoints. */
12846
12847 static int
12848 bkpt_probe_insert_location (struct bp_location *bl)
12849 {
12850 int v = bkpt_insert_location (bl);
12851
12852 if (v == 0)
12853 {
12854 /* The insertion was successful, now let's set the probe's semaphore
12855 if needed. */
12856 bl->probe.prob->set_semaphore (bl->probe.objfile, bl->gdbarch);
12857 }
12858
12859 return v;
12860 }
12861
12862 static int
12863 bkpt_probe_remove_location (struct bp_location *bl,
12864 enum remove_bp_reason reason)
12865 {
12866 /* Let's clear the semaphore before removing the location. */
12867 bl->probe.prob->clear_semaphore (bl->probe.objfile, bl->gdbarch);
12868
12869 return bkpt_remove_location (bl, reason);
12870 }
12871
12872 static void
12873 bkpt_probe_create_sals_from_location (const struct event_location *location,
12874 struct linespec_result *canonical,
12875 enum bptype type_wanted)
12876 {
12877 struct linespec_sals lsal;
12878
12879 lsal.sals = parse_probes (location, NULL, canonical);
12880 lsal.canonical
12881 = xstrdup (event_location_to_string (canonical->location.get ()));
12882 canonical->lsals.push_back (std::move (lsal));
12883 }
12884
12885 static std::vector<symtab_and_line>
12886 bkpt_probe_decode_location (struct breakpoint *b,
12887 const struct event_location *location,
12888 struct program_space *search_pspace)
12889 {
12890 std::vector<symtab_and_line> sals = parse_probes (location, search_pspace, NULL);
12891 if (sals.empty ())
12892 error (_("probe not found"));
12893 return sals;
12894 }
12895
12896 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used in tracepoints. */
12897
12898 static void
12899 tracepoint_re_set (struct breakpoint *b)
12900 {
12901 breakpoint_re_set_default (b);
12902 }
12903
12904 static int
12905 tracepoint_breakpoint_hit (const struct bp_location *bl,
12906 const address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR bp_addr,
12907 const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
12908 {
12909 /* By definition, the inferior does not report stops at
12910 tracepoints. */
12911 return 0;
12912 }
12913
12914 static void
12915 tracepoint_print_one_detail (const struct breakpoint *self,
12916 struct ui_out *uiout)
12917 {
12918 struct tracepoint *tp = (struct tracepoint *) self;
12919 if (tp->static_trace_marker_id)
12920 {
12921 gdb_assert (self->type == bp_static_tracepoint);
12922
12923 uiout->text ("\tmarker id is ");
12924 uiout->field_string ("static-tracepoint-marker-string-id",
12925 tp->static_trace_marker_id);
12926 uiout->text ("\n");
12927 }
12928 }
12929
12930 static void
12931 tracepoint_print_mention (struct breakpoint *b)
12932 {
12933 if (current_uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
12934 return;
12935
12936 switch (b->type)
12937 {
12938 case bp_tracepoint:
12939 printf_filtered (_("Tracepoint"));
12940 printf_filtered (_(" %d"), b->number);
12941 break;
12942 case bp_fast_tracepoint:
12943 printf_filtered (_("Fast tracepoint"));
12944 printf_filtered (_(" %d"), b->number);
12945 break;
12946 case bp_static_tracepoint:
12947 printf_filtered (_("Static tracepoint"));
12948 printf_filtered (_(" %d"), b->number);
12949 break;
12950 default:
12951 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
12952 _("unhandled tracepoint type %d"), (int) b->type);
12953 }
12954
12955 say_where (b);
12956 }
12957
12958 static void
12959 tracepoint_print_recreate (struct breakpoint *self, struct ui_file *fp)
12960 {
12961 struct tracepoint *tp = (struct tracepoint *) self;
12962
12963 if (self->type == bp_fast_tracepoint)
12964 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "ftrace");
12965 else if (self->type == bp_static_tracepoint)
12966 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "strace");
12967 else if (self->type == bp_tracepoint)
12968 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "trace");
12969 else
12970 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
12971 _("unhandled tracepoint type %d"), (int) self->type);
12972
12973 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " %s",
12974 event_location_to_string (self->location.get ()));
12975 print_recreate_thread (self, fp);
12976
12977 if (tp->pass_count)
12978 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " passcount %d\n", tp->pass_count);
12979 }
12980
12981 static void
12982 tracepoint_create_sals_from_location (const struct event_location *location,
12983 struct linespec_result *canonical,
12984 enum bptype type_wanted)
12985 {
12986 create_sals_from_location_default (location, canonical, type_wanted);
12987 }
12988
12989 static void
12990 tracepoint_create_breakpoints_sal (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
12991 struct linespec_result *canonical,
12992 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> cond_string,
12993 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> extra_string,
12994 enum bptype type_wanted,
12995 enum bpdisp disposition,
12996 int thread,
12997 int task, int ignore_count,
12998 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops,
12999 int from_tty, int enabled,
13000 int internal, unsigned flags)
13001 {
13002 create_breakpoints_sal_default (gdbarch, canonical,
13003 std::move (cond_string),
13004 std::move (extra_string),
13005 type_wanted,
13006 disposition, thread, task,
13007 ignore_count, ops, from_tty,
13008 enabled, internal, flags);
13009 }
13010
13011 static std::vector<symtab_and_line>
13012 tracepoint_decode_location (struct breakpoint *b,
13013 const struct event_location *location,
13014 struct program_space *search_pspace)
13015 {
13016 return decode_location_default (b, location, search_pspace);
13017 }
13018
13019 struct breakpoint_ops tracepoint_breakpoint_ops;
13020
13021 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be use on tracepoints placed in a
13022 static probe. */
13023
13024 static void
13025 tracepoint_probe_create_sals_from_location
13026 (const struct event_location *location,
13027 struct linespec_result *canonical,
13028 enum bptype type_wanted)
13029 {
13030 /* We use the same method for breakpoint on probes. */
13031 bkpt_probe_create_sals_from_location (location, canonical, type_wanted);
13032 }
13033
13034 static std::vector<symtab_and_line>
13035 tracepoint_probe_decode_location (struct breakpoint *b,
13036 const struct event_location *location,
13037 struct program_space *search_pspace)
13038 {
13039 /* We use the same method for breakpoint on probes. */
13040 return bkpt_probe_decode_location (b, location, search_pspace);
13041 }
13042
13043 static struct breakpoint_ops tracepoint_probe_breakpoint_ops;
13044
13045 /* Dprintf breakpoint_ops methods. */
13046
13047 static void
13048 dprintf_re_set (struct breakpoint *b)
13049 {
13050 breakpoint_re_set_default (b);
13051
13052 /* extra_string should never be non-NULL for dprintf. */
13053 gdb_assert (b->extra_string != NULL);
13054
13055 /* 1 - connect to target 1, that can run breakpoint commands.
13056 2 - create a dprintf, which resolves fine.
13057 3 - disconnect from target 1
13058 4 - connect to target 2, that can NOT run breakpoint commands.
13059
13060 After steps #3/#4, you'll want the dprintf command list to
13061 be updated, because target 1 and 2 may well return different
13062 answers for target_can_run_breakpoint_commands().
13063 Given absence of finer grained resetting, we get to do
13064 it all the time. */
13065 if (b->extra_string != NULL)
13066 update_dprintf_command_list (b);
13067 }
13068
13069 /* Implement the "print_recreate" breakpoint_ops method for dprintf. */
13070
13071 static void
13072 dprintf_print_recreate (struct breakpoint *tp, struct ui_file *fp)
13073 {
13074 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "dprintf %s,%s",
13075 event_location_to_string (tp->location.get ()),
13076 tp->extra_string);
13077 print_recreate_thread (tp, fp);
13078 }
13079
13080 /* Implement the "after_condition_true" breakpoint_ops method for
13081 dprintf.
13082
13083 dprintf's are implemented with regular commands in their command
13084 list, but we run the commands here instead of before presenting the
13085 stop to the user, as dprintf's don't actually cause a stop. This
13086 also makes it so that the commands of multiple dprintfs at the same
13087 address are all handled. */
13088
13089 static void
13090 dprintf_after_condition_true (struct bpstats *bs)
13091 {
13092 struct bpstats tmp_bs;
13093 struct bpstats *tmp_bs_p = &tmp_bs;
13094
13095 /* dprintf's never cause a stop. This wasn't set in the
13096 check_status hook instead because that would make the dprintf's
13097 condition not be evaluated. */
13098 bs->stop = 0;
13099
13100 /* Run the command list here. Take ownership of it instead of
13101 copying. We never want these commands to run later in
13102 bpstat_do_actions, if a breakpoint that causes a stop happens to
13103 be set at same address as this dprintf, or even if running the
13104 commands here throws. */
13105 tmp_bs.commands = bs->commands;
13106 bs->commands = NULL;
13107
13108 bpstat_do_actions_1 (&tmp_bs_p);
13109
13110 /* 'tmp_bs.commands' will usually be NULL by now, but
13111 bpstat_do_actions_1 may return early without processing the whole
13112 list. */
13113 }
13114
13115 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used on static tracepoints with
13116 markers (`-m'). */
13117
13118 static void
13119 strace_marker_create_sals_from_location (const struct event_location *location,
13120 struct linespec_result *canonical,
13121 enum bptype type_wanted)
13122 {
13123 struct linespec_sals lsal;
13124 const char *arg_start, *arg;
13125
13126 arg = arg_start = get_linespec_location (location)->spec_string;
13127 lsal.sals = decode_static_tracepoint_spec (&arg);
13128
13129 std::string str (arg_start, arg - arg_start);
13130 const char *ptr = str.c_str ();
13131 canonical->location
13132 = new_linespec_location (&ptr, symbol_name_match_type::FULL);
13133
13134 lsal.canonical
13135 = xstrdup (event_location_to_string (canonical->location.get ()));
13136 canonical->lsals.push_back (std::move (lsal));
13137 }
13138
13139 static void
13140 strace_marker_create_breakpoints_sal (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
13141 struct linespec_result *canonical,
13142 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> cond_string,
13143 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> extra_string,
13144 enum bptype type_wanted,
13145 enum bpdisp disposition,
13146 int thread,
13147 int task, int ignore_count,
13148 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops,
13149 int from_tty, int enabled,
13150 int internal, unsigned flags)
13151 {
13152 const linespec_sals &lsal = canonical->lsals[0];
13153
13154 /* If the user is creating a static tracepoint by marker id
13155 (strace -m MARKER_ID), then store the sals index, so that
13156 breakpoint_re_set can try to match up which of the newly
13157 found markers corresponds to this one, and, don't try to
13158 expand multiple locations for each sal, given than SALS
13159 already should contain all sals for MARKER_ID. */
13160
13161 for (size_t i = 0; i < lsal.sals.size (); i++)
13162 {
13163 event_location_up location
13164 = copy_event_location (canonical->location.get ());
13165
13166 std::unique_ptr<tracepoint> tp (new tracepoint ());
13167 init_breakpoint_sal (tp.get (), gdbarch, lsal.sals[i],
13168 std::move (location), NULL,
13169 std::move (cond_string),
13170 std::move (extra_string),
13171 type_wanted, disposition,
13172 thread, task, ignore_count, ops,
13173 from_tty, enabled, internal, flags,
13174 canonical->special_display);
13175 /* Given that its possible to have multiple markers with
13176 the same string id, if the user is creating a static
13177 tracepoint by marker id ("strace -m MARKER_ID"), then
13178 store the sals index, so that breakpoint_re_set can
13179 try to match up which of the newly found markers
13180 corresponds to this one */
13181 tp->static_trace_marker_id_idx = i;
13182
13183 install_breakpoint (internal, std::move (tp), 0);
13184 }
13185 }
13186
13187 static std::vector<symtab_and_line>
13188 strace_marker_decode_location (struct breakpoint *b,
13189 const struct event_location *location,
13190 struct program_space *search_pspace)
13191 {
13192 struct tracepoint *tp = (struct tracepoint *) b;
13193 const char *s = get_linespec_location (location)->spec_string;
13194
13195 std::vector<symtab_and_line> sals = decode_static_tracepoint_spec (&s);
13196 if (sals.size () > tp->static_trace_marker_id_idx)
13197 {
13198 sals[0] = sals[tp->static_trace_marker_id_idx];
13199 sals.resize (1);
13200 return sals;
13201 }
13202 else
13203 error (_("marker %s not found"), tp->static_trace_marker_id);
13204 }
13205
13206 static struct breakpoint_ops strace_marker_breakpoint_ops;
13207
13208 static int
13209 strace_marker_p (struct breakpoint *b)
13210 {
13211 return b->ops == &strace_marker_breakpoint_ops;
13212 }
13213
13214 /* Delete a breakpoint and clean up all traces of it in the data
13215 structures. */
13216
13217 void
13218 delete_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *bpt)
13219 {
13220 struct breakpoint *b;
13221
13222 gdb_assert (bpt != NULL);
13223
13224 /* Has this bp already been deleted? This can happen because
13225 multiple lists can hold pointers to bp's. bpstat lists are
13226 especial culprits.
13227
13228 One example of this happening is a watchpoint's scope bp. When
13229 the scope bp triggers, we notice that the watchpoint is out of
13230 scope, and delete it. We also delete its scope bp. But the
13231 scope bp is marked "auto-deleting", and is already on a bpstat.
13232 That bpstat is then checked for auto-deleting bp's, which are
13233 deleted.
13234
13235 A real solution to this problem might involve reference counts in
13236 bp's, and/or giving them pointers back to their referencing
13237 bpstat's, and teaching delete_breakpoint to only free a bp's
13238 storage when no more references were extent. A cheaper bandaid
13239 was chosen. */
13240 if (bpt->type == bp_none)
13241 return;
13242
13243 /* At least avoid this stale reference until the reference counting
13244 of breakpoints gets resolved. */
13245 if (bpt->related_breakpoint != bpt)
13246 {
13247 struct breakpoint *related;
13248 struct watchpoint *w;
13249
13250 if (bpt->type == bp_watchpoint_scope)
13251 w = (struct watchpoint *) bpt->related_breakpoint;
13252 else if (bpt->related_breakpoint->type == bp_watchpoint_scope)
13253 w = (struct watchpoint *) bpt;
13254 else
13255 w = NULL;
13256 if (w != NULL)
13257 watchpoint_del_at_next_stop (w);
13258
13259 /* Unlink bpt from the bpt->related_breakpoint ring. */
13260 for (related = bpt; related->related_breakpoint != bpt;
13261 related = related->related_breakpoint);
13262 related->related_breakpoint = bpt->related_breakpoint;
13263 bpt->related_breakpoint = bpt;
13264 }
13265
13266 /* watch_command_1 creates a watchpoint but only sets its number if
13267 update_watchpoint succeeds in creating its bp_locations. If there's
13268 a problem in that process, we'll be asked to delete the half-created
13269 watchpoint. In that case, don't announce the deletion. */
13270 if (bpt->number)
13271 observer_notify_breakpoint_deleted (bpt);
13272
13273 if (breakpoint_chain == bpt)
13274 breakpoint_chain = bpt->next;
13275
13276 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
13277 if (b->next == bpt)
13278 {
13279 b->next = bpt->next;
13280 break;
13281 }
13282
13283 /* Be sure no bpstat's are pointing at the breakpoint after it's
13284 been freed. */
13285 /* FIXME, how can we find all bpstat's? We just check stop_bpstat
13286 in all threads for now. Note that we cannot just remove bpstats
13287 pointing at bpt from the stop_bpstat list entirely, as breakpoint
13288 commands are associated with the bpstat; if we remove it here,
13289 then the later call to bpstat_do_actions (&stop_bpstat); in
13290 event-top.c won't do anything, and temporary breakpoints with
13291 commands won't work. */
13292
13293 iterate_over_threads (bpstat_remove_breakpoint_callback, bpt);
13294
13295 /* Now that breakpoint is removed from breakpoint list, update the
13296 global location list. This will remove locations that used to
13297 belong to this breakpoint. Do this before freeing the breakpoint
13298 itself, since remove_breakpoint looks at location's owner. It
13299 might be better design to have location completely
13300 self-contained, but it's not the case now. */
13301 update_global_location_list (UGLL_DONT_INSERT);
13302
13303 /* On the chance that someone will soon try again to delete this
13304 same bp, we mark it as deleted before freeing its storage. */
13305 bpt->type = bp_none;
13306 delete bpt;
13307 }
13308
13309 /* Iterator function to call a user-provided callback function once
13310 for each of B and its related breakpoints. */
13311
13312 static void
13313 iterate_over_related_breakpoints (struct breakpoint *b,
13314 gdb::function_view<void (breakpoint *)> function)
13315 {
13316 struct breakpoint *related;
13317
13318 related = b;
13319 do
13320 {
13321 struct breakpoint *next;
13322
13323 /* FUNCTION may delete RELATED. */
13324 next = related->related_breakpoint;
13325
13326 if (next == related)
13327 {
13328 /* RELATED is the last ring entry. */
13329 function (related);
13330
13331 /* FUNCTION may have deleted it, so we'd never reach back to
13332 B. There's nothing left to do anyway, so just break
13333 out. */
13334 break;
13335 }
13336 else
13337 function (related);
13338
13339 related = next;
13340 }
13341 while (related != b);
13342 }
13343
13344 static void
13345 delete_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
13346 {
13347 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
13348
13349 dont_repeat ();
13350
13351 if (arg == 0)
13352 {
13353 int breaks_to_delete = 0;
13354
13355 /* Delete all breakpoints if no argument. Do not delete
13356 internal breakpoints, these have to be deleted with an
13357 explicit breakpoint number argument. */
13358 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
13359 if (user_breakpoint_p (b))
13360 {
13361 breaks_to_delete = 1;
13362 break;
13363 }
13364
13365 /* Ask user only if there are some breakpoints to delete. */
13366 if (!from_tty
13367 || (breaks_to_delete && query (_("Delete all breakpoints? "))))
13368 {
13369 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
13370 if (user_breakpoint_p (b))
13371 delete_breakpoint (b);
13372 }
13373 }
13374 else
13375 map_breakpoint_numbers
13376 (arg, [&] (breakpoint *b)
13377 {
13378 iterate_over_related_breakpoints (b, delete_breakpoint);
13379 });
13380 }
13381
13382 /* Return true if all locations of B bound to PSPACE are pending. If
13383 PSPACE is NULL, all locations of all program spaces are
13384 considered. */
13385
13386 static int
13387 all_locations_are_pending (struct breakpoint *b, struct program_space *pspace)
13388 {
13389 struct bp_location *loc;
13390
13391 for (loc = b->loc; loc != NULL; loc = loc->next)
13392 if ((pspace == NULL
13393 || loc->pspace == pspace)
13394 && !loc->shlib_disabled
13395 && !loc->pspace->executing_startup)
13396 return 0;
13397 return 1;
13398 }
13399
13400 /* Subroutine of update_breakpoint_locations to simplify it.
13401 Return non-zero if multiple fns in list LOC have the same name.
13402 Null names are ignored. */
13403
13404 static int
13405 ambiguous_names_p (struct bp_location *loc)
13406 {
13407 struct bp_location *l;
13408 htab_t htab = htab_create_alloc (13, htab_hash_string,
13409 (int (*) (const void *,
13410 const void *)) streq,
13411 NULL, xcalloc, xfree);
13412
13413 for (l = loc; l != NULL; l = l->next)
13414 {
13415 const char **slot;
13416 const char *name = l->function_name;
13417
13418 /* Allow for some names to be NULL, ignore them. */
13419 if (name == NULL)
13420 continue;
13421
13422 slot = (const char **) htab_find_slot (htab, (const void *) name,
13423 INSERT);
13424 /* NOTE: We can assume slot != NULL here because xcalloc never
13425 returns NULL. */
13426 if (*slot != NULL)
13427 {
13428 htab_delete (htab);
13429 return 1;
13430 }
13431 *slot = name;
13432 }
13433
13434 htab_delete (htab);
13435 return 0;
13436 }
13437
13438 /* When symbols change, it probably means the sources changed as well,
13439 and it might mean the static tracepoint markers are no longer at
13440 the same address or line numbers they used to be at last we
13441 checked. Losing your static tracepoints whenever you rebuild is
13442 undesirable. This function tries to resync/rematch gdb static
13443 tracepoints with the markers on the target, for static tracepoints
13444 that have not been set by marker id. Static tracepoint that have
13445 been set by marker id are reset by marker id in breakpoint_re_set.
13446 The heuristic is:
13447
13448 1) For a tracepoint set at a specific address, look for a marker at
13449 the old PC. If one is found there, assume to be the same marker.
13450 If the name / string id of the marker found is different from the
13451 previous known name, assume that means the user renamed the marker
13452 in the sources, and output a warning.
13453
13454 2) For a tracepoint set at a given line number, look for a marker
13455 at the new address of the old line number. If one is found there,
13456 assume to be the same marker. If the name / string id of the
13457 marker found is different from the previous known name, assume that
13458 means the user renamed the marker in the sources, and output a
13459 warning.
13460
13461 3) If a marker is no longer found at the same address or line, it
13462 may mean the marker no longer exists. But it may also just mean
13463 the code changed a bit. Maybe the user added a few lines of code
13464 that made the marker move up or down (in line number terms). Ask
13465 the target for info about the marker with the string id as we knew
13466 it. If found, update line number and address in the matching
13467 static tracepoint. This will get confused if there's more than one
13468 marker with the same ID (possible in UST, although unadvised
13469 precisely because it confuses tools). */
13470
13471 static struct symtab_and_line
13472 update_static_tracepoint (struct breakpoint *b, struct symtab_and_line sal)
13473 {
13474 struct tracepoint *tp = (struct tracepoint *) b;
13475 struct static_tracepoint_marker marker;
13476 CORE_ADDR pc;
13477
13478 pc = sal.pc;
13479 if (sal.line)
13480 find_line_pc (sal.symtab, sal.line, &pc);
13481
13482 if (target_static_tracepoint_marker_at (pc, &marker))
13483 {
13484 if (strcmp (tp->static_trace_marker_id, marker.str_id) != 0)
13485 warning (_("static tracepoint %d changed probed marker from %s to %s"),
13486 b->number,
13487 tp->static_trace_marker_id, marker.str_id);
13488
13489 xfree (tp->static_trace_marker_id);
13490 tp->static_trace_marker_id = xstrdup (marker.str_id);
13491 release_static_tracepoint_marker (&marker);
13492
13493 return sal;
13494 }
13495
13496 /* Old marker wasn't found on target at lineno. Try looking it up
13497 by string ID. */
13498 if (!sal.explicit_pc
13499 && sal.line != 0
13500 && sal.symtab != NULL
13501 && tp->static_trace_marker_id != NULL)
13502 {
13503 VEC(static_tracepoint_marker_p) *markers;
13504
13505 markers
13506 = target_static_tracepoint_markers_by_strid (tp->static_trace_marker_id);
13507
13508 if (!VEC_empty(static_tracepoint_marker_p, markers))
13509 {
13510 struct symbol *sym;
13511 struct static_tracepoint_marker *tpmarker;
13512 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
13513 struct explicit_location explicit_loc;
13514
13515 tpmarker = VEC_index (static_tracepoint_marker_p, markers, 0);
13516
13517 xfree (tp->static_trace_marker_id);
13518 tp->static_trace_marker_id = xstrdup (tpmarker->str_id);
13519
13520 warning (_("marker for static tracepoint %d (%s) not "
13521 "found at previous line number"),
13522 b->number, tp->static_trace_marker_id);
13523
13524 symtab_and_line sal2 = find_pc_line (tpmarker->address, 0);
13525 sym = find_pc_sect_function (tpmarker->address, NULL);
13526 uiout->text ("Now in ");
13527 if (sym)
13528 {
13529 uiout->field_string ("func", SYMBOL_PRINT_NAME (sym));
13530 uiout->text (" at ");
13531 }
13532 uiout->field_string ("file",
13533 symtab_to_filename_for_display (sal2.symtab));
13534 uiout->text (":");
13535
13536 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
13537 {
13538 const char *fullname = symtab_to_fullname (sal2.symtab);
13539
13540 uiout->field_string ("fullname", fullname);
13541 }
13542
13543 uiout->field_int ("line", sal2.line);
13544 uiout->text ("\n");
13545
13546 b->loc->line_number = sal2.line;
13547 b->loc->symtab = sym != NULL ? sal2.symtab : NULL;
13548
13549 b->location.reset (NULL);
13550 initialize_explicit_location (&explicit_loc);
13551 explicit_loc.source_filename
13552 = ASTRDUP (symtab_to_filename_for_display (sal2.symtab));
13553 explicit_loc.line_offset.offset = b->loc->line_number;
13554 explicit_loc.line_offset.sign = LINE_OFFSET_NONE;
13555 b->location = new_explicit_location (&explicit_loc);
13556
13557 /* Might be nice to check if function changed, and warn if
13558 so. */
13559
13560 release_static_tracepoint_marker (tpmarker);
13561 }
13562 }
13563 return sal;
13564 }
13565
13566 /* Returns 1 iff locations A and B are sufficiently same that
13567 we don't need to report breakpoint as changed. */
13568
13569 static int
13570 locations_are_equal (struct bp_location *a, struct bp_location *b)
13571 {
13572 while (a && b)
13573 {
13574 if (a->address != b->address)
13575 return 0;
13576
13577 if (a->shlib_disabled != b->shlib_disabled)
13578 return 0;
13579
13580 if (a->enabled != b->enabled)
13581 return 0;
13582
13583 a = a->next;
13584 b = b->next;
13585 }
13586
13587 if ((a == NULL) != (b == NULL))
13588 return 0;
13589
13590 return 1;
13591 }
13592
13593 /* Split all locations of B that are bound to PSPACE out of B's
13594 location list to a separate list and return that list's head. If
13595 PSPACE is NULL, hoist out all locations of B. */
13596
13597 static struct bp_location *
13598 hoist_existing_locations (struct breakpoint *b, struct program_space *pspace)
13599 {
13600 struct bp_location head;
13601 struct bp_location *i = b->loc;
13602 struct bp_location **i_link = &b->loc;
13603 struct bp_location *hoisted = &head;
13604
13605 if (pspace == NULL)
13606 {
13607 i = b->loc;
13608 b->loc = NULL;
13609 return i;
13610 }
13611
13612 head.next = NULL;
13613
13614 while (i != NULL)
13615 {
13616 if (i->pspace == pspace)
13617 {
13618 *i_link = i->next;
13619 i->next = NULL;
13620 hoisted->next = i;
13621 hoisted = i;
13622 }
13623 else
13624 i_link = &i->next;
13625 i = *i_link;
13626 }
13627
13628 return head.next;
13629 }
13630
13631 /* Create new breakpoint locations for B (a hardware or software
13632 breakpoint) based on SALS and SALS_END. If SALS_END.NELTS is not
13633 zero, then B is a ranged breakpoint. Only recreates locations for
13634 FILTER_PSPACE. Locations of other program spaces are left
13635 untouched. */
13636
13637 void
13638 update_breakpoint_locations (struct breakpoint *b,
13639 struct program_space *filter_pspace,
13640 gdb::array_view<const symtab_and_line> sals,
13641 gdb::array_view<const symtab_and_line> sals_end)
13642 {
13643 struct bp_location *existing_locations;
13644
13645 if (!sals_end.empty () && (sals.size () != 1 || sals_end.size () != 1))
13646 {
13647 /* Ranged breakpoints have only one start location and one end
13648 location. */
13649 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
13650 printf_unfiltered (_("Could not reset ranged breakpoint %d: "
13651 "multiple locations found\n"),
13652 b->number);
13653 return;
13654 }
13655
13656 /* If there's no new locations, and all existing locations are
13657 pending, don't do anything. This optimizes the common case where
13658 all locations are in the same shared library, that was unloaded.
13659 We'd like to retain the location, so that when the library is
13660 loaded again, we don't loose the enabled/disabled status of the
13661 individual locations. */
13662 if (all_locations_are_pending (b, filter_pspace) && sals.empty ())
13663 return;
13664
13665 existing_locations = hoist_existing_locations (b, filter_pspace);
13666
13667 for (const auto &sal : sals)
13668 {
13669 struct bp_location *new_loc;
13670
13671 switch_to_program_space_and_thread (sal.pspace);
13672
13673 new_loc = add_location_to_breakpoint (b, &sal);
13674
13675 /* Reparse conditions, they might contain references to the
13676 old symtab. */
13677 if (b->cond_string != NULL)
13678 {
13679 const char *s;
13680
13681 s = b->cond_string;
13682 TRY
13683 {
13684 new_loc->cond = parse_exp_1 (&s, sal.pc,
13685 block_for_pc (sal.pc),
13686 0);
13687 }
13688 CATCH (e, RETURN_MASK_ERROR)
13689 {
13690 warning (_("failed to reevaluate condition "
13691 "for breakpoint %d: %s"),
13692 b->number, e.message);
13693 new_loc->enabled = 0;
13694 }
13695 END_CATCH
13696 }
13697
13698 if (!sals_end.empty ())
13699 {
13700 CORE_ADDR end = find_breakpoint_range_end (sals_end[0]);
13701
13702 new_loc->length = end - sals[0].pc + 1;
13703 }
13704 }
13705
13706 /* If possible, carry over 'disable' status from existing
13707 breakpoints. */
13708 {
13709 struct bp_location *e = existing_locations;
13710 /* If there are multiple breakpoints with the same function name,
13711 e.g. for inline functions, comparing function names won't work.
13712 Instead compare pc addresses; this is just a heuristic as things
13713 may have moved, but in practice it gives the correct answer
13714 often enough until a better solution is found. */
13715 int have_ambiguous_names = ambiguous_names_p (b->loc);
13716
13717 for (; e; e = e->next)
13718 {
13719 if (!e->enabled && e->function_name)
13720 {
13721 struct bp_location *l = b->loc;
13722 if (have_ambiguous_names)
13723 {
13724 for (; l; l = l->next)
13725 if (breakpoint_locations_match (e, l))
13726 {
13727 l->enabled = 0;
13728 break;
13729 }
13730 }
13731 else
13732 {
13733 for (; l; l = l->next)
13734 if (l->function_name
13735 && strcmp (e->function_name, l->function_name) == 0)
13736 {
13737 l->enabled = 0;
13738 break;
13739 }
13740 }
13741 }
13742 }
13743 }
13744
13745 if (!locations_are_equal (existing_locations, b->loc))
13746 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (b);
13747 }
13748
13749 /* Find the SaL locations corresponding to the given LOCATION.
13750 On return, FOUND will be 1 if any SaL was found, zero otherwise. */
13751
13752 static std::vector<symtab_and_line>
13753 location_to_sals (struct breakpoint *b, struct event_location *location,
13754 struct program_space *search_pspace, int *found)
13755 {
13756 struct gdb_exception exception = exception_none;
13757
13758 gdb_assert (b->ops != NULL);
13759
13760 std::vector<symtab_and_line> sals;
13761
13762 TRY
13763 {
13764 sals = b->ops->decode_location (b, location, search_pspace);
13765 }
13766 CATCH (e, RETURN_MASK_ERROR)
13767 {
13768 int not_found_and_ok = 0;
13769
13770 exception = e;
13771
13772 /* For pending breakpoints, it's expected that parsing will
13773 fail until the right shared library is loaded. User has
13774 already told to create pending breakpoints and don't need
13775 extra messages. If breakpoint is in bp_shlib_disabled
13776 state, then user already saw the message about that
13777 breakpoint being disabled, and don't want to see more
13778 errors. */
13779 if (e.error == NOT_FOUND_ERROR
13780 && (b->condition_not_parsed
13781 || (b->loc != NULL
13782 && search_pspace != NULL
13783 && b->loc->pspace != search_pspace)
13784 || (b->loc && b->loc->shlib_disabled)
13785 || (b->loc && b->loc->pspace->executing_startup)
13786 || b->enable_state == bp_disabled))
13787 not_found_and_ok = 1;
13788
13789 if (!not_found_and_ok)
13790 {
13791 /* We surely don't want to warn about the same breakpoint
13792 10 times. One solution, implemented here, is disable
13793 the breakpoint on error. Another solution would be to
13794 have separate 'warning emitted' flag. Since this
13795 happens only when a binary has changed, I don't know
13796 which approach is better. */
13797 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
13798 throw_exception (e);
13799 }
13800 }
13801 END_CATCH
13802
13803 if (exception.reason == 0 || exception.error != NOT_FOUND_ERROR)
13804 {
13805 for (auto &sal : sals)
13806 resolve_sal_pc (&sal);
13807 if (b->condition_not_parsed && b->extra_string != NULL)
13808 {
13809 char *cond_string, *extra_string;
13810 int thread, task;
13811
13812 find_condition_and_thread (b->extra_string, sals[0].pc,
13813 &cond_string, &thread, &task,
13814 &extra_string);
13815 gdb_assert (b->cond_string == NULL);
13816 if (cond_string)
13817 b->cond_string = cond_string;
13818 b->thread = thread;
13819 b->task = task;
13820 if (extra_string)
13821 {
13822 xfree (b->extra_string);
13823 b->extra_string = extra_string;
13824 }
13825 b->condition_not_parsed = 0;
13826 }
13827
13828 if (b->type == bp_static_tracepoint && !strace_marker_p (b))
13829 sals[0] = update_static_tracepoint (b, sals[0]);
13830
13831 *found = 1;
13832 }
13833 else
13834 *found = 0;
13835
13836 return sals;
13837 }
13838
13839 /* The default re_set method, for typical hardware or software
13840 breakpoints. Reevaluate the breakpoint and recreate its
13841 locations. */
13842
13843 static void
13844 breakpoint_re_set_default (struct breakpoint *b)
13845 {
13846 struct program_space *filter_pspace = current_program_space;
13847 std::vector<symtab_and_line> expanded, expanded_end;
13848
13849 int found;
13850 std::vector<symtab_and_line> sals = location_to_sals (b, b->location.get (),
13851 filter_pspace, &found);
13852 if (found)
13853 expanded = std::move (sals);
13854
13855 if (b->location_range_end != NULL)
13856 {
13857 std::vector<symtab_and_line> sals_end
13858 = location_to_sals (b, b->location_range_end.get (),
13859 filter_pspace, &found);
13860 if (found)
13861 expanded_end = std::move (sals_end);
13862 }
13863
13864 update_breakpoint_locations (b, filter_pspace, expanded, expanded_end);
13865 }
13866
13867 /* Default method for creating SALs from an address string. It basically
13868 calls parse_breakpoint_sals. Return 1 for success, zero for failure. */
13869
13870 static void
13871 create_sals_from_location_default (const struct event_location *location,
13872 struct linespec_result *canonical,
13873 enum bptype type_wanted)
13874 {
13875 parse_breakpoint_sals (location, canonical);
13876 }
13877
13878 /* Call create_breakpoints_sal for the given arguments. This is the default
13879 function for the `create_breakpoints_sal' method of
13880 breakpoint_ops. */
13881
13882 static void
13883 create_breakpoints_sal_default (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
13884 struct linespec_result *canonical,
13885 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> cond_string,
13886 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> extra_string,
13887 enum bptype type_wanted,
13888 enum bpdisp disposition,
13889 int thread,
13890 int task, int ignore_count,
13891 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops,
13892 int from_tty, int enabled,
13893 int internal, unsigned flags)
13894 {
13895 create_breakpoints_sal (gdbarch, canonical,
13896 std::move (cond_string),
13897 std::move (extra_string),
13898 type_wanted, disposition,
13899 thread, task, ignore_count, ops, from_tty,
13900 enabled, internal, flags);
13901 }
13902
13903 /* Decode the line represented by S by calling decode_line_full. This is the
13904 default function for the `decode_location' method of breakpoint_ops. */
13905
13906 static std::vector<symtab_and_line>
13907 decode_location_default (struct breakpoint *b,
13908 const struct event_location *location,
13909 struct program_space *search_pspace)
13910 {
13911 struct linespec_result canonical;
13912
13913 decode_line_full (location, DECODE_LINE_FUNFIRSTLINE, search_pspace,
13914 (struct symtab *) NULL, 0,
13915 &canonical, multiple_symbols_all,
13916 b->filter);
13917
13918 /* We should get 0 or 1 resulting SALs. */
13919 gdb_assert (canonical.lsals.size () < 2);
13920
13921 if (!canonical.lsals.empty ())
13922 {
13923 const linespec_sals &lsal = canonical.lsals[0];
13924 return std::move (lsal.sals);
13925 }
13926 return {};
13927 }
13928
13929 /* Reset a breakpoint. */
13930
13931 static void
13932 breakpoint_re_set_one (breakpoint *b)
13933 {
13934 input_radix = b->input_radix;
13935 set_language (b->language);
13936
13937 b->ops->re_set (b);
13938 }
13939
13940 /* Re-set breakpoint locations for the current program space.
13941 Locations bound to other program spaces are left untouched. */
13942
13943 void
13944 breakpoint_re_set (void)
13945 {
13946 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
13947
13948 {
13949 scoped_restore_current_language save_language;
13950 scoped_restore save_input_radix = make_scoped_restore (&input_radix);
13951 scoped_restore_current_pspace_and_thread restore_pspace_thread;
13952
13953 /* Note: we must not try to insert locations until after all
13954 breakpoints have been re-set. Otherwise, e.g., when re-setting
13955 breakpoint 1, we'd insert the locations of breakpoint 2, which
13956 hadn't been re-set yet, and thus may have stale locations. */
13957
13958 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
13959 {
13960 TRY
13961 {
13962 breakpoint_re_set_one (b);
13963 }
13964 CATCH (ex, RETURN_MASK_ALL)
13965 {
13966 exception_fprintf (gdb_stderr, ex,
13967 "Error in re-setting breakpoint %d: ",
13968 b->number);
13969 }
13970 END_CATCH
13971 }
13972
13973 jit_breakpoint_re_set ();
13974 }
13975
13976 create_overlay_event_breakpoint ();
13977 create_longjmp_master_breakpoint ();
13978 create_std_terminate_master_breakpoint ();
13979 create_exception_master_breakpoint ();
13980
13981 /* Now we can insert. */
13982 update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
13983 }
13984 \f
13985 /* Reset the thread number of this breakpoint:
13986
13987 - If the breakpoint is for all threads, leave it as-is.
13988 - Else, reset it to the current thread for inferior_ptid. */
13989 void
13990 breakpoint_re_set_thread (struct breakpoint *b)
13991 {
13992 if (b->thread != -1)
13993 {
13994 if (in_thread_list (inferior_ptid))
13995 b->thread = ptid_to_global_thread_id (inferior_ptid);
13996
13997 /* We're being called after following a fork. The new fork is
13998 selected as current, and unless this was a vfork will have a
13999 different program space from the original thread. Reset that
14000 as well. */
14001 b->loc->pspace = current_program_space;
14002 }
14003 }
14004
14005 /* Set ignore-count of breakpoint number BPTNUM to COUNT.
14006 If from_tty is nonzero, it prints a message to that effect,
14007 which ends with a period (no newline). */
14008
14009 void
14010 set_ignore_count (int bptnum, int count, int from_tty)
14011 {
14012 struct breakpoint *b;
14013
14014 if (count < 0)
14015 count = 0;
14016
14017 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
14018 if (b->number == bptnum)
14019 {
14020 if (is_tracepoint (b))
14021 {
14022 if (from_tty && count != 0)
14023 printf_filtered (_("Ignore count ignored for tracepoint %d."),
14024 bptnum);
14025 return;
14026 }
14027
14028 b->ignore_count = count;
14029 if (from_tty)
14030 {
14031 if (count == 0)
14032 printf_filtered (_("Will stop next time "
14033 "breakpoint %d is reached."),
14034 bptnum);
14035 else if (count == 1)
14036 printf_filtered (_("Will ignore next crossing of breakpoint %d."),
14037 bptnum);
14038 else
14039 printf_filtered (_("Will ignore next %d "
14040 "crossings of breakpoint %d."),
14041 count, bptnum);
14042 }
14043 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (b);
14044 return;
14045 }
14046
14047 error (_("No breakpoint number %d."), bptnum);
14048 }
14049
14050 /* Command to set ignore-count of breakpoint N to COUNT. */
14051
14052 static void
14053 ignore_command (const char *args, int from_tty)
14054 {
14055 const char *p = args;
14056 int num;
14057
14058 if (p == 0)
14059 error_no_arg (_("a breakpoint number"));
14060
14061 num = get_number (&p);
14062 if (num == 0)
14063 error (_("bad breakpoint number: '%s'"), args);
14064 if (*p == 0)
14065 error (_("Second argument (specified ignore-count) is missing."));
14066
14067 set_ignore_count (num,
14068 longest_to_int (value_as_long (parse_and_eval (p))),
14069 from_tty);
14070 if (from_tty)
14071 printf_filtered ("\n");
14072 }
14073 \f
14074
14075 /* Call FUNCTION on each of the breakpoints with numbers in the range
14076 defined by BP_NUM_RANGE (an inclusive range). */
14077
14078 static void
14079 map_breakpoint_number_range (std::pair<int, int> bp_num_range,
14080 gdb::function_view<void (breakpoint *)> function)
14081 {
14082 if (bp_num_range.first == 0)
14083 {
14084 warning (_("bad breakpoint number at or near '%d'"),
14085 bp_num_range.first);
14086 }
14087 else
14088 {
14089 struct breakpoint *b, *tmp;
14090
14091 for (int i = bp_num_range.first; i <= bp_num_range.second; i++)
14092 {
14093 bool match = false;
14094
14095 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, tmp)
14096 if (b->number == i)
14097 {
14098 match = true;
14099 function (b);
14100 break;
14101 }
14102 if (!match)
14103 printf_unfiltered (_("No breakpoint number %d.\n"), i);
14104 }
14105 }
14106 }
14107
14108 /* Call FUNCTION on each of the breakpoints whose numbers are given in
14109 ARGS. */
14110
14111 static void
14112 map_breakpoint_numbers (const char *args,
14113 gdb::function_view<void (breakpoint *)> function)
14114 {
14115 if (args == NULL || *args == '\0')
14116 error_no_arg (_("one or more breakpoint numbers"));
14117
14118 number_or_range_parser parser (args);
14119
14120 while (!parser.finished ())
14121 {
14122 int num = parser.get_number ();
14123 map_breakpoint_number_range (std::make_pair (num, num), function);
14124 }
14125 }
14126
14127 /* Return the breakpoint location structure corresponding to the
14128 BP_NUM and LOC_NUM values. */
14129
14130 static struct bp_location *
14131 find_location_by_number (int bp_num, int loc_num)
14132 {
14133 struct breakpoint *b;
14134
14135 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
14136 if (b->number == bp_num)
14137 {
14138 break;
14139 }
14140
14141 if (!b || b->number != bp_num)
14142 error (_("Bad breakpoint number '%d'"), bp_num);
14143
14144 if (loc_num == 0)
14145 error (_("Bad breakpoint location number '%d'"), loc_num);
14146
14147 int n = 0;
14148 for (bp_location *loc = b->loc; loc != NULL; loc = loc->next)
14149 if (++n == loc_num)
14150 return loc;
14151
14152 error (_("Bad breakpoint location number '%d'"), loc_num);
14153 }
14154
14155 /* Modes of operation for extract_bp_num. */
14156 enum class extract_bp_kind
14157 {
14158 /* Extracting a breakpoint number. */
14159 bp,
14160
14161 /* Extracting a location number. */
14162 loc,
14163 };
14164
14165 /* Extract a breakpoint or location number (as determined by KIND)
14166 from the string starting at START. TRAILER is a character which
14167 can be found after the number. If you don't want a trailer, use
14168 '\0'. If END_OUT is not NULL, it is set to point after the parsed
14169 string. This always returns a positive integer. */
14170
14171 static int
14172 extract_bp_num (extract_bp_kind kind, const char *start,
14173 int trailer, const char **end_out = NULL)
14174 {
14175 const char *end = start;
14176 int num = get_number_trailer (&end, trailer);
14177 if (num < 0)
14178 error (kind == extract_bp_kind::bp
14179 ? _("Negative breakpoint number '%.*s'")
14180 : _("Negative breakpoint location number '%.*s'"),
14181 int (end - start), start);
14182 if (num == 0)
14183 error (kind == extract_bp_kind::bp
14184 ? _("Bad breakpoint number '%.*s'")
14185 : _("Bad breakpoint location number '%.*s'"),
14186 int (end - start), start);
14187
14188 if (end_out != NULL)
14189 *end_out = end;
14190 return num;
14191 }
14192
14193 /* Extract a breakpoint or location range (as determined by KIND) in
14194 the form NUM1-NUM2 stored at &ARG[arg_offset]. Returns a std::pair
14195 representing the (inclusive) range. The returned pair's elements
14196 are always positive integers. */
14197
14198 static std::pair<int, int>
14199 extract_bp_or_bp_range (extract_bp_kind kind,
14200 const std::string &arg,
14201 std::string::size_type arg_offset)
14202 {
14203 std::pair<int, int> range;
14204 const char *bp_loc = &arg[arg_offset];
14205 std::string::size_type dash = arg.find ('-', arg_offset);
14206 if (dash != std::string::npos)
14207 {
14208 /* bp_loc is a range (x-z). */
14209 if (arg.length () == dash + 1)
14210 error (kind == extract_bp_kind::bp
14211 ? _("Bad breakpoint number at or near: '%s'")
14212 : _("Bad breakpoint location number at or near: '%s'"),
14213 bp_loc);
14214
14215 const char *end;
14216 const char *start_first = bp_loc;
14217 const char *start_second = &arg[dash + 1];
14218 range.first = extract_bp_num (kind, start_first, '-');
14219 range.second = extract_bp_num (kind, start_second, '\0', &end);
14220
14221 if (range.first > range.second)
14222 error (kind == extract_bp_kind::bp
14223 ? _("Inverted breakpoint range at '%.*s'")
14224 : _("Inverted breakpoint location range at '%.*s'"),
14225 int (end - start_first), start_first);
14226 }
14227 else
14228 {
14229 /* bp_loc is a single value. */
14230 range.first = extract_bp_num (kind, bp_loc, '\0');
14231 range.second = range.first;
14232 }
14233 return range;
14234 }
14235
14236 /* Extract the breakpoint/location range specified by ARG. Returns
14237 the breakpoint range in BP_NUM_RANGE, and the location range in
14238 BP_LOC_RANGE.
14239
14240 ARG may be in any of the following forms:
14241
14242 x where 'x' is a breakpoint number.
14243 x-y where 'x' and 'y' specify a breakpoint numbers range.
14244 x.y where 'x' is a breakpoint number and 'y' a location number.
14245 x.y-z where 'x' is a breakpoint number and 'y' and 'z' specify a
14246 location number range.
14247 */
14248
14249 static void
14250 extract_bp_number_and_location (const std::string &arg,
14251 std::pair<int, int> &bp_num_range,
14252 std::pair<int, int> &bp_loc_range)
14253 {
14254 std::string::size_type dot = arg.find ('.');
14255
14256 if (dot != std::string::npos)
14257 {
14258 /* Handle 'x.y' and 'x.y-z' cases. */
14259
14260 if (arg.length () == dot + 1 || dot == 0)
14261 error (_("Bad breakpoint number at or near: '%s'"), arg.c_str ());
14262
14263 bp_num_range.first
14264 = extract_bp_num (extract_bp_kind::bp, arg.c_str (), '.');
14265 bp_num_range.second = bp_num_range.first;
14266
14267 bp_loc_range = extract_bp_or_bp_range (extract_bp_kind::loc,
14268 arg, dot + 1);
14269 }
14270 else
14271 {
14272 /* Handle x and x-y cases. */
14273
14274 bp_num_range = extract_bp_or_bp_range (extract_bp_kind::bp, arg, 0);
14275 bp_loc_range.first = 0;
14276 bp_loc_range.second = 0;
14277 }
14278 }
14279
14280 /* Enable or disable a breakpoint location BP_NUM.LOC_NUM. ENABLE
14281 specifies whether to enable or disable. */
14282
14283 static void
14284 enable_disable_bp_num_loc (int bp_num, int loc_num, bool enable)
14285 {
14286 struct bp_location *loc = find_location_by_number (bp_num, loc_num);
14287 if (loc != NULL)
14288 {
14289 if (loc->enabled != enable)
14290 {
14291 loc->enabled = enable;
14292 mark_breakpoint_location_modified (loc);
14293 }
14294 if (target_supports_enable_disable_tracepoint ()
14295 && current_trace_status ()->running && loc->owner
14296 && is_tracepoint (loc->owner))
14297 target_disable_tracepoint (loc);
14298 }
14299 update_global_location_list (UGLL_DONT_INSERT);
14300 }
14301
14302 /* Enable or disable a range of breakpoint locations. BP_NUM is the
14303 number of the breakpoint, and BP_LOC_RANGE specifies the
14304 (inclusive) range of location numbers of that breakpoint to
14305 enable/disable. ENABLE specifies whether to enable or disable the
14306 location. */
14307
14308 static void
14309 enable_disable_breakpoint_location_range (int bp_num,
14310 std::pair<int, int> &bp_loc_range,
14311 bool enable)
14312 {
14313 for (int i = bp_loc_range.first; i <= bp_loc_range.second; i++)
14314 enable_disable_bp_num_loc (bp_num, i, enable);
14315 }
14316
14317 /* Set ignore-count of breakpoint number BPTNUM to COUNT.
14318 If from_tty is nonzero, it prints a message to that effect,
14319 which ends with a period (no newline). */
14320
14321 void
14322 disable_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *bpt)
14323 {
14324 /* Never disable a watchpoint scope breakpoint; we want to
14325 hit them when we leave scope so we can delete both the
14326 watchpoint and its scope breakpoint at that time. */
14327 if (bpt->type == bp_watchpoint_scope)
14328 return;
14329
14330 bpt->enable_state = bp_disabled;
14331
14332 /* Mark breakpoint locations modified. */
14333 mark_breakpoint_modified (bpt);
14334
14335 if (target_supports_enable_disable_tracepoint ()
14336 && current_trace_status ()->running && is_tracepoint (bpt))
14337 {
14338 struct bp_location *location;
14339
14340 for (location = bpt->loc; location; location = location->next)
14341 target_disable_tracepoint (location);
14342 }
14343
14344 update_global_location_list (UGLL_DONT_INSERT);
14345
14346 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (bpt);
14347 }
14348
14349 /* Enable or disable the breakpoint(s) or breakpoint location(s)
14350 specified in ARGS. ARGS may be in any of the formats handled by
14351 extract_bp_number_and_location. ENABLE specifies whether to enable
14352 or disable the breakpoints/locations. */
14353
14354 static void
14355 enable_disable_command (const char *args, int from_tty, bool enable)
14356 {
14357 if (args == 0)
14358 {
14359 struct breakpoint *bpt;
14360
14361 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (bpt)
14362 if (user_breakpoint_p (bpt))
14363 {
14364 if (enable)
14365 enable_breakpoint (bpt);
14366 else
14367 disable_breakpoint (bpt);
14368 }
14369 }
14370 else
14371 {
14372 std::string num = extract_arg (&args);
14373
14374 while (!num.empty ())
14375 {
14376 std::pair<int, int> bp_num_range, bp_loc_range;
14377
14378 extract_bp_number_and_location (num, bp_num_range, bp_loc_range);
14379
14380 if (bp_loc_range.first == bp_loc_range.second
14381 && bp_loc_range.first == 0)
14382 {
14383 /* Handle breakpoint ids with formats 'x' or 'x-z'. */
14384 map_breakpoint_number_range (bp_num_range,
14385 enable
14386 ? enable_breakpoint
14387 : disable_breakpoint);
14388 }
14389 else
14390 {
14391 /* Handle breakpoint ids with formats 'x.y' or
14392 'x.y-z'. */
14393 enable_disable_breakpoint_location_range
14394 (bp_num_range.first, bp_loc_range, enable);
14395 }
14396 num = extract_arg (&args);
14397 }
14398 }
14399 }
14400
14401 /* The disable command disables the specified breakpoints/locations
14402 (or all defined breakpoints) so they're no longer effective in
14403 stopping the inferior. ARGS may be in any of the forms defined in
14404 extract_bp_number_and_location. */
14405
14406 static void
14407 disable_command (const char *args, int from_tty)
14408 {
14409 enable_disable_command (args, from_tty, false);
14410 }
14411
14412 static void
14413 enable_breakpoint_disp (struct breakpoint *bpt, enum bpdisp disposition,
14414 int count)
14415 {
14416 int target_resources_ok;
14417
14418 if (bpt->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint)
14419 {
14420 int i;
14421 i = hw_breakpoint_used_count ();
14422 target_resources_ok =
14423 target_can_use_hardware_watchpoint (bp_hardware_breakpoint,
14424 i + 1, 0);
14425 if (target_resources_ok == 0)
14426 error (_("No hardware breakpoint support in the target."));
14427 else if (target_resources_ok < 0)
14428 error (_("Hardware breakpoints used exceeds limit."));
14429 }
14430
14431 if (is_watchpoint (bpt))
14432 {
14433 /* Initialize it just to avoid a GCC false warning. */
14434 enum enable_state orig_enable_state = bp_disabled;
14435
14436 TRY
14437 {
14438 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) bpt;
14439
14440 orig_enable_state = bpt->enable_state;
14441 bpt->enable_state = bp_enabled;
14442 update_watchpoint (w, 1 /* reparse */);
14443 }
14444 CATCH (e, RETURN_MASK_ALL)
14445 {
14446 bpt->enable_state = orig_enable_state;
14447 exception_fprintf (gdb_stderr, e, _("Cannot enable watchpoint %d: "),
14448 bpt->number);
14449 return;
14450 }
14451 END_CATCH
14452 }
14453
14454 bpt->enable_state = bp_enabled;
14455
14456 /* Mark breakpoint locations modified. */
14457 mark_breakpoint_modified (bpt);
14458
14459 if (target_supports_enable_disable_tracepoint ()
14460 && current_trace_status ()->running && is_tracepoint (bpt))
14461 {
14462 struct bp_location *location;
14463
14464 for (location = bpt->loc; location; location = location->next)
14465 target_enable_tracepoint (location);
14466 }
14467
14468 bpt->disposition = disposition;
14469 bpt->enable_count = count;
14470 update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
14471
14472 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (bpt);
14473 }
14474
14475
14476 void
14477 enable_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *bpt)
14478 {
14479 enable_breakpoint_disp (bpt, bpt->disposition, 0);
14480 }
14481
14482 /* The enable command enables the specified breakpoints/locations (or
14483 all defined breakpoints) so they once again become (or continue to
14484 be) effective in stopping the inferior. ARGS may be in any of the
14485 forms defined in extract_bp_number_and_location. */
14486
14487 static void
14488 enable_command (const char *args, int from_tty)
14489 {
14490 enable_disable_command (args, from_tty, true);
14491 }
14492
14493 static void
14494 enable_once_command (const char *args, int from_tty)
14495 {
14496 map_breakpoint_numbers
14497 (args, [&] (breakpoint *b)
14498 {
14499 iterate_over_related_breakpoints
14500 (b, [&] (breakpoint *bpt)
14501 {
14502 enable_breakpoint_disp (bpt, disp_disable, 1);
14503 });
14504 });
14505 }
14506
14507 static void
14508 enable_count_command (const char *args, int from_tty)
14509 {
14510 int count;
14511
14512 if (args == NULL)
14513 error_no_arg (_("hit count"));
14514
14515 count = get_number (&args);
14516
14517 map_breakpoint_numbers
14518 (args, [&] (breakpoint *b)
14519 {
14520 iterate_over_related_breakpoints
14521 (b, [&] (breakpoint *bpt)
14522 {
14523 enable_breakpoint_disp (bpt, disp_disable, count);
14524 });
14525 });
14526 }
14527
14528 static void
14529 enable_delete_command (const char *args, int from_tty)
14530 {
14531 map_breakpoint_numbers
14532 (args, [&] (breakpoint *b)
14533 {
14534 iterate_over_related_breakpoints
14535 (b, [&] (breakpoint *bpt)
14536 {
14537 enable_breakpoint_disp (bpt, disp_del, 1);
14538 });
14539 });
14540 }
14541 \f
14542 static void
14543 set_breakpoint_cmd (const char *args, int from_tty)
14544 {
14545 }
14546
14547 static void
14548 show_breakpoint_cmd (const char *args, int from_tty)
14549 {
14550 }
14551
14552 /* Invalidate last known value of any hardware watchpoint if
14553 the memory which that value represents has been written to by
14554 GDB itself. */
14555
14556 static void
14557 invalidate_bp_value_on_memory_change (struct inferior *inferior,
14558 CORE_ADDR addr, ssize_t len,
14559 const bfd_byte *data)
14560 {
14561 struct breakpoint *bp;
14562
14563 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (bp)
14564 if (bp->enable_state == bp_enabled
14565 && bp->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint)
14566 {
14567 struct watchpoint *wp = (struct watchpoint *) bp;
14568
14569 if (wp->val_valid && wp->val)
14570 {
14571 struct bp_location *loc;
14572
14573 for (loc = bp->loc; loc != NULL; loc = loc->next)
14574 if (loc->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_watchpoint
14575 && loc->address + loc->length > addr
14576 && addr + len > loc->address)
14577 {
14578 value_free (wp->val);
14579 wp->val = NULL;
14580 wp->val_valid = 0;
14581 }
14582 }
14583 }
14584 }
14585
14586 /* Create and insert a breakpoint for software single step. */
14587
14588 void
14589 insert_single_step_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
14590 const address_space *aspace,
14591 CORE_ADDR next_pc)
14592 {
14593 struct thread_info *tp = inferior_thread ();
14594 struct symtab_and_line sal;
14595 CORE_ADDR pc = next_pc;
14596
14597 if (tp->control.single_step_breakpoints == NULL)
14598 {
14599 tp->control.single_step_breakpoints
14600 = new_single_step_breakpoint (tp->global_num, gdbarch);
14601 }
14602
14603 sal = find_pc_line (pc, 0);
14604 sal.pc = pc;
14605 sal.section = find_pc_overlay (pc);
14606 sal.explicit_pc = 1;
14607 add_location_to_breakpoint (tp->control.single_step_breakpoints, &sal);
14608
14609 update_global_location_list (UGLL_INSERT);
14610 }
14611
14612 /* Insert single step breakpoints according to the current state. */
14613
14614 int
14615 insert_single_step_breakpoints (struct gdbarch *gdbarch)
14616 {
14617 struct regcache *regcache = get_current_regcache ();
14618 std::vector<CORE_ADDR> next_pcs;
14619
14620 next_pcs = gdbarch_software_single_step (gdbarch, regcache);
14621
14622 if (!next_pcs.empty ())
14623 {
14624 struct frame_info *frame = get_current_frame ();
14625 const address_space *aspace = get_frame_address_space (frame);
14626
14627 for (CORE_ADDR pc : next_pcs)
14628 insert_single_step_breakpoint (gdbarch, aspace, pc);
14629
14630 return 1;
14631 }
14632 else
14633 return 0;
14634 }
14635
14636 /* See breakpoint.h. */
14637
14638 int
14639 breakpoint_has_location_inserted_here (struct breakpoint *bp,
14640 const address_space *aspace,
14641 CORE_ADDR pc)
14642 {
14643 struct bp_location *loc;
14644
14645 for (loc = bp->loc; loc != NULL; loc = loc->next)
14646 if (loc->inserted
14647 && breakpoint_location_address_match (loc, aspace, pc))
14648 return 1;
14649
14650 return 0;
14651 }
14652
14653 /* Check whether a software single-step breakpoint is inserted at
14654 PC. */
14655
14656 int
14657 single_step_breakpoint_inserted_here_p (const address_space *aspace,
14658 CORE_ADDR pc)
14659 {
14660 struct breakpoint *bpt;
14661
14662 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (bpt)
14663 {
14664 if (bpt->type == bp_single_step
14665 && breakpoint_has_location_inserted_here (bpt, aspace, pc))
14666 return 1;
14667 }
14668 return 0;
14669 }
14670
14671 /* Tracepoint-specific operations. */
14672
14673 /* Set tracepoint count to NUM. */
14674 static void
14675 set_tracepoint_count (int num)
14676 {
14677 tracepoint_count = num;
14678 set_internalvar_integer (lookup_internalvar ("tpnum"), num);
14679 }
14680
14681 static void
14682 trace_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
14683 {
14684 struct breakpoint_ops *ops;
14685
14686 event_location_up location = string_to_event_location (&arg,
14687 current_language);
14688 if (location != NULL
14689 && event_location_type (location.get ()) == PROBE_LOCATION)
14690 ops = &tracepoint_probe_breakpoint_ops;
14691 else
14692 ops = &tracepoint_breakpoint_ops;
14693
14694 create_breakpoint (get_current_arch (),
14695 location.get (),
14696 NULL, 0, arg, 1 /* parse arg */,
14697 0 /* tempflag */,
14698 bp_tracepoint /* type_wanted */,
14699 0 /* Ignore count */,
14700 pending_break_support,
14701 ops,
14702 from_tty,
14703 1 /* enabled */,
14704 0 /* internal */, 0);
14705 }
14706
14707 static void
14708 ftrace_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
14709 {
14710 event_location_up location = string_to_event_location (&arg,
14711 current_language);
14712 create_breakpoint (get_current_arch (),
14713 location.get (),
14714 NULL, 0, arg, 1 /* parse arg */,
14715 0 /* tempflag */,
14716 bp_fast_tracepoint /* type_wanted */,
14717 0 /* Ignore count */,
14718 pending_break_support,
14719 &tracepoint_breakpoint_ops,
14720 from_tty,
14721 1 /* enabled */,
14722 0 /* internal */, 0);
14723 }
14724
14725 /* strace command implementation. Creates a static tracepoint. */
14726
14727 static void
14728 strace_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
14729 {
14730 struct breakpoint_ops *ops;
14731 event_location_up location;
14732
14733 /* Decide if we are dealing with a static tracepoint marker (`-m'),
14734 or with a normal static tracepoint. */
14735 if (arg && startswith (arg, "-m") && isspace (arg[2]))
14736 {
14737 ops = &strace_marker_breakpoint_ops;
14738 location = new_linespec_location (&arg, symbol_name_match_type::FULL);
14739 }
14740 else
14741 {
14742 ops = &tracepoint_breakpoint_ops;
14743 location = string_to_event_location (&arg, current_language);
14744 }
14745
14746 create_breakpoint (get_current_arch (),
14747 location.get (),
14748 NULL, 0, arg, 1 /* parse arg */,
14749 0 /* tempflag */,
14750 bp_static_tracepoint /* type_wanted */,
14751 0 /* Ignore count */,
14752 pending_break_support,
14753 ops,
14754 from_tty,
14755 1 /* enabled */,
14756 0 /* internal */, 0);
14757 }
14758
14759 /* Set up a fake reader function that gets command lines from a linked
14760 list that was acquired during tracepoint uploading. */
14761
14762 static struct uploaded_tp *this_utp;
14763 static int next_cmd;
14764
14765 static char *
14766 read_uploaded_action (void)
14767 {
14768 char *rslt;
14769
14770 VEC_iterate (char_ptr, this_utp->cmd_strings, next_cmd, rslt);
14771
14772 next_cmd++;
14773
14774 return rslt;
14775 }
14776
14777 /* Given information about a tracepoint as recorded on a target (which
14778 can be either a live system or a trace file), attempt to create an
14779 equivalent GDB tracepoint. This is not a reliable process, since
14780 the target does not necessarily have all the information used when
14781 the tracepoint was originally defined. */
14782
14783 struct tracepoint *
14784 create_tracepoint_from_upload (struct uploaded_tp *utp)
14785 {
14786 const char *addr_str;
14787 char small_buf[100];
14788 struct tracepoint *tp;
14789
14790 if (utp->at_string)
14791 addr_str = utp->at_string;
14792 else
14793 {
14794 /* In the absence of a source location, fall back to raw
14795 address. Since there is no way to confirm that the address
14796 means the same thing as when the trace was started, warn the
14797 user. */
14798 warning (_("Uploaded tracepoint %d has no "
14799 "source location, using raw address"),
14800 utp->number);
14801 xsnprintf (small_buf, sizeof (small_buf), "*%s", hex_string (utp->addr));
14802 addr_str = small_buf;
14803 }
14804
14805 /* There's not much we can do with a sequence of bytecodes. */
14806 if (utp->cond && !utp->cond_string)
14807 warning (_("Uploaded tracepoint %d condition "
14808 "has no source form, ignoring it"),
14809 utp->number);
14810
14811 event_location_up location = string_to_event_location (&addr_str,
14812 current_language);
14813 if (!create_breakpoint (get_current_arch (),
14814 location.get (),
14815 utp->cond_string, -1, addr_str,
14816 0 /* parse cond/thread */,
14817 0 /* tempflag */,
14818 utp->type /* type_wanted */,
14819 0 /* Ignore count */,
14820 pending_break_support,
14821 &tracepoint_breakpoint_ops,
14822 0 /* from_tty */,
14823 utp->enabled /* enabled */,
14824 0 /* internal */,
14825 CREATE_BREAKPOINT_FLAGS_INSERTED))
14826 return NULL;
14827
14828 /* Get the tracepoint we just created. */
14829 tp = get_tracepoint (tracepoint_count);
14830 gdb_assert (tp != NULL);
14831
14832 if (utp->pass > 0)
14833 {
14834 xsnprintf (small_buf, sizeof (small_buf), "%d %d", utp->pass,
14835 tp->number);
14836
14837 trace_pass_command (small_buf, 0);
14838 }
14839
14840 /* If we have uploaded versions of the original commands, set up a
14841 special-purpose "reader" function and call the usual command line
14842 reader, then pass the result to the breakpoint command-setting
14843 function. */
14844 if (!VEC_empty (char_ptr, utp->cmd_strings))
14845 {
14846 command_line_up cmd_list;
14847
14848 this_utp = utp;
14849 next_cmd = 0;
14850
14851 cmd_list = read_command_lines_1 (read_uploaded_action, 1, NULL, NULL);
14852
14853 breakpoint_set_commands (tp, std::move (cmd_list));
14854 }
14855 else if (!VEC_empty (char_ptr, utp->actions)
14856 || !VEC_empty (char_ptr, utp->step_actions))
14857 warning (_("Uploaded tracepoint %d actions "
14858 "have no source form, ignoring them"),
14859 utp->number);
14860
14861 /* Copy any status information that might be available. */
14862 tp->hit_count = utp->hit_count;
14863 tp->traceframe_usage = utp->traceframe_usage;
14864
14865 return tp;
14866 }
14867
14868 /* Print information on tracepoint number TPNUM_EXP, or all if
14869 omitted. */
14870
14871 static void
14872 info_tracepoints_command (const char *args, int from_tty)
14873 {
14874 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
14875 int num_printed;
14876
14877 num_printed = breakpoint_1 (args, 0, is_tracepoint);
14878
14879 if (num_printed == 0)
14880 {
14881 if (args == NULL || *args == '\0')
14882 uiout->message ("No tracepoints.\n");
14883 else
14884 uiout->message ("No tracepoint matching '%s'.\n", args);
14885 }
14886
14887 default_collect_info ();
14888 }
14889
14890 /* The 'enable trace' command enables tracepoints.
14891 Not supported by all targets. */
14892 static void
14893 enable_trace_command (const char *args, int from_tty)
14894 {
14895 enable_command (args, from_tty);
14896 }
14897
14898 /* The 'disable trace' command disables tracepoints.
14899 Not supported by all targets. */
14900 static void
14901 disable_trace_command (const char *args, int from_tty)
14902 {
14903 disable_command (args, from_tty);
14904 }
14905
14906 /* Remove a tracepoint (or all if no argument). */
14907 static void
14908 delete_trace_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
14909 {
14910 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
14911
14912 dont_repeat ();
14913
14914 if (arg == 0)
14915 {
14916 int breaks_to_delete = 0;
14917
14918 /* Delete all breakpoints if no argument.
14919 Do not delete internal or call-dummy breakpoints, these
14920 have to be deleted with an explicit breakpoint number
14921 argument. */
14922 ALL_TRACEPOINTS (b)
14923 if (is_tracepoint (b) && user_breakpoint_p (b))
14924 {
14925 breaks_to_delete = 1;
14926 break;
14927 }
14928
14929 /* Ask user only if there are some breakpoints to delete. */
14930 if (!from_tty
14931 || (breaks_to_delete && query (_("Delete all tracepoints? "))))
14932 {
14933 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
14934 if (is_tracepoint (b) && user_breakpoint_p (b))
14935 delete_breakpoint (b);
14936 }
14937 }
14938 else
14939 map_breakpoint_numbers
14940 (arg, [&] (breakpoint *b)
14941 {
14942 iterate_over_related_breakpoints (b, delete_breakpoint);
14943 });
14944 }
14945
14946 /* Helper function for trace_pass_command. */
14947
14948 static void
14949 trace_pass_set_count (struct tracepoint *tp, int count, int from_tty)
14950 {
14951 tp->pass_count = count;
14952 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (tp);
14953 if (from_tty)
14954 printf_filtered (_("Setting tracepoint %d's passcount to %d\n"),
14955 tp->number, count);
14956 }
14957
14958 /* Set passcount for tracepoint.
14959
14960 First command argument is passcount, second is tracepoint number.
14961 If tracepoint number omitted, apply to most recently defined.
14962 Also accepts special argument "all". */
14963
14964 static void
14965 trace_pass_command (const char *args, int from_tty)
14966 {
14967 struct tracepoint *t1;
14968 ULONGEST count;
14969
14970 if (args == 0 || *args == 0)
14971 error (_("passcount command requires an "
14972 "argument (count + optional TP num)"));
14973
14974 count = strtoulst (args, &args, 10); /* Count comes first, then TP num. */
14975
14976 args = skip_spaces (args);
14977 if (*args && strncasecmp (args, "all", 3) == 0)
14978 {
14979 struct breakpoint *b;
14980
14981 args += 3; /* Skip special argument "all". */
14982 if (*args)
14983 error (_("Junk at end of arguments."));
14984
14985 ALL_TRACEPOINTS (b)
14986 {
14987 t1 = (struct tracepoint *) b;
14988 trace_pass_set_count (t1, count, from_tty);
14989 }
14990 }
14991 else if (*args == '\0')
14992 {
14993 t1 = get_tracepoint_by_number (&args, NULL);
14994 if (t1)
14995 trace_pass_set_count (t1, count, from_tty);
14996 }
14997 else
14998 {
14999 number_or_range_parser parser (args);
15000 while (!parser.finished ())
15001 {
15002 t1 = get_tracepoint_by_number (&args, &parser);
15003 if (t1)
15004 trace_pass_set_count (t1, count, from_tty);
15005 }
15006 }
15007 }
15008
15009 struct tracepoint *
15010 get_tracepoint (int num)
15011 {
15012 struct breakpoint *t;
15013
15014 ALL_TRACEPOINTS (t)
15015 if (t->number == num)
15016 return (struct tracepoint *) t;
15017
15018 return NULL;
15019 }
15020
15021 /* Find the tracepoint with the given target-side number (which may be
15022 different from the tracepoint number after disconnecting and
15023 reconnecting). */
15024
15025 struct tracepoint *
15026 get_tracepoint_by_number_on_target (int num)
15027 {
15028 struct breakpoint *b;
15029
15030 ALL_TRACEPOINTS (b)
15031 {
15032 struct tracepoint *t = (struct tracepoint *) b;
15033
15034 if (t->number_on_target == num)
15035 return t;
15036 }
15037
15038 return NULL;
15039 }
15040
15041 /* Utility: parse a tracepoint number and look it up in the list.
15042 If STATE is not NULL, use, get_number_or_range_state and ignore ARG.
15043 If the argument is missing, the most recent tracepoint
15044 (tracepoint_count) is returned. */
15045
15046 struct tracepoint *
15047 get_tracepoint_by_number (const char **arg,
15048 number_or_range_parser *parser)
15049 {
15050 struct breakpoint *t;
15051 int tpnum;
15052 const char *instring = arg == NULL ? NULL : *arg;
15053
15054 if (parser != NULL)
15055 {
15056 gdb_assert (!parser->finished ());
15057 tpnum = parser->get_number ();
15058 }
15059 else if (arg == NULL || *arg == NULL || ! **arg)
15060 tpnum = tracepoint_count;
15061 else
15062 tpnum = get_number (arg);
15063
15064 if (tpnum <= 0)
15065 {
15066 if (instring && *instring)
15067 printf_filtered (_("bad tracepoint number at or near '%s'\n"),
15068 instring);
15069 else
15070 printf_filtered (_("No previous tracepoint\n"));
15071 return NULL;
15072 }
15073
15074 ALL_TRACEPOINTS (t)
15075 if (t->number == tpnum)
15076 {
15077 return (struct tracepoint *) t;
15078 }
15079
15080 printf_unfiltered ("No tracepoint number %d.\n", tpnum);
15081 return NULL;
15082 }
15083
15084 void
15085 print_recreate_thread (struct breakpoint *b, struct ui_file *fp)
15086 {
15087 if (b->thread != -1)
15088 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " thread %d", b->thread);
15089
15090 if (b->task != 0)
15091 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " task %d", b->task);
15092
15093 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "\n");
15094 }
15095
15096 /* Save information on user settable breakpoints (watchpoints, etc) to
15097 a new script file named FILENAME. If FILTER is non-NULL, call it
15098 on each breakpoint and only include the ones for which it returns
15099 non-zero. */
15100
15101 static void
15102 save_breakpoints (const char *filename, int from_tty,
15103 int (*filter) (const struct breakpoint *))
15104 {
15105 struct breakpoint *tp;
15106 int any = 0;
15107 int extra_trace_bits = 0;
15108
15109 if (filename == 0 || *filename == 0)
15110 error (_("Argument required (file name in which to save)"));
15111
15112 /* See if we have anything to save. */
15113 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (tp)
15114 {
15115 /* Skip internal and momentary breakpoints. */
15116 if (!user_breakpoint_p (tp))
15117 continue;
15118
15119 /* If we have a filter, only save the breakpoints it accepts. */
15120 if (filter && !filter (tp))
15121 continue;
15122
15123 any = 1;
15124
15125 if (is_tracepoint (tp))
15126 {
15127 extra_trace_bits = 1;
15128
15129 /* We can stop searching. */
15130 break;
15131 }
15132 }
15133
15134 if (!any)
15135 {
15136 warning (_("Nothing to save."));
15137 return;
15138 }
15139
15140 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> expanded_filename (tilde_expand (filename));
15141
15142 stdio_file fp;
15143
15144 if (!fp.open (expanded_filename.get (), "w"))
15145 error (_("Unable to open file '%s' for saving (%s)"),
15146 expanded_filename.get (), safe_strerror (errno));
15147
15148 if (extra_trace_bits)
15149 save_trace_state_variables (&fp);
15150
15151 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (tp)
15152 {
15153 /* Skip internal and momentary breakpoints. */
15154 if (!user_breakpoint_p (tp))
15155 continue;
15156
15157 /* If we have a filter, only save the breakpoints it accepts. */
15158 if (filter && !filter (tp))
15159 continue;
15160
15161 tp->ops->print_recreate (tp, &fp);
15162
15163 /* Note, we can't rely on tp->number for anything, as we can't
15164 assume the recreated breakpoint numbers will match. Use $bpnum
15165 instead. */
15166
15167 if (tp->cond_string)
15168 fp.printf (" condition $bpnum %s\n", tp->cond_string);
15169
15170 if (tp->ignore_count)
15171 fp.printf (" ignore $bpnum %d\n", tp->ignore_count);
15172
15173 if (tp->type != bp_dprintf && tp->commands)
15174 {
15175 fp.puts (" commands\n");
15176
15177 current_uiout->redirect (&fp);
15178 TRY
15179 {
15180 print_command_lines (current_uiout, tp->commands.get (), 2);
15181 }
15182 CATCH (ex, RETURN_MASK_ALL)
15183 {
15184 current_uiout->redirect (NULL);
15185 throw_exception (ex);
15186 }
15187 END_CATCH
15188
15189 current_uiout->redirect (NULL);
15190 fp.puts (" end\n");
15191 }
15192
15193 if (tp->enable_state == bp_disabled)
15194 fp.puts ("disable $bpnum\n");
15195
15196 /* If this is a multi-location breakpoint, check if the locations
15197 should be individually disabled. Watchpoint locations are
15198 special, and not user visible. */
15199 if (!is_watchpoint (tp) && tp->loc && tp->loc->next)
15200 {
15201 struct bp_location *loc;
15202 int n = 1;
15203
15204 for (loc = tp->loc; loc != NULL; loc = loc->next, n++)
15205 if (!loc->enabled)
15206 fp.printf ("disable $bpnum.%d\n", n);
15207 }
15208 }
15209
15210 if (extra_trace_bits && *default_collect)
15211 fp.printf ("set default-collect %s\n", default_collect);
15212
15213 if (from_tty)
15214 printf_filtered (_("Saved to file '%s'.\n"), expanded_filename.get ());
15215 }
15216
15217 /* The `save breakpoints' command. */
15218
15219 static void
15220 save_breakpoints_command (const char *args, int from_tty)
15221 {
15222 save_breakpoints (args, from_tty, NULL);
15223 }
15224
15225 /* The `save tracepoints' command. */
15226
15227 static void
15228 save_tracepoints_command (const char *args, int from_tty)
15229 {
15230 save_breakpoints (args, from_tty, is_tracepoint);
15231 }
15232
15233 /* Create a vector of all tracepoints. */
15234
15235 VEC(breakpoint_p) *
15236 all_tracepoints (void)
15237 {
15238 VEC(breakpoint_p) *tp_vec = 0;
15239 struct breakpoint *tp;
15240
15241 ALL_TRACEPOINTS (tp)
15242 {
15243 VEC_safe_push (breakpoint_p, tp_vec, tp);
15244 }
15245
15246 return tp_vec;
15247 }
15248
15249 \f
15250 /* This help string is used to consolidate all the help string for specifying
15251 locations used by several commands. */
15252
15253 #define LOCATION_HELP_STRING \
15254 "Linespecs are colon-separated lists of location parameters, such as\n\
15255 source filename, function name, label name, and line number.\n\
15256 Example: To specify the start of a label named \"the_top\" in the\n\
15257 function \"fact\" in the file \"factorial.c\", use\n\
15258 \"factorial.c:fact:the_top\".\n\
15259 \n\
15260 Address locations begin with \"*\" and specify an exact address in the\n\
15261 program. Example: To specify the fourth byte past the start function\n\
15262 \"main\", use \"*main + 4\".\n\
15263 \n\
15264 Explicit locations are similar to linespecs but use an option/argument\n\
15265 syntax to specify location parameters.\n\
15266 Example: To specify the start of the label named \"the_top\" in the\n\
15267 function \"fact\" in the file \"factorial.c\", use \"-source factorial.c\n\
15268 -function fact -label the_top\".\n\
15269 \n\
15270 By default, a specified function is matched against the program's\n\
15271 functions in all scopes. For C++, this means in all namespaces and\n\
15272 classes. For Ada, this means in all packages. E.g., in C++,\n\
15273 \"func()\" matches \"A::func()\", \"A::B::func()\", etc. The\n\
15274 \"-qualified\" flag overrides this behavior, making GDB interpret the\n\
15275 specified name as a complete fully-qualified name instead.\n"
15276
15277 /* This help string is used for the break, hbreak, tbreak and thbreak
15278 commands. It is defined as a macro to prevent duplication.
15279 COMMAND should be a string constant containing the name of the
15280 command. */
15281
15282 #define BREAK_ARGS_HELP(command) \
15283 command" [PROBE_MODIFIER] [LOCATION] [thread THREADNUM] [if CONDITION]\n\
15284 PROBE_MODIFIER shall be present if the command is to be placed in a\n\
15285 probe point. Accepted values are `-probe' (for a generic, automatically\n\
15286 guessed probe type), `-probe-stap' (for a SystemTap probe) or \n\
15287 `-probe-dtrace' (for a DTrace probe).\n\
15288 LOCATION may be a linespec, address, or explicit location as described\n\
15289 below.\n\
15290 \n\
15291 With no LOCATION, uses current execution address of the selected\n\
15292 stack frame. This is useful for breaking on return to a stack frame.\n\
15293 \n\
15294 THREADNUM is the number from \"info threads\".\n\
15295 CONDITION is a boolean expression.\n\
15296 \n" LOCATION_HELP_STRING "\n\
15297 Multiple breakpoints at one place are permitted, and useful if their\n\
15298 conditions are different.\n\
15299 \n\
15300 Do \"help breakpoints\" for info on other commands dealing with breakpoints."
15301
15302 /* List of subcommands for "catch". */
15303 static struct cmd_list_element *catch_cmdlist;
15304
15305 /* List of subcommands for "tcatch". */
15306 static struct cmd_list_element *tcatch_cmdlist;
15307
15308 void
15309 add_catch_command (const char *name, const char *docstring,
15310 cmd_const_sfunc_ftype *sfunc,
15311 completer_ftype *completer,
15312 void *user_data_catch,
15313 void *user_data_tcatch)
15314 {
15315 struct cmd_list_element *command;
15316
15317 command = add_cmd (name, class_breakpoint, docstring,
15318 &catch_cmdlist);
15319 set_cmd_sfunc (command, sfunc);
15320 set_cmd_context (command, user_data_catch);
15321 set_cmd_completer (command, completer);
15322
15323 command = add_cmd (name, class_breakpoint, docstring,
15324 &tcatch_cmdlist);
15325 set_cmd_sfunc (command, sfunc);
15326 set_cmd_context (command, user_data_tcatch);
15327 set_cmd_completer (command, completer);
15328 }
15329
15330 static void
15331 save_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
15332 {
15333 printf_unfiltered (_("\"save\" must be followed by "
15334 "the name of a save subcommand.\n"));
15335 help_list (save_cmdlist, "save ", all_commands, gdb_stdout);
15336 }
15337
15338 struct breakpoint *
15339 iterate_over_breakpoints (int (*callback) (struct breakpoint *, void *),
15340 void *data)
15341 {
15342 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
15343
15344 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
15345 {
15346 if ((*callback) (b, data))
15347 return b;
15348 }
15349
15350 return NULL;
15351 }
15352
15353 /* Zero if any of the breakpoint's locations could be a location where
15354 functions have been inlined, nonzero otherwise. */
15355
15356 static int
15357 is_non_inline_function (struct breakpoint *b)
15358 {
15359 /* The shared library event breakpoint is set on the address of a
15360 non-inline function. */
15361 if (b->type == bp_shlib_event)
15362 return 1;
15363
15364 return 0;
15365 }
15366
15367 /* Nonzero if the specified PC cannot be a location where functions
15368 have been inlined. */
15369
15370 int
15371 pc_at_non_inline_function (const address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR pc,
15372 const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
15373 {
15374 struct breakpoint *b;
15375 struct bp_location *bl;
15376
15377 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
15378 {
15379 if (!is_non_inline_function (b))
15380 continue;
15381
15382 for (bl = b->loc; bl != NULL; bl = bl->next)
15383 {
15384 if (!bl->shlib_disabled
15385 && bpstat_check_location (bl, aspace, pc, ws))
15386 return 1;
15387 }
15388 }
15389
15390 return 0;
15391 }
15392
15393 /* Remove any references to OBJFILE which is going to be freed. */
15394
15395 void
15396 breakpoint_free_objfile (struct objfile *objfile)
15397 {
15398 struct bp_location **locp, *loc;
15399
15400 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (loc, locp)
15401 if (loc->symtab != NULL && SYMTAB_OBJFILE (loc->symtab) == objfile)
15402 loc->symtab = NULL;
15403 }
15404
15405 void
15406 initialize_breakpoint_ops (void)
15407 {
15408 static int initialized = 0;
15409
15410 struct breakpoint_ops *ops;
15411
15412 if (initialized)
15413 return;
15414 initialized = 1;
15415
15416 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be inherit by all kinds of
15417 breakpoints (real breakpoints, i.e., user "break" breakpoints,
15418 internal and momentary breakpoints, etc.). */
15419 ops = &bkpt_base_breakpoint_ops;
15420 *ops = base_breakpoint_ops;
15421 ops->re_set = bkpt_re_set;
15422 ops->insert_location = bkpt_insert_location;
15423 ops->remove_location = bkpt_remove_location;
15424 ops->breakpoint_hit = bkpt_breakpoint_hit;
15425 ops->create_sals_from_location = bkpt_create_sals_from_location;
15426 ops->create_breakpoints_sal = bkpt_create_breakpoints_sal;
15427 ops->decode_location = bkpt_decode_location;
15428
15429 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used in regular breakpoints. */
15430 ops = &bkpt_breakpoint_ops;
15431 *ops = bkpt_base_breakpoint_ops;
15432 ops->re_set = bkpt_re_set;
15433 ops->resources_needed = bkpt_resources_needed;
15434 ops->print_it = bkpt_print_it;
15435 ops->print_mention = bkpt_print_mention;
15436 ops->print_recreate = bkpt_print_recreate;
15437
15438 /* Ranged breakpoints. */
15439 ops = &ranged_breakpoint_ops;
15440 *ops = bkpt_breakpoint_ops;
15441 ops->breakpoint_hit = breakpoint_hit_ranged_breakpoint;
15442 ops->resources_needed = resources_needed_ranged_breakpoint;
15443 ops->print_it = print_it_ranged_breakpoint;
15444 ops->print_one = print_one_ranged_breakpoint;
15445 ops->print_one_detail = print_one_detail_ranged_breakpoint;
15446 ops->print_mention = print_mention_ranged_breakpoint;
15447 ops->print_recreate = print_recreate_ranged_breakpoint;
15448
15449 /* Internal breakpoints. */
15450 ops = &internal_breakpoint_ops;
15451 *ops = bkpt_base_breakpoint_ops;
15452 ops->re_set = internal_bkpt_re_set;
15453 ops->check_status = internal_bkpt_check_status;
15454 ops->print_it = internal_bkpt_print_it;
15455 ops->print_mention = internal_bkpt_print_mention;
15456
15457 /* Momentary breakpoints. */
15458 ops = &momentary_breakpoint_ops;
15459 *ops = bkpt_base_breakpoint_ops;
15460 ops->re_set = momentary_bkpt_re_set;
15461 ops->check_status = momentary_bkpt_check_status;
15462 ops->print_it = momentary_bkpt_print_it;
15463 ops->print_mention = momentary_bkpt_print_mention;
15464
15465 /* Probe breakpoints. */
15466 ops = &bkpt_probe_breakpoint_ops;
15467 *ops = bkpt_breakpoint_ops;
15468 ops->insert_location = bkpt_probe_insert_location;
15469 ops->remove_location = bkpt_probe_remove_location;
15470 ops->create_sals_from_location = bkpt_probe_create_sals_from_location;
15471 ops->decode_location = bkpt_probe_decode_location;
15472
15473 /* Watchpoints. */
15474 ops = &watchpoint_breakpoint_ops;
15475 *ops = base_breakpoint_ops;
15476 ops->re_set = re_set_watchpoint;
15477 ops->insert_location = insert_watchpoint;
15478 ops->remove_location = remove_watchpoint;
15479 ops->breakpoint_hit = breakpoint_hit_watchpoint;
15480 ops->check_status = check_status_watchpoint;
15481 ops->resources_needed = resources_needed_watchpoint;
15482 ops->works_in_software_mode = works_in_software_mode_watchpoint;
15483 ops->print_it = print_it_watchpoint;
15484 ops->print_mention = print_mention_watchpoint;
15485 ops->print_recreate = print_recreate_watchpoint;
15486 ops->explains_signal = explains_signal_watchpoint;
15487
15488 /* Masked watchpoints. */
15489 ops = &masked_watchpoint_breakpoint_ops;
15490 *ops = watchpoint_breakpoint_ops;
15491 ops->insert_location = insert_masked_watchpoint;
15492 ops->remove_location = remove_masked_watchpoint;
15493 ops->resources_needed = resources_needed_masked_watchpoint;
15494 ops->works_in_software_mode = works_in_software_mode_masked_watchpoint;
15495 ops->print_it = print_it_masked_watchpoint;
15496 ops->print_one_detail = print_one_detail_masked_watchpoint;
15497 ops->print_mention = print_mention_masked_watchpoint;
15498 ops->print_recreate = print_recreate_masked_watchpoint;
15499
15500 /* Tracepoints. */
15501 ops = &tracepoint_breakpoint_ops;
15502 *ops = base_breakpoint_ops;
15503 ops->re_set = tracepoint_re_set;
15504 ops->breakpoint_hit = tracepoint_breakpoint_hit;
15505 ops->print_one_detail = tracepoint_print_one_detail;
15506 ops->print_mention = tracepoint_print_mention;
15507 ops->print_recreate = tracepoint_print_recreate;
15508 ops->create_sals_from_location = tracepoint_create_sals_from_location;
15509 ops->create_breakpoints_sal = tracepoint_create_breakpoints_sal;
15510 ops->decode_location = tracepoint_decode_location;
15511
15512 /* Probe tracepoints. */
15513 ops = &tracepoint_probe_breakpoint_ops;
15514 *ops = tracepoint_breakpoint_ops;
15515 ops->create_sals_from_location = tracepoint_probe_create_sals_from_location;
15516 ops->decode_location = tracepoint_probe_decode_location;
15517
15518 /* Static tracepoints with marker (`-m'). */
15519 ops = &strace_marker_breakpoint_ops;
15520 *ops = tracepoint_breakpoint_ops;
15521 ops->create_sals_from_location = strace_marker_create_sals_from_location;
15522 ops->create_breakpoints_sal = strace_marker_create_breakpoints_sal;
15523 ops->decode_location = strace_marker_decode_location;
15524
15525 /* Fork catchpoints. */
15526 ops = &catch_fork_breakpoint_ops;
15527 *ops = base_breakpoint_ops;
15528 ops->insert_location = insert_catch_fork;
15529 ops->remove_location = remove_catch_fork;
15530 ops->breakpoint_hit = breakpoint_hit_catch_fork;
15531 ops->print_it = print_it_catch_fork;
15532 ops->print_one = print_one_catch_fork;
15533 ops->print_mention = print_mention_catch_fork;
15534 ops->print_recreate = print_recreate_catch_fork;
15535
15536 /* Vfork catchpoints. */
15537 ops = &catch_vfork_breakpoint_ops;
15538 *ops = base_breakpoint_ops;
15539 ops->insert_location = insert_catch_vfork;
15540 ops->remove_location = remove_catch_vfork;
15541 ops->breakpoint_hit = breakpoint_hit_catch_vfork;
15542 ops->print_it = print_it_catch_vfork;
15543 ops->print_one = print_one_catch_vfork;
15544 ops->print_mention = print_mention_catch_vfork;
15545 ops->print_recreate = print_recreate_catch_vfork;
15546
15547 /* Exec catchpoints. */
15548 ops = &catch_exec_breakpoint_ops;
15549 *ops = base_breakpoint_ops;
15550 ops->insert_location = insert_catch_exec;
15551 ops->remove_location = remove_catch_exec;
15552 ops->breakpoint_hit = breakpoint_hit_catch_exec;
15553 ops->print_it = print_it_catch_exec;
15554 ops->print_one = print_one_catch_exec;
15555 ops->print_mention = print_mention_catch_exec;
15556 ops->print_recreate = print_recreate_catch_exec;
15557
15558 /* Solib-related catchpoints. */
15559 ops = &catch_solib_breakpoint_ops;
15560 *ops = base_breakpoint_ops;
15561 ops->insert_location = insert_catch_solib;
15562 ops->remove_location = remove_catch_solib;
15563 ops->breakpoint_hit = breakpoint_hit_catch_solib;
15564 ops->check_status = check_status_catch_solib;
15565 ops->print_it = print_it_catch_solib;
15566 ops->print_one = print_one_catch_solib;
15567 ops->print_mention = print_mention_catch_solib;
15568 ops->print_recreate = print_recreate_catch_solib;
15569
15570 ops = &dprintf_breakpoint_ops;
15571 *ops = bkpt_base_breakpoint_ops;
15572 ops->re_set = dprintf_re_set;
15573 ops->resources_needed = bkpt_resources_needed;
15574 ops->print_it = bkpt_print_it;
15575 ops->print_mention = bkpt_print_mention;
15576 ops->print_recreate = dprintf_print_recreate;
15577 ops->after_condition_true = dprintf_after_condition_true;
15578 ops->breakpoint_hit = dprintf_breakpoint_hit;
15579 }
15580
15581 /* Chain containing all defined "enable breakpoint" subcommands. */
15582
15583 static struct cmd_list_element *enablebreaklist = NULL;
15584
15585 void
15586 _initialize_breakpoint (void)
15587 {
15588 struct cmd_list_element *c;
15589
15590 initialize_breakpoint_ops ();
15591
15592 observer_attach_solib_unloaded (disable_breakpoints_in_unloaded_shlib);
15593 observer_attach_free_objfile (disable_breakpoints_in_freed_objfile);
15594 observer_attach_memory_changed (invalidate_bp_value_on_memory_change);
15595
15596 breakpoint_objfile_key
15597 = register_objfile_data_with_cleanup (NULL, free_breakpoint_objfile_data);
15598
15599 breakpoint_chain = 0;
15600 /* Don't bother to call set_breakpoint_count. $bpnum isn't useful
15601 before a breakpoint is set. */
15602 breakpoint_count = 0;
15603
15604 tracepoint_count = 0;
15605
15606 add_com ("ignore", class_breakpoint, ignore_command, _("\
15607 Set ignore-count of breakpoint number N to COUNT.\n\
15608 Usage is `ignore N COUNT'."));
15609
15610 add_com ("commands", class_breakpoint, commands_command, _("\
15611 Set commands to be executed when the given breakpoints are hit.\n\
15612 Give a space-separated breakpoint list as argument after \"commands\".\n\
15613 A list element can be a breakpoint number (e.g. `5') or a range of numbers\n\
15614 (e.g. `5-7').\n\
15615 With no argument, the targeted breakpoint is the last one set.\n\
15616 The commands themselves follow starting on the next line.\n\
15617 Type a line containing \"end\" to indicate the end of them.\n\
15618 Give \"silent\" as the first line to make the breakpoint silent;\n\
15619 then no output is printed when it is hit, except what the commands print."));
15620
15621 c = add_com ("condition", class_breakpoint, condition_command, _("\
15622 Specify breakpoint number N to break only if COND is true.\n\
15623 Usage is `condition N COND', where N is an integer and COND is an\n\
15624 expression to be evaluated whenever breakpoint N is reached."));
15625 set_cmd_completer (c, condition_completer);
15626
15627 c = add_com ("tbreak", class_breakpoint, tbreak_command, _("\
15628 Set a temporary breakpoint.\n\
15629 Like \"break\" except the breakpoint is only temporary,\n\
15630 so it will be deleted when hit. Equivalent to \"break\" followed\n\
15631 by using \"enable delete\" on the breakpoint number.\n\
15632 \n"
15633 BREAK_ARGS_HELP ("tbreak")));
15634 set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer);
15635
15636 c = add_com ("hbreak", class_breakpoint, hbreak_command, _("\
15637 Set a hardware assisted breakpoint.\n\
15638 Like \"break\" except the breakpoint requires hardware support,\n\
15639 some target hardware may not have this support.\n\
15640 \n"
15641 BREAK_ARGS_HELP ("hbreak")));
15642 set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer);
15643
15644 c = add_com ("thbreak", class_breakpoint, thbreak_command, _("\
15645 Set a temporary hardware assisted breakpoint.\n\
15646 Like \"hbreak\" except the breakpoint is only temporary,\n\
15647 so it will be deleted when hit.\n\
15648 \n"
15649 BREAK_ARGS_HELP ("thbreak")));
15650 set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer);
15651
15652 add_prefix_cmd ("enable", class_breakpoint, enable_command, _("\
15653 Enable some breakpoints.\n\
15654 Give breakpoint numbers (separated by spaces) as arguments.\n\
15655 With no subcommand, breakpoints are enabled until you command otherwise.\n\
15656 This is used to cancel the effect of the \"disable\" command.\n\
15657 With a subcommand you can enable temporarily."),
15658 &enablelist, "enable ", 1, &cmdlist);
15659
15660 add_com_alias ("en", "enable", class_breakpoint, 1);
15661
15662 add_prefix_cmd ("breakpoints", class_breakpoint, enable_command, _("\
15663 Enable some breakpoints.\n\
15664 Give breakpoint numbers (separated by spaces) as arguments.\n\
15665 This is used to cancel the effect of the \"disable\" command.\n\
15666 May be abbreviated to simply \"enable\".\n"),
15667 &enablebreaklist, "enable breakpoints ", 1, &enablelist);
15668
15669 add_cmd ("once", no_class, enable_once_command, _("\
15670 Enable breakpoints for one hit. Give breakpoint numbers.\n\
15671 If a breakpoint is hit while enabled in this fashion, it becomes disabled."),
15672 &enablebreaklist);
15673
15674 add_cmd ("delete", no_class, enable_delete_command, _("\
15675 Enable breakpoints and delete when hit. Give breakpoint numbers.\n\
15676 If a breakpoint is hit while enabled in this fashion, it is deleted."),
15677 &enablebreaklist);
15678
15679 add_cmd ("count", no_class, enable_count_command, _("\
15680 Enable breakpoints for COUNT hits. Give count and then breakpoint numbers.\n\
15681 If a breakpoint is hit while enabled in this fashion,\n\
15682 the count is decremented; when it reaches zero, the breakpoint is disabled."),
15683 &enablebreaklist);
15684
15685 add_cmd ("delete", no_class, enable_delete_command, _("\
15686 Enable breakpoints and delete when hit. Give breakpoint numbers.\n\
15687 If a breakpoint is hit while enabled in this fashion, it is deleted."),
15688 &enablelist);
15689
15690 add_cmd ("once", no_class, enable_once_command, _("\
15691 Enable breakpoints for one hit. Give breakpoint numbers.\n\
15692 If a breakpoint is hit while enabled in this fashion, it becomes disabled."),
15693 &enablelist);
15694
15695 add_cmd ("count", no_class, enable_count_command, _("\
15696 Enable breakpoints for COUNT hits. Give count and then breakpoint numbers.\n\
15697 If a breakpoint is hit while enabled in this fashion,\n\
15698 the count is decremented; when it reaches zero, the breakpoint is disabled."),
15699 &enablelist);
15700
15701 add_prefix_cmd ("disable", class_breakpoint, disable_command, _("\
15702 Disable some breakpoints.\n\
15703 Arguments are breakpoint numbers with spaces in between.\n\
15704 To disable all breakpoints, give no argument.\n\
15705 A disabled breakpoint is not forgotten, but has no effect until re-enabled."),
15706 &disablelist, "disable ", 1, &cmdlist);
15707 add_com_alias ("dis", "disable", class_breakpoint, 1);
15708 add_com_alias ("disa", "disable", class_breakpoint, 1);
15709
15710 add_cmd ("breakpoints", class_alias, disable_command, _("\
15711 Disable some breakpoints.\n\
15712 Arguments are breakpoint numbers with spaces in between.\n\
15713 To disable all breakpoints, give no argument.\n\
15714 A disabled breakpoint is not forgotten, but has no effect until re-enabled.\n\
15715 This command may be abbreviated \"disable\"."),
15716 &disablelist);
15717
15718 add_prefix_cmd ("delete", class_breakpoint, delete_command, _("\
15719 Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions.\n\
15720 Arguments are breakpoint numbers with spaces in between.\n\
15721 To delete all breakpoints, give no argument.\n\
15722 \n\
15723 Also a prefix command for deletion of other GDB objects.\n\
15724 The \"unset\" command is also an alias for \"delete\"."),
15725 &deletelist, "delete ", 1, &cmdlist);
15726 add_com_alias ("d", "delete", class_breakpoint, 1);
15727 add_com_alias ("del", "delete", class_breakpoint, 1);
15728
15729 add_cmd ("breakpoints", class_alias, delete_command, _("\
15730 Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions.\n\
15731 Arguments are breakpoint numbers with spaces in between.\n\
15732 To delete all breakpoints, give no argument.\n\
15733 This command may be abbreviated \"delete\"."),
15734 &deletelist);
15735
15736 add_com ("clear", class_breakpoint, clear_command, _("\
15737 Clear breakpoint at specified location.\n\
15738 Argument may be a linespec, explicit, or address location as described below.\n\
15739 \n\
15740 With no argument, clears all breakpoints in the line that the selected frame\n\
15741 is executing in.\n"
15742 "\n" LOCATION_HELP_STRING "\n\
15743 See also the \"delete\" command which clears breakpoints by number."));
15744 add_com_alias ("cl", "clear", class_breakpoint, 1);
15745
15746 c = add_com ("break", class_breakpoint, break_command, _("\
15747 Set breakpoint at specified location.\n"
15748 BREAK_ARGS_HELP ("break")));
15749 set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer);
15750
15751 add_com_alias ("b", "break", class_run, 1);
15752 add_com_alias ("br", "break", class_run, 1);
15753 add_com_alias ("bre", "break", class_run, 1);
15754 add_com_alias ("brea", "break", class_run, 1);
15755
15756 if (dbx_commands)
15757 {
15758 add_abbrev_prefix_cmd ("stop", class_breakpoint, stop_command, _("\
15759 Break in function/address or break at a line in the current file."),
15760 &stoplist, "stop ", 1, &cmdlist);
15761 add_cmd ("in", class_breakpoint, stopin_command,
15762 _("Break in function or address."), &stoplist);
15763 add_cmd ("at", class_breakpoint, stopat_command,
15764 _("Break at a line in the current file."), &stoplist);
15765 add_com ("status", class_info, info_breakpoints_command, _("\
15766 Status of user-settable breakpoints, or breakpoint number NUMBER.\n\
15767 The \"Type\" column indicates one of:\n\
15768 \tbreakpoint - normal breakpoint\n\
15769 \twatchpoint - watchpoint\n\
15770 The \"Disp\" column contains one of \"keep\", \"del\", or \"dis\" to indicate\n\
15771 the disposition of the breakpoint after it gets hit. \"dis\" means that the\n\
15772 breakpoint will be disabled. The \"Address\" and \"What\" columns indicate the\n\
15773 address and file/line number respectively.\n\
15774 \n\
15775 Convenience variable \"$_\" and default examine address for \"x\"\n\
15776 are set to the address of the last breakpoint listed unless the command\n\
15777 is prefixed with \"server \".\n\n\
15778 Convenience variable \"$bpnum\" contains the number of the last\n\
15779 breakpoint set."));
15780 }
15781
15782 add_info ("breakpoints", info_breakpoints_command, _("\
15783 Status of specified breakpoints (all user-settable breakpoints if no argument).\n\
15784 The \"Type\" column indicates one of:\n\
15785 \tbreakpoint - normal breakpoint\n\
15786 \twatchpoint - watchpoint\n\
15787 The \"Disp\" column contains one of \"keep\", \"del\", or \"dis\" to indicate\n\
15788 the disposition of the breakpoint after it gets hit. \"dis\" means that the\n\
15789 breakpoint will be disabled. The \"Address\" and \"What\" columns indicate the\n\
15790 address and file/line number respectively.\n\
15791 \n\
15792 Convenience variable \"$_\" and default examine address for \"x\"\n\
15793 are set to the address of the last breakpoint listed unless the command\n\
15794 is prefixed with \"server \".\n\n\
15795 Convenience variable \"$bpnum\" contains the number of the last\n\
15796 breakpoint set."));
15797
15798 add_info_alias ("b", "breakpoints", 1);
15799
15800 add_cmd ("breakpoints", class_maintenance, maintenance_info_breakpoints, _("\
15801 Status of all breakpoints, or breakpoint number NUMBER.\n\
15802 The \"Type\" column indicates one of:\n\
15803 \tbreakpoint - normal breakpoint\n\
15804 \twatchpoint - watchpoint\n\
15805 \tlongjmp - internal breakpoint used to step through longjmp()\n\
15806 \tlongjmp resume - internal breakpoint at the target of longjmp()\n\
15807 \tuntil - internal breakpoint used by the \"until\" command\n\
15808 \tfinish - internal breakpoint used by the \"finish\" command\n\
15809 The \"Disp\" column contains one of \"keep\", \"del\", or \"dis\" to indicate\n\
15810 the disposition of the breakpoint after it gets hit. \"dis\" means that the\n\
15811 breakpoint will be disabled. The \"Address\" and \"What\" columns indicate the\n\
15812 address and file/line number respectively.\n\
15813 \n\
15814 Convenience variable \"$_\" and default examine address for \"x\"\n\
15815 are set to the address of the last breakpoint listed unless the command\n\
15816 is prefixed with \"server \".\n\n\
15817 Convenience variable \"$bpnum\" contains the number of the last\n\
15818 breakpoint set."),
15819 &maintenanceinfolist);
15820
15821 add_prefix_cmd ("catch", class_breakpoint, catch_command, _("\
15822 Set catchpoints to catch events."),
15823 &catch_cmdlist, "catch ",
15824 0/*allow-unknown*/, &cmdlist);
15825
15826 add_prefix_cmd ("tcatch", class_breakpoint, tcatch_command, _("\
15827 Set temporary catchpoints to catch events."),
15828 &tcatch_cmdlist, "tcatch ",
15829 0/*allow-unknown*/, &cmdlist);
15830
15831 add_catch_command ("fork", _("Catch calls to fork."),
15832 catch_fork_command_1,
15833 NULL,
15834 (void *) (uintptr_t) catch_fork_permanent,
15835 (void *) (uintptr_t) catch_fork_temporary);
15836 add_catch_command ("vfork", _("Catch calls to vfork."),
15837 catch_fork_command_1,
15838 NULL,
15839 (void *) (uintptr_t) catch_vfork_permanent,
15840 (void *) (uintptr_t) catch_vfork_temporary);
15841 add_catch_command ("exec", _("Catch calls to exec."),
15842 catch_exec_command_1,
15843 NULL,
15844 CATCH_PERMANENT,
15845 CATCH_TEMPORARY);
15846 add_catch_command ("load", _("Catch loads of shared libraries.\n\
15847 Usage: catch load [REGEX]\n\
15848 If REGEX is given, only stop for libraries matching the regular expression."),
15849 catch_load_command_1,
15850 NULL,
15851 CATCH_PERMANENT,
15852 CATCH_TEMPORARY);
15853 add_catch_command ("unload", _("Catch unloads of shared libraries.\n\
15854 Usage: catch unload [REGEX]\n\
15855 If REGEX is given, only stop for libraries matching the regular expression."),
15856 catch_unload_command_1,
15857 NULL,
15858 CATCH_PERMANENT,
15859 CATCH_TEMPORARY);
15860
15861 c = add_com ("watch", class_breakpoint, watch_command, _("\
15862 Set a watchpoint for an expression.\n\
15863 Usage: watch [-l|-location] EXPRESSION\n\
15864 A watchpoint stops execution of your program whenever the value of\n\
15865 an expression changes.\n\
15866 If -l or -location is given, this evaluates EXPRESSION and watches\n\
15867 the memory to which it refers."));
15868 set_cmd_completer (c, expression_completer);
15869
15870 c = add_com ("rwatch", class_breakpoint, rwatch_command, _("\
15871 Set a read watchpoint for an expression.\n\
15872 Usage: rwatch [-l|-location] EXPRESSION\n\
15873 A watchpoint stops execution of your program whenever the value of\n\
15874 an expression is read.\n\
15875 If -l or -location is given, this evaluates EXPRESSION and watches\n\
15876 the memory to which it refers."));
15877 set_cmd_completer (c, expression_completer);
15878
15879 c = add_com ("awatch", class_breakpoint, awatch_command, _("\
15880 Set a watchpoint for an expression.\n\
15881 Usage: awatch [-l|-location] EXPRESSION\n\
15882 A watchpoint stops execution of your program whenever the value of\n\
15883 an expression is either read or written.\n\
15884 If -l or -location is given, this evaluates EXPRESSION and watches\n\
15885 the memory to which it refers."));
15886 set_cmd_completer (c, expression_completer);
15887
15888 add_info ("watchpoints", info_watchpoints_command, _("\
15889 Status of specified watchpoints (all watchpoints if no argument)."));
15890
15891 /* XXX: cagney/2005-02-23: This should be a boolean, and should
15892 respond to changes - contrary to the description. */
15893 add_setshow_zinteger_cmd ("can-use-hw-watchpoints", class_support,
15894 &can_use_hw_watchpoints, _("\
15895 Set debugger's willingness to use watchpoint hardware."), _("\
15896 Show debugger's willingness to use watchpoint hardware."), _("\
15897 If zero, gdb will not use hardware for new watchpoints, even if\n\
15898 such is available. (However, any hardware watchpoints that were\n\
15899 created before setting this to nonzero, will continue to use watchpoint\n\
15900 hardware.)"),
15901 NULL,
15902 show_can_use_hw_watchpoints,
15903 &setlist, &showlist);
15904
15905 can_use_hw_watchpoints = 1;
15906
15907 /* Tracepoint manipulation commands. */
15908
15909 c = add_com ("trace", class_breakpoint, trace_command, _("\
15910 Set a tracepoint at specified location.\n\
15911 \n"
15912 BREAK_ARGS_HELP ("trace") "\n\
15913 Do \"help tracepoints\" for info on other tracepoint commands."));
15914 set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer);
15915
15916 add_com_alias ("tp", "trace", class_alias, 0);
15917 add_com_alias ("tr", "trace", class_alias, 1);
15918 add_com_alias ("tra", "trace", class_alias, 1);
15919 add_com_alias ("trac", "trace", class_alias, 1);
15920
15921 c = add_com ("ftrace", class_breakpoint, ftrace_command, _("\
15922 Set a fast tracepoint at specified location.\n\
15923 \n"
15924 BREAK_ARGS_HELP ("ftrace") "\n\
15925 Do \"help tracepoints\" for info on other tracepoint commands."));
15926 set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer);
15927
15928 c = add_com ("strace", class_breakpoint, strace_command, _("\
15929 Set a static tracepoint at location or marker.\n\
15930 \n\
15931 strace [LOCATION] [if CONDITION]\n\
15932 LOCATION may be a linespec, explicit, or address location (described below) \n\
15933 or -m MARKER_ID.\n\n\
15934 If a marker id is specified, probe the marker with that name. With\n\
15935 no LOCATION, uses current execution address of the selected stack frame.\n\
15936 Static tracepoints accept an extra collect action -- ``collect $_sdata''.\n\
15937 This collects arbitrary user data passed in the probe point call to the\n\
15938 tracing library. You can inspect it when analyzing the trace buffer,\n\
15939 by printing the $_sdata variable like any other convenience variable.\n\
15940 \n\
15941 CONDITION is a boolean expression.\n\
15942 \n" LOCATION_HELP_STRING "\n\
15943 Multiple tracepoints at one place are permitted, and useful if their\n\
15944 conditions are different.\n\
15945 \n\
15946 Do \"help breakpoints\" for info on other commands dealing with breakpoints.\n\
15947 Do \"help tracepoints\" for info on other tracepoint commands."));
15948 set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer);
15949
15950 add_info ("tracepoints", info_tracepoints_command, _("\
15951 Status of specified tracepoints (all tracepoints if no argument).\n\
15952 Convenience variable \"$tpnum\" contains the number of the\n\
15953 last tracepoint set."));
15954
15955 add_info_alias ("tp", "tracepoints", 1);
15956
15957 add_cmd ("tracepoints", class_trace, delete_trace_command, _("\
15958 Delete specified tracepoints.\n\
15959 Arguments are tracepoint numbers, separated by spaces.\n\
15960 No argument means delete all tracepoints."),
15961 &deletelist);
15962 add_alias_cmd ("tr", "tracepoints", class_trace, 1, &deletelist);
15963
15964 c = add_cmd ("tracepoints", class_trace, disable_trace_command, _("\
15965 Disable specified tracepoints.\n\
15966 Arguments are tracepoint numbers, separated by spaces.\n\
15967 No argument means disable all tracepoints."),
15968 &disablelist);
15969 deprecate_cmd (c, "disable");
15970
15971 c = add_cmd ("tracepoints", class_trace, enable_trace_command, _("\
15972 Enable specified tracepoints.\n\
15973 Arguments are tracepoint numbers, separated by spaces.\n\
15974 No argument means enable all tracepoints."),
15975 &enablelist);
15976 deprecate_cmd (c, "enable");
15977
15978 add_com ("passcount", class_trace, trace_pass_command, _("\
15979 Set the passcount for a tracepoint.\n\
15980 The trace will end when the tracepoint has been passed 'count' times.\n\
15981 Usage: passcount COUNT TPNUM, where TPNUM may also be \"all\";\n\
15982 if TPNUM is omitted, passcount refers to the last tracepoint defined."));
15983
15984 add_prefix_cmd ("save", class_breakpoint, save_command,
15985 _("Save breakpoint definitions as a script."),
15986 &save_cmdlist, "save ",
15987 0/*allow-unknown*/, &cmdlist);
15988
15989 c = add_cmd ("breakpoints", class_breakpoint, save_breakpoints_command, _("\
15990 Save current breakpoint definitions as a script.\n\
15991 This includes all types of breakpoints (breakpoints, watchpoints,\n\
15992 catchpoints, tracepoints). Use the 'source' command in another debug\n\
15993 session to restore them."),
15994 &save_cmdlist);
15995 set_cmd_completer (c, filename_completer);
15996
15997 c = add_cmd ("tracepoints", class_trace, save_tracepoints_command, _("\
15998 Save current tracepoint definitions as a script.\n\
15999 Use the 'source' command in another debug session to restore them."),
16000 &save_cmdlist);
16001 set_cmd_completer (c, filename_completer);
16002
16003 c = add_com_alias ("save-tracepoints", "save tracepoints", class_trace, 0);
16004 deprecate_cmd (c, "save tracepoints");
16005
16006 add_prefix_cmd ("breakpoint", class_maintenance, set_breakpoint_cmd, _("\
16007 Breakpoint specific settings\n\
16008 Configure various breakpoint-specific variables such as\n\
16009 pending breakpoint behavior"),
16010 &breakpoint_set_cmdlist, "set breakpoint ",
16011 0/*allow-unknown*/, &setlist);
16012 add_prefix_cmd ("breakpoint", class_maintenance, show_breakpoint_cmd, _("\
16013 Breakpoint specific settings\n\
16014 Configure various breakpoint-specific variables such as\n\
16015 pending breakpoint behavior"),
16016 &breakpoint_show_cmdlist, "show breakpoint ",
16017 0/*allow-unknown*/, &showlist);
16018
16019 add_setshow_auto_boolean_cmd ("pending", no_class,
16020 &pending_break_support, _("\
16021 Set debugger's behavior regarding pending breakpoints."), _("\
16022 Show debugger's behavior regarding pending breakpoints."), _("\
16023 If on, an unrecognized breakpoint location will cause gdb to create a\n\
16024 pending breakpoint. If off, an unrecognized breakpoint location results in\n\
16025 an error. If auto, an unrecognized breakpoint location results in a\n\
16026 user-query to see if a pending breakpoint should be created."),
16027 NULL,
16028 show_pending_break_support,
16029 &breakpoint_set_cmdlist,
16030 &breakpoint_show_cmdlist);
16031
16032 pending_break_support = AUTO_BOOLEAN_AUTO;
16033
16034 add_setshow_boolean_cmd ("auto-hw", no_class,
16035 &automatic_hardware_breakpoints, _("\
16036 Set automatic usage of hardware breakpoints."), _("\
16037 Show automatic usage of hardware breakpoints."), _("\
16038 If set, the debugger will automatically use hardware breakpoints for\n\
16039 breakpoints set with \"break\" but falling in read-only memory. If not set,\n\
16040 a warning will be emitted for such breakpoints."),
16041 NULL,
16042 show_automatic_hardware_breakpoints,
16043 &breakpoint_set_cmdlist,
16044 &breakpoint_show_cmdlist);
16045
16046 add_setshow_boolean_cmd ("always-inserted", class_support,
16047 &always_inserted_mode, _("\
16048 Set mode for inserting breakpoints."), _("\
16049 Show mode for inserting breakpoints."), _("\
16050 When this mode is on, breakpoints are inserted immediately as soon as\n\
16051 they're created, kept inserted even when execution stops, and removed\n\
16052 only when the user deletes them. When this mode is off (the default),\n\
16053 breakpoints are inserted only when execution continues, and removed\n\
16054 when execution stops."),
16055 NULL,
16056 &show_always_inserted_mode,
16057 &breakpoint_set_cmdlist,
16058 &breakpoint_show_cmdlist);
16059
16060 add_setshow_enum_cmd ("condition-evaluation", class_breakpoint,
16061 condition_evaluation_enums,
16062 &condition_evaluation_mode_1, _("\
16063 Set mode of breakpoint condition evaluation."), _("\
16064 Show mode of breakpoint condition evaluation."), _("\
16065 When this is set to \"host\", breakpoint conditions will be\n\
16066 evaluated on the host's side by GDB. When it is set to \"target\",\n\
16067 breakpoint conditions will be downloaded to the target (if the target\n\
16068 supports such feature) and conditions will be evaluated on the target's side.\n\
16069 If this is set to \"auto\" (default), this will be automatically set to\n\
16070 \"target\" if it supports condition evaluation, otherwise it will\n\
16071 be set to \"gdb\""),
16072 &set_condition_evaluation_mode,
16073 &show_condition_evaluation_mode,
16074 &breakpoint_set_cmdlist,
16075 &breakpoint_show_cmdlist);
16076
16077 add_com ("break-range", class_breakpoint, break_range_command, _("\
16078 Set a breakpoint for an address range.\n\
16079 break-range START-LOCATION, END-LOCATION\n\
16080 where START-LOCATION and END-LOCATION can be one of the following:\n\
16081 LINENUM, for that line in the current file,\n\
16082 FILE:LINENUM, for that line in that file,\n\
16083 +OFFSET, for that number of lines after the current line\n\
16084 or the start of the range\n\
16085 FUNCTION, for the first line in that function,\n\
16086 FILE:FUNCTION, to distinguish among like-named static functions.\n\
16087 *ADDRESS, for the instruction at that address.\n\
16088 \n\
16089 The breakpoint will stop execution of the inferior whenever it executes\n\
16090 an instruction at any address within the [START-LOCATION, END-LOCATION]\n\
16091 range (including START-LOCATION and END-LOCATION)."));
16092
16093 c = add_com ("dprintf", class_breakpoint, dprintf_command, _("\
16094 Set a dynamic printf at specified location.\n\
16095 dprintf location,format string,arg1,arg2,...\n\
16096 location may be a linespec, explicit, or address location.\n"
16097 "\n" LOCATION_HELP_STRING));
16098 set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer);
16099
16100 add_setshow_enum_cmd ("dprintf-style", class_support,
16101 dprintf_style_enums, &dprintf_style, _("\
16102 Set the style of usage for dynamic printf."), _("\
16103 Show the style of usage for dynamic printf."), _("\
16104 This setting chooses how GDB will do a dynamic printf.\n\
16105 If the value is \"gdb\", then the printing is done by GDB to its own\n\
16106 console, as with the \"printf\" command.\n\
16107 If the value is \"call\", the print is done by calling a function in your\n\
16108 program; by default printf(), but you can choose a different function or\n\
16109 output stream by setting dprintf-function and dprintf-channel."),
16110 update_dprintf_commands, NULL,
16111 &setlist, &showlist);
16112
16113 dprintf_function = xstrdup ("printf");
16114 add_setshow_string_cmd ("dprintf-function", class_support,
16115 &dprintf_function, _("\
16116 Set the function to use for dynamic printf"), _("\
16117 Show the function to use for dynamic printf"), NULL,
16118 update_dprintf_commands, NULL,
16119 &setlist, &showlist);
16120
16121 dprintf_channel = xstrdup ("");
16122 add_setshow_string_cmd ("dprintf-channel", class_support,
16123 &dprintf_channel, _("\
16124 Set the channel to use for dynamic printf"), _("\
16125 Show the channel to use for dynamic printf"), NULL,
16126 update_dprintf_commands, NULL,
16127 &setlist, &showlist);
16128
16129 add_setshow_boolean_cmd ("disconnected-dprintf", no_class,
16130 &disconnected_dprintf, _("\
16131 Set whether dprintf continues after GDB disconnects."), _("\
16132 Show whether dprintf continues after GDB disconnects."), _("\
16133 Use this to let dprintf commands continue to hit and produce output\n\
16134 even if GDB disconnects or detaches from the target."),
16135 NULL,
16136 NULL,
16137 &setlist, &showlist);
16138
16139 add_com ("agent-printf", class_vars, agent_printf_command, _("\
16140 agent-printf \"printf format string\", arg1, arg2, arg3, ..., argn\n\
16141 (target agent only) This is useful for formatted output in user-defined commands."));
16142
16143 automatic_hardware_breakpoints = 1;
16144
16145 observer_attach_about_to_proceed (breakpoint_about_to_proceed);
16146 observer_attach_thread_exit (remove_threaded_breakpoints);
16147 }
This page took 0.395042 seconds and 4 git commands to generate.